Brother Laser Printer
Technical Reference Guide
<MODELS COVERED BY THIS MANUAL>
HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N
P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/
1650/1670N/3260N/2460
First version
Ver. A
August, 1999
March, 2000
Created for HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/
1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C
Revised for Addition of HL-2400Ce/3400CN
Ver. B
Ver. C
March, 2001
Revised for Addition of HL-1650/1670N/3260N/2460
Revised for Addition of HL-1450/1470N
October, 2001
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
GLOSSARY
CHAPTER 1 INTRODUCTION
1. ABOUT THE MANUAL----------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3
2. AREAS OF USE------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4
CHAPTER 2 PCL
1. COMMAND LIST------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 7
2. INTRODUCTION----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------10
3. CONTROLLING THE PRINTER ---------------------------------------------------------------------11
4. JOB CONTROL-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------15
5. USING FONTS-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------33
6. USING GRAPHICS--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------65
7. MACROS--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------85
8. STATUS READBACK----------------------------------------------------------------------------------91
9. INDEX------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------99
CHAPTER 3 PCL5C
1. INTRODUCTION----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3
2. COLOR MODES----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4
3. COLOR PALLETS--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------10
4. COLOR GRAPHICS------------------------------------------------------------------------------------13
5. ENHANCE OUTPUT------------------------------------------------------------------------------------15
6. HP-GL/2---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------17
7. INDEX-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------19
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 GRAPHICS LANGUAGE
1. COMMAND LIST------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4
2. INTRODUCTION----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6
3. TERMINOLOGY ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 7
4. COMMAND SYNTAX ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 9
5. THE HP-GL GRAPHICS WINDOW -----------------------------------------------------------------10
6. PREPARING TO PRINT GRAPHIC IMAGES------------------------------------------------------11
7. COMMANDS---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------12
8. INDEX-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------52
CHAPTER 5 PJL PRINTER JOB LANGUAGE
1. INTRODUCTION----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4
2. HOW TO USE PJL -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8
3. COMMAND GROUP------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 9
4. KERNEL COMMANDS---------------------------------------------------------------------------------10
5. JOB SEPARATION COMMANDS -------------------------------------------------------------------13
6. ENVIRONMENT COMMANDS------------------------------------------------------------------------15
7. STATUS READBACK COMMANDS ----------------------------------------------------------------30
8. DEVICE ATTENDANCE COMMANDS -------------------------------------------------------------45
9. INDEX------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------48
i
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
CHAPTER 6 EPSON FX-850
1. COMMAND LIST------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 3
2. INTRODUCTION----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5
3. EMULATION DETAILS ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6
4. TERMINOLOGY ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 7
5. CONTROLLING THE PRINTER ---------------------------------------------------------------------- 8
6. COMMANDS ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 9
7. INDEX------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------30
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER XL
1. COMMAND LIST------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 3
2. INTRODUCTION----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5
3. EMULATION DETAILS ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6
4. NOTATION USED IN THIS EMULATION DESCRIPTION--------------------------------------- 7
5. COMMANDS ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8
6. INDEX------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------21
CHAPTER 8 BARCODE CONTROL
1. INTRODUCTION----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3
2. PRINT BAR CODES OR EXPANDED CHARACTERS ----------------------------------------- 4
3. DEFINITION OF PARAMETERS---------------------------------------------------------------------- 5
4. EXAMPLE PROGRAM LISTINGS--------------------------------------------------------------------10
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL GRAPHICS LANGUAGE
1. COMMAND LIST------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 3
2. INTRODUCTION----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4
3. COMMANDS ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6
4. INDEX------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------27
APPENDIX A COMPARISON LIST
APPENDIX B FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS
APPENDIX-C HBP MODE COMMANDS
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000 SERIES UNIQUE
COMMANDS
ii
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
GLOSSARY
Absolute plotting
A method of plotting in the HP-GL and HP-GL/2 graphics language where
coordinates are specified relative to the origin of the coordinate system currently in
use.
Anchor point
The top left-hand corner of the PCL picture frame. You can position this on the
page using a PCL command.
Anisotropic scaling
A form of image scaling using the SC command in HP-GL and HP-GL/2 mode in
which the user units can be of different sizes. Hence the entire graphics window
can be used to display the image.
ASCII
The standard system for assigning number codes (0 ~ 255) to alphabetic, numeric
and control code characters.
Attribute
Bitmap font
Bold
A characteristic of a downloadable font or a character of a Downloadable font that
is represented by a number of a fixed length.
A font whose characters are defined as raster images. The characters that make
up a bitmap font are of a fixed size.
A wider line thickness for typographicalcharacters, used to make the text stand
out, for example, in headings.
Calling a macro
Cartridge
A way of running a macro in which changes to the modified print environment are
not retained when the macro has finished running.
A storage medium that you can insert into the printer cartridge slots. Cartridges
can store fonts. The advantage of using cartridges is that they allow you to use
more fonts without taking up printer memory space.
Cartridge font
A font that is stored on a cartridge. These are widely available commercially.
The imaginary grid on which downloadable characters are designed.
A number assigned to a character that uniquely identifies it.
Character cell
Character code
Character descriptor
A block of data that describes the characteristics of an individual character in a
downloadable font, such as its width and height.
Character set
A selection of different characters. Characters sets normally include the alphabet
in both upper- and lowercase, the digits' 0-9, punctuation marks, common
mathematical symbols and a few other useful characters. There are also some
specialized character sets that are used for specific applications like mathematics.
A font is defined as having a particular character set.
Column
A vertical sub-division of the page whose width is equal to the HMI (horizontal
motion index). The print position moves across the page one column width when
any single character is printed ( in a monospaced font), or when a space character
is printed ( in a proportionally spaced font). See also HMI.
iii
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Control code
An ASCII code that tells the computer to perform a particular function, such as a
carriage return.
Control panel reset
Cross-hatching
Current units
A reset or factory reset performed using the printer control panel.
A method of shading using perpendicular diagonal lines that cross one another.
The current unit type in use in HP-GL and HP-GL/2 mode. Current units are either
user units or graphics units depending on whether an SC command has been used.
Cursor
Although the printer does not have a cursor, it is sometimes easier to visualize the
printer's operation in terms of a cursor that can be moved from place to place on
the page.
Cursor position
Decipoint
The current position of the imaginary cursor.
A unit of measure equal to 1/720".
Default conditions
A set of HP-GL and HP-GL/2 mode settings that you restore using the DF;
command. The default conditions are a subset of the initial settings.
Destination image
Dots
The graphic image that is already in place on a page and to which the source image
is applied in the LaserJet series print model.
A unit of measure equal to 1/600", the smallest increment that the cursor can
move.
Downloadable font
A character font that can be downloaded from your computer to the printer. You
can either buy Downloadable fonts or create your own. A downloadable font
consists of a font descriptor block followed by a character code, character
descriptor block and the data for each character in the font.
Downloading
The process of sending either a font, a macro or a graphic image from your
computer to the printer.
Effective window
The area of the page on which HP-GL and HP-GL/2 output can appear. The
effective window is determined by the overlap of the logical page, the PCL picture
frame, the hard clip and the soft clip limits.
Emulation mode
A mode of operation in which the printer imitates the functions of a different model.
Enabling a macro for overlay
A macro that is enabled for overlay runs as the final operation before each page is
printed, using the macro overlay environment printer settings.
Escape sequence
The Esc character followed by a string of other characters that tell the printer
which operation to perform.
Factory default environment The collection of printer settings that have been made to the printer before it leaves
the factory. You can reset the printer to the factory settings either by using a
printer command or using the control panel.
Factory reset
A reset in which LaserJet mode is made the current emulation mode and the
factory default environment is restored.
iv
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Fill
A shading applied to a shape that you have drawn.
See monospacing.
Fixed spacing
Font
A collection of characters that are designed to work in harmony together. A font
has several characteristics that identify it uniquely: character or symbol set,
spacing, pitch, height or point size, style, stroke weight and typeface. Fonts can
either be resident in the printer's ROM, installed on cartridge or downloaded from
your computer. You can either buy downloadable fonts commercially or create
your own. The word "font" is often wrongly used to mean "typeface". A font is
confined to a single height or point size whereas a typeface is not.
Font descriptor
A block of data that is downloaded to the printer as the first part of a downloaded
font. The font descriptor describes the characteristics that are common to every
character in the font, such as stroke weight, and contains other relevant
information.
Graphics mode initial settings
The HP-GL and HP-GL/2 mode settings that are in effect when you enter HP-GL
and HP-GL/2 mode. You can restore the initial conditions using the IN; command.
Graphics units
The default units of the HP-GL and HP-GL/2 coordinate system. Also sometimes
called plotter units.
Graphics window
The area on the page in which HP-GL and HP-GL/2 graphic images can appear.
Initially this is the same as the picture frame, but you can change the size, position
and aspect ratio of the graphics window using the IW command.
Gray scale
A degree of continuous shading ranging from 0%, white, to 100%, black.
Hard clip limits
The area of the page on which it is physically possible to print using HP-GL and
HP-GL/2 graphics language commands. The hard clip limits are determined by the
size of the physical page and are equivalent to the LaserJet mode printable area.
Hatching
Height
A method of shading using parallel lines.
The height in typographic points (1/72" units) of an unaccented capital letter in a
font.
HMI
Horizontal motion index. The horizontal distance that the print position moves
across the page when any single character is printed ( in a monospaced font ), or
when a space character is printed ( in a proportionally spaced font ). You can set
the HMI using printer commands, however, when you alter any font characteristic
( in effect, select a new font ) or switch between the primary and secondary fonts,
the HMI is reset to its default value based on the newly selected font.
Horizontal plot size
Internal font
The original horizontal size of an imported HP-GL and HP-GL/2 image.
A font that is stored in the printer ROM and is therefore always available for use,
for example, Brougham 10 pitch, or a font generated from a scalable typeface
stored in the printer's ROM, for example, Tennessee bold 15 pt.
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Isotropic scaling
Justification
A form of image scaling using the SC command in HP-GL or HP-GL/2 mode in
which the user units must be of equal size. Hence it may not be possible to use the
entire graphics window to display the image.
The way in which text is aligned. For example, left justification involves aligning the
left end of every line of text.
Label
A text string that forms part of an HP-GL and HP-GL/2 plot.
Landscape
Logical page
The orientation in which the top edge of the page is longer than the side edges.
The area of the physical page on which the cursor can be positioned in LaserJet
mode. You can use PCL commands to specify the position of the logical page on
the physical page. Also known as the PCL addressable area.
LSB
i) The least significant byte of a set of data bytes.
ii) The least significant bit of a single byte of data.
Macro
A sequence of PCL commands that can be stored in the printer memory. To run
the sequence you need only use a single PCL command.
Macro execution
Executing a macro is a way of running a macro whereby any changes made to the
modified print environment by the macro are retained when macro execution has
been completed.
Macro overlay environment Used only by a macro that has been enabled for overlay. A combination of the
user default environment and the modified print environment.
Medium
The line thickness of normal type.
Modified print environment The collection of all current LaserJet printer settings. This environment is saved if
you call a macro or enter HP-GL and HP-GL/2 mode, it is restored when the
macro has finished running or when you quit HP-GL or HP-GL/2 mode.
Monospacing
MSB
Some bitmap fonts are printed with each character occupying the same space on a
line of text. This is known as monospacing.
i) The most significant byte of a set of data bytes.
ii) The most significant bit of a single byte of data.
Pattern
i) The hatching or cross-hatching that can be applied to an outline shape.
ii) The non-white areas of the source image in the LaserJet print model.
Pattern transparency
The patterned ( non-white ) areas of the source image are either transparent, in
which case the destination image is visible through the white parts of the pattern, or
opaque, in which case the destination image is not visible at all throughout the
patterned areas of the source image.
PCL
Printer Control Language. The language consisting of escape sequences that is
used to control the printer in LaserJet mode
PCL addressable area
PCL picture frame
See logical page.
See picture frame.
vi
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Pen
Although this printer is a laser printer the HP-GL/2 and HP-GL graphics languages
retains the notion of a pen and allows you to select between two pens, white and
black. You must select a pen before you can draw anything. The HP-GL and HP-
GL/2 language were originally developed for use with plotters and the terminology
remains.
Perforation skip
A feature whereby the printer automatically compensates for a page break and
resumes printing from the top of the text area on the next page.
Permanent font
Permanent macro
Physical page
A downloaded font that is retained when a printer reset is performed.
A macro stored in the printer that will not be erased if the printer is reset.
The paper or envelope on which the printer prints.
Picture frame
The area of the physical page in which HP-GL and HP-GL/2 graphic images can
be printed.
Pitch
Plot
The number of characters in one inch of text. Only applicable to monospaced
(fixed pitch fonts.)
A drawing produced using the HP-GL and HP-GL/2 graphics language. So called
because the language was originally invented for use with plotters.
Plotter units
Point
See graphics units.
The standard unit of measurement for character height. Equal to 1/72".
Point factor scaling
A form of image scaling using the SC command in HP-GL or HP-GL/2 mode in
which the user units and the location of the scaling point P1 are specified in terms
of graphics units.
Point size
See height.
Polygon
A shape consisting of one or more closed groups of connected lines.
Polygon buffer
An area of printer memory in which you can store one or more polygons and sub-
polygons defined using HP-GL and HP-GL/2 commands. Some HP-GL and HP-
GL/2 commands use the polygon buffer automatically.
Portrait
The orientation in which the side edges of the page are longer than the top edge.
A component of a font's style - whether it is upright or italic.
Posture
Primary font
In LaserJet mode the printer maintains two current font settings. The primary font
is the first of these.
Print model
A way of describing the interaction between different graphic elements ( source
image, pattern and destination image ).
Printable area
The area of the page on which the printer can print.
vii
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Print position
The position from which printing of the next character or graphic object will begin,
providing that no operations that change the print position are performed in the
interim.
viii
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Proportional spacing
Fonts intended for high quality typographic output use a method of character
spacing in which the space occupied by a single character on a line of text depends
on the individual design of the character. This is known as proportional spacing.
Scalable fonts are almost invariably proportionally spaced.
RAM
Random Access Memory. The printer's memory in which fonts and macros can be
stored and where pages that are to be printed are composed.
Raster graphics
Relative plotting
A method of representing a graphic image as a series of zeroes and ones that
correspond to white and black dots respectively.
A method of plotting in the HP-GL and HP-GL/2 graphics language where
coordinates are specified relative to the point at which the last graphics command
terminated.
Reset
When you reset the printer you restore a base set of conditions. A reset can either
be performed using the control panel or by sending the printer a reset command.
There are two types of reset, the normal reset and factory reset. A normal reset
simply restores the current emulation mode with the most recent control panel
settings -- it does not change the emulation mode itself. A factory reset makes
LaserJet mode the current emulation mode and restores the factory default
environment.
Resident font
ROM
See internal font.
Read Only Memory. Part of the printer's memory that contains the software
controlling the printer and the printer internal fonts. The ROM cannot be altered
unless the type of ROM fitted to the printer is Flash ROM, in which case it can be
written to electronically via the parallel port of the printer .
Row
A horizontal sub-division of the page whose height is equal to the VMI (vertical
motion index). The print position moves down the page a distance equal to the row
height when a line feed is performed.
Sans serif
A kind of typeface normally used for headlines. Sans serif typefaces do not have
little hooks (serifs) on the individual characters. This helps Sans serif headline text
stand out more prominently.
Scalable fonts
Scaling
A font for which you can specify the character size. The printer will automatically
scale the characters to the size you require.
In HP-GL or HP-GL/2 mode you can use the SC command to scale graphic
images. The three types of scaling are known as anisotropic, isotropic and point
factor scaling.
Scaling points
Two imaginary points called P1 and P2 that define a rectangular area relative to the
picture frame. You can use the HP-GL or HP-GL/2 SC and IP or IR commands to
transform and scale images by changing the relationship between the two scaling
points.
Scalable typeface
A typeface for which you can choose a point size (height) in order to obtain a
particular font for printing. For example, you might select the Utah typeface and
then select 14 pt. as the height. The printer has many resident typefaces. You can
also buy scalable typeface cartridge and disks.
ix
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Secondary font
In LaserJet mode the printer maintains two current font settings. The secondary
font is the second of these.
x
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Serif
A kind of typeface normally used for body text. Serif typefaces have little hooks
(serifs) on the individual characters that makes text more readable.
Soft clip limits
Source image
See graphics window. The soft limits are determined by the IW command.
The graphic image that is applied to the destination image in the LaserJet print
model. The interaction of the two images is determined by the current source and
pattern transparency settings.
Source transparency
Spacing
The source image is either transparent, in which case the destination image is
visible throughout the white parts of the source image, or opaque, in which case the
destination image is not visible at all through the source image.
The way in which a font's characters are arranged on a line of text. See
monospacing and proportional spacing.
Stick font
The default HP-GL and HP-GL/2 font consisting of thin lined characters.
Stroke weight
The thickness of the lines that comprise the characters in a particular font.
Medium, bold and light stroke weights are commonly used.
Sub-polygon
A shape consisting of a closed group of points connected by lines. Several sub-
polygons can form one polygon.
Symbol set
See character set.
Tab channel
A set of up to sixteen vertical tab stops. Up to eight vertical tab channels can be
set up in the Epson FX-850 mode.
Temporary font
A downloaded font that is erased from the printer's memory when a printer reset is
performed. To use the font again you must download it again.
Temporary macro
A macro that is erased from the printer's memory when a reset is performed. If
you want to use the macro again you must redefine it and download it to the printer
again.
Text area
Text direction
TIFF
The area of the physical page on which the printer can place text.
The orientation of printed text relative to the physical page.
Tagged Image File Format. A common file format used for storing raster graphics
data.
Transparency
Typeface
See pattern transparency and source transparency.
The design style of a set of typographic characters. The character design is
intended to make the characters work together cohesively to produce readable text.
The word "font" is often erroneously used to mean "typeface".
User default environment The current combination of LaserJet factory default settings and settings made
using the control panel. This is the environment that is in effect when you switch
on the printer in LaserJet mode or change to LaserJet emulation from another
emulation mode. You can reset the printer to its user default settings either by
using a printer command or using the control panel.
xi
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User units
Coordinate units specified by the user with the HP-GL and HP-GL/2 SC command.
Vector graphics
A method of defining graphic images in terms of coordinates, points and lines. The
HP-GL and HP-GL/2 graphics languages use this method.
Vertical plot size
VMI
The original vertical size of an imported HP-GL and HP-GL/2 image.
Vertical motion index. The vertical distance that the print position moves down the
page when a line feed is performed. This can be set using printer commands or
with the printer's control panel by adjusting the "Lines" menu option in PAGE
FORMAT MODE.
xii
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 1
INTRODUCTION
CHAPTER 1 INTRODUCTION - 1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CONTENTS
1. ABOUT THE MANUAL ............................................................................................................... 3
2. AREAS OF USE........................................................................................................................... 4
2.1 Using Word Processing Packages and Spreadsheets.............................................................4
2.2 Graphics.....................................................................................................................................4
2.3 Programming .............................................................................................................................4
2.4 Font Development......................................................................................................................5
CHAPTER 1 INTRODUCTION - 2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
1. ABOUT THE MANUAL
This technical reference manual is intended to help you get the most out of each of the emulation modes
supported by your HL-Series laser printer. It is divided into nine sections - this introductory section and one
section for each of the emulation modes. Each emulation mode section describes the software commands (the
escape sequences and control codes) that you can use to make the printer perform each of its available
functions. Some example programs are included to give you useful ideas.
This manual is for our PCL models. For the differences between each model, see the Appendix "Model
Comparison."
For basic set-up information, such as how to connect the printer to your computer, look in the User’s guide.
The User’s guide also describes the printers control panel and how you can set various options using the
keys.
CHAPTER 1 INTRODUCTION - 3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
2. AREAS OF USE
There are several different applications for which you may want to use your HL-Series laser printer. Four
general areas are outlined in the following sections.
2.1
Using Word Processing Packages and Spreadsheets
You may simply wish to use the printer with your software application packages, such as word-processors or
spreadsheets. Many software packages automatically send commands to the printer requesting particular
type styles, character sizes and specifying page set-up information and other relevant data. In this case you
will not need to use this manual, as your software package will perform the task of controlling the printer for
you. Other packages allow you to embed software commands within your word-processed or spreadsheet
documents. This manual describes the commands you need, and you can simply include them in the form that
your package requires. In either case, read the documentation that came with your software to find out its own
specific requirements for driving a printer.
2.2
2.3
Graphics
HP-GL/2 or HP-GL mode offers many powerful graphic features that enable you to draw and print detailed
images quickly and easily. Many commercial graphic packages, notably computer-aided design applications
programs, produce HP-GL/2 or HP-GL output. LaserJet mode also has several graphics features. You can
either write your own programs to generate images or use existing graphics software.
Programming
If you are writing software, for example in BASIC or C, to drive the printer, the description and formal
specification of each command will enable you to transcribe them straight into your programs. Below is a
simple example of a program to draw and print a three inch black square. The program is given in both C and
BASIC.
C language program
#include <stdio.h>
main()
{
FILE *prn; /* initialization section */
prn = fopen("PRN","wb");
fprintf(prn,"\33E"); /* Esc E - Reset the printer */
fprintf(prn,"\33%0B"); /* Esc%0B - Enter HP-GL/2 */
fprintf(prn,"IN"); /* Initialize */
fprintf(prn,"SP1PA1024,1024"); /* Select pen 1 & move to 0,0 */
fprintf(prn,"PDFT1RA4096,4096"); /* Draw 3" solid square */
fprintf(prn,"\33%0A"); /* Quit HP-GL/2 & restore original cursor
position */
fprintf(prn,"\33E /* Reset and eject page */
}
BASIC language program
10 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E"; :REM Esc E - Reset the printer
20 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0B"; :REM Esc%0B - Enter HP-GL/2
30 LPRINT "IN"; :REM Initialize
40 LPRINT "SP1PA1024,1024"; :REM Select pen 1 & move to 0,0
50 LPRINT "PDFT1RA4096,4096"; :REM Draw 3" solid square
60 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0A"; :REM Quit HP-GL/2 & restore original cursor
position
70 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E"; :REM Reset and eject page
CHAPTER 1 INTRODUCTION - 4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
2.4
Font Development
In LaserJet mode you can send your own character designs to an HL-Series laser printer and print text using
them. To do this you need first to design your characters on paper. Having done this you can then either
input and download your characters using a commercial software package, or encode your designs
numerically and write your own program to download them.
CHAPTER 1 INTRODUCTION - 5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 1 INTRODUCTION - 6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 2
PCL
PRINTER CONTROL
LANGUAGE
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CONTENTS
1. COMMAND LIST....................................................................................................................................7
2. INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................................. 10
3. CONTROLLING THE PRINTER ...................................................................................................... 11
3.1. Control Codes ..................................................................................................................................11
3.1.1. Backspace (08) <08h> ................................................................................................................... 11
3.1.2. Line feed (10) <0Ah>...................................................................................................................... 11
3.1.3. Form feed (12) <0Ch> .................................................................................................................... 11
3.1.4. Carriage return (13) <0Dh>.............................................................................................................. 11
3.1.5. Select primary font (14) <0Eh>........................................................................................................ 11
3.1.6. Select secondary font (15) <0Fh>.................................................................................................... 11
3.1.7. Escape (27) <1Bh>........................................................................................................................ 11
3.1.8. Horizontal tab (09) <09h> .............................................................................................................. 11
3.1.9. Space (32) <20h> .......................................................................................................................... 11
3.2. Escape Sequences..........................................................................................................................12
3.2.1. Line termination............................................................................................................................. 12
3.2.2. End-of-line wrap............................................................................................................................. 12
3.2.3. Display functions mode .................................................................................................................. 13
3.3. Environments ...................................................................................................................................14
3.3.1. Factory default environment ............................................................................................................ 14
3.3.2. User default environment................................................................................................................. 14
3.3.3. Modified print environment............................................................................................................... 14
3.3.4. Macro overlay environment.............................................................................................................. 14
4. JOB CONTROL................................................................................................................................... 15
4.1.1. Page size...................................................................................................................................... 15
4.1.2. Output tray.................................................................................................................................... 16
4.1.3. Paper source................................................................................................................................. 17
4.1.4. Left long-edge offset registration...................................................................................................... 18
4.1.5. Top offset registration..................................................................................................................... 19
4.1.6. Simplex/duplex printing (For HL-1660e/2060/3400CN) ....................................................................... 19
4.1.7. Paper side selection....................................................................................................................... 19
4.1.8. Job separation command................................................................................................................ 20
4.1.9. Reset............................................................................................................................................ 20
4.1.10. Reset to factory default settings .................................................................................................... 20
4.1.11. Reset to user settings .................................................................................................................. 20
4.1.12. Printer self test ............................................................................................................................ 20
4.1.13. Exit current emulation mode.......................................................................................................... 20
4.1.14. Change emulation mode ............................................................................................................... 21
4.2. The Page..........................................................................................................................................22
4.2.1. Physical page................................................................................................................................ 22
4.2.2. Printable area................................................................................................................................ 22
4.2.3. Logical page.................................................................................................................................. 22
4.2.4. Text area....................................................................................................................................... 22
4.2.5. HP-GL/2 graphics window............................................................................................................... 22
4.2.6. Portrait page dimensions ................................................................................................................ 23
4.2.7. Landscape page dimensions........................................................................................................... 24
4.2.8. Coordinates................................................................................................................................... 25
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.2.9. Units............................................................................................................................................. 25
4.2.10. Unit of measure............................................................................................................................ 25
4.2.11. Setting the left and right margins ................................................................................................... 25
4.2.12. Resetting the horizontal margins.................................................................................................... 26
4.2.13. Setting the top margin .................................................................................................................. 26
4.2.14. Setting the vertical motion index (VMI) ........................................................................................... 27
4.2.15. Setting the horizontal motion index (HMI) ....................................................................................... 27
4.2.16. Setting line spacing...................................................................................................................... 28
4.2.17. Text length.................................................................................................................................. 28
4.2.18. Page length................................................................................................................................. 29
4.2.19. Perforation skip............................................................................................................................ 29
4.2.20. Positioning the cursor................................................................................................................... 30
4.2.21. Vertical positioning....................................................................................................................... 30
4.2.22. Horizontal position........................................................................................................................ 31
4.2.23. Positioning the cursor using control codes...................................................................................... 32
4.2.24. Using the cursor position stack ..................................................................................................... 32
4.2.25. Half line feed................................................................................................................................ 33
4.2.26. Logical page orientation................................................................................................................ 33
4.2.27. Text direction............................................................................................................................... 33
5. USING FONTS..................................................................................................................................... 35
5.1. Introduction.......................................................................................................................................35
5.1.1. Font types..................................................................................................................................... 35
5.1.2. Bitmap fonts.................................................................................................................................. 35
5.1.3. Scalable fonts................................................................................................................................ 35
5.1.4. Bound fonts................................................................................................................................... 36
5.1.5. Unbound fonts ............................................................................................................................... 36
5.1.6. Font sources ................................................................................................................................. 36
5.1.7. Internal fonts.................................................................................................................................. 36
5.1.8. Card/cartridge fonts........................................................................................................................ 36
5.1.9. Downloadable fonts........................................................................................................................ 38
5.1.10. Primary and secondary fonts......................................................................................................... 38
5.1.11. Specifying the primary font............................................................................................................ 38
5.1.12. Specifying the secondary font........................................................................................................ 38
5.1.13. Selecting the default fonts............................................................................................................. 38
5.1.14. Switching between the primary and secondary fonts........................................................................ 38
5.1.15. Criteria for font selection ............................................................................................................... 38
5.1.16. Symbol set.................................................................................................................................. 40
5.1.17. Symbol collections....................................................................................................................... 40
5.1.18. Type of character spacing............................................................................................................. 40
5.1.19. Pitch........................................................................................................................................... 40
5.1.20. Height ......................................................................................................................................... 40
5.1.21. Style........................................................................................................................................... 40
5.1.22. Stroke weight............................................................................................................................... 40
5.1.23. Typeface..................................................................................................................................... 40
5.2. Font Selection Commands ..............................................................................................................41
5.2.1. User-defined symbol sets ............................................................................................................... 41
5.2.2. Symbol set ID code command ........................................................................................................ 41
5.2.3. Define symbol set .......................................................................................................................... 41
5.2.4. Symbol set control command.......................................................................................................... 43
5.2.5. Selecting the symbol set ................................................................................................................ 43
5.2.6. Selecting the type of character spacing............................................................................................ 45
5.2.7. Selecting the pitch......................................................................................................................... 45
5.2.8. Selecting the height ....................................................................................................................... 46
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.2.9. Scaling the scalable fonts vertically or horizontally............................................................................ 46
5.2.10. Selecting the style ....................................................................................................................... 46
5.2.11. Selecting the stroke weight ........................................................................................................... 47
5.2.12. Selecting the typeface.................................................................................................................. 47
5.2.13. Font orientation............................................................................................................................ 48
5.2.14. Transparent print data................................................................................................................... 48
5.2.15. Underlining text............................................................................................................................ 49
5.3. Downloadable font manipulation......................................................................................................50
5.3.1. Font ID.......................................................................................................................................... 50
5.3.2. Operations on downloaded fonts...................................................................................................... 50
5.3.3. Selecting a downloaded font............................................................................................................ 50
5.4. Creating Downloadable Fonts..........................................................................................................51
5.4.1. Downloading.................................................................................................................................. 51
5.4.2. Sending the font descriptor ............................................................................................................. 51
5.4.3. Unicode symbol index character complement bits............................................................................. 63
5.4.4. Sending a character code............................................................................................................... 64
5.4.5. Sending a character descriptor and data.......................................................................................... 64
6. USING GRAPHICS............................................................................................................................. 70
6.1. Source, Pattern and Destination......................................................................................................70
6.1.1. Set source transparency................................................................................................................. 70
6.1.2. Set pattern transparency ................................................................................................................ 71
6.1.3. Set area fill identity ........................................................................................................................ 72
6.1.4. User-defined pattern command........................................................................................................ 73
6.1.5. Set pattern reference point.............................................................................................................. 73
6.1.6. User-defined pattern control ............................................................................................................ 74
6.1.7. Set pattern type............................................................................................................................. 74
6.2. Plotting Rectangles ..........................................................................................................................76
6.2.1. Cursor position .............................................................................................................................. 76
6.2.2. Set rectangle width........................................................................................................................ 76
6.2.3. Set rectangle height ....................................................................................................................... 76
6.2.4. Draw filled rectangle....................................................................................................................... 76
6.3. Raster Graphics...............................................................................................................................78
6.3.1. Positioning the cursor..................................................................................................................... 78
6.3.2. Set raster resolution....................................................................................................................... 78
6.3.3. Set high resolution control .............................................................................................................. 78
6.3.4. Set raster image orientation............................................................................................................ 78
6.3.5. Set raster area height..................................................................................................................... 80
6.3.6. Set raster area width...................................................................................................................... 80
6.3.7. Set raster y-offset .......................................................................................................................... 80
6.3.8. Set compression mode................................................................................................................... 80
6.3.9. Start raster transfer........................................................................................................................ 86
6.3.10. Send raster data.......................................................................................................................... 86
6.3.11. Compress transfer graphics........................................................................................................... 86
6.3.12. End raster transfer........................................................................................................................ 86
6.3.13. Horizontal 1200-dpi image format mode (Raster Graphic Mode 1027)................................................ 88
6.4. Vector Graphics ...............................................................................................................................91
6.4.1. Enter HP-GL/2 mode...................................................................................................................... 91
6.5. The Picture Frame...........................................................................................................................92
6.5.1. The default picture frame................................................................................................................. 92
6.5.2. Set picture frame anchor point......................................................................................................... 92
6.5.3. Set picture frame vertical size......................................................................................................... 92
6.5.4. Set picture frame horizontal size..................................................................................................... 92
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.5.5. Specify vertical plot size................................................................................................................. 92
6.5.6. Specify horizontal plot size............................................................................................................. 92
7. MACROS .............................................................................................................................................. 93
7.1. The Purpose of a Macro...................................................................................................................93
7.2. Defining a Macro ..............................................................................................................................94
7.2.1. Macro ID....................................................................................................................................... 94
7.2.2. Start macro definition ..................................................................................................................... 94
7.2.3. End macro definition....................................................................................................................... 94
7.3. Running a Macro..............................................................................................................................95
7.3.1. Execute macro.............................................................................................................................. 95
7.3.2. Call macro..................................................................................................................................... 95
7.3.3. Enable macro for overlay................................................................................................................. 95
7.3.4. Disable macro for overlay................................................................................................................ 95
7.4. Handling Macros...............................................................................................................................96
7.4.1. Delete all macros........................................................................................................................... 96
7.4.2. Delete all temporary macros ........................................................................................................... 96
7.4.3. Delete macro................................................................................................................................. 96
7.4.4. Make macro temporary................................................................................................................... 96
7.4.5. Make macro permanent.................................................................................................................. 96
7.4.6. Delete all macros from the storage device........................................................................................ 96
7.4.7. Delete macro from the storage device.............................................................................................. 96
7.4.8. Save macro into the storage device.................................................................................................. 96
7.4.9. Execute data................................................................................................................................. 97
7.4.10. AppleTalk configuration................................................................................................................. 97
7.4.11. MIO video I/O port control.............................................................................................................. 98
8. STATUS READBACK........................................................................................................................ 99
8.1. Introduction.......................................................................................................................................99
8.2. Memory Status request....................................................................................................................99
8.3. Entity Status .....................................................................................................................................99
8.4. Status Response.............................................................................................................................99
8.5. Status Response Syntax ...............................................................................................................100
8.5.1. Set status readback location type ..................................................................................................100
8.5.2. Set status readback location unit ...................................................................................................100
8.5.3. Inquire status readback entity ........................................................................................................101
8.5.4. Entity status response..................................................................................................................101
8.5.5. Font response..............................................................................................................................101
8.5.6. Bitmap fonts.................................................................................................................................102
8.5.7. Bound scalable fonts.....................................................................................................................102
8.5.8. Unbound scalable fonts .................................................................................................................102
8.5.9. Download fonts.............................................................................................................................102
8.5.10. Location type 1 (currently selected) font ........................................................................................102
8.5.11. Font extended response..............................................................................................................104
8.5.12. Macro response..........................................................................................................................105
8.5.13. Use-defined pattern response.......................................................................................................105
8.5.14. Symbol set response...................................................................................................................105
8.5.15. Entity error codes........................................................................................................................106
8.5.16. Free space command..................................................................................................................106
8.5.17. Font cache.................................................................................................................................107
8.5.18. Memory status response.............................................................................................................107
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
8.5.19. Memory error response................................................................................................................107
8.5.20. Flush all pages command............................................................................................................107
8.5.21. Echo command...........................................................................................................................107
9. INDEX..................................................................................................................................................108
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
1.
COMMAND LIST
Control Codes
11
12
Escape sequences
Esc&k#G
Esc&s#C
EscY
Line termination
End-of-line wrap
Display function mode
Display function mode
12
12
13
13
EscZ
Environments
14
Job Control
15
Esc&l#A
Esc&l#G
Esc&l#H
Esc&l#U
Esc&l#Z
Esc&l#S
Esc&a#G
Esc&l1T
EscE
EscCR FD
EscCR!#R
Escz
Esc%-12345X
EscCR##
Page size
Output tray
Paper source
15
15
16
16
17
17
17
18
18
18
18
18
18
19
Left long-edge offset registration
Top offset registration
Simplex/duplex printing (For HL-1660e/2060/HL-3400CN)
Paper side selection
Job separation command
Reset
Reset to factory default settings
Reset to user settings
Printer self test
Exit current emulation mode
Change emulation mode
The Page
20
Esc&u#D
Esc&a#L
Esc&a#M
Esc9
Unit of measure
23
23
23
24
24
25
25
26
26
27
27
28
28
28
29
29
30
30
31
31
31
Setting the left and right margins
Setting the left and right margins
Resetting the horizontal margins
Setting the top margin
Setting the vertical motion index (VMI)
Setting the horizontal motion index (HMI)
Setting line spacing
Text length
Page length
Perforation skip
Vertical cursor positioning -rows
Vertical cursor positioning - units
Vertical cursor positioning - decipoints
Horizontal cursor positioning - columns
Horizontal cursor positioning - units
Horizontal cursor positioning - decipoints
Using the cursor position stack
Half line feed
Esc&l#E
Esc&l#C
Esc&k#H
Esc&l#D
Esc&l#F
Esc&l#P
Esc&l#L
Esc&a#R
Esc*p#Y
Esc&a#V
Esc&a#C
Esc*p#X
Esc&a#H
Esc&f#S
Esc=
Esc&l#O
Esc&a#P
Logical page orientation
Text direction
Using fonts
33
Esc(3@, Esc)3@
SI, SO
Esc*c#R
Esc(f#W
Selecting the default fonts
35
35
37
37
39
39
40
41
Switching between the primary and secondary font
Symbol set ID code command
Define symbol set
Esc*c#S
Symbol set control command
Esc(symbol set ID Select the symbol set
Esc(s#C, Esc)s#C Select the symbol set
Esc(s#P, Esc)s#P Selecting the type of character spacing
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Esc(s#H, Esc)s#H Selecting the pitch
Esc(s#V, Esc)s#V Selecting the height
EscCR!#H, EscCR!#V Scaling the scalable fonts vertically or horizontally
Esc(s#S, Esc)s#S Selecting the style
Esc(s#B, Esc)s#B Selecting the stroke weight
Esc(s#T, Esc)s#T Selecting the typeface
41
42
42
42
43
43
44
45
46
46
46
47
59
59
Esc&p#X
Transparent print data
Esc&d#D, Esc&d@ Underlining text
Esc&*c#D
Esc*c#F
Esc(#X, Esc)#X
Esc)s#W
Esc*c#E
Esc(s#W
Font ID
Operations on downloaded fonts
Selecting a downloaded font
Sending the font descriptor
Sending a character code
Sending a character descriptor and data
Using graphics
65
Esc*v#N
Esc*v#O
Esc*c#G
Esc*c#W
Esc*p#R
Esc*c#Q
Esc*v#T
Set source transparency
Set pattern transparency
Set area fill identity
User-defined pattern command
Set pattern reference point
User-defined pattern control
Set pattern type
65
66
67
68
68
69
69
71
71
71
73
73
73
74
74
74
74
79
79
79
79
79
81
83
84
84
84
84
84
Esc*c#A, Esc*c#H Set rectangle width
Esc*c#B, Esc*c#V Set rectangle height
Esc*c#P
Esc*t#R
EscCR ##
Esc*r#F
Esc*r#T
Esc*r#S
Esc*b#Y
Esc*b#M
Esc*r#A
Esc*b#W
Esc*b#C
Esc*rB
Draw filled rectangle
Set raster resolution
Set high resolution control
Set raster image orientation
Set raster area height
Set raster area width
set raster y-offset
Set compression mode
Start raster transfer
Send raster data
Compress transfer graphics
End raster transfer
End raster transfer
Horizontal 1200-dpi image format mode (Raster Graphic Mode 1027)
Enter HP-GL/2 mode
Set picture frame anchor point
Set picture frame vertical size
Set picture frame horizontal size
Specify vertical plot size
Specify horizontal plot size
Esc*rC
Esc*b##W
Esc%#B
Esc*c0T
Esc*c#Y
Esc*c#X
Esc*c#L
Esc*c#K
Macros
85
Esc&f#Y
Esc&f0X
Esc&f1X
Esc&f2X
Esc&f3X
Esc&f4X
Esc&f5X
Esc&f6X
Esc&f7X
Esc&f8X
Esc&f9X
Esc&f10X
Esc&f1030X
Esc&f1036X
Esc&f1038X
Macro ID
Start macro definition
End macro definition
Execute macro
Call macro
Enable macro for overlay
Disable macro for overlay
Delete all macros
Delete all temporary macros
Delete macro
Make macro temporary
Make macro permanent
Delete all macros from the storage device
Delete macro from the storage device
Save macro into the storage device
86
86
86
87
87
87
87
88
88
88
88
88
88
88
88
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
EscCR!#E
Esc&b#W
EscCR!1234#M
Execute data
AppleTalk configuration
MIO video I/O port control
89
89
90
Status Readback
91
Esc*s#T
Esc*s#U
Esc*s#I
Esc*s1M
Esc&r#F
Esc*s#X
Set status readback location type
Set status readback location unit
Inquire status readback entity
Free space command
Flush all pages command
Echo command
92
92
93
97
98
98
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
2.
INTRODUCTION
This laser printer provides a complete emulation of the supported Hewlett Packard LaserJet printer. Features
include raster and vector graphics, support for bitmap and scalable fonts and page control. There are many
resident fonts in the printer and you can gain access to more by inserting a font cartridge/card or the storage
device into the printer or by downloading fonts from your computer.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.
CONTROLLING THE PRINTER
3.1. Control Codes
Control codes are ASCII codes that tell the printer to perform a given function, such as a carriage return. You can
send these codes to the printer as part of a program.
3.1.1. Backspace
(08)
<08h>
ASCII code 8. This code moves the cursor one column to the left.
3.1.2. Line feed
(10)
<0Ah>
ASCII code 10. This code performs a line feed.
3.1.3. Form feed
(12)
<0Ch>
ASCII code 12. This code ejects the most recently printed page from the printer.
3.1.4. Carriage return
(13)
<0Dh>
ASCII code 13. This code performs a carriage return.
3.1.5. Select primary font
(14)
<0Eh>
ASCII code 15. When you send this code to the printer subsequent characters will be printed in the current
primary font. This is explained further in the sub-section entitled “Using fonts”.
3.1.6. Select secondary font (15)
<0Fh>
ASCII code 14. When you send this code to the printer subsequent characters will be printed in the current
secondary font. This is explained further in the sub-section entitled “Using fonts”.
3.1.7. Escape
(27)
<1Bh>
ASCII code 27. You must use this character code to start every instruction sequence that you send to the printer.
3.1.8. Horizontal tab
(09) <09h>
ASCII code 9. This code moves the cursor one tab position to the right. The tab positions are at the left margin
and at the left edge of every 8th column as defined by the horizontal motion index (HMI) described in the next
section, entitled “The Page”.
3.1.9. Space
(32)
<20h>
ASCII code 32. This code moves the cursor one column to the right.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.2. Escape Sequences
Escape sequences, also known as PCL (Printer Control Language) commands, tell the printer which operations to
perform. An escape sequence consists of the Esc character followed by a string of characters which define the
operation to be performed. Some escape sequences require parameter values. These are included in the sequence
as numeric characters. The final letter of an escape sequence must be uppercase: all others must be lowercase.
You can send the printer instructions by embedding escape sequences in programs or in word processed
documents.
In this manual escape sequences are shown as they would be entered, except that the character # in a sequence
indicates that a number should be included at that point in the sequence. If no number is included, the printer
interprets that parameter’s value as 0.
When downloading fonts or sending raster scan images to the printer the final uppercase character of the
sequence is followed by the relevant data.
Two escape sequences can be combined into one if the first three characters of each sequence (including the Esc
character itself) are the same. Hence, Esc*c45Gand Esc*c2P may be combined to give Esc*c45g2P. The
uppercase ‘G’ which terminated the first sequence becomes a lowercase character in the combined sequence.
Combined escape sequences are executed left to right, so be careful to place commands in the order in which you
want them to be executed.
Esc*c45G
Esc*c2P
Esc*c45g2P
3.2.1. Line termination
You can set the carriage return, line feed and form feed control codes to perform compound functions. You can
either do this using the printer’s control panel (see the User Guide) or by sending the printer the following escape
sequence:
·
·
·
0 = Carriage return, line feed and form feed perform their normal functions.
1 = Carriage return performs carriage return/line feed, line feed and form feed perform their normal functions.
2 = Carriage return performs its normal function, line feed performs carriage return/line feed and form feed
performs carriage return/form feed.
·
3 = Carriage return performs carriage return/line feed, line feed performs carriage return/line feed and form feed
performs carriage return/form feed.
0
1
2
3
CR®CR
LF®LF
FF®FF
CR®CR+LF
CR®CR
LF®LF
FF®FF
LF®CR+LF
LF®CR+LF
FF®CR+FF
FF®CR+FF
CR®CR+LF
3.2.2. End-of-line wrap
If the printer tries to print a line of text that is longer than the width of the text area, the end of the line will
normally be lost. However, you can set the printer to flow text onto the next line so that text is not lost.
You can turn on the automatic text wrap feature either from the printer’s control panel (see the User Guide) or by
sending the printer the following escape sequence:
Esc&s0C (27)(38)(115)(48)(67) <1Bh><26h><73h><30h><43h>
To turn off the facility send:
Esc&s1C (27)(38)(115)(49)(67) <1Bh><26h><73h><31h><43h>
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.2.3. Display functions mode
You can choose to make the printer print escape sequences instead of executing them. Send the printer the
following sequence:
EscY
(27)(89) <1B><59>
Now the printer prints out escape sequences and prints the characters of the control codes. It does not execute
them. The only exceptions to this are CR, the carriage return code, which causes a carriage return and line feed to
be performed, and the EscZ escape sequence which turns the mode off.
To turn the display functions mode off and enable escape sequences to be executed again send:
EscZ
(27)(90) <1B><5A>
The printer exits the display function mode after printing a character of code 1B Hex and the letter "Z". All
subsequent escape sequences and control codes are executed normally and not printed literally.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.3. Environments
3.3.1. Factory default environment
The factory default environment is the collection of printer settings programmed into the printer before it leaves
the factory. You can restore the factory default environment using the printer’s control panel.
See the User's Guide to find how to reset the printer from the printer's control panel.
Some settings cannot be restored to the factory default environment with the RESET operation from the printer's
control panel.
3.3.2. User default environment
The user default environment is a combination of factory default settings and settings which the user has made
from the printer’s control panel or remote printer console. You can store user default setting(s) in the printer by
using the printer control panel. You can restore the user default environment either by sending the reset escape
sequence to the printer, EscE, or by performing a reset from the printer’s control panel. On some models, there
are multiple User settings available, refer to your printer User Guide to see if your printer supports these.
3.3.3. Modified print environment
The modified print environment is made up of all the current printer settings. If you call a macro or go into HP-
GL/2 graphics language the modified print environment settings are saved. When the macro has been executed,
or when you quit HP-GL/2, these saved settings are restored. The modified print environment consists of settings
for the following features:
Page length
Primary font characteristics
Raster graphics presentation mode
Page size
Secondary font characteristics HMI Raster graphics left margin
Orientation
Primary font
Pattern ID
Left registration
Top registration
Paper source
Secondary font
Current pattern
Font ID
Source transparency mode
Pattern transparency mode
Print direction
Character code Macro ID
VMI/Line spacing
Horizontal rectangle size
Vertical rectangle size
Area fill ID
Number of copies
Margins
Raster graphics compression mode
Underline mode
Perforation skip mode
Line termination mode
End-of line wrap
Current font
Raster graphics height
Raster graphics width
Raster graphics resolution
3.3.4. Macro overlay environment
The macro overlay environment is a combination of the user default environment and the current modified print
environment. The overlay environments settings take effect when a macro is enabled for automatic overlay. This
is detailed in the section of this manual in which macros are described.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.
JOB CONTROL
4.1.1. Page size
Esc&l#A (27)(38)(108)#(65)
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<41h>
# stands for the type of paper or envelope to be used.
Values for # correspond to the paper or envelope sizes shown in the table. Envelopes sizes are shown in the
shaded part of the table.
HL-1050 HL-1070
HL-
1250/
P2500
HL-
1270N
HL-
1660e
HL-2060
HL-
2400C
HL-
2400Ce
HL-
3400CN
Model
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
2
3
6
Letter
Legal
Ledger
¡
¡ ¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
¡
¡ ¡ ¡
¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
26
27
45
100
1024
1025
1028
2048
80
A4
A3
B5 (JIS)
B5
B6
A5
¡ ¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
¡
13"X19"
16"
Monarch
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
90
International
DL
International
91
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
C5
HL-
1650/
1670N
HL-
3260N
HL-2460
HL-
1450/
1470N
Model
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
¡
1
3
6
25
Executive
Legal
Ledger
A5
27
A3
¡
¡ ¡
45
46
B5 (JIS)
B4 (JIS)
B6
A5
¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
¡
1024
1025
1026
2048
80
¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
A6
16"
Monarch
COM-10
International
DL
¡ ¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
81
90
International
91
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡
¡ ¡ ¡
C5
Free size
101
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
When the printer receives this command any unprinted pages are printed and the left, right and top margins
and the text length are set to their factory defaults for the new page size.
·
·
The cursor is moved to the top left of the text area on the new page.
Depending on your model, you may also set the page size from the printer’s control panel or remote printer
console program (see the User Guide).
·
If the paper size you select differs from the size of the currently loaded paper, a message appears in the
control panel prompting you to load the selected size of paper (for HL-1660e, 2060, 2400C/Ce, 3400CN, 3260N
and 2460).
Example)
Select letter size:
Esc&l2A
<1Bh><26h><6Ch><32h><41h>
Select the width of free size paper: Esc&l#G(1/720 inch unit; for HL-3260N and 2460)
Select the height of free size paper: Esc&l#F (1/720 inch unit; for HL-3260N and 2460)
4.1.2. Output tray
Esc&l#G (27)(38)(108)#(71)
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<47h>
# denotes the output tray.
· 1:
· 3:
· 4:
· 5:
· 6:
· 7:
· 8:
· 9:
· 10:
· 11:
· 12:
Select the printer output tray.
Select #1 bin.
Select #2 bin.
Select #3 bin.
Select #4 bin.
Select #5 bin.
Select #6 bin.
Select #7 bin.
Select #8 bin.
Select #9 bin.
Select #10 bin.
· 100: Select the finisher tray (HL-3260N)
·
·
·
·
This command selects the specified output tray.
This command is ignored when the specified tray is not available.
The PJL OUTBIN command is ignored when this command is executed.
If the printer has data to print when this command is executed, the command is valid from the next page
immediately after the data is printed.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 16
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.1.3. Paper source
Esc&l#H (27)(38)(108)#(72)
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<48h>
# denotes the paper source.
Values for # may be 0, 1, 2, 3, or 4.
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
If # = 0 the current page is ejected and the paper source remains the same.
If # = 1 the current page is printed and the upper cassette becomes the paper source.
If # = 2 the current page is printed and paper is fed in manually.
If # = 3 the current page is printed and envelopes are fed in manually.
If # = 4 the current page is printed and the lower cassette becomes the paper source.
If # = 4 the current page is printed and the multi-purpose tray becomes the paper source. (HL-1660e/2060)
If # = 5, 6 the current page is printed and the lower cassette becomes the paper source.
(HL-1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460)
·
·
If # = 7 the current page is printed and the paper source is auto selected.
If # = 8 the current page is printed and the lower cassette (Tray 3) becomes the paper source.
(HL-3400CN/3260N/2460)
·
If # = 9 the current page is printed and the lower cassette (Tray 4) becomes the paper source.
(HL-3260N/2460)
·
·
·
·
·
·
If # = 100 the current page is printed and the Tray ID 1 becomes the paper source. (HL-2460)
If # = 101 the current page is printed and the Tray ID 2 becomes the paper source. (HL-2460)
If # = 102 the current page is printed and the Tray ID 3 becomes the paper source. (HL-2460)
If # = 103 the current page is printed and the Tray ID 4 becomes the paper source. (HL-2460)
If # = 1 or # = 2 either paper or envelopes may be fed in, depending on the current page size setting.
The cursor is positioned at the top left of the text area on the next page.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
HL-1050
HL-1060/
1070
HL-1250/
1270N/
P2500
HL-
1660e
/2060
HL-
2400C
HL-
HL-
HL-
1450
/1470N
2400Ce 3400C
N
#=0 Eject
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
N/A
#=1 Sheet Feeder Tray 1
#=2 Manual Feed
#=3 N/A
¬
¬
Tray 2
Tray 2
Tray 2
¬
Envelope
#=4 N/A
MP Tray Tray 2
¬
¬
¬
¬
#=5 N/A
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
#=6 N/A
#=7 Auto
selection
#=8 N/A
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
Tray 3
N/A
HL-1650/
1670N
HL-3260N HL-2460
#=0
#=1
#=2
#=3
#=4
#=5
#=6
#=7
#=8
#=9
Eject
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
Tray 1
Manual Feed
Envelope
Tray 2
Tray 2
Tray 2
Auto selection
N/A
Tray 3
¬
¬
N/A
Tray 4
#=100 N/A
#=101 N/A
#=102 N/A
#=103 N/A
¬
¬
¬
¬
Tray ID 1
Tray ID 2
Tray ID 3
Tray ID 4
4.1.4. Left long-edge offset registration
Esc&l#U (27)(38)(108)#(85)
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<55h>
# stands for the distance in decipoints (1/720") that the left edge of the logical page is to be moved.
·
·
·
Values for # may be in the range -32,767 to 32,767.
The distance specified is relative to the logical page’s current position.
# can be positive or negative. Use a positive number to move the logical page to the right on the physical
page, and a negative number to move it to the left.
Positive
Negative
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 18
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.1.5. Top offset registration
Esc&l#Z (27)(38)(108)#(90)
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<5Ah>
# stands for the distance in decipoints (1/720") that the top edge of the logical page is to be moved.
·
·
·
Values for # may be in the range -32,767 to 32,767.
The distance specified is relative to the logical page’s current position.
# can be positive or negative. Use a positive number to move the logical page downwards on the physical
page, and a negative number to move it upwards.
Negative
Positive
4.1.6. Simplex/duplex printing (For HL-1660e/2060/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460)
Esc&l#S (27)(38)(108)#(83)
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<53h>
# can be 0, 1, or 2.
·
·
·
·
# = 0 indicates Simplex printing.
# = 1 indicates Duplex - Long edge binding printing.
# = 2 indicates Duplex - Short edge binding printing.
If the optional duplex unit is not installed onto the printer, this mode is set to Simplex mode.
This command setting is not saved in the printer's NV-RAM.
[Short Edge Binding]
[Long Edge Binding]
4.1.7. Paper side selection
Esc&a#G (27)(38)(97)#(71) <1Bh><26h><61h>#<47h>
# can be 0, 1, or 2.
·
# = 0 indicates the next side. If there is a page being processed, the printer finishes the processing of that
page. If there are no pages being processed, this command is ignored.
·
# = 1 indicates the front face.
If the currently processing page is an odd page, the printer finishes the processing of that page and attaches
a dummy page.
If the odd page has already been processed onto the page and the even page has not been processed yet,
only a dummy page is attached.
If the currently processing page is an even page, the printer finishes the processing of the page.
If both an even and odd page have been processed and the next odd page has not been processed yet, this
command is ignored.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
# = 2 indicates the back face.
If the currently processing page is an odd page, the printer finishes the processing of the page.
If the odd page has already been processed onto the page and the even page has not been processed yet,
this command is ignored.
If the currently processing page is an even page, the printer finishes the processing of the page and attaches
a dummy (white) page.
If both an even and odd page have been processed and the next odd page has not been processed yet, only a
dummy (white) page is attached.
4.1.8. Job separation command (For HL-3260N/2460)
Esc&l1T (27)(38)(108)(49)(84) <1Bh><26h><6Ch><31h><54h>
It is recommended to insert this command at the end of each job.
4.1.9. Reset
EscE
(27)(69) <1Bh><45h>
·
·
·
A printer reset restores the user default environment, deletes any temporary fonts and temporary macros.
Any pages that have been transmitted are printed out.
You can also perform a printer reset using the printer’s control panel or remote printer console program (see
the User Guide).
4.1.10. Reset to factory default settings
EscCRFD (27)(13)(70)(68) <1Bh><0Dh><46h><44h>
This command causes a factory reset to be performed, restoring all the printer’s factory default settings. See
·
·
the section “Factory default environment” for a list of the factory default settings.
You can also perform a factory reset using the printer’s control panel or remote printer console program (see
the User Guide).
4.1.11. Reset to user settings
EscCR!#R (27)(13)(33)#(82) <1Bh><0Dh><21h>#<52h>
·
·
# can be 0, 1 or 2.
#0 indicates the current settings are restored. Unlike the Esc E reset command, the Esc CR!0R command
resets the input buffer.
·
·
·
#1 indicates the user settings 1 are restored, if the printer supports multi user settings.
#2 indicates the user settings 2 are restored, if the printer supports multi user settings.
Depending on the model, you may be able to lock the control panel settings ("SETTING LOCK=ON"). In that
case, parameters 1 and 2 are ignored.
4.1.12. Printer self test
Escz (27)(122)
<1Bh><7Ah>
A printer self test causes a test sheet to be printed out to show that the machine is working properly. Depending
on the model, you may also see the test pattern for HRC setting.
4.1.13. Exit current emulation mode
Esc%-12345X
(27)(37)(45)(49)(50)(51)(52)(53)(88)
<1Bh><25h><2Dh><31h><32h><33h><34h><35h><58h>
·
·
·
When the printer receives this command, all page data already received is printed out.
All settings are reset to the user settings.
Exits the current emulation mode.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 20
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
PR2000070
4.1.14. Change emulation mode
EscCRGL
(27)(13)(71)(76) <1Bh><0Dh><47h><4Ch>
This command changes the emulation mode to HP-GL mode.
EscCRAB (27)(13)(65)(66) <1Bh><0Dh><41h><42h>
This command changes the emulation mode to BR-Script Batch mode.
EscCRAI (27)(13)(65)(73) <1Bh><0Dh><41h><49h>
This command changes the emulation mode to BR-Script Interactive mode.
EscCRI
(27)(13)(73)
<1Bh><0Dh><49h>
This command changes the emulation mode to IBM Proprinter XL mode.
EscCRE
(27)(13)(69)
<1Bh><0Dh><45h>
This command changes the emulation mode to Epson FX-850 mode.
Depending on the model, you can also switch between emulation modes using the printer’s control panel (see
the User Guide).
Emulations available for each model are listed below.
PCL HP-GL BR-Script2 BR-Script3
Epson
IBM
FX-850 Proprinter XL
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
HL-1050
HL-1070
¡
¡
¡
¡
HL-1250
¡
HL-1270N
HL-P2500
HL-1660e
HL-2060
¡
¡ ¡
¡ ¡
¡ ¡
¡ ¡
¡ ¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
HL-2400C
HL-2400Ce
HL-3400CN
HL-1650/1670N
HL-3260N
HL-2460
¡
¡
¡
¡ ¡
¡ ¡
¡
HL-1450
¡
¡
HL-1470N
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.2. The Page
4.2.1. Physical page
The physical page refers to the size of the paper or envelope currently in use: A4, Letter, B5, JIS B5, Legal and
Executive are the permitted paper sizes: Monarch, COM-10, International DL and International C5 are the
allowable envelope sizes.
4.2.2. Printable area
The printable area is a rectangular area of the physical page on which the printer can print. Its edges are
approximately 1/6" in from the edges of the physical page, please refer to the printer User Guide for the exact
measurement for each model.
4.2.3. Logical page
The logical page is the area of the physical page where the cursor can be positioned. (Although the printer does
not really have a cursor, we refer to the position on the page from which the printing of a character or graphic
starts as the cursor position). You can alter the size of the logical page using the left offset registration and top
offset registration commands. The logical page is also called the PCL (printer control language) addressable area.
4.2.4. Text area
The text area is the area of the physical page on which text can be printed, and is determined by the left, right and
top margin settings, the text length and whether the perforation skip facility is on or off. All these settings can be
made either from the printer’s control panel (see the User Guide) or using PCL commands.
4.2.5. HP-GL/2 graphics window
The HP-GL/2 graphics window is the area of the physical page on which images can be printed using HP-GL/2
commands. This is described in the HP-GL/2 section of this manual. The default graphics window is bound by the
left and right edges of the logical page and horizontal boundaries half an inch below the top and above the
bottom of the logical page.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 22
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.2.6. Portrait page dimensions
(DEFAULT VALUES)
F
H
G
Physical page
Printable area
Logical page
E
E
Default HP-GL/2 picture frame
B
D
Physical page length
B
D
G
G
Maximum logical page length
Distance from edge of physical page to
edge of logical page
F
F
G
H
C
A
PAPER SIZE
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
LETTER
LEGAL
EXECUTIVE
A4
2550
2550
2175
2480
2078
2148
1476
1754
1240
2480
2480
1237
1162
1913
1299
3507
3900
3035
3300
3300
4200
3150
3507
2952
3030
2078
2480
1754
3507
4783
2850
2250
2704
2598
4960
5700
4298
5100
2400
2400
2025
2338
1936
2010
1334
1612
1098
2400
2400
1087
1012
1771
1157
3365
3750
2893
3150
3300
4200
3150
3507
2952
3030
2078
2480
1754
3507
4783
2850
2250
2704
2598
4960
5700
4298
5100
75
75
75
71
71
69
71
71
71
40
40
75
75
71
71
71
75
71
75
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
40
40
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
B5
JIS B5
B6
A5
A6
A4 80 character
A4 long
COM-10
MONARCH
C5
DL
A3
13"X19"
JIS B4
Ledger
All measurements are in 1/300" units
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.2.7. Landscape page dimensions
(DEFAULT VALUES)
F
H
G
Physical page
Printable area
Logical page
E
E
D
B
Default HP-GL/2 picture frame
Physical page length
G
G
B
D
F
Maximum logical page length
Distance from edge of physical
page to edge of logical page
G
F
H
C
A
PAPER SIZE
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
LETTER
LEGAL
EXECUTIVE
A4
3300
4200
3150
3507
2952
3030
2078
2480
1754
4783
2850
2250
2704
2598
4960
5700
4298
5100
2550
2550
2175
2480
2078
2148
1476
1754
1240
2480
1237
1162
1913
1299
3507
3900
3035
3300
3180
4080
3030
3389
2834
2910
1960
2362
1636
4665
2730
2130
2586
2480
4842
5580
4180
4980
2550
2550
2175
2480
2078
2148
1476
1754
1240
2480
1237
1162
1913
1299
3507
3900
3035
3300
60
60
60
59
59
60
59
59
59
59
60
60
59
59
59
60
59
60
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
150
B5
JIS B5
B6
A5
A6
A4 long
COM-10
MONARCH
C5
DL
A3
13"X19"
JIS B4
Ledger
All measurements are in 1/300" units
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 24
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.2.8. Coordinates
The printer control language coordinate system has its origin at the intersection of the left edge of the logical
page and the top margin. The x-coordinate value of the current cursor position increases as the cursor moves
from left to right, the y-coordinate value increases as the cursor moves down the page. The cursor can be
explicitly positioned anywhere on the current logical page using the PCL coordinate system. In addition, the
cursor’s coordinate position will change as text and graphics are printed.
4.2.9. Units
You can specify cursor movement within the PCL coordinate system using one of three different unit systems.
Decipoints
A decipoint is one-tenth of a typographic point measurement = 1/720".
Rows and columns
Using the horizontal motion index (HMI) (Esc&k#H) and vertical motion index (VMI)(Esc&l#C) commands you
can set the width of a column and the height of a row. You can then use the column width and row height as the
units of the coordinate system. The line-spacing command is an alternative to the VMI command.
Units
The unit of measurement used must be defined by the unit of measure command as described in 4.2.10.
4.2.10. Unit of measure
Esc&u#D (27)(38)(117)#(68)
<1Bh><26h><75h>#<44h>
·
# value can be 96, 100, 120, 144, 150, 160, 180, 200, 225, 240, 288, 300, 360, 400, 450, 480, 600, 720, 800, 900, 1200,
1440, 1800, 2400, 3600, 7200.
·
·
# stands for the unit of measurement in dots per inch.
The value set by this command is used as the unit setting for use by other setting commands such as
ESC*p#X.
·
The default value of # is 300.
Example)
Esc&u300D Esc*p+100x+200Y
move cursor 100/300 inch right and 200/300 inch down.
Esc&u600D Esc*p+100x+200Y
move cursor 100/600 inch right and 200/600 inch down.
4.2.11. Setting the left and right margins
Esc&a#L (27)(38)(97)#(76)
<1Bh><26h><61h>#<4Ch>
# stands for the distance between the left edge of the logical page and the left margin in columns.
Esc&a#M (27)(38)(97)#(77)
<1Bh><26h><61h>#<4Dh>
# stands for the distance between the left edge of the logical page and the right margin in columns.
·
The column width is as defined by the HMI. If you subsequently change the HMI, the margin positions that
you have set do not change - that is, when you specify margin positions they remain fixed physically until
you specify new ones or reset them to default values.
·
·
You cannot specify a value for the left margin that is greater than the value of the current right margin.
If the current cursor position is to the left of your new left margin setting, the cursor will be moved to the new
left margin.
·
You cannot set the right margin further right than the right edge of the logical page.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
·
·
If the current cursor position is to the right of your new right margin setting, the cursor will be moved to the
new right margin.
The factory default left and right margin settings are at the left and right edges of the logical page
respectively.
Depending on your model, margin settings can be made from the printer’s control panel (see the User Guide).
10 REM ***** SET AND CLEAR SIDE MARGINS *****
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)
30 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
40 REM --- END OF LINE WRAP ON ---
50 LPRINT ESC$+"&s0C";
60 REM --- LEFT MARGIN SET TO 10 COLUMNS ----
70 LPRINT ESC$+"&a10L";
80 REM --- RIGHT MARGIN SET TO 70 COLUMNS ----
90 LPRINT ESC$+"&a70M";
100 REM --- PRINT "0123456789" 10 TIMES
110 FOR I=1 TO 10
120 LPRINT "0123456789";
130 NEXT
140 LPRINT
150 REM --- CLEAR SIDE MARGIN ----
160 LPRINT ESC$+"9";
170 REM --- PRINT "0123456789" 10 TIMES
180 FOR I=1 TO 10
190 LPRINT "0123456789";
200 NEXT
210 REM --- PAPER EJECT ----
220 LPRINT CHR$(12);
230 END
4.2.12. Resetting the horizontal margins
Esc9 (27)(39) <1Bh><39h>
This command resets the left and right margins to the left and right edges of the logical page respectively.
4.2.13. Setting the top margin
Esc&l#E (27)(38)(108)#(69)
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<45h>
# stands for the distance between the top of the logical page and the top margin in rows.
·
·
The row height is as defined by the VMI. If you subsequently change the VMI (or the line spacing) the top
margin position that you have set does not change - that is, when you specify the top margin position it
remains fixed physically until you specify a new one or reset it to a default value.
The top margin command is ignored if you try to set a margin greater than the current length of the logical
page.
·
·
·
The top margin command is ignored if the current VMI is 0.
The factory default top margin setting is half an inch below the top of the logical page.
Depending on your model, the top margin can be set from the printer’s control panel (see the User Guide).
10 REM ******* SET TOP MARGIN TO 10 LINES *******
20 REM
30 ESC$=CHR$(27)
40 LPRINT ESC$+"&l10E";
50 LPRINT "10 LINES "
60 LPRINT CHR$(12);
70 END
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 26
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.2.14. Setting the vertical motion index (VMI)
Esc&l#C (27)(38)(108)#(67)
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<43h>
# stands for the height of one row in 1/48".
·
·
# can have any value in the range 0-32767.
The distance specified by the VMI is the vertical distance moved down the page when the printer performs a
line feed. The VMI is also sometimes referred to as the line pitch.
·
·
·
·
If you try to set a VMI that is greater than the current length of the logical page the command is ignored.
Changing the VMI setting does not affect the position of the top margin.
The factory default setting is 8 - that is, the printer will print six lines of text per inch.
Depending on your model, you can change the number of lines per page setting fromthe printer's control
panel or remote printer console. If you change its setting, the VMI will change automatically.
10 REM ***** SETTING THE LINE PITCH *****
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)
30 REM
40 REM --- SET LINE PITCH TO 1/48 INCH ---
50 LPRINT ESC$+"&l1C";
60 FOR I=1 TO 10
70 LPRINT "I can't read."
80 NEXT
90 LPRINT ESC$+"&l8C";
100 LPRINT
110 LPRINT
120 REM --- SET LINE PITCH TO 1/12 INCH ----
130 LPRINT ESC$+"&l4C";
140 LPRINT "line pitch is 1/12 inch"
150 REM --- SET LINE PITCH TO 1/8 INCH ----
160 LPRINT ESC$+"&l6C";
170 LPRINT "line pitch is 1/8 inch"
180 REM --- SET LINE PITCH TO 1/6 INCH ----
190 LPRINT ESC$+"&l8C";
200 LPRINT "line pitch is 1/6 inch"
210 REM --- SET LINE PITCH TO 1/4 INCH ----
220 LPRINT ESC$+"&l12C";
230 LPRINT "line pitch is 1/4 inch"
240 LPRINT "line pitch is 1/4 inch"
250 REM --- PAPER EJECT ----
260 LPRINT CHR$(12);
270 END
<Sample file 1>
4.2.15. Setting the horizontal motion index (HMI)
Esc&k#H (27)(38)(107)#(72)
<1Bh><26h><6Bh>#<48h>
# stands for the width of one column in 1/120".
·
·
# can have any value in the range 0-32767 and can have up to four decimal places.
If you are using a fixed space font the HMI is the horizontal distance moved across the page when the printer
prints one character.
·
·
If you are using a proportionally spaced font the HMI is the horizontal distance moved across the page when
the printer receives a space control code <20h>.
If any font characteristics are changed, or a Select Primary Font or Select Secondary Font control code is sent
to the printer, the HMI is set to correspond to the default pitch value of the newly selected font.
·
·
Changing the HMI setting does not affect the positions of the left and right margins.
The factory default setting is 12 - that is, the printer will print ten characters of fixed pitch text per inch.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 27
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
10 REM ***** SETTING THE CHARACTER PITCH *****
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)
30 REM --- DEFAULT IS 10 CPI PITCH ---
40 LPRINT "10 PITCH "
50 REM --- SET 5 CPI PITCH ---
60 LPRINT ESC$+"&k24H";
70 LPRINT "AAA"
80 REM --- SET 6 CPI PITCH ---
90 LPRINT ESC$+"&k20H";
100 LPRINT "AAA"
110 REM --- SET 8 CPI PITCH ---
120 LPRINT ESC$+"&k15H";
130 LPRINT "AAA"
140 REM --- SET 10 CPI PITCH ---
150 LPRINT ESC$+"&k12H";
160 LPRINT "AAA"
170 REM --- SET 12 CPI PITCH ---
180 LPRINT ESC$+"&k12H";
190 LPRINT "AAA"
200 REM --- SET 0 CPI PITCH ---
210 LPRINT ESC$+"&kH";
220 LPRINT "I CAN'T READ"
230 REM --- PAPER EJECT ----
240 LPRINT CHR$(12);
250 END
<Sample file 2>
4.2.16. Setting line spacing
Esc&l#D (27)(38)(108)#(68)
# stands for the number of lines to be printed per inch.
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<44h>
·
·
·
·
·
# can have any of the following values: 1, 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 12, 16, 24 or 48.
This command performs the same function as the VMI command.
Changing the line spacing setting does not affect the position of the top margin.
The factory default setting is 6 - that is, the printer will print six lines of text per inch.
Depending on your printer model, the number of lines per page can also be set from the printer’s control
panel or remote printer console (see the User Guide).
4.2.17. Text length
Esc&l#F (27)(38)(108)#(70)
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<46h>
# stands for the number of lines of text (at the current VMI) to be printed on each page.
·
·
·
Values for # should be within the value (Logical Page length-Top margin).
Text is printed from the top margin downwards.
If you specify a value that would cause the text area to extend beyond the end of the logical page, the
command is ignored.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 28
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Top margin
Page length
Text length
Bottom margin
4.2.18. Page length
Esc&l#P (27)(38)(108)#(80)
# stands for the length of the logical page in lines (at the current VMI).
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<50h>
·
·
·
If you specify a page length greater than is allowed by the physical size of the paper in the currently installed
paper tray, a control panel message prompts you to load paper of the appropriate size.
When the printer receives this command any unprinted pages are printed and the left, right and top margins
and the text length are set to their user defaults.
If you specify a page length greater than is allowed by any of the supported paper sizes, the command is
ignored.
·
·
If the current VMI is 0 the command is ignored.
For the USA, the factory default page size is letter, for which the default page length is 66 lines (11 inches at 6
lines per inch). For Europe, the factory default page size is A4, for which the default page length is 70 lines
(11.6 inches at 6 lines per inch). The default lengths for other paper sizes are: Legal - 84 lines, Executive - 63
lines (all at 6 lines per inch).
·
Depending on your printer model, you can also set the page length from the printer’s control panel or remote
printer console by setting LINES to the required number of lines per page in the PAGE FORMAT mode (see
the User Guide).
10 REM ******* SETTING THE PAGE LENGTH TO 66 LINES *******
20 REM
30 ESC$=CHR$(27)
40 LPRINT ESC$+"&l66P";
50 FOR I=1 TO 67
60 LPRINT STR$(I)
70 NEXT
80 LPRINT CHR$(12);
90 END
4.2.19. Perforation skip
You can set the printer to flow text from one page to the next when it encounters a line feed (or half line feed) that
would otherwise move the cursor position to below the bottom of the text area. When perforation skip is enabled
the cursor is automatically moved to the top left hand corner of the text area on the next page and printing
continues.
Esc&l#L (27)(38)(108)#(76)
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<4Ch>
# is either 0 or 1.
·
·
·
·
# = 0 turns the perforation skip feature off.
# = 1 turns the perforation skip feature on.
The factory default mode is perforation skip on.
Whenever the perforation skip mode is changed, the top margin and page length values are reset to their
default values.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 29
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.2.20. Positioning the cursor
You can position the cursor anywhere on the logical page. In addition, the cursor position is automatically
changed when text or graphics are printed. You can either position the cursor using absolute PCL coordinate
values or position it relative to the current cursor position, using dots, decipoints or rows and columns as units.
In case of using dots, the units value is defined by the ESC & u # d command. The commands for positioning the
cursor are listed below.
4.2.21. Vertical positioning
Vertical cursor positioning - rows
Esc&a#R (27)(38)(97)#(82)
<1Bh><26h><61h>#<52h>
# = number of rows
·
·
A plus or minus sign preceding the number of rows parameter indicates that the cursor is to be positioned
relative to its current position. A signed positive parameter value signifies that the cursor is to be repositioned
vertically downwards on the page, a negative value means that it will be moved upwards.
An unsigned number as the parameter signifies that the vertical repositioning is absolute - the cursor will be
repositioned the specified number of rows below the top margin, the PCL coordinate system’s x-axis.
·
·
·
The parameter value can have up to two decimal places.
The cursor’s horizontal position remains unchanged.
If you attempt to move the cursor to a position that is outside the boundaries of the logical page, the cursor
will be positioned at either the top or bottom of the logical page as appropriate.
Vertical cursor positioning - units
Esc*p#Y (27)(42)(112)#(89)
<1Bh><2Ah><70h>#<79h>
# = number of units
·
·
Units value is defined by the Esc & u # D command.
A plus or minus sign preceding the number of dots parameter indicates that the cursor is to be positioned
relative to its current position. A signed positive parameter value signifies that the cursor is to be repositioned
vertically downwards on the page, a negative value means that it will be moved upwards.
·
An unsigned number as the parameter signifies that the vertical repositioning is absolute - the cursor will be
repositioned the specified number of dots below the top margin, the PCL coordinate system’s x-axis.
·
·
The cursor’s horizontal position remains unchanged.
If you attempt to move the cursor to a position that is outside the boundaries of the logical page, the cursor
will be positioned at either the top or bottom of the logical page as appropriate.
Vertical cursor positioning - decipoints
Esc&a#V (27)(38)(97)#(86)
<1Bh><26h><61h>#<56h>
# = number of decipoints in 1/720"
·
·
A plus or minus sign preceding the number of decipoints parameter indicates that the cursor is to be
positioned relative to its current position. A signed positive parameter value signifies that the cursor is to be
repositioned vertically downwards on the page, a negative value means that it will be moved upwards.
An unsigned number as the parameter signifies that the vertical repositioning is absolute - the cursor will be
repositioned the specified number of decipoints below the top margin, the PCL coordinate system’s x-axis.
·
·
The cursor’s horizontal position remains unchanged.
If you attempt to move the cursor to a position that is outside the boundaries of the logical page, the cursor
will be positioned at either the top or bottom of the logical page as appropriate.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 30
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.2.22. Horizontal position
Horizontal cursor positioning - columns
Esc&a#C (27)(38)(97)#(67)
<1Bh><26h><61h>#<43h>
# = number of columns
·
·
A plus or minus sign preceding the number of columns parameter indicates that the cursor is to be positioned
relative to its current position. A signed positive parameter value signifies that the cursor is to be repositioned
to the right on the page, a negative value means that it will be moved to the left.
An unsigned number as the parameter signifies that the horizontal repositioning is absolute - the cursor will
be repositioned the specified number of columns to the right of the left edge of the logical page, the PCL
coordinate system’s y-axis.
·
·
·
The parameter value can have up to two decimal places.
The cursor’s vertical position remains unchanged.
If you attempt to move the cursor to a position that is outside the boundaries of the logical page, the cursor
will be positioned at either the left or right edge of the logical page as appropriate.
10 REM ***** HORIZONTAL CURSOR POSITIONING *****
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)
30 REM
40 REM --- POSITIONING CURSOR AT COLUMN 10 ---
50 LPRINT ESC$+"&a10C";
60 LPRINT "A";
70 REM --- MOVING CURSOR 5 COLUMNS TO THE LEFT ---
80 LPRINT ESC$+"&a-5C";
90 LPRINT "B";
100 REM --- MOVING CURSOR 10 COLUMNS TO THE RIGHT ---
110 LPRINT ESC$+"&a+10C";
120 LPRINT "C";
130 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---
140 LPRINT CHR$(12);
150 END
<Sample file 3>
Horizontal cursor positioning - units
Esc*p#X (27)(42)(112)#(88)
<1Bh><2Ah><70h>#<58h>
# = number of units
·
·
The Units value is defined by the Esc & u # D command.
A plus or minus sign preceding the number of dots parameter indicates that the cursor is to be positioned
relative to its current position. A signed positive parameter value signifies that the cursor is to be repositioned
to the right on the page, a negative value means that it will be moved to the left.
·
An unsigned number as the parameter signifies that the horizontal repositioning is absolute - the cursor will
be repositioned the specified number of dots to the right of the left edge of the logical page, the PCL
coordinate system’s y-axis.
·
·
The cursor’s vertical position remains unchanged.
If you attempt to move the cursor to a position that is outside the boundaries of the logical page, the cursor
will be positioned at either the left or right edge of the logical page as appropriate.
10 REM ***** HORIZONTAL CURSOR POSITIONING *****
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)
30 REM
40 REM --- POSITIONING CURSOR AT 1 INCH ---
50 LPRINT ESC$+"*p300X";
60 LPRINT "A";
70 REM --- MOVING CURSOR 0.5 INCHES TO THE LEFT ---
80 LPRINT ESC$+"*p-150X";
90 LPRINT "B";
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 31
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
100 REM --- MOVING CURSOR 1 INCH TO THE RIGHT ---
110 LPRINT ESC$+"*p+300X";
120 LPRINT "C";
130 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---
140 LPRINT CHR$(12);
150 END
<Sample file 4>
Horizontal cursor positioning - decipoints
Esc&a#H (27)(38)(97)#(72)
<1Bh><26h><61h>#<48h>
# = number of decipoints 1/720"
·
·
A plus or minus sign preceding the number of decipoints parameter indicates that the cursor is to be
positioned relative to its current position. A signed positive parameter value signifies that the cursor is to be
repositioned to the right on the page, a negative value means that it will be moved to the left.
An unsigned number as the parameter signifies that the horizontal repositioning is absolute - the cursor will
be repositioned the specified number of decipoints to the right of the left edge of the logical page, the PCL
coordinate system’s y-axis.
·
·
The cursor’s vertical position remains unchanged.
If you attempt to move the cursor to a position that is outside the boundaries of the logical page, the cursor
will be positioned at either the left or right edge of the logical page as appropriate.
10 REM ***** HORIZONTAL CURSOR POSITIONING *****
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)
30 REM
40 REM --- POSITIONING CURSOR AT 1 INCH ---
50 LPRINT ESC$+"&a720H";
60 LPRINT "A";
70 REM --- MOVING CURSOR 0.5 INCHES TO THE LEFT ---
80 LPRINT ESC$+"&a-360H";
90 LPRINT "B";
100 REM --- MOVING CURSOR 1 INCH TO THE RIGHT ---
110 LPRINT ESC$+"&a+720H";
120 LPRINT "C";
130 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---
140 LPRINT CHR$(12);
150 END
<Sample file 5>
4.2.23. Positioning the cursor using control codes
The carriage return, space, horizontal tab and backspace control codes can also be used to reposition the cursor
using the current VMI and HMI settings.
4.2.24. Using the cursor position stack
You can save and retrieve up to 20 cursor positions using the cursor position stack.
Esc&f#S (27)(38)(102)#(115)
<1Bh><26h><66h>#<73h>
# = 0 or 1
·
·
Setting # to 0 stores the current cursor position on the stack.
Setting # to 1 retrieves the cursor position currently on the top of the stack and makes it the current cursor
position.
·
Resetting the printer deletes all the positions from the stack.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 32
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.2.25. Half line feed
Esc=(27)(61) <1Bh><3Dh>
This command moves the cursor down half a row as defined by the last VMI or line spacing command (Esc&l#C).
4.2.26. Logical page orientation
Esc&l#O (27)(38)(108)#(79)
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<4Fh>
# = 0, 1, 2 or 3
·
·
This command sets the orientation of the logical page relative to the physical page.
Values of # produce orientations as follows: 0 = portrait, 1 = landscape, 2=reverse portrait and 3 = reverse
landscape.
·
Sending this command to the printer causes the page length, text length, top, left and right margins to be set
to their user default values. Any previously transmitted data is printed out and the cursor is positioned at the
top left hand corner of the text area on the next page.
·
·
Portrait or Landscape orientation can also be selected from the printer’s control panel.
The factory default orientation is portrait.
X
(0,0)
"TEXT"
Y
Top margin
Physical page
Logical page
X
(0,0)
Y
Portrait
# = 0
Landscape # = 1
Y
(0,0)
Physical page
Logical page
Top margin
X
Y
(0,0)
X
Reverse portrait
Reverse landscape
# = 2
# = 3
4.2.27. Text direction
Esc&a#P (27)(38)(97)#(80)
<1Bh><26h><61h>#<50h>
# = 0, 90, 180 or 270.
·
This command changes the orientation of the logical page relative to the physical page, but without the side
effects of the logical page orientation command. Hence you can print text in different directions on the same
page.
·
·
Values of # have the following effects: 0 = portrait, 90 = landscape, 180= reverse portrait and 270 = reverse
landscape. The value specifies the angle through which the text direction is rotated counterclockwise.
The cursor position remains at the same physical page position.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 33
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
·
All subsequent text is printed in the newly selected orientation.
The PCL coordinate system and margin settings are rotated through the specified angle. Hence the cursor
coordinates will change.
·
·
HP-GL/2 graphics images cannot be rotated using this command.
The factory default orientation is portrait.
10 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
20 REM --- PRINTER RESET ---
30 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";
40 REM --- MOVING CURSOR TO X=500, Y=500 ---
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);"*p500X";
60 LPRINT CHR$(27);"*p500Y";
70 REM --- 0 deg ---
80 LPRINT CHR$(27);"&a0P";
90 LPRINT "BROTHER ";
100 REM --- 90 deg ---
110 LPRINT CHR$(27);"&a90P";
120 LPRINT "BROTHER ";
130 REM --- 180 deg ---
140 LPRINT CHR$(27);"&a180P";
150 LPRINT "BROTHER ";
160 REM --- 270 deg ---
170 LPRINT CHR$(27);"&a270P";
180 LPRINT "BROTHER ";
190 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---
200 LPRINT CHR$(12)
210 END
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 34
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.
USING FONTS
5.1. Introduction
A font is a collection of characters that have common characteristics, such as size, style and typeface, and which
ranges over a given set of symbols. For example, 12 point Tennessee Bold in the Roman-8 symbol set is a typical
HL Series font. Different sorts of fonts are used to create various typographic effects. Traditionally, large point
size sans serif typeface fonts, like Helsinki and Utah are used for document headlines while smaller fonts with
serif typefaces, like Tennessee and Portugal are used for body text. In LaserJet mode you can have access to a
large range of fonts that are already built in to the printer’s ROM, plus the facility for downloading more fonts
from a personal computer or plugging in font cards/cartridges or the storage device. When you select a font for
printing you will specify a number of characteristics which identify the font you require. The laser printer does its
best to print using the font you specified, but if amongst all its available fonts it does not have the exact one that
you specified, it will compromise and give you what it regards as the closest available font. Sometimes the results
will not be what you expected and you should exercise care in selecting fonts for printing.
In most instances the selection of a font will be handled automatically from your word processing software or
other applications package. In these cases you need only ensure that the correct font is available (that is, as a
standard font in the ROM, on cartridge/card or downloaded) and the application will do the rest. You do not need
to concern yourself with sending any escape sequences.
As well as using software commands you can also select fonts using the printer’s control panel. Consult the
printer User Guide for details.
5.1.1. Font types
There are two types of fonts supported by the HL Series printers in LaserJet mode - bitmap fonts and scalable
fonts.
5.1.2. Bitmap fonts
The characters which make up a bitmap font are raster bit images of the relevant symbols. When text is printed
using the font it is nearly always monospaced and when you select the font you specify it by its typeface, pitch
(the number of characters printed per inch), height (point size) and symbol set.
5.1.3. Scalable fonts
The printer has many scalable fonts available as standard. The following table shows scalable fonts available for
models HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN. (For the other models'
resident fonts, please see the printer User's Guide.)
Intellifont Compatible Fonts:
HL-
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/
2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
Alaska
Antique Oakland
PcBrussels
Medium, Extra Bold
Medium, Oblique, Bold
Light, Light italic, Demi, Demi italic
Medium, Oblique, Bold, BoldOblique
Oklahoma
Cleveland Condensed
Connecticut
Brougham
Guatemala
LetterGothic
Maryland
PcTennessee
PcBrussels
Utah
Medium, Oblique, Bold, Bold oblique
Antique, Italic, Bold, Bold italic
Medium, Oblique, Bold
Roman, Italic, Bold, Bold italic
Light, Demi, LightItalic, DemiItalic
Medium, Oblique, Bold, BoldOblique
Medium, Oblique, Bold, Bold oblique
Utah Condensed
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 35
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Microsoft Windows 3.1 TrueType Compatible Fonts:
HL-
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/
2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460
ü
ü
ü
ü
Tennessee
Helsinki
BR Symbol
W Dingbats
Roman, Italic, Bold, Bold Italic
Medium, Oblique, Bold, BoldOblique
BR-Script Fonts:
HL-
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/
2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460
ü
Atlanta
Book, BookOblique, Demi,
DemiOblique
ü
ü
ü
Copenhagen
Portugal
Calgary
Roman, Italic, Bold, Bold italic
Roman, Italic, Bold, Bold italic
MediumItalic
Brother Original Fonts:
HL-
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/
2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460
ü
ü
ü
ü
Bermuda Script
German
US Roman
San Diego
You can select a font in any of these typefaces, specifying height (point size) and symbol set. Characters printed
in scalable fonts are always proportionally spaced - that is, the spacing between characters on a line depends on
their shapes. To add to the number of fonts available, you can buy scalable typeface cartridges/cards which you
can insert into the printer’s cartridge/card slots and scalable typeface disks from which you can copy the
typefaces into the printer’s memory. You can also create your own downloadable scalable typefaces, using
software commands.
5.1.4. Bound fonts
Bound fonts are fonts which have only a single symbol set.
5.1.5. Unbound fonts
Unbound fonts are fonts which have a large amount of symbols selected from a complementary symbol index
(intellifont) or unicode symbol index (TrueType).
5.1.6. Font sources
Depending on your printer model, fonts available to the printer can be in one of three places, either in the
printer’s ROM as supplied from the factory, on a cartridge/card, on the storage device, or in the printer’s RAM.
RAM fonts are downloaded from a personal computer.
5.1.7. Internal fonts
The printer comes with some bitmap fonts contained in its ROM and many scalable typefaces which can be used
to create scalable fonts.
5.1.8. Card/cartridge fonts
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 36
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
You can buy cartridge/card -based bitmap fonts and scalable typefaces. Plug the cartridge/card into one of the
printer’s cartridge/card slots and then select any font from them as if it were in the printer’s ROM. Depending on
your model, you can also save bitmap fonts and scalable typeface in the flash ROM memory, installed optional
storage device and you can use any of these as if they were a font card.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 37
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.1.9. Downloadable fonts
You can buy diskettes containing fonts which can be copied directly to the printer using the DOS COPY
command. You can also design your own fonts and download them to the printer.
One disadvantage of downloaded fonts is that they reside in the printer’s RAM memory. The printer also uses
this memory for composing the text and graphic output that it prints on the page. If the memory contains too
many fonts the printer may run out of memory. Since downloaded fonts are stored in the printer’s RAM they are
lost when the printer is switched off, and you must download them again before you can use them.
5.1.10. Primary and secondary fonts
The printer maintains two sets of font characteristics which define its primary and secondary fonts. The primary
font is the one it will use by default, the secondary font can be selected instead. This facility enables you to have
two parallel font definitions that you can switch between easily without invoking long escape sequences. You
can select the primary and secondary fonts using PCL commands.
Depending on your model, you can also set any available fonts to be the printer’s user default primary and
secondary fonts using the printer’s control panel. Refer to the User Guide for instructions on how to do this.
The factory default settings for both primary and secondary fonts are Brougham 12 point, 10 cpi Roman 8.
5.1.11. Specifying the primary font
When you specify primary font characteristics you send escape codes with ‘(’ as the second character of the
sequence. This tells the printer that the font characteristic you are specifying applies to the primary font.
5.1.12. Specifying the secondary font
When you specify secondary font characteristics you send escape codes with ‘)’ as the second character of the
sequence. This tells the printer that the font characteristic you are specifying applies to the secondary font.
5.1.13. Selecting the default fonts
To set the primary font settings to those of the printers default font and discard all the software settings you
have made in the meantime, send the printer the following escape sequence:
Esc(3@ (27)(40)(51)(64)
<1Bh><28h><33h><40h>
To set the secondary font settings to those of the printers default font send:
Esc)3@ (27)(41)(51)(64) <1Bh><29h><33h><40h>
5.1.14. Switching between the primary and secondary fonts
To select the primary font as the font for printing send the printer the SI control code:
SI (15)
(0F)
To select the secondary font as the font for printing send the printer the SO control code:
SO (14) (0E)
5.1.15. Criteria for font selection
The printer will try to match your stated font requirements as best it can with the fonts available to it in any of the
three possible font locations. In most cases you will be specifying a font you know to be present in one of the
locations and the resulting printed text will appear exactly as you envisaged. However, if you specify a particular
combination of font characteristics that is not possible, the printer will produce the closest possible match that it
can by satisfying the following specifications in the following order: symbol set / spacing type / pitch (for
monospaced fonts) / height / stroke weight / style.
The meanings of each of these are explained in the following sub-sections. Likewise, if you simply specify a font
attribute that is not available, for example if you request a Utah Light font when only Utah Medium and Utah Bold
are available in the font locations, the printer will simply ignore the requirement (light stroke weight, in this case)
that it cannot fulfill.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 38
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 39
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.1.16. Symbol set
The symbol set is the list of symbols that constitute a particular font. Normally, symbol sets contain lower and
upper case letters, numbers, punctuation marks and a selection of other commonly used symbols. Some symbol
sets are designed for specific needs, for example, for generating text with mathematical expressions. The symbol
set has the highest priority of all the characteristics you specify when you designate the font you require. If the
symbol set you choose is available, but not in conjunction with any of the other characteristics you specify, the
printer will satisfy your symbol set request at the expense of the rest of your designation and the text printed out
may well look completely different from what you expected to see.
5.1.17. Symbol collections
The symbol collections contain many symbols and a symbol set is made from symbol collections by selecting the
required symbols for unbound fonts. As symbol collections have more symbols than symbol sets, unbound
fonts can have more symbols than bound fonts. Due to the compatibility between symbol sets and symbol
collections, the printer searches the designated MSL or Unicode number by using a symbol set mapping table.
5.1.18. Type of character spacing
Character spacing is either fixed (monospacing), in which every printed character is allocated the same amount of
space on the line, or proportional, where characters are spaced according to their shape and size. For any serious
typographic work proportional spacing is essential since fixed spacing is unattractive and hard to read. In
general, monospacing is used with bitmap fonts and proportional spacing is used with scalable fonts. However,
proportionally spaced bitmap fonts do exist.
5.1.19. Pitch
Pitch is the number of characters that are printed per inch and therefore only applies to monospaced fonts. If you
make a pitch selection while using a proportionally spaced font the command will have no immediate effect.
However, the new pitch will be stored as part of the primary (or secondary) font designation and applied the next
time a monospaced font is selected as the primary (or secondary) font.
The printer’s in-built bitmap fonts all have a pitch of either 10, 12 or 16.66 characters per inch.
5.1.20. Height
Height refers to the height in points (1/72") of unaccented capital letters in a font. This is the generally accepted
method of defining the height of a font’s characters. Scaled fonts can be specified to an accuracy of 0.25 points.
5.1.21. Style
A font’s style is defined by its posture (upright or italic), width (condensed, normal or expanded) and structure
(solid, outline or shadow). Upright and italic bitmap fonts and scalable typefaces are available in the printer’s
ROM. However, these are all normal and solid fonts. To print using any of the other styles (for example, using
Condensed Helsinki or Outline Tennessee) you would have to download the requisite font or install a font
card/cartridge containing it.
5.1.22. Stroke weight
Stroke weight refers to the thickness of the lines which make up the printed characters. Characters of normal line
thickness are called medium. Thicker lines are referred to as bold or black and thinner lines as light or thin. You
can specify 15 different stroke weights - 0 denotes medium weight, negative values signify thinner strokes, and
positive values signify bolder (thicker) strokes. If you have the bold font available that matches your font
designation, a stroke weight selection of 1 to 7 will produce bold text. Likewise, for light or thin text you would
need to make the requisite light or thin font available for the stroke weight selection to have any effect.
5.1.23. Typeface
Typeface refers to the designed style of the characters. Commonly known typefaces include Times, Helvetica,
Univers and Palatino. The printer has its own resident typefaces. When selecting a particular typeface ensure
that it meets all your other specified criteria, otherwise the printer will substitute a font of a different typeface that
can satisfy the other, higher priority criteria, such as style and stroke weight.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 40
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.2. Font Selection Commands
5.2.1. User-defined symbol sets
User-defined symbol sets can be used with Unbound scalable fonts. Three new commands below are prepared
for use to control a user-defined symbol set.
To define a symbol set, its ID code must first be defined.
Next, a list of symbols for the symbol set must be downloaded.
Then, you can use the defined ID code for the symbol set selection.
5.2.2. Symbol set ID code command
Esc*c#R (27)(42)(99)#(82)
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<52h>
·
·
Value for # can be from 0 to 2047.
This command defines the ID code for a user-defined symbol set which can be used to control symbol set
selection.
·
·
The symbol set ID code defined by this command must be calculated by using the following formula.
Symbol Set ID Code = ( # x 32 ) + ( ID - 64 )
Symbol set selection values consists of numerical character(s) and an alphabetical character.
For example, 8U is the symbol set selection value for Roman-8. In this case, the Symbol set ID code
is 277 as the result of the following calculation.
(8 x 32 ) + (85 - 64) = 277
Make sure to select an unused number for a new ID code that you define. If the ID code has been used
already, the printer deletes the existing symbol set and defines the new symbol set.
5.2.3. Define symbol set
Esc(f#W[data] (27)(49)(102)#(87)
<1Bh><28h><66h>#<57h>
·
·
·
·
·
# value can be from 18 to 32767.
# stands for number of bytes of data that follow this command.
If an existing ID code is used for a user-defined symbol set, it is overwritten.
Up to 2047 downloadable user-defined symbol sets can be stored subject to the printer's memory capacity.
If a memory full error occurs while downloading the user-defined symbol set, the symbol set which is being
downloaded becomes invalid.
·
·
The symbol set which is defined by this command is temporarily stored in the printer memory.
The data following this command should be in the following format.
15
8
7
0
MSB
LSB
0 - 1 Header Size (18)
2 - 3 Encoded symbol set designator
4 - 5 Format
Symbol Set Type
6 - 7 First Code
8 - 9 Last Code
10 - Character Requirements
Symbol Map [Last Code - First code + 1 ]
(B)
Boolean
(0,1)
(UB)
(SB)
Unsigned Byte
Signed Byte
(0 ~ 255)
( -128 ~ 127 )
(UI)
(SI)
(ULI)
(SLI)
(ASC**)
Unsigned Integer
Signed Integer
( 0 ~ 65535 )
( - 32768 ~ 32767 )
Unsigned Long Integer ( 0 ~ 232-1)
Signed Long Integer
ASCII string array
(-231 ~ 231 - 1)
(0 ~ **-1) of characters
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 41
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
0 -1: Header size (UI) - set to 18 or greater.
This value stands for the number of header bytes.
2 -3 : Encoded Symbol Set Designator (UI) - should be as same as the ID code which is defined by ESC*c#R.
4 :
Format (UB) - 1 for MSL (Intellifont), 3 for Unicode (TrueType).
5 :
Symbol Set Type (UB) - 0, 1 or 2.
0 specifies a 7-bit font with character codes 20H to 7FH acceptable.
1 specifies an 8-bit font with character codes 20H to 7FH and 80H to FFH acceptable.
2 specifies 8-bit 256 all character fonts. Only when the printer is set to transparent print mode can the
characters 0, 7~15 and 27 be printed.
6 - 7: First Code (UI) - indicates the first code of definition data following this header.
8 -9: Last Code (UI) - indicates the last code of definition data following this header. This value should be more
than the first code value. Also, the data followed this header should have (Last code - first code + 1)
bytes.
10 - 17:
Character Requirement Flag ( 8 bytes )
Used in conjunction with the character complement field in the header of the font descriptor to decide the
compatibility of a symbol set for an unbound font. This flag indicates which symbol collections are
necessary to make the required symbol set.
Each bit in this field stands for the selection of each symbol collection. When set to 1, the symbol
collection is included and when set to 0, the symbol collection is not included in the unbound scalable
font.
Character Requirements for MSL Symbol index
Bit
Value
Designated Use
63
1
0
Basic Latin required (such as ISO 8859/1 Latin 1)
Basic Latin not required
62
61
1
0
1
0
East European Latin required (such as ISO 8859/2 Latin 2)
Basic European Latin not required
Turkish required (such as ISO 8859/9 Latin 5)
Turkish not required
34
1
0
Math required (such as Math-8)
Math not required
33
1
0
Semi-graphic required (such as PC-8 D/N)
Semi-graphic not required
32
1
0
Dingbats required (such as ITC Zapf Dingbats series 100, series 200 )
Dingbats not required
2,1,0
000
MSL Symbol index
Character Requirements for Unicode Symbol index
Bit
Value
Designated Use
31
1
0
ASCII required (such as ISO 6 ASCII)
ASCII not required
30
29
1
0
1
0
West Europe extensions required (such as ISO 69 French)
West Europe extensions not required
East Europe extensions required (such as ISO 8859/2 Latin 2)
East Europe extensions not required
28
1
0
Turkish extensions required (such as ISO 8859/9 Latin 5)
Turkish extensions not required
27
1
0
1
0
Desktop Publishing extensions required (such as Windows 3.1)
Desktop Publishing extensions not required
Accent extensions required (such as ISO 8859/1 Latin 1)
Accent extensions not required
26
25
1
0
PCL extensions required (such as Roman-8)
PCL extensions not required
24
1
0
Macintosh extensions required (such as MC text)
Macintosh extensions not required
23
1
0
PostScript extensions required (such as PS Text)
PostScript extensions not required
22
1
0
Code Page extensions required (such as PC-8)
Code Page extensions not required
2,1,0
001
Unicode Symbol Index
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 42
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Symbol map (Array of UI )
The symbol map, which has a list of symbol index numbers, is used to define the symbols for the symbol set.
This map defines the combinations of symbol index numbers and character codes.
5.2.4. Symbol set control command
Esc*c#S (27)(42)(99)#(83)
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<53h>
·
·
·
·
·
·
Values for # can be 0, 1, 2, 4, or 5.
0 specifies to delete all temporary and permanent user-defined symbol sets.
1 specifies to delete all temporary user-defined symbol sets.
2 specifies to delete current user-defined symbol set.
4 specifies to make current user-defined symbol set temporary.
5 specifies to make current user-defined symbol set permanent.
5.2.5. Selecting the symbol set
Esc(symbol set ID (27)(40)
This command selects the symbol set (character set) for the primary font.
<1Bh><28h>
·
·
·
Symbol set IDs consist of a number followed by a letter.
Default symbol set ID is Roman-8. If an invalid default symbol set ID is selected, the symbol set becomes
Roman-8.
·
The selectable symbol set varies depending on the printer model.
Symbol set
Set primary font
Esc(0D
Esc(1D
Esc(1E
Esc(9E
Esc(0F
Esc(1F
Esc(0G
Esc(1G
Esc(0I
Symbol set
Set primary font
Esc(2K
ISO 60 : Norwegian 1
ISO 61 : Norwegian 2
ISO 4 : United Kingdom
Windows 3.1 Latin 2
ISO 25 : French
ISO 69 : French
HP German
ISO 21 : German
ISO 15 : Italian
Microsoft Publishing
Desk Top
ISO 57 : Chinese
ISO8859-1 (ECMA-94) Latin 1
Wingdings
PS Math
Ventura Math
Math-8
Esc(0N
Esc(579L
Esc(5M
Esc(6M
Esc(8M
Esc(19M
Esc(2N
Esc(5N
Esc(0S
Esc(10J
Esc(13J
Esc(14J
Esc(4S
Symbol
ISO 8859-2 Latin 2
ISO 8859-9 Latin 5
ISO 11: Swedish; names
PS Text
Ventura International
Ventura US
ISO 16 : Portuguese
ISO 84 : Portuguese
Windows 3.1 Latin 5
ISO 6 : ASCII
ISO 2 : IRV
Windows 3.0 Latin 1
PC-8 D/N
Pi Font
Windows 3.1 Latin 1
Esc(6J
Esc(7J
HP Spanish
Esc(1S
Esc(2S
Esc(3S
Esc(0K
Esc(6S
Esc(9T
Esc(1U
Esc(8U
Esc(10U
Esc(12U
Esc(17U
Esc(12J
ISO 17 : Spanish
ISO 10 : Swedish
ISO 14 : JIS ASCII
ISO 85 : Spanish
PC Turkish
Legal
Roman 8
PC-8
PC-850
Esc(5S
Esc(5T
Esc(0U
Esc(2U
Esc(9U
Esc(11U
Esc(15U
Esc (19U
PC-852
MC Text
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 43
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
User-defined symbol sets are defined by the command ESC ( f # W.
Esc)symbol set ID (27)(41) <1Bh><29h>
This command selects the symbol set (character set) for the secondary font.
·
·
To select any of the above symbol sets for the secondary font simply substitute ‘)’ for ‘(’ in the command
shown in the table.
10 REM ****** SELECT A CHARACTER SET ******
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)
30 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
40 REM --- ROMAN-8 CHARACTER SET SELECTION ------
50 LPRINT ESC$+"(8U";
60 REM --- PRINT CHARACTERS ----
70 FOR I=160 TO 255
80 LPRINT CHR$(I);
90 NEXT
100 LPRINT
110 REM --- PC-8 CHARACTER SET SELECTION ------
120 LPRINT ESC$+"(10U";
130 REM --- PRINT CHARACTERS ----
140 FOR I=160 TO 255
150 LPRINT CHR$(I);
160 NEXT
170 LPRINT
180 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---
190 LPRINT CHR$(12);
200 END
There is a further group of symbol sets that are available for Brother fonts only. You can select these as follows:
Esc(s#C (27)(40)(115)#(67) <1Bh><28h><73h>#<43h>
This command selects the symbol set (character set) for the primary font.
·
Esc)s#C (27)(41)(115)#(67)
<1Bh><29h><73h>#<43h>
·
·
This command selects the symbol set (character set) for the secondary font.
Brother symbol set IDs consist of a number only.
Symbol Set
Roman-8
US ASCII
German
UK English
French
Dutch
Set primary font
Esc(s1C
Symbol set
Portuguese
Swiss German
American Spanish
Norwegian/Danish
Canadian
Finnish/Swedish
South African
PC-8 D/N
PC-8
PC-850
PC-860
PC-863
Set primary font
Esc(s15C
Esc(s16C
Esc(s17C
Esc(s18C
Esc(s19C
Esc(s20C
Esc(s21C
Esc(s23C
Esc(s25C
Esc(s26C
Esc(s27C
Esc(s28C
Esc(s29C
Esc(s38C
Esc(s2C
Esc(s3C
Esc(s4C
Esc(s5C
Esc(s6C
Esc(s7C
Esc(s8C
Esc(s9C
Esc(s10C
Esc(s11C
Esc(s12C
Esc(s13C
Esc(s14C
Italian
S. Spanish
A. English WP
UK ASCII/2
Symbol
International
American English
UK ASCII
PC-865
Japanese English
·
To select any of the above symbol sets for the secondary font simply substitute ‘)’ for ‘(’ in the command
shown in the table.
10 REM ****** SELECTING CHARACTER SETS ******
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)
30 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
40 REM --- GERMAN CHARACTER SET SELECTION ------
50 LPRINT ESC$+"(s3C";
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 44
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
60 REM --- PRINT CHARACTERS ----
70 FOR I=33 TO 127
80 LPRINT CHR$(I);
90 NEXT
100 LPRINT
110 REM --- FRENCH CHARACTER SET SELECTION ------
120 LPRINT ESC$+"(s5C";
130 REM --- PRINT CHARACTERS ----
140 FOR I=33 TO 127
150 LPRINT CHR$(I);
160 NEXT
170 LPRINT
180 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---
190 LPRINT CHR$(12);
200 END
5.2.6. Selecting the type of character spacing
Esc(s#P (27)(40)(115)#(80)<1Bh><28h><73h>#<50h>
·
This command selects the spacing type for the primary font.
Esc)s#P (27)(41)(115)#(80)
<1Bh><29h><73h>#<50h>
·
·
This command selects the spacing type for the secondary font.
# = 0 selects fixed spacing and # = 1 selects proportional spacing.
10 REM ****** SELECTING A PROPORTIONAL OR FIXED SPACE FONT ******
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)
30 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
40 REM --- SELECT A PROPORTIONALLY SPACED FONT ----
50 LPRINT ESC$+"(s1P";
60 FOR I=33 TO 127
70 LPRINT CHR$(I);
80 NEXT
90 LPRINT
100 REM --- SELECT A FIXED SPACE FONT ---
110 LPRINT ESC$+"(s0P";
120 FOR I=33 TO 127
130 LPRINT CHR$(I);
140 NEXT
150 LPRINT
160 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---
170 LPRINT CHR$(12);
180 END
5.2.7. Selecting the pitch
Esc(s#H (27)(40)(115)#(72)<1Bh><28h><73h>#<48h>
This command designates the pitch for the primary font.
Esc)s#H (27)(41)(115)#(72)<1Bh><29h><73h>#<48h>
·
·
This command designates the pitch for the secondary font.
# = the number of characters to be printed per inch. However, the actual size range is defined in combination
with the character height.
·
The printer’s in-built bitmap fonts all have a pitch of either 10, 12 or 16.66 characters per inch, and you can
specify any of these as follows:
Esc&k0S
Esc&k2S
Esc&k4S
( 10 cpi )
( 16.66 cpi )
( 12 cpi )
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 45
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
·
The selection will apply to whichever font you are currently specifying (primary or secondary).
If the printer doesn't have the specified size font, the next largest size font is used. If the printer doesn't have
a larger sized font, the next smallest one is used.
·
This value is ignored by the printer when a proportional spaced font is selected.
10 REM ****** CHARACTER PITCH SELECTION ******
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)
30 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
40 REM --- SELECT A 10 CPI PITCH FONT ----
50 LPRINT ESC$+"(s10H";
60 FOR I=33 TO 127
70 LPRINT CHR$(I);
80 NEXT
90 LPRINT
100 REM --- SELECT A 12 CPI PITCH FONT ---
110 LPRINT ESC$+"(s12H";
120 FOR I=33 TO 127
130 LPRINT CHR$(I);
140 NEXT
150 LPRINT
160 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---
170 LPRINT CHR$(12);
180 END
5.2.8. Selecting the height
Esc(s#V (27)(40)(115)#(86)<1Bh><28h><73h>#<56h>
This command designates the height of the primary font.
Esc)s#V (27)(41)(115)#(86)<1Bh><29h><73h>#<56h>
·
·
·
This command designates the height of the secondary font.
# is the size in points (1/72") from 0.25 to 999.75 in 0.25 increments.
This value is ignored by the printer when a fixed-spaced scalable font is selected.
5.2.9. Scaling the scalable fonts vertically or horizontally
EscCR!#H (27)(13)(33)#(72)<1Bh><0Dh><21h>#<48h>
This command designates the height of the scalable fonts.
EscCR!#V (27)(13)(33)#(86)<1Bh><0Dh><21h>#<56h>
This command designates the width of the scalable fonts.
·
·
# can be from 0.25 ~ 3.00 in 0.01 increments.
# value is set to 0.25 when # is specified less than 0.25, and # value is set to 3.00 when # is specified bigger
than 3.00.
·
The value set by this command is initialized when the emulation is changed, a printer Reset, Test Print or
Macro overlay is executed.
5.2.10. Selecting the style
Esc(s#S (27)(40)(115)#(83)<1Bh><28h><73h>#<53h>
·
This command designates the style of the primary font.
Esc)s#S (27)(41)(115)#(83)<1Bh><29h><73h>#<53h>
·
·
This command designates the style of the secondary font.
If you select a particular style (for example upright condensed outline) the command will only take effect if the
font is available in one of the three font locations.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 46
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Value
0
1
Font Style
Upright & solid
Italic
4
Condensed
5
8
Condensed italic
Compressed, or extra condensed
Expanded
Outline
Inline
24
32
64
128
160
Shadowed
Outline shadowed
10 REM ****** PRINT IN ITALIC & UPRIGHT STYLE ******
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)
30 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
40 REM --- PRINT USING AN ITALIC FONT ----
50 LPRINT ESC$+"(s1S";
60 REM --- PRINT FONT ----
70 FOR I=33 TO 127
80 LPRINT CHR$(I);
90 NEXT
100 LPRINT
110 REM --- PRINT USING AN UPRIGHT FONT ---
120 LPRINT ESC$+"(s0S";
130 REM --- PRINT FONT ----
140 FOR I=33 TO 127
150 LPRINT CHR$(I);
160 NEXT
170 LPRINT
180 REM -- PAPER EJECT ---
190 LPRINT CHR$(12);
200 END
5.2.11. Selecting the stroke weight
Esc(s#B (27)(40)(115)#(66)<1Bh><28h><73h>#<42h>
This command designates the stroke weight of the primary font.
·
Esc)s#B (27)(41)(115)#(66)<1Bh><29h><73h>#<42h>
·
·
This command designates the stroke weight of the secondary font
# is an integer between –7 and 7. A value of 0 signifies a medium stroke weight, negative numbers signify thin
or light stroke weights and positive numbers signify bold stroke weights.
·
If you select a light or bold stroke weight the command will only have an effect if the font is available in one of
the three font locations.
5.2.12. Selecting the typeface
Esc(s#T (27)(40)(115)#(84)<1Bh><28h><73h>#<54h>
·
This command designates the typeface of the primary font.
Esc)s#T (27)(41)(115)#(84)<1Bh><29h><73h>#<54h>
·
·
This command designates the typeface of the secondary font.
If the typeface you specify is not available in any of the three font source locations the printer will substitute
a font of a different typeface.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 47
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
The available values vary with the printer model. The following table shows the value for each typeface and
availability.
Typeface
Set primary
font
Set secondary 1050 1250/ 1070 1270N 1660e 2400C 3400CN
font
P2500
/ 2060 /Ce
Alaska
Antique Oakland
Brougham
Cleveland Condensed
Connecticut
Guatemala Antique
LetterGothic
Maryland
Esc(s4362T
Esc(s4168T
Esc(s4099T
Esc(s4140T
Esc(s4116T
Esc(s4197T
Esc(s4102T
Esc(s4297T
Esc(s4113T
Esc(s4143T
Esc(s4101T
Esc(s4148T
Esc)s4362T
Esc)s4168T
Esc)s4099T
Esc)s4140T
Esc)s4116T
Esc)s4197T
Esc)s4102T
Esc)s4297T
Esc)s4113T
Esc)s4143T
Esc)s4101T
Esc)s4148T
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Oakland
PC Brussels
PC Tennessee
Utah
BR Symbol
Helsinki
Tennessee
W Dingbats
Esc(s16686T
Esc(s16602T
Esc(s16901T
Esc(s31402T
Esc)s16686T
Esc)s16602T
Esc)s16901T
Esc)s31402T
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Atlanta
Calgary
Copenhagen
Portugal
Esc(s155T
Esc(s159T
Esc(s157T
Esc(s158T
Esc)s155T
Esc)s159T
Esc)s157T
Esc)s158T
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Letter Gothic16.66
Brougham
OCR-A
Esc(s130T
Esc(s128T
Esc(s104T
Esc(s110T
Esc)s130T
Esc)s128T
Esc)s104T
Esc)s110T
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
OCR-B
Bermuda Script
Germany
San Diego
US Roman
Esc(s134T
Esc(s132T
Esc(s133T
Esc(s135T
Esc)s134T
Esc)s132T
Esc)s133T
Esc)s135T
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
5.2.13. Font orientation
The printer’s built-in fonts are all portrait fonts. If you switch the orientation of the logical page to landscape and
select a font, the printer will automatically create the landscape font in its memory. This saves you having to make
the landscape font available by installing a card/cartridge or by downloading the font, but takes up printer
memory and may cause the printer to run out of space when trying to compose complex page layouts.
5.2.14. Transparent print data
Esc&p#X (character codes)
(27)(38)(112)#(88)
<1Bh><26h><70h>#<58h>
·
·
·
This command enables you to print characters which are normally unprintable.
# is the number of bytes of data that follow the command.
Each byte of data is interpreted as a character code and the corresponding character in the currently selected
symbol set is printed (if there is one). You can use this command to print the symbols in the character set
which do not appear on the keyboard.
·
·
If there is no character in the current symbol set corresponding to a specified code, a space is printed.
The command is useful when using character sets like the IBM All Character Set in which every single code
has a corresponding character.
·
Any control codes within the data will have no effect. The control code byte is treated as a character code.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 48
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.2.15. Underlining text
Esc&d#D (27)(38)(100)#(68)
<1Bh><26h><64h>#<44h>
·
·
·
·
This command enables the underline facility.
# is either 0 or 3. A value of 0 signifies fixed underlining, 3 specifies floating underlining.
Fixed underlining means that the underline is drawn in the same place for all the characters of a particular font.
Floating underlining means that the underline is drawn in the same place for all the characters on a particular
line.
·
The command below disables the underline facility.
Esc&d@
(27)(38)(100)(64) <1Bh><26h><64h><40h>
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 49
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.3. Downloadable font manipulation
Fonts that you have bought on diskette can be downloaded to the printer from diskette or hard disk using the
DOS COPY command or a font downloading applications program. To create your own fonts you can use PCL
commands to send the various blocks of data that comprise a downloadable font. There are also a number of PCL
commands that enable you to manage fonts that you have already downloaded (both those that you have bought
and those you may have created yourself).
If you are using commercially available fonts consult the documentation that came with them for information on
how best to send them to the printer.
5.3.1. Font ID
Esc&*c#D (27)(38)(42)(99)#(68)
<1Bh><26h><2Ah><63h>#<44h>
·
·
·
This command identifies the numerical ID of the font on which subsequent operations will be performed.
# is the font ID number.
Use this command to specify the ID number of a font that you are about to download, or of a font already in
printer memory that you want to perform a particular operation on.
·
If you specify the number of a font that already exists in memory and then download a new font from your
computer, the new font will overwrite the original font and assume the ID number that you specified.
5.3.2. Operations on downloaded fonts
Esc*c#F (27)(38)(42)(99)#(70)
<1Bh><26h><2Ah><63h>#<46h>
·
·
·
·
This command performs an operation on one or more downloaded fonts.
# identifies the operation to be performed.
# = 0 Delete all downloaded fonts from the printer’s memory.
# = 1 Delete all temporary fonts from the printer’s memory.
(Fonts can be made permanent so as to be saved when the printer is reset - see below).
·
·
# = 2 Delete the font (whose ID number was most recently specified) from the printer’s memory.
# = 3 Delete the character (whose character code was most recently specified) from the font (whose ID number
was most recently specified).
(The command for specifying a character code is given in the section entitled Creating Downloadable
Fonts).
·
·
·
·
·
·
# = 4 Make the font (whose ID number was most recently specified) temporary
# = 5 Make the font (whose ID number was most recently specified) permanent
# = 6 Make/Assign a copy of the current font (primary or secondary) with the last specified ID number.
# = 1026 Delete the font (whose ID number was most recently specified) from the storage device.
# = 1028 Delete all download fonts in the storage device.
# = 1029 Save the font (whose ID number was most recently specified) into the storage device.
(All download fonts in the storage device are permanent fonts.)
·
Note: #=1026, 1028, 1029 are available only when a storage device is installed into the printer.
5.3.3. Selecting a downloaded font
Esc(#X (27)(40)#(88)
This command selects a downloaded font as the primary font.
<1Bh><28h>#<58h>
·
Esc)#X
(27)(41)#(88)
<1Bh><29h>#<58h>
·
·
This command selects a downloaded font as the secondary font.
# is the ID number of the downloaded font.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 50
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.4. Creating Downloadable Fonts
5.4.1. Downloading
You can download existing fonts (that is, ones that you have bought or ones that you have created previously)
using either a font downloading application program or the DOS command
COPY/b <filename> PRN
In addition, some word-processing and DeskTop publishing programs will automatically download the fonts that
have been used in a document when that document is printed.
Alternatively, you can create a new downloadable font and download the necessary blocks of data that comprise
the downloadable font using PCL commands.
To send a font, you must send
* a font descriptor block followed by the character code
* a character descriptor
* data for each character
The printer can download 3 types of fonts.
Bitmap fonts, Bound Scalable fonts and Unbound Scalable fonts.
5.4.2. Sending the font descriptor
Esc)s#W (font descriptor data) (27)(40)(115)#(58) <1Bh><28h><73h>#<88h>
·
·
·
·
This command sends the font descriptor to the printer.
# should be in the range 0 to 32767.
# is the number of bytes in the descriptor.
Characters are designed on a notional grid known as the character cell. The positioning and shape of each
character on the grid defines its size, shape and alignment to the other characters in the font.
Cell width
Cell height
Baseline distance
x-height
Baseline
Underline distance
Underline thickness
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 51
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
The Font descriptor has information for the whole character set. When this font descriptor is sent to the
printer with a font header to identify the font ID, the descriptor parameters become the basis of the
downloaded fonts.
·
The data format for each type of font descriptor block is shown below.
<Bitmap font>
Byte 15 (MSB)
8
7
(LSB) 0
0 Font Descriptor Size (64)
4 Style MSB
Reserved
6 Base Line Position
8 Cell Width
12 Orientation
Spacing
14 Symbol Set
16 Pitch (Default HMI)
20 x-Height
22 Width Type
24 Stroke Weight
28 Quality
Style LSB
Typeface LSB
Placement
30 Underline Distance
32 Text Height
Underline Height
36 First Code
38 Last Code
40 Pitch Extended
Height Extended
44 - 47 Font Number
48 - 63 Font Name
64 Copyright (optional)
<Special Bitmap font>
Byte 15 (MSB)
2 Descriptor Format (20)
4 Style MSB
8
7
(LSB) 0
Font Type
Reserved
6 Base Line Position
10 Cell Height
12 Orientation
Spacing
14 Symbol Set
18 Height
20 x-Height
22 Width Type
26 Typeface MSB
28 Quality
Style LSB
Serif Style
Placement
30 Underline Distance
Underline Height
34 Text Width
36 First Code
38 Last Code
42 Cap Height
44 - 47 Font Number
48 - 63 Font Name
66 Y Resolution
X=Y: 300 or 600
n
Copyright (Optional)
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 52
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
<Intellifont Scalable Bound font>
0 Font Descriptor Size (>80)
2 Descriptor Format (10)
4 Style MSB
Font Type
Reserved
8 Cell Width
10 Cell Height
12 Orientation
Spacing
16 Pitch (Default HMI)
18 Height
20 x-Height
24 Stroke Weight
26 Typeface MSB
28 Quality
Typeface LSB
Serif Style
Placement
32 Text Height
34 Text Width
36 First Code
40 Pitch Extended
42 Cap Height
Height Extended
44 - 47 Font Number
64 Scale Factor
66 Master X Resolution
68 Master Y Resolution
72 Master Underline Thickness (Height)
74 OR Threshold
76 Global Italic Angle
80 Global Intellifont Data
n
Copyright (optional)
Reserved
Checksum
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 53
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
<Intellifont Scalable Unbound font>
Byte 15 (MSB)
0 Font Descriptor Size (<88)
2 Descriptor Format (11)
4 Style MSB
8
7
(LSB) 0
Font Type (10)
Reserved
6 Base Line Position
8 Cell Width
10 Cell Height
12 Orientation
Spacing
14 Symbol Set
16 Pitch (Default HMI)
18 Height
20 x-Height
22 Width Type
24 Stroke Weight
26 Typeface MSB
28 Quality
Style LSB
Typeface LSB
Serif Style
Placement
30 Underline Distance
32 Text Height
34 Text Width
Underline Thickness
36 Reserved
38 Number of Contours (Characters)
40 Pitch Extended
Height Extended
42 Cap Height
44 - 47 Font Number
48 - 63 Font Name
64 Scale Factor
66 Master X Resolution
68 Master Y Resolution
70 Master Underline Position
72 Master Underline Thickness
74 OR Threshold
76 Global Italic Angle
78-85 Character Complement
Desc. Size Global Intellifont Data size
- 2
Desc. size Global Intellifont Data
n
Copyright (optional)
Reserved
Checksum
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 54
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
<TrueType Scalable Bound font>
Byte 15 (MSB)
8
7
(LSB) 0
0 Font Descriptor Size (>72)
2 Descriptor Format (15)
4 Style MSB
Font Type
Reserved
6 Base Line Position
8 Cell Width
10 Cell Height
12 Orientation
Spacing
14 Symbol Set
16 Pitch (Default HMI)
18 Height
20 x-Height
22 Width Type
Style LSB
24 Stroke Weight
26 Typeface MSB
28 Quality
Typeface LSB
Serif Style
Placement
30 Underline Distance
32 Text Height
Underline Thickness
34 Text Width
36 First Code
38 Last Code / Number of characters
40 Pitch Extended
42 Cap Height
Height Extended
44 - 47 Font Number
48 - 63 Font Name
64 Scale Factor
66 Master Underline position
68 Master Underline Thickness
70 Font Scaling Technology
Variety
72 [ additional data may be inserted here ]
Desc. size Segmented Font data
# - 2 Reserved
Checksum
·
Attributes are in one of six numerical formats.
Unsigned integer (UI) 0 to 65535
Unsigned long integer (ULI) 0 to 232–1
Signed integer (SI) –32768 to 32767
Unsigned byte (UB) 0 to 255
Signed byte (SB) –128 to 127
Boolean 0 or 1
·
·
Font descriptor size (UI) - the size in bytes of the font descriptor block. Minimum size values for each font
type are shown in the above figure.
Descriptor format (UB) - format type of the font.
0
Bitmap font
10
11
15
20
Intellifont bound scalable font
Intellifont unbound scalable font
TrueType bound scalable font
Special bitmap font
·
Font type (UB) - specifies type of symbol set.
0
1
2
Bound font. A 7-bit font with character codes 20H to 7FH acceptable.
Bound font. An 8-bit font with character codes 20H to 7FH and 80H to FFH acceptable.
Bound font. 8-bit all character codes are printable. However, 00H, 07H to 0FH and 1BH are printable
only when the data is defined as transparent print data.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 55
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 56
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
10
11
Unbound font. Character codes corresponding to MSL numbers are acceptable.
Unbound font. Character codes corresponding to Unicode numbers are acceptable.
When a 7-bit font or 8-bit font is selected, it is possible for codes 00H to FFH to load characters or delete
them. It is also possible to print the characters if they are defined as transparent print data.
·
Style MSB (UW) - combined with the Style LSB to make the style word. The value of the style word is
calculated as follows: style word = posture + (4 width) + (32 structure).
Value
Posture
0
1
2
3
Upright
Italic
Alternate Italic
Reserved
Value
Width
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Normal
Condensed
Compressed or Extra Condensed
Extra compressed
Ultra compressed
Reserved
Extended or Expanded
Extra Extended or Extra Expanded
Value
Structure
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Solid
Outline
In-line
Contour
Solid with Shadow
Outline with Shadow
Inline with Shadow
Contour with Shadow
Patterned (Complex patterns, subject to type family )
Patterned with Shadow
Inverse
8-11
12-15
16
17
18-30
31
Inverse in Open Border
Reserved
Unknown structure
The reserved bits should be set to Zero.
·
Baseline position (UI) -
Bitmap font -
the height in dots from the top of the character cell to the baseline. The units of dots is
the same as the defined font resolution. This number can be in the range 0 to (cell
height - 1).
Intellifont scalable - a Y coordinate in the design cell.
TrueType scalable - the height in dots from the top of the character cell to the baseline. This should be set
to 0.
·
·
Cell width (UI) - ignored by these printers. The width in dots of the character cell. This can be from 1 to 65535.
Cell height (UI) - ignored by these printers. The height in dots of the character cell. This can be from 1 to
65535.
·
Orientation (UB) - 0(portrait), 1(landscape), 2(reverse portrait) or 3(reverse landscape). Ignored by these
printers.
·
·
Spacing (B) - the type of spacing, 0 (fixed pitch) or 1 (proportional spacing).
Symbol set (UI) - a symbol set ID consists of a number and a letter. The symbol set attribute value is
calculated as follows: symbol set = (32 x number) + (ASCII value of letter - 64). For example, Math-8 has the
symbol set ID ‘8M’ so it would be encoded as (32 x 8) + (77 – 64) = 269.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 57
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Symbol set name
Symbol set ID Symbol set name
Symbol set ID
Default Set
Line Draw-7
ISO 60: Danish/Norwegian
Roman Extensions
ISO 25: French
HP German
0@
0B
0D
0E
Math-7
0A
0C
1D
1E
HP Large Characters (264x Terminals)
ISO 61: Norwegian version 2
ISO 4: United Kingdom
ISO 69: French
ISO 21: German
Hebrew-7
ISO 15: Italian
DeskTop
PS Text
Ventura US
ISO 13: Katakana
Kana-8
Line Draw-7 (Same as 0B)
Tax Line Draw
Math-7 (Same as 0A)
PS Math
Math-8
ECMA-94 Latin 2 (ISO 8859/2)
ECMA-113/88 Latin/Cyrillic
OCR B
APL (Typewriter Paired)
Specials
0F
1F
0G
8G
8H
6J
1G
0H
0I
Greek-8
Hebrew-8
Microsoft Publishing
Document
Ventura International
ISO 14: JIS ASCII
ISO 57: Chinese
Korean-8
HP Block Characters
Line Draw-8
Tech-7
7J
8J
10J
14J
1K
8K
0L
13J
0K
2K
9K
1L
2L
8L
0M
5M
8M
2N
10N
1O
0P
xQ
1R
0S
2S
4S
6S
8S
17S
8T
0U
2U
7U
9U
11U
17U
0V
0Y
2Y
5Y
7Y
15Y
1M
6M
0N
5N
0O
2O
1P
0R
3R
1S
3S
5S
7S
16S
18S
0T
1U
5U
8U
10U
12U
15U
8V
1Y
4Y
6Y
8Y
Ventura Math
ECMA-94 Latin 1 (ISO 8859/1)
ECMA-128 Latin 5 (ISO 8859/9)
OCR A
OCR M
APL (Bit Paired)
Cyrillic ASCII (ECMA-113/86, ISO
PC Cyrillic
Cyrillic
ISO 11: Swedish for Names
ISO 17: Spanish
ISO 16: Portuguese
ISO 85: Spanish
HP Latin Spanish
HP-GL Drafting
Turkish-8
ISO 6: ASCII
ISO 2: International Reference Version
OEM-1
Windows
PC-8 D/N (Danish/Norwegian)
PC-852
Arabic (McKay’s version)
3 of 9 Barcode
Matrix 2 of 5 Barcode
CODABAR Barcode
Code 11 Barcode
USPS Zip
HP Spanish
ISO 10: Swedish
ISO 84: Portuguese
HP European Spanish
HP-GL Download
HP-GL Special Symbols
Thai-8
Legal
HP-GL Language Set
Roman-8
PC-8
PC-850
Pi Font
Arabic-8
Industrial 2 of 5 Barcode
Interleaved 2 of 5 Barcode
MSI/Plessey Barcode
UPC/EAN Barcode
·
Pitch (UI) - This value defines the default spacing for each point size in 1/4 dots. Combined with Pitch
Extended to specify the pitch of the font in 1/1024 dots. This is available for fixed pitch font characters
including the space character, and the space character of proportional spacing fonts.
For example, in case of a 17 cpi font (at 600 dpi),
1 inch
600 dpi
1 inch
4
= 141.17646
17 chara.
1
the value of Pitch (UI) should be 141.
The remainder of 0.17646 is calculated as pitch extended:
0.17646
256
1
= 45.17376
4
the value for pitch extended is 45.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 58
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
For Intellifont-scalable fonts only, the default HMI is calculated as follows.
Default HMI (in dots) = (300 x master design pitch x required point size) ÷
{Master x Resolution ÷(height x 8)}
Default HMI ( in dots ) =
(300 x master design pitch x required point size) ÷ {72.307 x scale factor}
Height (UI) - specifies the height of the font in 1/4 dots. Combined with Height Extended to specify the
height of the font in 1/1024 dots. This value can be converted to the point size (1/72").
For example, in case of a 10 point font at 300 dpi,
4
1
300 dots
1 inch
10 point
= 166.667
1 dots
72
This value is normally set to 2000 for Intellifont and should be set to zero for TrueType fonts.
·
·
x-height (UI) - ignored by the HL Series printers. This word specifies the height (for Bitmap fonts) or the
distance from the baseline (for Scalable fonts) of a lower case ‘x’ in 1/4 dots.
Width type (SB) - ignored by the HL Series printers. This byte specifies the font character width according to
the table below.
Value
–5
Width type
Ultra compressed
Extra compressed
Compressed or Extra condensed
Condensed
–4
–3
–2
0
Normal
2
Expanded
3
Extra expanded
·
·
Style LSB (UB) - see Style MSB.
Stroke weight (SB) - valid values are from –7 to +7. 0 denotes the normal (Roman) stroke width, –7 is the
lightest possible stroke and 7 is the boldest.
Value
–7
–6
–5
–4
–3
–2
–1
0
Stroke Weight
Ultra thin
Extra thin
Thin
Extra light
Light
Demi light
Semi light
Medium, Book, or Text
Semi bold
Demi bold
Bold
1
2
3
4
5
Extra bold
Black
6
7
Extra black
Ultra black
·
Typeface family (UB) – the typeface. This word is made up of the Typeface MSB and the Typeface LSB and
identifies the typeface by number.
Bits 0 to 11 specify the typeface family and bits 12 to 15 specify the vending company.
15
12 11
Typeface Family
Vendor
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 59
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Value
Vendor
0
1
2
3
4
5
Reserved
Agfa Division, Miles Inc.
Bitstream Inc.
Linotype Company
The Monotype Corporation plc
Adobe Systems Inc.
The Typeface family number can be 0 to 4095. This value is calculated as follows;
(TrueType base value) + (Vendor value x 4096) = Typeface Family
·
Serif style (UB) -
Bitmap font - ignored by these printers.
Scalable font - values for the lower 6 bits are ignored and values for the upper 2 bits indicates the serif style.
Bit 6 indicates sans serif and bit 7 indicates serif.
·
·
·
Quality (UB) - ignored by these HL Series printers. This byte specifies the fonts quality according to the
following table.
Placement (SB) - ignored by these HL Series printers. This byte specifies the placement of characters relative
to the baseline according to the following table.
Underline distance (SB) -
Bitmap fonts - the distance in dots from the baseline to the underline. A positive value places the underline
above the baseline, a negative value places it below the baseline. A value of 0 places it on the baseline.
Scalable fonts - ignored by these printers. This value should be set to 0.
·
·
·
Underline height (UB) - the height of underline itself.
Bitmap fonts - this value is fixed at 3 dots.
Scalable fonts - ignored by these printers. This value should be set to 0.
Text height (UI) - ignored by these HL Series printers.
This word specifies the spacing between successive lines of text in 1/4 dots for bitmap fonts and in design
units for scalable fonts. This is normally about 1.2 times the fonts height.
Text width (UI) - ignored by these HL Series printers.
This word specifies the average width of the fonts lowercase characters in 1/4 dots for bitmap fonts and in
design units for scalable fonts.
·
·
·
First code (UI) - ignored by these printers. This word specifies the character code of the first (lowest
numbered) printable character in the font.
Last code (UI) - specifies the character code of the last (highest numbered) character in the font. If this value
is less than 255, it is recognized as 00FFH.
Pitch extended (UB) - the fractional part of the character pitch. For a 17 cpi font the bytes value would be
calculated as follows:
-
-
1200/17 = 70.588 The Pitch byte takes the value 70.
Pitch Extended = 0.588 X 256 = 150 (rounded down).
( According to HP's manual, this should be set to 0.) This printer ignores the value for scalable fonts.
·
·
Height extended (UB) - the fractional part of the height of the font. For a 10 point font the bytes value would
be calculated as follows:
1200 X 10/72 = 166.667, the Height byte takes the value 166
Height Extended = 0.667 X 256 = 170 (rounded down).
Point size = (character height x 256 + extended character height) x 300 / (72 x 1024)
( According to HP's manual, this should be set to 0.) These printers ignore the value for scalable fonts.
Cap height data (UI) - ignored by these HL Series printers. This word specifies for the font the distance
between the baseline and the top of an unaccented capital letter (for example, ‘H’), as a percentage of the
font’s em rule, ‘—’.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 60
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
Font number (ULI) - ignored by these HL Series printers. This 4-byte field specifies the number assigned to
the font by the vending company. The number is stored as a hexadecimal value in the lower three bytes, bytes
44, 45 and 46.
·
·
Font name (16 bytes) - ignored by these HL Series printers. This 16-byte field can be used to specify a name
for the font.
X-Resolution (UI) - specifies the resolution in the X-scan direction.
This value can be 300 or 600 for bitmap fonts, and is normally set to 2540 for Intellifont scalable fonts. This is
used for scaling the X-coordinates of font data to the required point size.
After scaling ( in dots ) =
(300 x the required point size x X-coordinate) ÷ {72.307 x scale factor (8782)}
After scaling ( in dots ) =
(300 x the required point size x X-coordinate) ÷ {Master X-resolution x (Height ÷ 8) }
·
Y-Resolution (UI) - specifies the resolution in the Y-scan direction.
This value should be set to 300 or 600 dpi for special bitmap fonts and is not available for Bitmap fonts and
TrueType fonts.
This is normally set to 2540 for Intellifont -scalable fonts and is used for scaling the Y-coordinates of the font
data to the required point size.
This value is calculated as:
After scaling ( in dots ) = (300 x the required point size x Y-coordinate) ÷ (72.307 x scale factor (8782) )
After scaling ( in dots ) = (300 x the required point size x Y-coordinate) ÷
{Master Y-resolution x
(Height ÷8)}
·
Scale Factor (UI) - specifies the number of design units per Em. This value can be the unit for the metrics of
Intellifont / TrueType scalable fonts.
This is normally set to 8782 and is calculated for Intellifont as follows:
·
·
·
Scale factor x 72.307 = resolution x height ÷ 8
This is normally set to 2048 for TrueType fonts.
Master Underline position (UI) - Specifies the distance from the baseline to the top of the underline in design
units and this is an alternative for "Underline Position (bit 30)" only for scalable fonts.
·
Master Underline height (UI) - specifies the height of the underline itself in design units and this is an
alternative for "Underline Thickness (bit 31)" only for scalable fonts.
·
·
·
Font Scaling Technology (UB) - specifies the type of font scaling technology for any scalable fonts.
Variety (UB) - only for TrueType fonts, this value should be set to 0.
OR (LRE) Threshold (UI) - specifies the pixel size in design units. This is switched on between scaling the font
and its rasterization.
·
Global Italic Angle (SI) - specifies the italic angle as a tangent relative to the vertical. The value 0 makes
upright fonts.
·
·
·
Global Intellifont Data Size (UI) - indicates the size of the global Intellifont data block.
Global Intellifont Data - includes the global intellifont data.
Character Complement (Array of UB) - identifies the symbol set compatibility for unbound fonts used with the
Character Requirement flag in the symbol set descriptor.
MSL Symbol Index
Bit Field
58 - 63
55 - 57
52 - 54
50 - 51
48 - 49
3 - 47
Designated Use
Reserved for Latin fonts.
Reserved for Cyrillic fonts.
Reserved for Arabic fonts.
Reserved for Greek fonts.
Reserved for Hebrew fonts.
Miscellaneous uses (South Asian, Armenian, other alphabets,
bar codes, OCR, Math, PC Semi-graphics, etc.)
Symbol Index field. 111 - MSL Symbol Index
0 - 2
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 61
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Unicode Symbol Index
Bit Field
Designated Use
32 - 63
Miscellaneous uses (South Asian, Armenian, other alphabets, bar codes,
OCR, Math, etc.)
28 - 31
22 - 27
3 - 21
0 - 2
Reserved for Latin fonts.
Reserved for platform / application variant fonts.
Reserved for Cyrillic, Arabic, Greek and Hebrew fonts.
Symbol Index field. 110 - Unicode Symbol Index
MSL Symbol Index Character Complement bits
Bit Field
Designated Use
63
0 if font is compatible with standard Latin character sets (e.g., Roman-8,
ISO 8859-1 Latin 1); otherwise set to 1.
62
0 if font is compatible with East European Latin character sets (e.g., ISO
8859-2 Latin 2); otherwise set to 1.
61
0 if font contains Turkish character sets (e.g., ISO 8859/9 Latin 5);
otherwise set to 1.
34
0 if font has access to the math characters of the Math-8, PS Math and
Ventura Math character sets; otherwise set to 1.
0 if font has access to the semi-graphic character of the PC-8, PC-850,
etc. character sets; otherwise set to 1.
33
32
0 if font is compatible with ITC Zapf Dingbats series 100, 200, etc.;
otherwise set to 1.
2,1,0
111 if font is arranged in MSL symbol Index order.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 62
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.4.3. Unicode symbol index character complement bits
Bit Field
Designated Use
31
30
0 if font is compatible with 7-bit ASCII; otherwise set to 1.
0 if font is compatible with ISO 8859/1 Latin 1 (West Europe) character
sets; otherwise set to 1.
29
28
27
26
0 if font is compatible with ISO 8859/2 Latin 2 (East Europe) character
sets; otherwise set to 1.
0 if font is compatible with Latin 5 (Turkish) character sets (e.g., ISO
8859/9 Latin 5, PC-Turkish); otherwise set to 1.
0 if font is compatible with Desktop Publishing character sets (e.g.,
Windows 3.1 Latin 1, DeskTop, MC Text); otherwise set to 1.
0 if font is compatible with character sets requiring a wider
selection of accents (e.g., MC Text, ISO 8859/1 Latin 1);
otherwise set to 1.
25
0 if font is compatible with traditional PCL character sets (e.g., Roman-8,
Legal, ISO 4 United Kingdom); otherwise set to 1.
0 if font is compatible with the Macintosh character set (MS
Text); otherwise set to 1.
24
23
0 if font is compatible with PostScript Standard Encoding (PS Text);
otherwise set to 1.
22
0 if font is compatible with Code Pages (e.g., PC-8, PC-850,
PC-Turk, etc.); otherwise set to 1.
2,1,0
110 if font is arranged in Unicode Symbol Index order.
·
·
Checksum - This should be set to a value which, when added to the contents of the 64 bytes of this font
descriptor data produces a total of 0.
Descriptor size - segmented font data.
MSB
15
LSB
0
8
7
x
First segment, segment identifier
x + 2 First segment, Segment size
x + 4 First segment, Data segment
x + 4 + 1st seg. Second segment, segment identifier,
size
Size, Data segment
|
|
# - 6 Null segment identifier
# - 4 Null segment size
# - 2 Reserved
Checksum
This segment follows just after the font header for TrueType. Each segment is divided into segment identifier,
segment size and data segment parts.
*Segment Identifier (UI) -
Each item in the data segment part has an identification number.
Value
Mnemonic
Data Segment
17219
17232
18260
20545
22618
65535
CC
CP
Character Complement
Copyright
GT
PA
XW
Global TrueType Data
Panose Description
X windows font name
Null Segment
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 63
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
*Segment Size (UI) - indicates the size of each item in the data segment.
*Data segment -
AP - Application support segment (reserved)
CC - Character Complement
Function and form are as same as character complement flag in the font descriptor. This is only for
unbound fonts.
CP - Copyright
Value should be ASCII data.
GI - Global Intellifont data (reserved)
GT - Global TrueType Data
This segment consists of a table directory and several tables for the TrueType font scaler.
The table directory consists of a 12-byte header and 16 bytes pen entry.
IF - Intellifont Face Data (Reserved)
PA - PANOSE Descriptor
This data segment is used for font selection and substitution.
PF - PS-compatible font name (Reserved)
XW - X-Windows font name
5.4.4. Sending a character code
Esc*c#E (character code) (27)(42)(99)#(69)
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<45h>
·
·
·
This command sends a character code for the bitmap font ( MSL number for unbound fonts ) to the printer.
The font data must follow immediately.
# is the character code. # can be from 0 to 65535. The specified character is defined by the data which follows
the character code.
Use this command also to designate a character for deletion from a font, using the command for deleting a
character from a downloaded font.
5.4.5. Sending a character descriptor and data
Esc(s#W (character descriptor and character data)
(27)(40)(115)#(87)
<1Bh><28h><73h>#<57h>
·
·
This command sends a character descriptor block and raster data describing the shape of the character to the
printer.
# is the total number of bytes (descriptor and data) which will follow this command and can be up to 32767. If
you need to send more than 32767 bytes to describe a single character you must split it into blocks of 32767
bytes or less and send each block separately.
·
The character header for the first block of data describing a character is in the following format.
[Bitmap font ]
Byte Data
0 - 1 Format
2 - 3 Descriptor size
4 - 5 Orientation
Continuation
Class
Reserved
6 - 7 Left offset
8 - 9 Top offset
10 - 11 Character width
12 - 13 Character height
14 - 15 Delta X
16 - Raster Character Data
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 64
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
<Bitmap continuation data>
Byte
Data
0-1 Format
Continuation
2
Raster Character Data
·
·
The bytes which follow the header are the raster data that make up the character.
Attributes are in one of four numerical formats.
Unsigned integer (UI) 0 to 65535
Signed integer (SI) –32768 to 32767
Unsigned byte (UB) 0 to 255
Boolean - 0 or 1
·
·
Format (UB) - 4 for bitmap fonts.
Continuation (B) - signifies whether the character data represents a new character (0) or is a continuation of
the character described by the previous character descriptor block and its data (non-zero). If the continuation
byte is non-zero the bytes following it are interpreted as character data.
·
·
Descriptor size (UB) - 14 for bitmap fonts.
Class (UB) - 1 for bitmap fonts, 2 for compressed bitmap fonts. Bitmap fonts are described using
uncompressed raster data. Compressed bitmap fonts character data is encoded as follows. The first byte of a
line of data contains the number of times that the line is successively repeated. The second byte indicates the
number of successive white pixels that start the line and the third byte indicates the number of successive
black pixels that follow the white pixels. Subsequent even and odd numbered bytes indicate the number of
successive white and black pixels respectively that make up the line. If there are more than 255 successive
pixels of a single color this is indicated by a byte set to 255 followed by a byte set to 0 followed by a byte
indicating the remaining number of pixels of that color. The width of each line is determined by the character
width attribute. All rows must contain the same number of pixels. The total number of pixels on each row must
equal the character width attribute.
·
·
·
Orientation (UB) - the orientation of the character. 0 = portrait, 1 = landscape, 2 = reverse portrait or 3 =
reverse landscape. This attribute setting must match the orientation specified in the font descriptor block.
Left offset (SI) - the distance between the character reference point and the leftmost dot of the character on
the grid. The offset can be from -16384 to 16383.
Top offset (SI) - the distance between the character reference point and the topmost dot of the character on
the grid. The offset can be from -16384 to 16383.
·
·
·
Character width (UI) - the width of the download character in grid dots. This can be in the range 1 to 16384.
Character height (UI) - the height of the download character in grid dots. This can be in the range 1 to 16384.
Delta X (UI) - the horizontal distance from the bottom left hand corner of the character’s grid that the cursor is
moved after the character is printed. The attribute is specified in units of 1/1200" and can be in the range -
32768 to 32767.
[Intellifont scalable font data]
Byte
Data
0-1 Format
2 - 3 Descriptor size
4 - 5 Contour Character data
Continuation
Class
Last data Reserved
Checksum
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 65
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
<Intellifont-scalable contour data>
MSB
LSB
4
6
8
Contour Data size
Metric data offset
Character Intellifont data
offset
10 Contour tree offset
12 XY data offset
14
Metric data
Character Intellifont Data
Contour tree data
XY coordinate data
<Continuation data for Intellifont scalable contour data>
Byte
0-1 Format
Data
Continuation
2 - 3 Continuous contour character data
Last Reserved
Checksum
<Compound character data of Intellifont scalable font>
Byte Data
0-1 Format
Continuation
Class
2 - 3 Descriptor size
4 - 5 Compound character escarpment
6 - 7 piled character number
ignore
8 - ... piled character list ( 6 byte x characters )
Last Reserved checksum
Format (UB) - specifies the character format.
·
·
Value
4
Format
Bitmap font
10
15
Intellifont-scalable font
TrueType scalable font
Continuation (B) - signifies whether the character data represents a new character (0) or is a continuation of
the character described by the previous character descriptor block and its data (non-zero). If the continuation
byte is non-zero the bytes following it are interpreted as character data.
·
·
Descriptor size (UB) - specifies the character descriptor size in bytes.
Class (UB) . indicates the character format.
Value
Class
1
Bitmap
2
3
4
15
Compressed Bitmap
Contour (Intellifont scalable)
Compound Contour (Intellifont scalable)
TrueType Scalable
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
Contour data size (UI) - specifies the contour data size.
Metric Data offset (SI) - relative to the address of the contour data size field.
Contour Tree Offset (SI) -relative to the address of the contour data size field.
XY Data Offset (SI) -relative to the address of the contour data size field.
Metric Data
Character Intellifont Scalable Data
Contour Tree Data
XY Coordinate Data
Checksum - this value is placed at the end of the character data.
Compound character escapement (SI)
Piled character number (UB)
Piled character list - includes some piled characters. Each of them is 6 bytes.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 66
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
[TrueType scalable font]
<TrueType character descriptor>
Byte
Data
0-1 Format (15)
2 - 3 Descriptor size
Continuation (0)
Class (15)
4 ~ Additional descriptor size
2 + Desc.size Character Data Size
4 + Desc. size Glyph ID
6 + Desc. size TrueType Glyph Data
0-1 Format (15)
2 - 3 Descriptor size
Continuation (0)
Class (15)
4 ~ Additional descriptor size
2 + Desc.size Character Data Size
4 + Desc. size Glyph ID
6 + Desc. size beginning of TrueType Glyph Data
0-1 Format (15)
TrueType Glyph Data
Continuation (1)
Last-2 Reserved
Checksum
·
The character data follows these header bytes. Characters are represented as raster data and the data bytes
are used to build up an image of the character from left to right and from top to bottom, according to the
character width and height settings.
·
·
Format (UB) - 15 specifies TrueType font.
Continuation (B) - specifies whether the character data represents a new character (0) or is a continuation of
the character described by the previous character descriptor block (non-zero). If the continuation byte is non-
zero the bytes following it are interpreted as character data.
·
·
Descriptor size (UB) - specifies the character descriptor size in bytes.
Class (UB) - indicates the character format.
Value Class
1
Bitmap
2
Compressed Bitmap
3
4
15
Contour (Intellifont scalable)
Compound Contour (Intellifont scalable)
TrueType scalable
·
Character data size (UI) - should be the same value as (the character data size + Glyph ID + TrueType Glyph
data) size.
·
·
Glyph ID (UI) - specifies the ID number for glyph data, which is used by the TrueType font scaler.
TrueType Glyph data - includes the data segment which is associated with the given character as found in the
glyph table of the original TrueType font file.
·
Checksum (UB) - should be a value which, when added to "Character data + Glyph ID + TrueType Glyph
data" size, produces a zero result.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 67
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Portrait character
Paper motion
Raster scan
Top offset
= 22 dots
Baseline
Character height
= 31 dots
Cursor position after
character has been printed
Character reference
point
Left offset
= 2 dots
Character width = 26 dots
Delta X = 30 dots
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 68
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Landscape character
Paper motion
Top offset = 27 dots
Character height
= 26 dots
Raster scan
Left offset
= 22 dots
Baseline
Character width
= 31 dots
Cursor position after
character has been printed
Character reference
point
Delta X = 30 dots
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 69
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.
USING GRAPHICS
This HL Series printer affords the user considerable flexibility in the creation of graphic images. Vector, raster and
rectangle graphics are available, all of which allow a range of shading and filling options. The HP-GL/2 graphics
commands that are supported are described in the HP-GL/2 section of this manual.
6.1. Source, Pattern and Destination
We refer to a printing model in which a source image (the image to be drawn) is applied to a destination image
(simply the graphics or text that already exist on the page). The source image consists of white space and non-
white areas. The non-white areas are covered by a pattern of some description. The pattern may simply be solid
black or it may itself consist of white and non-white areas, for example the pattern may consist of vertical spaced
lines. You can specify the way in which the white and dark areas of the entire source image and the white and
dark areas of the pattern interact with the destination image to produce the finished effect.
For example
Pattern
Source image
Destination image
Possible results
6.1.1. Set source transparency
Esc*v#N (27)(42)(118)#(78)
<1Bh><2Ah><76h>#<4Eh>
·
·
·
This command sets the source image transparency.
# is either 0 or 1. Set # to 0 to select transparent mode and to 1 to specify opaque mode.
Transparent mode means that parts of the destination image will be visible through the white space areas of
the source image when the source image has been printed on top of the destination image.
·
Opaque mode means that parts of the destination image will not be visible through the white space areas of
the source image when the source image has been printed on top of the destination image.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 70
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
For example
Pattern
Source image
Destination image
With transparent
source image
With opaque
source image
Possible results
6.1.2. Set pattern transparency
Esc*v#O (27)(42)(118)#(79)
<1Bh><2Ah><76h>#<4Fh>
·
·
·
This command sets the pattern transparency.
# is either 0 or 1. Set # to 0 to select transparent mode and to 1 to specify opaque mode.
Transparent mode means that parts of the destination image will be visible through the patterned areas of the
source image when the source image has been printed on top of the destination image. If the pattern is a solid
black fill obviously you will not be able to see any of the destination image through the patterned areas of the
source image.
·
Opaque mode means that the destination image will not be visible through the patterned areas of the source
image when the source image has been printed on top of the destination image.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 71
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
For example
Pattern
Source image
(Source image is transparent)
Destination image
With transparent
pattern
With opaque
pattern
Possible results
6.1.3. Set area fill identity
Esc*c#G (27)(42)(99)#(71)
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<47h>
·
This command sets the pattern ID of a shading tone, a fill pattern or a user-defined pattern for subsequent
selection with the Set Pattern Type command.
·
·
·
·
# 1 ~ 100 specify the percentage of a gray scale.
# 1 ~ 6 select a fill pattern.
# 1 ~ 32767 select a user-defined pattern.
You can specify a gray scale tone from 1 to 100. To use the specified tone for shading you must then select
one of the two gray scale pattern options with the Set Pattern Type command.
For example
Fill patterns
# = 1
# = 4
# = 2
# = 5
# = 3
# = 6
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 72
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.1.4. User-defined pattern command
Esc*c#W [ data ] (27)(42)(99)#(87)
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<57h>
·
·
·
·
# should be in the range 0 ~ 32767.
# stands for the number of pattern data bytes.
User defined patterns can be defined by binary data or an 8 byte pattern descriptor.
The formats for the pattern descriptor are listed below.
<For 300 dpi>
MSB
LSB
0 - 1 Format (0)
Continuation (0)
Reserved (0)
2 - 3 Pixel Encoding (1)
4 - 5 Height in Pixe ls
6 - 7 Width in Pixels
8 - Pattern Image
MSB
LSB
0 - 1 Format (20)
2 - 3 Pixel Encoding (1)
4 - 5 Height in Pixels
6 - 7 Width in Pixels
8 - 9 X resolution
10 - 11 Y resolution
12 - Pattern Image
Continuation (0)
Reserved (0)
X=Y: 300 or 600
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
A pattern which is defined at 600 dpi cannot be converted to one at 300 dpi.
Format - set to 0 or 20.
Continuation - set to 0.
Pixel Encoding - set to 1.
Height in Pixels - specifies the pattern height by the number of rows.
Width in Pixels - specifies the pattern width by the number of pixels.
Pattern Image - consists of the raster data for the pattern.
X resolution - specifies the resolution in the X scan direction.
Y resolution - specifies the resolution in the Y scan direction.
6.1.5. Set pattern reference point
Esc*p#R (27)(42)(112)#(82)
<1Bh><2Ah><70h>#<52h>
·
·
·
This command sets the pattern reference point to the current cursor position.
# specifies whether the pattern rotates with the print direction or remains fixed.
The Pattern reference point should be placed on a physical page and the base pattern is positioned at the
pattern reference point for tiling.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 73
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.1.6. User-defined pattern control
Esc*c#Q (27)(42)(99)#(81)
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<51h>
·
·
·
·
·
# = 0 deletes all (temporary and permanent) user-defined patterns from the printer memory.
# = 1 deletes all temporary user-defined patterns from the printer memory.
# = 2 deletes the pattern whose ID number was specified most recently.
# = 4 saves the user-defined pattern as a temporary pattern whose ID number was specified most recently.
# = 5 saves the user-defined pattern as a permanent pattern whose ID number was specified most recently.
6.1.7. Set pattern type
Esc*v#T (27)(42)(118)#(84)
<1Bh><2Ah><76h>#<54h>
·
This command selects the fill pattern (black, white, gray scale or cross-hatch pattern) for use with subsequent
graphics operations.
·
·
·
·
# is in the range 0 to 4 or 130.
# = 0 selects solid black as the fill pattern.
# = 1 selects white as the fill pattern (all source images will be completely white).
# = 2 selects one of eight gray scales. Specify the gray scale you require as a percentage (0-100%) with the Set
Area Fill Identity command.
·
·
·
# = 3 selects the cross-hatch pattern you choose with the Set Area Fill Identity.
# = 4 selects the user-defined pattern
# = 130 selects one of the 64 gray scales. You can specify the gray scale you require as a percentage (0-100%)
with the Set Area Fill Identity command. This feature is unique to these HL-Series printers.
0%
100%
#=130
#=2
56-80%
21-55%
3 - 10%
11 - 20 % 36-55%
81-99%
1- 2%
#=0
#=1
#=2
#=3
#=130
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 74
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Pattern example
10 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
20 ESC$ = CHR$(27)
30 REM --- RESET PRINTER ---
40 LPRINT ESC$; "E";
50 REM --- SET SOURCE=TRANSPARENT ---
60 REM --- SET PATTERN=OPAQUE ---
70 LPRINT ESC$; "*v0n1O";
80 REM --- BACKGROUND ---
90 LPRINT ESC$; "*c80G"; ESC$; "*v2T";
100 LPRINT ESC$; "*p100x100Y"; ESC$; "*c1000a300b2P";
110 REM --- PATTERN ---
120 LPRINT ESC$; "*p150x300Y";
130 LPRINT ESC$; "(s1p48v0s0b4101T";
140 LPRINT ESC$; "*c1G"; ESC$; "*v3T"; : LPRINT "P";
150 LPRINT ESC$; "*c2G"; ESC$; "*v3T"; : LPRINT "A";
160 LPRINT ESC$; "*c6G"; ESC$; "*v3T"; : LPRINT "T";
170 LPRINT ESC$; "*c4G"; ESC$; "*v3T"; : LPRINT "T";
180 LPRINT ESC$; "*c5G"; ESC$; "*v3T"; : LPRINT "E";
190 LPRINT ESC$; "*c3G"; ESC$; "*v3T"; : LPRINT "R";
200 LPRINT ESC$; "*c1G"; ESC$; "*v3T"; : LPRINT "N";
210 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---
220 LPRINT CHR$(12);
230 END
<Sample file 6>
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 75
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.2. Plotting Rectangles
Drawing rectangles is a basic case of printing graphics: the source image consists solely of the rectangle itself.
Thus only the pattern transparency has any bearing on the final effect - the source transparency is irrelevant.
6.2.1. Cursor position
Position the cursor using the commands described in the chapter entitled “The Page”. You can use units,
decipoints or rows and columns as coordinate units. Remember that the y-coordinate value goes up as the cursor
moves down the logical page.
6.2.2. Set rectangle width
Esc*c#A (27)(42)(99)#(65)
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<41h>
This command sets the width of the rectangle to be printed in dots.
# is the number of dots.
·
·
Esc*c#H (27)(42)(99)#(72)
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<48h>
This command sets the width of the rectangle to be printed in decipoints.
# is the number of decipoints.
·
·
6.2.3. Set rectangle height
Esc*c#B (27)(42)(99)#(66)
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<42h>
·
This command sets the height of the rectangle to be printed in dots.
# is the number of dots.
·
Esc*c#V (27)(42)(99)#(86)
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<56h>
This command sets the height of the rectangle to be printed in decipoints.
# is the number of decipoints.
·
·
6.2.4. Draw filled rectangle
Esc*c#P (27)(42)(99)#(80)
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<50h>
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
This command fills a rectangular area with the specified shading option.
# is 0 to 5 or 130.
# = 0 uses solid black as the fill pattern.
# = 1 uses white as the fill pattern.
# = 2 selects the gray scale you chose with the Set Area Fill Identity command as the fill pattern.
# = 3 selects the cross-hatch pattern you chose with the Set Area Fill Identity.
# = 4 selects the user defined pattern, which is the ID number selected by the set Area Fill Identity.
# = 5 uses the pattern specified by the combination of the most recent Set Area Fill Identity command and the
most recent Set Pattern Type command.
·
·
# = 130 selects one of the sixty-four gray scales. You can specify the gray scale you require as a percentage
(0-100%) with the Set Area Fill Identity command. This feature is unique to these HL Series printers.
See the following two pages for programming examples using gray scales and patterns
#
0
Fill
Solid black
1
White
2
3
4
5
Gray scale (1 - 8)
Cross hatch pattern
User-defined pattern
Current pattern
Gray scale ( 1 - 64)
130
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 76
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Gray scale example
10 ESC$ = CHR$(27)
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 REM --- DRAW A PATTERN USING 64 GRAY SCALES ---
40 X = 50: Y = 100: XL=50 :YL=200
50 FOR GRAY = 0 TO 100 STEP 2
60 GOSUB 220
70 X=GRAY*10+50 :XL=X-XL
80 GOSUB 260
90 XL=X
100 NEXT GRAY
110 REM --- DRAW A PATTERN USING 8 GRAY SCALES ---
120 Y=400
130 FOR GRAY = 0 TO 100 STEP 2
140 GOSUB 220
150 X=GRAY*10+50 :XL=X-XL
160 GOSUB 320
170 XL=X
180 NEXT GRAY
190 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---
200 LPRINT CHR$(12)
210 END
220 REM --- SET THE CURSOR POSITION ---
230 LPRINT ESC$; "*p"; X; "X";
240 LPRINT ESC$; "*p"; Y; "Y";
250 RETURN
260 REM --- PRINT 64-GRAY SCALE PATTERN ---
270 LPRINT ESC$; "*c"; XL; "A";
280 LPRINT ESC$; "*c"; YL; "B";
290 LPRINT ESC$; "*c"; GRAY; "G";
300 LPRINT ESC$; "*c130P";
310 RETURN
320 REM --- PRINT 8-GRAY SCALE PATTERN ---
330 LPRINT ESC$; "*c"; XL; "A";
340 LPRINT ESC$; "*c"; YL; "B";
350 LPRINT ESC$; "*c"; GRAY; "G";
360 LPRINT ESC$; "*c2P";
370 RETURN
<Sample file 7>
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 77
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.3. Raster Graphics
6.3.1. Positioning the cursor
Position the cursor using the commands described in the chapter entitled “The Page”, using dots, decipoints or
rows and columns as coordinate units.
6.3.2. Set raster resolution
Esc*t#R (27)(42)(116)#(82)
<1Bh><2Ah><74h>#<52h>
·
·
·
·
This command sets the raster image resolution in dots per inch.
# is 75, 100, 150, 200, 300 or 600.
The lower the resolution you specify, the less printer memory your raster image will occupy.
Use this command before you issue a Begin Raster Graphics command, otherwise the resolution that you
specify will not take effect until the next time you re-enter raster graphics mode.
6.3.3. Set high resolution control
EscCRRO (27)(13)(82)(79)
<1Bh><0Dh><52h><4Fh>
·
This command sets high resolution control off.
EscCRRL (27)(13)(82)(76)
<1Bh><0Dh><52h><4Ch>
·
This command sets high resolution control Light level.
EscCRRM (27)(13)(82)(77)
<1Bh><0Dh><52h><4Dh>
·
This command sets high resolution control Medium level.
EscCRRD (27)(13)(82)(68)
<1Bh><0Dh><52h><44h>
·
This command sets high resolution control Dark level.
6.3.4. Set raster image orientation
Esc*r#F (27)(42)(114)#(70)
<1Bh><2Ah><72h>#<46h>
·
·
·
This command specifies the orientation of the raster image.
# is 0 or 3.
# = 0 determines that the image will be printed from left to right and from top to bottom within the current
logical page.
·
·
# = 3 determines that the image will be printed from left to right and from top to bottom within the current
physical page irrespective of logical page orientation.
The default value of # is 3.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 78
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
X
(X1,Y1) = Cursor position
Y
(X1, Y1)
X
Y
#=0
(X1, Y1)
#=0
Portrait
Landscape
X
Y
(X1, Y1)
X
Y
(X1, Y1)
#=3
#=3
Landscape
Portrait
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 79
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.3.5. Set raster area height
Esc*r#T (27)(42)(114)#(84)
<1Bh><2Ah><72h>#<54h>
·
·
·
This command sets the height of the raster image to be printed.
# is the number of raster rows.
If you use this command after using a Start Raster Graphics or a Transfer Raster Data command, it does not
take effect until after the next End Raster Graphics command.
6.3.6. Set raster area width
Esc*r#S (27)(42)(114)#(83)
<1Bh><2Ah><72h>#<53h>
·
·
·
This command sets the width of the raster image to be printed.
# is the number of dots at the specified dots per inch resolution.
If you use this command after using a Start Raster Graphics or a Transfer Raster Data command, it does not
take effect until after the next End Raster Graphics command.
6.3.7. Set raster y-offset
Esc*b#Y (27)(42)(98)#(89)
<1Bh><2Ah><62h>#<59h>
·
·
·
·
This command sets the offset (number of blank rows to be skipped) for the raster image to be printed.
# is the number of rows that are left blank at the top of the image.
# must be in the range 0-32767.
This command is only effective in raster graphics mode, that is, after a Start Raster Graphics mode command.
6.3.8. Set compression mode
Esc*b#M (27)(42)(98)#(77)
<1Bh><2Ah><62h>#<4Dh>
Identifies the method of compression used to encode the raster image that is to be sent to the printer.
·
# is 0, 1, 2, 3, 5, 9, 1152 or 1024.
·
·
# = 0 signifies no compression is to be used.
# = 1 indicates that run-length encoding is to be used. The raster data bytes are transmitted in pairs.
The second byte of each pair specifies the raster output, the first byte specifies the number of times the
second byte is successively repeated. A value of 0 for the first byte indicates a single occurrence of the
second byte, a value of 1 indicates two consecutive occurrences of the second byte and so on.
·
# = 2 indicates that TIFF (tagged image file format) encoding is to be used. In this format the data is
transmitted in groups of bytes. The first byte of each group is a control byte and defines how the subsequent
data byte or bytes should be interpreted, and how many data bytes there are before the next control byte. If
the two’s complement value of the control byte is in the range –1 to –127, the following byte is a repeated
data byte. The number of successive occurrences of the data byte is given by the absolute value of the
control byte plus one - that is, if the control byte is -6, the following data byte is repeated 7 times. If the value
of the control byte is in the range 0-127 the bytes which follow are unencoded raster data. The number of data
bytes is given by the absolute value of the control byte plus one - that is, if the control byte is 9, the following
ten bytes are unencoded data. If a control byte has the two’s complement value –128 it is ignored and the next
byte is treated as a control byte.
·
# = 3 indicates that delta row compression is to be used. In this method byte sequences identify how
each raster row differs from the last row that was transmitted. The first byte identifies the number of
consecutive bytes (the value of the most significant 3 bits plus 1) to be changed and the position in the line at
which to start substituting the replacement bytes (the least significant 5 bits plus 1). Hence, if the command
byte has a 3 in the top three bits and 10 in the bottom five bits, the 11th, 12th, 13th and 14th bytes of the last
row will be replaced by the four data bytes that follow.
If the least significant 5 bits are all 1, the next byte is treated as a further offset value and its value is added to
32 to calculate the offset. If this byte in turn is all ones the next byte is also treated as a continuation byte and
its value is added to the offset and so on until a byte whose value is not 255 is encountered.
This combination of command bytes and replacement bytes is used to specify all the differences
between the last raster row sent (the seed row) and the new row to be transmitted. When the new row has
been sent it becomes the new seed row.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 80
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
# = 5 indicates that adaptive compression is to be used.
This compression compresses multiple rows (a block) into one transfer graphics command.
Most other compression methods compress only one row to one transfer graphics command.
One transfer graphic command (ESC *b##W) can contain only up to 32,767 bytes.
As mode 5 compression compresses multiple rows, the amount of transferred data may become large.
If compressed data exceeds this limit, reduce the number of rows in the block.
We can use mode 0 to mode 3 compression to compress each row. We can even compress empty (white) rows
and duplicate rows with these compression methods.
Command byte
Mode 5 compressed data consists of multiple elements. Each element contains 3 header bytes at the
beginning.
The first byte of the header bytes is a command byte.
First byte
Second, third byte
0
1
2
3
Unencoded
Run-length Encoding
TIFF
Number of bytes of data
Delta Row compression
4
5
Empty Row
Duplicate Row
Number of empty row or repetition
Command byte
0 -
1 -
2 -
3 -
4 -
5 -
This element is an uncompressed row. The next two bytes contain the byte count of the uncompressed
data. Uncompressed data follows the header.
This element identifies a compressed row. Compression method is mode 1. The next two bytes (upper
byte first) contain the byte count of the compressed data. Compressed data follows the header.
This element identifies a compressed row. Compression method is mode 2. The next two bytes (upper
byte first) contain the byte count of the compressed data. Compressed data follows the header
This element identifies a compressed row. Compression method is mode 3. The next two bytes (upper
byte first) contain the byte count of the compressed data. Compressed data follows the header
This element identifies multiple empty rows. The next two bytes (upper byte first) contain the empty
row count.
This element identifies duplicate rows. The next two bytes (upper byte first) contain the duplicate row
count.
·
# = 9 Mode 9 compression
Like mode 3 compression, this mode 9 compression data contains only the difference of the current row from
the preceding row.
Replacement data often consists of a repetition of a particular byte in mode 3 compression.
Mode 9 compression is effective in such cases.
Simple mode 9 compression data consists of a command byte and the replacement data.
A Command byte consists of 3 parts. These are the control bit, the offset count and the replacement count.
The Control bit is the most significant bit (bit 7) of a control byte.
Command byte for mode 9 compression (non repeated replacement data)
7
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Offset count
Control bit
Replacement count-1
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 81
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
If the control bit is 0, replacement data is not repeated data. Bits 6 to 3 contain the offset count. This field
value is from 0 to 15. If this value is 15, the next byte of the control bytes is an optional offset count. The
value of this optional offset count byte is from 0 to 255. If this optional offset count value is 255, then the
next byte is another (second) optional offset count byte. Optional offset count bytes will continue until the
value is less than 255. The total Offset value is the sum of the offset count in the control byte and all the
optional offset bytes.
Bits 2 to 0 of the control byte contains the replacement count - 1. The value is from 0 to 7. If this value is 7,
optional replacement byte(s) follow the control byte or optional offset byte(s) (if any).
If the first optional replacement count byte is 255, then a second optional count byte follows the first optional
count byte. Optional offset count bytes will continue until the value becomes less than 255. The addition of
the replacement count in the control byte and all optional replacement count bytes gives the total replacement
count.
Replacement data bytes follow the control byte and any optional offset bytes and any optional replacement
count bytes.
<Example>
Seed row
Current row
55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55
55 55 55 55 55 11 11 22 33 44 55 66 77
<Different section 11 11 22 33 44 55 66 77>
Offset count = 5
Replacement count = 8
Replacement data = 11 11 22 33 44 55 66 77
7
6
0
5
1
4
0
3
1
2
1
1
1
0
1
0
Optional offset count byte = 0
11 11 22 33 44 55 66 77
8 bytes of repracement data
Offset count = 5
Replacement count = 7 + 1 = 8
Command byte for mode 9 compression (repeated replacement data)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
Offset count
Control bit
Replacement count
If the control bit is 1, replacement data is repeated data. Bits 6 to 5 contain the offset count and bits 4 to 0
contain the 'replacement count (repeat count) - 2'.
If bit 6 and bit 5 are '1', then an optional offset byte follows the control byte. If the value of this optional offset
byte is 255, another (second) optional offset byte follows the first optional offset byte. The addition of the
offset count in the control byte and any optional offset bytes gives the total offset count.
If bits 4 to 0 are all '1', an optional replacement count byte follows the control byte or any optional offset
byte(s). If the first optional replacement count byte has a value of 255, a second optional replacement count
byte follows the first optional replacement count byte. Optional replacement count bytes will continue until
the value becomes less than 255.
<Example>
Seed row
Current row
55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55
55 55 55 11 11 11 55 55 66 66 66 66 55
<First section 11 11 11>
Offset count = 3
Replacement count = 3
Replacement data = 11
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 82
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
<Second section 66 66 66 66>
Offset count = 2
Replacement count = 4
Replacement data = 66
7
6
1
5
1
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
0
1
1
Optional offset count byte = 0
Replacement data = 11
Replacement count = 1 + 2 = 3
Offset count = 3
7
6
1
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
1
0
0
1
Replacement data = 66
Replacement count = 2 + 2 = 4
Offset count = 2
·
# = 1152 indicates that CCITT G3/G4 data compression is to be used.
This format is popular in optical document storage areas as this compression is effective to store black and
white type pictures. As G3/G4 format does not have picture size/resolution information, the printer requires a
header at the beginning of the picture data. The header size is 94 Bytes. Both the header and the picture data
are transferred by the ESC*b###W(###=data length) command. The normal PCL transfer graphics data
command has a limitation on the data size and ### should not exceed 32767. Unlike other modes, this mode is
special and does not have the 32767 size limitation. The data must have the following structure - Header and
Picture data. The values in this mode are little endians.
Header
94 bytes
File Length
Picture
data
Picture data
length
Byte
Data
Description
position
0 - 1
2 - 3
6E 6E
0A 00
'nn' This is header ID.
Reserved
4 - 7
8 - 11
5E 00 00 00
File length
Picture data start offset from header top
File length including 94 Byte header. If file length is 65,536 byte,
these 4 bytes become "00 00 01 00"
12 - 13
14 - 15
16 - 19
20 - 21
01 00
01 00
4A 00 00 00
Compression mode
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
02 00: Fax MH format
03 00: Fax MR format
04 00: Fax G4 format
22 - 55
56 - 59
00 ... 00
Picture data length
All zero
If picture data length is 65,442 (65,536 ~-94) byte, these 4 bytes
become "A2 FF 00 00."
60 - 61
62 - 63
64 - 65
66 - 67
68- 69
01 00
01 00
Pixels/line
Pixels/line
Lines/picture
bit / pixel
bit / pixel
If picture dot width = 2,400, these 2 bytes become "60 09"
Same as above.
If picture dot count = 3,100, these 2 bytes become "1C 0C."
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 83
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
71 - 71
Lines/picture
Same as above.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 84
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
72 - 73
74 - 75
00 00
Photometrics 00 00
or 01 00
Reserved
00 00 : data 0 = white
01 00 : data 0 = black
Reserved
76 - 77
78 - 79
02 00
Fill order 01 00 or 02 01 00 : filled from MSB
00
02 00 : filled from LSB
Reserved
Reserved
80 - 81
82 - 83
84 - 85
86 - 87
01 00
00 00
01 00
Reserved
Resolution 200, 300, C8 00 00 00 : 200 dpi,
400, 600 90 01 00 00 : 400 dpi,
2C 01 00 00 : 300 dpi,
58 02 00 00 : 600 dpi
400 and 600 dpi are available when the printer operates in 600 dpi
mode.
88 - 89
Resolution 200, 300, C8 00 00 00 : 200 dpi,
2C 01 00 00 : 300 dpi,
58 02 00 00 : 600 dpi
400, 600
90 01 00 00 : 400 dpi,
400 and 600 dpi are available when the printer operates in 600 dpi
mode.
90 - 91
92 - 93
02 00
00 00
Reserved
Reserved
For further information about the CCITT G3/G4 data format, please refer to CCITT (The International
Telegraph and Telephone Consultative Committee) BLUE BOOK Volume VII.
# = 1024 indicates TIFF format. This is valid only for 600 dpi data. The raster graphics data is transferred with
the ESC*b###W (### = data length) command. The TIFF file follows this mode set command. This printer
does not support LZW compression. Pages that contain TIFF data are printed in gray scale mode. The TIFF
data contains the header, tag and print data.
·
This mode supports TIFF Version 5.0 file format. In this mode, the transfer graphics data count does not have
a limitation of 32,767 bytes. This printer supports both "MM" (big endian) format and "II" (little endian)
format. The Print model is not applied to this type of data transfer. The printer has some limitations on the
TIFF format as follows:-
1. Tag position has to be prior to the picture (strip) data.
2. Compression tag - Tag ID : 259
The printer supports 1, 2, 3, 4 and 32773.
1 : no compression (Bits/Sample=1,4,8)
2 : CCITT G3 MH (Bits/Sample=1)
3 : CCITT G3 MR (Bits/Sample=1)
4 : CCITT G4 (Bits/Sample=1)
32773 : Pack Bits (Bits/Sample=1)
3. Sample/pixel - Tag ID : 277
This value should be 1. This means the printer accepts only monochrome TIFF files.
4. Bits/Sample - Tag ID: 258
The printer supports 1,4 and 8.
If you specify 4 or 8 and the printer resolution is 600 dpi, the printer prints the page using
APT.
5. Horizontal resolution (Tag ID=282) and Vertical resolution (Tag ID=283)
Compression type Bits/Sample
Available Resolution
From 1 dpi to 300 dpi
Printer's Resolution
(300 or 600 dpi)
APT
ON
OFF
No Compression
No Compression
Pack Bit
4,8
1
CCITT G3 & G4
1
200,300,400,600 dpi
OFF
400 & 600 dpi are only available
when the printer operates in 600
dpi mode.
We recommend 150 dpi or less resolution for APT to reduce data size.
# = 1025 indicates the Brother original Compression Method.
·
·
# = 1026 indicates the Brother Advanced Data Transfer Mode.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 85
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.3.9. Start raster transfer
Esc*r#A (27)(42)(114)#(65)
<1Bh><2Ah><72h>#<41h>
·
·
·
·
·
This command signals the start of the transfer of a raster image to the printer.
# is 0 or 1.
# = 0 denotes that the image will be printed starting from the left edge of the logical page.
# = 1 denotes that the image will be printed starting from the current cursor position.
The transfer of raster data to the printer continues until either an End Raster Transfer command is sent or a
command other than Send Raster Data, Set Compression Mode or Set Raster Y-Offset is sent.
6.3.10. Send raster data
Esc*b#W<data> (27)(42)(98)#(87) <1Bh><2Ah><62h>#<57h>
·
·
·
This command sends a single row of the raster image to the printer for printing.
# signifies the number of bytes to be sent.
If more data is transmitted than can be fitted onto one row of the specified raster area, the excess data will be
ignored.
6.3.11. Compress transfer graphics
Esc*b#C<image data> (27)(42)(98)#(67) <1Bh><2Ah><62h>#<43h>
·
As a more efficient alternative to the Send Raster Data command, this command sends a single row of the
raster image to the printer for printing in a compressed form.
·
·
·
# signifies the number of data bytes that the uncompressed row consisted of.
Pairs of bytes describe the data which follows.
If the MSB of the first byte of a pair is 1, the byte that follows the pair is repeated. The number held in the
remaining fifteen bits of the byte pair is the number of times the data byte is repeated.
·
·
If the MSB of the first byte of the pair is 0, the bytes that follow the pair are not repeated. The number held in
the remaining fifteen bits of the byte pair is the number of bytes of unrepeated raster data that follow.
A raster row is made up of a sequence of byte pair-image data combinations.
6.3.12. End raster transfer
Esc*rB (27)(42)(114)(66)
<1Bh><2Ah><72h><42h>
·
·
This command signals the end of a transfer of a raster image to the printer.
After execution of this command the cursor is positioned a distance of one raster row (at the last specified
number of dots per inch) down from the bottom of the raster area.
Esc*rC
(27)(42)(114)(67)
<1Bh><2Ah><72h><43h>
·
·
·
This command signifies the end of the raster graphic data transfer and this is a modified version of the ESC
*rB command.
After receiving this command, the printer resets the compression seed, comp ression mode and left-graphics
margin to 0.
Also, the cursor is positioned a distance of one raster row (at the last specified number of dots per inch)
down from the bottom of the raster data.
·
·
This command resets the compression mode setting to 0.
This command defaults the left graphics margin to 0.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 86
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Raster graphics example
10 REM ***** A EXAMPLE OF RASTER GRAPHICS *****
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)
30 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
40 REM --- SET GRAPHICS RESOLUTION TO 300 DPI ---
50 LPRINT ESC$+"*t300R";
60 REM --- START RASTER GRAPHICS ---
70 LPRINT ESC$+"*r1A";
80 REM --- TRANSFER RASTER GRAPHICS ---
90 FOR I=1 TO 28
100 REM --- TRANSFER 1 LINE OF DOTS (4 byte = line) ---
110 LPRINT ESC$+"*b4W";
120 FOR J=1 TO 4
130 READ A$
140 LPRINT CHR$(VAL("&H"+A$));
150 NEXT J
160 NEXT I
170 REM --- END RASTER GRAPHICS ---
180 LPRINT ESC$+"*rB"
190 LPRINT
200 LPRINT
210 REM --- CHANGE GRAPHIC RESOLUTION
220 LPRINT ESC$+"*t75R";
230 REM --- START RASTER GRAPHICS ---
240 LPRINT ESC$+"*r1A";
250 REM --- TRANSFER RASTER GRAPHICS ---
260 RESTORE 410
270 FOR I=1 TO 28
280 REM --- TRANSFER 1 LINE OF DOTS (4 byte = line) ---
290 LPRINT ESC$+"*b4W";
300 FOR J=1 TO 4
310 READ A$
320 LPRINT CHR$(VAL("&H"+A$));
330 NEXT J
340 NEXT I
350 REM --- END RASTER GRAPHICS ---
360 LPRINT ESC$+"*rB"
370 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---
380 LPRINT CHR$(12);
390 END
400 REM --- RASTER DATA ---
410 DATA 00,1F,E0,00
420 DATA 00,7F,F8,00
430 DATA 01,F0,3E,00
440 DATA 03,C0,0F,00
450 DATA 07,00,03,80
460 DATA 0E,00,01,C0
470 DATA 1C,38,70,E0
480 DATA 18,70,70,60
490 DATA 38,38,70,70
500 DATA 30,00,00,30
510 DATA 70,00,00,38
520 DATA 61,00,02,18
530 DATA 61,00,02,18
540 DATA 6F,80,07,98
550 DATA 67,80,07,D8
560 DATA 61,80,06,18
570 DATA 61,C0,0E,18
580 DATA 70,E0,1C,38
590 DATA 30,70,78,30
600 DATA 38,3F,F0,70
610 DATA 18,0F,C0,60
620 DATA 1C,00,00,E0
630 DATA 0E,00,01,C0
640 DATA 07,00,03,80
650 DATA 03,C0,0F,00
660 DATA 01,F0,3E,00
670 DATA 00,7F,F8,00
680 DATA 00,1F,E0,00
690 REM --- DATA END ---
<Sample file 8>
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 87
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.3.13. Horizontal 1200-dpi image format mode (Raster Graphic Mode 1027)
The printer supports 1200 dpi printing for special image formats in 1200 dpi mode. We recommend that the
installed printer memory is 10 Mbytes or more for 1200 dpi printing.
To set 1200 dpi mode,
1. Set 1200 dpi printing mode by using the following PJL command:
@PJL SET RAS1200MODE = ON
2. Choose PCL mode with the following PJL command:
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL
(If you select a mode other than PCL mode, 1200 dpi printing mode cannot be selected.)
The PCL Mode set command for 1200 dpi Image Format is ESC *b1027M. The transfer raster data command
(ESC*b###W) then transfers horizontal 1200 dpi data.
<1200 dpi Graphic Data Compression Format>
This comp ression format consists of blocks of data 64 dots down the page starting from the leading edge of the
paper.
i.e.: If the graphic data extends over three bands as shown in the following diagram, it transfers the data as three
blocks of data:
ESC*b##W <Block 1> <Block 2> <Block 3>
0
Band 1
64
Block 1
Band 2
128
Block 2
Band 3
192
Band 4
Band 5
Block 3
256
320
In mode 1027, the transfer graphic data command byte count does not have a limitation of 32,767 bytes.
The block data is composed as follows:
Position
0 - 1
2 - 3
Data
Description
n - 2
dots from the left of the page
dots from the leading edge of the
page
Block length
Horizontal position
Vertical position
4 - 5
6
7 - 8
Height dots
Width words
number of image vertical dots
number of image horizontal 16 bit
words
9 - (n - 1) Compression data
compression image data
i.e.: Data is at horizontal position = 256, vertical position = 64, height = 32 dots, width = 100 x 16 bit words (1600
dots), and compression data is 800 bytes;
ESC*b809W 03h 27h 01h 00h 00h 40h 20h 00h 64h [Data800Byte]
ë _ û ë _ û ë _ û
|
ë _ û
|
a
b
c
d
e
f
0
a: Block length(807)
Band 1
Band 2
(256, 64)
b: Horizontal position(256)
c: Vertical position(64)
d: Height dots(32)
e: Width words(100)
f: Compression image data
64
128
32
1600
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 88
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 89
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
<Compressed Image Data>
Data compression compresses the original image data word by word (16 bits).
The comp ressed data consists of both horizontal compression which uses 16 bit, 8 bit and 4 bit repeating patterns
within 1 word or 2 words of data and vertical compression which indicates how many times to repeat the same
data as in the previous line within 1 word of data.
ŸNon-compressed data
When the most significant bit in the first 2 bytes is 0, the printer goes into non-compression mode. The following
11 bits then indicate the number of words of data, the least significant 4 bits are not used. After that, the image
data follows word by word.
15 14
0
4 3
0
data word count (11 bits)
data 1 (16 bits)
:
not used
data n (16 bits)
Ÿ16 bit repeating compressed data
When the most significant 3 bits in the first 2 bytes are in the order 1, 0, 0, the remaining 13 bits indicate the
number of times to repeat 16 bit data. The following 2 bytes should be the 16 bit data to repeat.
15 14 13 12
0
1
0
0
number of repeats(13 bits)
data to repeat(16 bits)
Ÿ8 bit repeating comp ressed data
When the most significant 3 bits in the first 2 bytes are in the order 1, 1, 0, the following 5 bits indicate the number
of times to repeat 16 bit (two by 8 bits) data. The remaining 8 bits should be the 8 bit data to repeat.
15 14 13 12
8
7
0
1
1
0
number of repeats
data to repeat(8 bits)
(5 bits)
Ÿ4 bit repeating compression data
When the most significant 3 bits in the first 2 bytes are in the order 1, 0, 1, the following 4 bits are the 4 bit data to
repeat. The remaining 9 bits indicate the number of times to repeat the 16 bit (4 by 4 bits) data.
15 14 13 12
9
8
0
1
0
1
data to repeat
number or repeats(9 bits)
(4 bits)
ŸVertical repeating compressed data
When the most significant 3 bits in the first 2 bytes are in the order 1, 1, 1, the remaining 13 bits indicate the same
data words as in the previous line.
15 14 13 12
0
1
1
1
the same data words as in the previous line (13 bits)
The printer cannot support the APT and HRC function in the 1200 dpi printing mode.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 90
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.4. Vector Graphics
For large-scale graphic images it is more efficient to use vector graphics. In LaserJet emulation mode you can set
up the page area on which to print vector graphics images. The vector graphics capabilities of these HL Series
printers working in HP-GL/2 mode are described in the HP-GL/2 section of this manual.
6.4.1. Enter HP-GL/2 mode
Esc%#B
(27)(37)#(66)
<1Bh><25h>#<42h>
·
·
This command enters HP-GL/2 graphics mode.
# = 0 the cursor is positioned at the previous HP-GL/2 cursor position. If this is the first time you have
switched to HP-GL/2 mode since switching the printer on, the cursor is placed at the origin of the HP-GL/2
graphics window.
·
# = 1 the cursor remains at its current position.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 91
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.5. The Picture Frame
The PCL picture frame is the rectangular area of the page on which you can print graphic images. You can
position and size the picture frame to suit your requirements and achieve effects such as scaling or distortion of
vector graphics images.
6.5.1. The default picture frame
The default picture frame size and position is determined by the default logical page size and text length for each
given paper size.
6.5.2. Set picture frame anchor point
Esc*c0T (27)(42)(99)(48)(84) <1Bh><2Ah><63h><30h><54h>
·
This command sets the anchor point (top left hand corner) of the picture frame to the current cursor position.
6.5.3. Set picture frame vertical size
Esc*c#Y (27)(42)(99)#(89)
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<59h>
·
·
This command sets the vertical size of the picture frame.
# is the height of the picture frame in decipoints.
6.5.4. Set picture frame horizontal size
Esc*c#X (27)(42)(99)#(88)
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<58h>
·
·
This command sets the horizontal size of the picture frame.
# is the width of the picture frame in decipoints.
6.5.5. Specify vertical plot size
Esc*c#L (27)(42)(99)#(76)
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<4Ch>
·
·
·
·
·
This command specifies the height in inches of an imported image.
# is the height of the image in inches.
# can be in the range 0 to 32767 and can have up to four places of decimals.
This command is only applicable to existing graphic images which are being imported from an application.
The imported graphic will be scaled so that its height matches that of the HP-GL/2 graphics window.
6.5.6. Specify horizontal plot size
Esc*c#K (27)(42)(99)#(75)
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<4Bh>
·
·
·
·
·
This command specifies the width in inches of the image being imported.
# is the width of the image in inches.
# can be in the range 0 to 32767 and can have up to four places of decimals.
This command is only applicable to existing graphic images which are being imported from an application.
The imported graphic will be scaled so that its width matches that of the HP-GL/2 graphics window.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 92
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
7.
MACROS
7.1. The Purpose of a Macro
A macro is a sequence of commands that you wish to execute. You can specify the command sequence and
download it to the printer after which you can execute it with a single command. For example, you might wish to
draw a raster image at the top of each page you print. Rather than sending the same sequence of commands every
time you print a new page, it is more efficient to define a macro to draw the image and store the macro in the
printer’s memory. Having done this, you can draw the picture on each page simply by running the macro, that is,
with a single command.
Like downloaded fonts, macros take up printer memory. To alleviate this, some macros are available on cartridges
that can be plugged into the printer’s cartridge slots. A cartridge-based macro must have a unique ID number or
else you will not be able to access it. If a downloaded macro has the same ID number as a cartridge macro, all
references to the ID number will be interpreted as references to the downloaded macro. To access the cartridge
macro you would first have to delete the downloaded macro.
Another method of storing Macros is uniquely available on the HL-1660e / 2060 / 2400C / 2400Ce / 3400CN
printers. Macros can be saved to these cards as required and then executed from the card. For the HL-2400Ce /
3400CN printers, Macros can be also saved to and executed from the optional internal hard disk drive installed as
required. A delete facility is also included to allow the removal of macros when no longer required. The rules for
identifying and calling Macros from this card are exactly the same as for cartridge stored Macros detailed above.
For the HL-1270N/1470N printer, Macros can be stored in the incorporated Flash memory.
One macro can call another, however, only two levels of nesting are permitted.
A printer reset will delete macros from the printer’s memory unless they have been explicitly designated as
permanent.
The PCL picture frame commands, the printer reset command and HP-GL/2 graphic language commands cannot be
invoked from within a macro.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 93
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
7.2. Defining a Macro
To define a macro you must first assign an ID number to it, then send to the printer a Start Macro Definition
command, the macro definition itself (consisting of a sequence of PCL commands) and finally an End Macro
Definition command.
7.2.1. Macro ID
Esc&f#Y (27)(38)(102)#(89)
<1Bh><26h><66h>#<59h>
·
This command assigns an identity number to a macro that is to be downloaded, or references an existing
macro in the printer’s memory.
·
·
# is the ID number of a macro. The ID number must be in the range 0-32767.
If you specify the ID number of an existing macro and then download a new macro definition to the printer,
the new macro will overwrite the existing macro.
7.2.2. Start macro definition
Esc&f0X (27)(38)(102)(48)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><30h><58h>
·
This command signifies that the following commands constitute a macro definition.
7.2.3. End macro definition
Esc&f1X (27)(38)(102)(49)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><31h><58h>
·
This command terminates the macro definition.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 94
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
7.3. Running a Macro
Macros can be invoked in three different ways: they can be ‘executed’, ‘called’ or ‘enabled for overlay’. When a
macro is 'executed' it uses the current modified print environment. Any changes it makes to the environment are
permanent. A macro that is 'called' also uses the current modified print environment, however, any changes it
makes to the environment are discarded when the macro has performed its function. When a macro is 'enabled' for
overlay, the macro’s command sequence is performed as the final operation every time a page is printed. Overlaid
macros use the overlay environment. The overlay environment is a combination of the user default environment
and the modified print environment. This environment is effective only while the macro is running.
Page length
Page size
Orientation
Registration
Paper source
Number of copies
Cursor position stack
7.3.1. Execute macro
Esc&f2X (27)(38)(102)(50)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><32h><58h>
·
·
This command executes the macro whose ID number was specified most recently.
Any changes made to the modified print environment during the execution of a macro, such as font selection
or margin settings, are retained after macro execution has been completed.
7.3.2. Call macro
Esc&f3X (27)(38)(102)(51)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><33h><58h>
·
·
This command calls the macro whose ID number was specified most recently.
Any changes made to the modified print environment during a macro call, such as raster graphics settings, are
temporary and remain in effect only while the macro is running. They are not retained after the macro has
finished.
7.3.3. Enable macro for overlay
Esc&f4X (27)(38)(102)(52)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><34h><58h>
·
This command overlays the macro whose ID number was specified most recently.
7.3.4. Disable macro for overlay
Esc&f5X (27)(38)(102)(53)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><35h><58h>
·
This command stops overlaying the macro whose ID number was specified most recently.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 95
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
7.4. Handling Macros
7.4.1. Delete all macros
Esc&f6X (27)(38)(102)(54)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><36h><58h>
·
This command deletes all macros from the printer’s memory.
7.4.2. Delete all temporary macros
Esc&f7X (27)(38)(102)(55)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><37h><58h>
·
This command deletes all temporary macros from the printer’s memory. Temporary macros are those which
have not been made permanent with the Esc&f10X command.
7.4.3. Delete macro
Esc&f8X (27)(38)(102)(56)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><38h><58h>
·
This command deletes from printer memory the macro whose ID number was specified most recently.
7.4.4. Make macro temporary
Esc&f9X (27)(38)(102)(57)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><39h><58h>
·
This command makes the macro whose ID number was specified most recently temporary (that is, it will not be
retained if the printer is reset).
7.4.5. Make macro permanent
Esc&f10X (27)(38)(102)(49)(48)(88)
<1Bh><26h><66h><31h><30h><58h>
·
This command makes the macro whose ID number was specified most recently permanent (that is, it will be
retained if the printer is reset).
7.4.6. Delete all macros from the storage device
Esc&f1030X (27)(38)(102)(49)(48)(51)(48)(88)
<1Bh><26h><66h><31h><30h><33h><30h><58h>
This command deletes all macros and all data from the storage device.
·
7.4.7. Delete macro from the storage device
Esc&f1036X (27)(38)(102)(49)(48)(51)(54)(88)
<1Bh><26h><66h><31h><30h><33h><36h><58h>
This command deletes the macro whose ID number was specified most recently from the storage device.
·
7.4.8. Save macro into the storage device
Esc&f1038X (27)(38)(102)(49)(48)(51)(56)(88)
<1Bh><26h><66h><31h><30h><33h><38h><58h>
This command saves the macro whose ID number was specified most recently into the storage device.
·
Macro example
10 REM ***** A EXAMPLE OF A MACRO *****
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)
30 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
40 REM --- RESET PRINTER ---
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E":
60 REM --- SET MACRO ID TO 0 ---
70 LPRINT ESC$+"&f0Y";
80 REM --- START MACRO DEFINITION ---
90 LPRINT ESC$+"&f0X";
100 REM --- SET CURSOR POSITION X=1800 DOT, Y=0 DOT ---
110 LPRINT ESC$+"*p1800x0Y";
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 96
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
120 REM --- SET FONT TO LETTER GOTHIC (18 DOTS WIDE) ---
130 LPRINT ESC$+"(s0p16.66h8.5v0s0b130T";
140 REM --- PRINT COMMENT ---
150 LPRINT "Printed by this printer";
160 REM --- SET CURSOR POSITION X=1790 DOT, Y=-40 DOT ---
170 LPRINT ESC$+"*p1790x-40Y";
180 REM --- PERFORM SHADING ---
190 REM --- SET SHADING WIDTH TO 23 CHARACTERS + 20 DOTS ---
200 LPRINT ESC$+"*c";23*18+20;"A";
210 REM --- SET SHADING HEIGHT TO 30 DOTS ---
220 LPRINT ESC$+"*c60B";
230 REM --- DRAW SHADING PATTERN (5% GRAY SCALE) ---
240 LPRINT ESC$+"*c5g2P";
250 REM --- END MACRO DEFINITION ---
260 LPRINT ESC$+"&f1X";
270 REM --- MACRO OVERLAY ON (PRINT THE MESSAGE ON EVERY PRINTOUT)
-- 280 LPRINT ESC$+"&f4X";
290 REM --- SET FONT TO BROUGHAM 10 ---
300 LPRINT ESC$+"(s0p10h12v0s0b128T";
310 REM --- MACRO OVERLAY ON, PAPER EJECT ---
320 LPRINT "MACRO OVERLAY ON"
330 LPRINT CHR$(12);
340 REM --- MACRO OVERLAY ON, PAPER EJECT ---
350 LPRINT "MACRO OVERLAY ON"
360 LPRINT CHR$(12);
370 REM --- MACRO OVERLAY OFF (PRINT WITHOUT THE MESSAGE) ---
380 LPRINT ESC$+"&f5X";
390 REM --- MACRO OVERLAY OFF, PAPER EJECT ---
400 LPRINT "MACRO OVERLAY OFF"
410 LPRINT CHR$(12);
420 END
7.4.9. Execute data
The data saved in the storage device by using Printer's control panel "SAVE DATA" function can be printed by
the following command. It can also be printed by operation of the Printer control panel.
EscCR!#E (27)(13)(33)#(69)
<1Bh><0Dh><21h>#<45h>
·
·
·
·
·
# indicates the DATA ID.
Execute the data which is saved in the flash memory card or Hard Disk card.
The printer uses the current environment when this command is executed.
While executing the data, it is possible to change the emulation or reset the printer.
If this command is included in the last data which was saved by the "SAVE DATA" operation from the
printer's control panel, the printer enters a permanent loop so that saved data such as DEMO printing keeps
printing. To stop it, press the RESET key on the printer's control panel. This function is available only for
the Flash ROM card.
7.4.10. AppleTalk configuration
Esc&b#W[key]<sp>[value]
(27)(38)(98)#(87)[Key](32)[value]
<1Bh><26h><62h>#<57h>[Key]<20h>[value]
·
·
·
# value can be from 0 to 32767.
# stands for number of bytes in the data which is following this command.
[key] should be [RENAME], [JOB] or [TYPE].
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 97
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
If the key is [RENAME], this command allows the printer to change the name field of the AppleTalk name
binding protocol.
<ESC>&b#WRENAME<sp>printername
printername should be specified with 1 to 31 characters.
The characters $00 to $FF (except for $00, @, :, *, =, $C5) can be used for the printername.
$00 is used as the terminator.
If invalid characters are used, this command is ignored.
·
·
If the [key] is set to [JOB], this command changes the current job name.
<ESC>&b#WJOB<sp>jobname
All characters from $00 to $FF can be used for the jobname.
jobname can have a maximum of 127 characters.
If the [key] is set to [TYPE], this command allows the printer to change the type field of the AppleTalk name
binding protocol.
<ESC>&b#WTYPE<sp>devicetype
devicetype should be specified with 1 to 31 characters.
The characters $00 to $FF (except for $00, @, :, *, =, $C5) can be used for the devicetype.
$00 is used as the terminator.
If invalid characters are used, this command is ignored.
7.4.11. MIO video I/O port control
The HL-1660e and 2060 printers have only the "VSREQ" signal for vertical synchronization that can be sent to the
MIO port. This causes a short delay to the actual printing start after sending the VSREQ signal if the video
controller is processing an interrupt. This delay causes an incorrect vertical printing position. To avoid the
problem, the following command is useful.
EscCR!12340M (27)(13)(33)(49)(50)(51)(52)(48)(77)
<1Bh><0Dh><21h><31h><32h><33h><34h><30h><4Dh>
·
Laser diode video interface port of the MIO port is closed.
EscCR!12341M (27)(13)(33)(49)(50)(51)(52)(49)(77)
<1Bh><0Dh><21h><31h><32h><33h><34h><31h><4Dh>
·
Laser diode video interface port of the MIO port is opened.
EscCR!12342M (27)(13)(33)(49)(50)(51)(52)(50)(77)
<1Bh><0Dh><21h><31h><32h><33h><34h><32h><4Dh>
·
Laser diode video interface port of the MIO port is opened and the print start command is sent to the printer
engine immediately after sending the VSREQ signal.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 98
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
8.
STATUS READBACK
8.1. Introduction
Status readback features are explained in this section. The printer sends a status response message after
receiving a request for its status by these commands. You can get the information as shown below from the
printer.
- available printer (user) memory
- current available fonts and symbol sets
- the ID numbers of downloaded macros and user-defined patterns to verify their
presence
The computer system must have a device driver for bi-directional communication to get the printers status
response. Bi-directional communication is supported on the HL Series laser printers by the printer driver that
comes with these machines.
8.2. Memory Status request
You can identify the capacity of the user memory in the printer by using the memory status request. You can
determine whether to execute "downloading" or not, by knowing the available memory and thus avoid printer
memory overrun errors.
8.3. Entity Status
You can request the printer to send the status of its entities. A font, symbol set, macro or user-defined pattern in
the printer can be an entity. In order to request entity status, a position type and a position unit must be
identified first and then the entity request command must be sent.
Location type is the memory positions that contain the entities. Memory positions are internal ROM, RAM,
cartridges/cards, the storage device and one additional position specified as "currently selected". Currently
selected means the entity is active. However, "currently selected" can be applied only for fonts and user-defined
patterns.
Location unit means a more specific position within the location type.
When the location type and unit are identified, you can request the status with the Inquire Status Readback
Entity command. The entity (font, symbol set, macro or user-defined pattern) is specified by this command and
the printer sends the response.
When an invalid request is sent, the printer sends an error response back.
8.4. Status Response
If a status request (command) is received, the printer produces the response data. The printer accumulates this
data in an I/O status buffer and saves the response in this buffer until a user reads it or you turn off the printer.
The printer clears the status responses when Printer resolution, Page protection or Emulation language is
changed.
The printer processes status requests and their related response in the order in which the printer receives them.
According to the internal printer operations, the number of responses the printer can accumulate is different. If
you use multiple applications or share the printer, you should read the response to a request before making a new
request.
You should use the Echo command so that your applications request will synchronize with the printer's
responses, because an earlier application might have requested a status and the printer might retain it.
A status response gets routed back to the I/O port that it was requested from.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 99
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
8.5. Status Response Syntax
All of the status responses begin with "PCL", Carriage Return control code and a Line Feed control code. The
response is ended by a Carriage Return and a Line Feed control code. At the end of the transaction, status
responses are ended by a Form Feed Control code. The fundamental syntax for the status response is as shown
below.
PCL<CR> <LF>
INFO TITLE<CR><LF>
KEYWORDn=DATAn<CR><LF>
KEYWORDn=DATAn<CR><LF>
.
.
.
<FF>
TITLE, KEYWORDn, and DATAn are strings which differ according to the status readback command being
operated. One or more keyword lines related to the status readback response accompany every status readback
response. The Echo command response differs from this and is as shown below.
PCL<CR><LF>
ECHO ValueField<CR><LF>
<FF>
ValueField is the decimal number which comes from the Echo command value field.
For future printers, keywords might be added. Applications in which the status readback is used should be made
to disregard lines with keywords they do not understand.
8.5.1. Set status readback location type
ESC*s#T (27)(42)(115)#(84)
<1Bh><2Ah><73h>#<54h>
This command determines the status location type according to the value of #.
The location type is used in association with the location unit in order to specify an entity location for a status
request.
·
#=0 specifies an invalid location. When the printer receives an Inquire Entity Command, an error response is
generated. This is the default value. When you execute a printer reset, this value is reset to 0.
·
·
·
·
·
# = 1 specifies the currently selected location.
# = 2 specifies all locations.
# = 3 specifies the printer's internal location.
# = 4 specifies the downloaded entity.
# = 5 specifies the user-installed card/cartridge
The location type setting is retained by the printer. When the printer does not send the set status readback
location type command in order to change the setting for an entity request, then the printer uses the currently
available location type setting.
8.5.2. Set status readback location unit
ESC*s#U (27)(42)(115)#(85)
<1Bh><2Ah><73h>#<55h>
·
·
The status location unit is selected by the value of #.
The printer uses the location unit in association with the location type in order to specify an entity location
for a status request.
Type
Unit
0
1
2
3
-
-
-
invalid location
currently selected location
all locations
0
all internal entities
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 100
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4
5
0
1
2
0
1
n
all downloaded entities
downloaded entity as temporary
downloaded entity as permanent
All cartridge/cards
the cartridge/card which has the highest priority.
the cartridge/card which has the lowest priority
·
·
·
When the location value is 0, 1 and 2, it ignores the unit value (which might be set to any value). The default
value is 0, and whenever you reset the printer, the value is reset to the default value.
The location unit setting is retained by the printer. If the printer does not send this command to change the
setting for an entity request, then it uses the currently available location units.
The printer may set the location type and unit in order. It does not identify any invalid combinations until it
receives the inquire entity command. Hence, if the unit value is not in the correct range, it sets the unit to the
value for a proper error response to be sent when the inquire entity command is received.
8.5.3. Inquire status readback entity
ESC*s#I (27)(42)(115)#(73)
<1Bh><2Ah><73h>#<49h>
·
Specifies the entity type and makes the printer produce a status response for the entity identified in the status
readback location (type and unit).
Value
Entity type
Font
Macro
User-defined Pattern
Symbol set
Font extended
0
1
2
3
4
8.5.4. Entity status response
The status response for an inquire status readback entity command differs according to the type of the requested
entity.
8.5.5. Font response
Keywords returned from the printer depend on whether the printer font is a bitmap, unbound scalable or bound
scalable. Below is the list of keywords for a font request.
SELECT =
SYMBOLSETS=
LOCTYPE=
LOCUNIT=
Below is an example of a font status response for inquire status command.
Internal, bitmap, LetterGothic 16.66
Internal, unbound scalable, PcTennessee italic
Downloaded, bound scalable, Portugal
Font status:
PCL
INFO FONTS
SELECT="<Esc>(8U<ESC>(s0p16.66h9.5v0s0b130T"
SELECT="<Esc>(s1p__v1s0b4101T"
SYMBOLSETS="0D, 0I, 0N, 0S, 0U, 1E, 1F, 1G, ..."
SELECT="<Esc>(1U<Esc>(s1p__v0s0b5111T<Esc>(22X"
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 101
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
In a font status response, the "SELECT=" keyword line specifies the individual fonts. The font is identified by
this line by specifying the font selection characteristics such as symbol set, spacing, pitch, height, style, stroke
weight, and typefaces. It returns the "SELECT=" for all font types.
In a status response, the five characters "<", "E", "s", "c", and "&>" represent an escape character.
Keywords following a "SELECT=" keyword mean the font specified by that "SELECT=" keyword.
8.5.6. Bitmap fonts
For bitmap fonts, the printer returns the "SELECT=" line. This specifies the font selection features. For instance,
the printer returns the printer's internal, bitmap, Roman-8 LetterGothic font as follows.
PCL
INFO FONTS
SELECT"=<Esc>(8U<Esc>(s0p16.66h8.5v0s0b130T"
8.5.7. Bound scalable fonts
For bound scalable fonts, an underscore( "...s1p__v0s...,") in the "SELECT=" line means it is a bound scalable
font. Also, the related features are indicated. Either the height or pitch is indicated depending upon whether the
font is proportional or fixed spaced. The printer, for instance, returns the printer's internal scalable Symbol font
(proportionally spaced) as follows.
PCL
INFO FONTS
SELECT="<Esc>(19M<Esc>(s1p__v0s0b16901T"
8.5.8. Unbound scalable fonts
For unbound fonts, the printer adds the "SYMBOLSETS=" keyword to specify the symbol sets which can be
used, as the symbol sets can also be used with an unbound font, and there is no symbol set sequence in the
"SELECT=" line. The printer, for instance, returns the printer's internal unbound scalable Brougham (medium,
fixed spaced) font and Pc Tennessee (bold italic, proportional spaced) fonts as follows.
PCL
INFO FONTS
SELECT="<Esc>(s0p__h0s0b4099T"
SYMBOLSETS="0D, 0I, 0N, 0U, 1E, 1F, 1G, ..."
SELECT="<Esc>(s1p__v1s1s3b4101T"
SYMBOLSETS="0D, 0I, 0N, 0S, 0U, 1E, 1F, 1G, ..."
8.5.9. Download fonts
For download fonts (bitmap, bound scalable or unbound scalable), the font ID number is included at the end of
the "SELECT=" line. For instance, the printer returns a downloaded bitmap Brougham with a font ID of 40 and a
downloaded, unbound scalable, Dom Casual typeface with a font ID of 79 as follows.
PCL
INFO FONTS
SELECT="<Esc>(8U<Esc>(s0p11.00h12.0v0s0b3T<Esc>(40X"
SELECT="<Esc>(s1p__v1s0b5259T<Esc>)79X"
SYMBOLSETS="0D, 0D, 0N, 0S, 0U, 1E, 1F, 1G, ..."
8.5.10. Location type 1 (currently selected) font
For a status location type 1 (currently selected) font, the printer returns a single font, the printer font which is
currently selected. The following are the keywords and data returned.
The printer returns the "LOCTYPE=" and "LOCUNIT=" after the "SELECT=" line for every font.
The "SELECT=" line changes for bound and unbound scalable fonts.
For all scalable fonts, the actual size (height or pitch ) is indicated instead of the underscores. For unbound
scalable fonts, the symbol set which is bound to the font at present is indicated. For all fonts, when the font is a
secondary font, ")" replace the "(" characters in the "SELECT=" line.
"LOCTYPE=" specifies the location type of the font which is selected at present. The value field of the Set Status
Readback Type command is related to the value returned.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 102
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 103
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
"LOCUNIT=" specifies the location unit of the font which is selected at present. The value field of the Set Status
Readback Unit command is related to the value returned.
For instance, if the printer font which is selected at present is a bold 12 point Presentation bitmap font which is
selected from a cartridge, and a font entity request with the location type set to 1 is produced, the response will
be returned as follows.
PCL
INFO FONTS
SELECT="<Esc>(2U<Esc>(s0p10.00h12.0v0s3b11T"
LOCTYPE=5
LOCUNIT=1
For instance, suppose the printer font which is selected at present is unbound scalable Dom Casual font with the
features below:
downloaded (font ID of 78)
temporary
Roman-8(specified for printing)
secondary font
18 point
When an entity request is produced with the location type set to 1(selected at present), it returns the response
below.
PCL
INFO FONTS
SELECT="<Esc>)8U<Esc>)s1p18.00v1s0b4148T<Esc>)78X"
LOCTYPE=4
LOCUNIT=1
8.5.11. Font extended response
The font extended response supplies a method to return the name and internal ID number of the font as well as
the "SELECT=" line. It is the same as a font status response since "SELECT=", "SYMBOLSETS=", "LOCTYPE=",
and "LOCUNIT=" are returned in the same way. With regard to a font extended request, it returns the two
additional keywords, "DEFID=" and "NAME=" as follows.
"DEFID" specifies the internal ID number of the font which is shown on the test print
( font list ). This is the
number which is used to select the font as the default font from the control panel of printer or from PJL. The
"DEFID=" number is made of two parts, which are a location and an ID number. The locations which are likely are
as follows;
I
- Internal
C
Cn
S
- Cartridge (printer with single cartridge)
- Cartridge (printer with multiple cartridge/card when n is specified by printer.)
- Permanent download fonts
For temporary download fonts, it returns "DEFID=NONE" because temporary download fonts do not have an
internal ID number.
The printer assigns the internal ID number of a temporary download font with the Font ID (ESC*c#D) command.
This internal ID number differs from the downloaded ID number assigned to a downloaded font.
It returns "NAME=" only for font extended status requests. The name of the font is the same as shown on the
font printout.
For instance, it returns the font extended response for the printer's internal bitmap LetterGothic font and a
downloaded unbound Portugal temporary font as follows.
PCL
INFO FONTS EXTENDED
SELECT="<Esc>(8U<Esc>(s0p10.00h12.0v0s0b0T"
DEFID="I 45"
NAME="Line Printer"
SELECT="<Ec>(s1p__v1s3b4111T<Esc>(7X"
SymbolSETS="0D, 0I, 0N, 0S, 0U, 1E, 1F, 1G,..."
DEFID=NONE
NAME="CG Palacio BdIt"
SELECT="...
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 104
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
For instance, a font extended response with the location type set to 1( selected at present ) where the font which
is selected at present is the internal Pc Tennessee (18 point identified for printing) bold, returns the response as
follows.
PCL
INFO FONTS EXTENDED
SELECT="<Esc>(8U<Esc>(s0p18.00h0s3b4101T"
DEFID="<Esc>(8U<Esc>s0p18.000s3b4101T"
DEFID="I 2"
NAME="PcTennessee Bd"
LOCTYPE=1
LOCUNIT=1
8.5.12. Macro response
The status response for macros indicates all of the macro IDs ("IDLIST=") for the macros in a particular location.
Status location type 1( selected at present ) is an unused location for macros and an error is returned.
A macro status response may be shown as follows.
PCL
INFO MACROS
IDLIST="1, 3, 8, 29, 32"
8.5.13. Use-defined pattern response
The status response of user-defined patterns indicates all of the user-defined patterns and all of the user-defined
pattern IDs ("IDLIST") for the patterns in a particular location.
A user-defined pattern response may be shown as follows.
PCL
INFO PATTERN
IDLIST="1, 2, 9, 13, 27, 456"
When the location type is specified to 1 (selected at present), "LOCTYPE=" and "LOCUNIT=" lines are added.
It returns the "LOCTYPE=" only for a status location type 1 requirement. It specifies the location type of the
pattern which is selected at present.
It returns the "LOCUNIT=" only for a status location type 1 requirement. It specifies the location unit of the
pattern which is selected at present.
A user-defined pattern response for the pattern selected at present may be shown as follows.
PCL
INFO PATTERN
IDLIST="88"
LOCTYPE=4
LOCUNIT=2
When the pattern selected at present is set to one of the internal HP-specified patterns, there is no number
available and it returns the response "ERROR=NONE".
PCL
INFO PATTERNS
ERROR=NONE
8.5.14. Symbol set response
The symbol set response indicates all of the symbol set IDs ("IDLIST") for all of the symbol sets in the identified
location. There can be bound and unbound scalable fonts in the identified location (type and unit).
A symbol set response may be shown as follows.
PCL
INFO SYMBOLSETS
IDLIST="0U, 2K, 8M, 11U"
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 105
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Status location type 1 (selected at present) is an incorrect location for unbound font symbol sets and returns an
error.
Example responses in this section for "SYMBOLSETS=" do not indicate the complete list of symbol sets which
are available internally, but only a partial list . The internal symbol sets depend on the printer and might differ
according to the printer.
8.5.15. Entity error codes
When an out-of-range value exists in the command value fields, or when the entity is not supported or does not
exist, or the request is inadequate, the printer replies with one of four likely errors as follows:
Invalid Entity
Invalid Location
None
Internal Error
ERROR=INVALID ENTITY
When the identified entity type is not in the range or not supported, it returns an invalid entity error.
PCL
INFO ENTITY
ERROR=INVALID ENTITY
ERROR=INVALID LOCATION
When the entity type is correct, but the location ( the type, the unit, or the combination) is not, or when the
identified device is not installed, it returns an invalid location error.
PCL
INFO FONTS
ERROR=INVALID LOCATION
ERROR=NONE
When the entity type and location are correct, but there are not any entities of the identified type in the location,
or when the type is not correct for the identified entity, it generates the NONE error response.
PCL
INFO SYMBOLSETS
ERROR=NONE
ERROR=INTERNAL ERROR
The status response for some requirements could be quite big. When status replies are requested, it returns an
internal error if the printer runs out of memory as follows:
PCL
INFO SYMBOL SETS
ERROR=INTERNAL ERROR
8.5.16. Free space command
ESC*s1M (27)(42)(115)(48)(77) <1Bh><2Ah><73h><31h><4Dh>
The amount of memory which is free for use is returned by this command. Two values are returned: the total
amount of free memory and the largest block of free memory.
When you send a value other than 1, an error ( "ERROR = INVALID UNIT" )is returned.
The Free Space command is sent to check the free memory space and you can acknowledge whether the printer
has enough memory for a job or not before you execute your job. Also you can check the amount of memory
which an entity or any other data has already used.
Free memory space will always be changing during different printing conditions.
For example, when the printer receives print data, it is stored in the printer memory and so the free space in
the printer memory becomes smaller. After the data is printed, the printer memory becomes empty, so the
free space becomes larger again.
Certain action is needed when you decide there is not enough memory to hold the data to be downloaded.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 106
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
8.5.17. Font cache
In order to print characters from a scalable font, the printer changes the scalable character outlines into sized
bitmaps. These bitmapped characters are produced on a character-by-character basis and the produced
bitmapped characters are stored in memory. As it prints more pages using more fonts, more memory is consumed
by the bitmaps. The bitmap characters used on the first page of a job can stay in memory till the end of a job.
These stored bitmap characters are known as the font cache.
If a Brother HL-Series printer encounters a memory low condition, all of the font cache is automatically deleted.
Also, font cache and temporary entities can be cleared by a Printer Reset command.
8.5.18. Memory status response
The total available memory is specified by "TOTAL=" and the largest continuous block size of available memory
is specified by "LARGEST=".
PCL
INFO MEMORY
TOTAL = 10000
LARGEST = 3500
8.5.19. Memory error response
When the value field of the free memory command is out of range, the response for this command would be as
follows;
PCL
INFO MEMORY
ERROR = INVALID UNIT
8.5.20. Flush all pages command
ESC&r#F (27)(38)(114)#(70)
<1Bh><26h><72h>#<46h>
This command suspends accepting data from a PC and clears the user memory.
·
·
#=0 suspends receiving data and clears all completed data. Incompleted data remains in the printers memory.
#=1 suspends receiving data and clears all data remaining in the printer memory.
8.5.21. Echo command
ESC*s#X (27)(42)(115)#(88)
<1Bh><2Ah><73h>#<58h>
This command is used to distinguish each request and response. In networking/sharing environments, some
requests may be sent from a number of PCs to one printer. This command sends the user selected value to the
printer and the printer can return the same value. Adding this command before the status request command
allows this echo value to distinguish the corresponding status response.
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 107
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
9.
INDEX
change..................................................................................... 19
exit ............................................................................................ 18
end-of-line wrap .......................................................................... 12
entity error code.......................................................................... 97
entity status................................................................................. 91
entity status response................................................................ 93
envelope....................................................................................... 15
environment................................................................................. 14
error response
A
adaptive compression.................................................................75
anchor point.................................................................................84
AppleTalk configuration............................................................89
APT ...............................................................................................78
area fill...........................................................................................67
memory .................................................................................... 98
Esc................................................................................................. 12
escape........................................................................................... 11
escape sequence......................................................................... 12
B
backspace.....................................................................................11
binding..........................................................................................17
bitmap font .............................................................................33, 94
bound font....................................................................................34
bound scalable font ....................................................................94
F
factory default environment...................................................... 14
factory default setting................................................................ 18
fill pattern ..................................................................................... 69
filled rectangle
C
draw......................................................................................... 71
fixed spacing................................................................................ 41
fixed underlining.......................................................................... 45
floating underlining .................................................................... 45
Flush All Pages command ......................................................... 98
font................................................................................................ 33
font cache..................................................................................... 98
font descriptor............................................................................. 47
font extended response.............................................................. 95
font ID........................................................................................... 46
font orientation............................................................................ 44
font response............................................................................... 93
font selection criteria .................................................................. 35
font source................................................................................... 34
font type....................................................................................... 33
form feed....................................................................................... 11
Free Space command.................................................................. 97
carriage return ..............................................................................11
CCITT G3/G4 ................................................................................77
character code..............................................................................59
character descriptor and data....................................................59
character spacing ........................................................................36
compress transfer graphics........................................................79
compression mode ......................................................................74
condensed....................................................................................43
control code .................................................................................11
coordinate.....................................................................................23
cursor
position..............................................................................28, 30
cursor position stack..................................................................30
D
decipoints .....................................................................................23
default fonts .................................................................................35
defined symbol set......................................................................37
destination....................................................................................65
display function mode................................................................13
download font..............................................................................94
downloadable font ......................................................................35
create........................................................................................47
manipulation ...........................................................................46
downloaded font
G
graphics ........................................................................................ 65
graphics window......................................................................... 20
H
half line feed................................................................................. 31
height...................................................................................... 36, 42
raster image............................................................................. 74
select........................................................................................ 42
high resolution control............................................................... 73
HMI............................................................................................... 25
horizontal cursor position.......................................................... 29
horizontal margin......................................................................... 24
horizontal motion index.............................................................. 25
horizontal plot size ...................................................................... 84
operation .................................................................................46
select........................................................................................46
duplex printing.............................................................................17
E
Echo command.............................................................................98
emulation mode
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 108
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
horizontal tab ...............................................................................11
HP-GL/2 mode..............................................................................83
P
page............................................................................................... 20
page dimensions
I
landscape................................................................................ 22
portrait ..................................................................................... 21
page length .................................................................................. 27
page size ....................................................................................... 15
paper side selection.................................................................... 17
paper source ................................................................................ 16
paper type .................................................................................... 15
pattern........................................................................................... 65
pattern reference point............................................................... 68
pattern transparency .................................................................. 66
pattern type.................................................................................. 69
PCL................................................................................................ 12
perforation skip ........................................................................... 27
physical page............................................................................... 20
picture frame ................................................................................ 84
horizontal size......................................................................... 84
vertical size ............................................................................. 84
pitch ........................................................................................ 36, 41
select........................................................................................ 41
portrait .......................................................................................... 31
primary font............................................................................ 11, 35
printable area ............................................................................... 20
proportional spacing .................................................................. 41
internal font..................................................................................34
italic ...............................................................................................43
J
Job separation command............................................................18
L
landscape......................................................................................31
left long-edge offset registration ..............................................16
left margin .....................................................................................23
line feed.........................................................................................11
line pitch .......................................................................................25
line spacing ..................................................................................26
line termination ............................................................................12
location type
status readback......................................................................92
location unit
status readback......................................................................92
logical page ..................................................................................20
logical page orientation..............................................................31
lower cassette ..............................................................................16
R
Raster Graphic Mode 1027......................................................... 81
raster graphics ............................................................................. 73
raster image
send ......................................................................................... 79
raster resolution .......................................................................... 73
raster transfer
end ........................................................................................... 79
rectangle height........................................................................... 71
rectangle width............................................................................ 71
rectangles ..................................................................................... 71
RESET ..................................................................................... 14, 18
right margin .................................................................................. 23
rows and columns....................................................................... 23
M
macro .............................................................................................85
call ............................................................................................87
delete........................................................................................88
execute.....................................................................................87
overlay.....................................................................................87
macro definition
end............................................................................................86
start ..........................................................................................86
macro ID........................................................................................86
macro overlay environment .......................................................14
macro response............................................................................96
manual paper feed .......................................................................16
measurement ................................................................................23
memory status request...............................................................91
MIO video I/O port control........................................................90
Mode 9 compression ..................................................................75
modified print environment........................................................14
multi-purpose tray.......................................................................16
S
scalable font................................................................................. 33
scale ......................................................................................... 42
secondary font ...................................................................... 11, 35
self test......................................................................................... 18
simlex printing.............................................................................. 17
solid............................................................................................... 43
source ........................................................................................... 65
source transparency................................................................... 65
space............................................................................................. 11
status location type 1 font......................................................... 94
status readback........................................................................... 91
O
orientation
raster image.............................................................................73
output tray....................................................................................15
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 109
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
status response...........................................................................91
U
memory ....................................................................................98
status response syntax...............................................................92
stroke weight................................................................................36
select........................................................................................43
style .........................................................................................36, 42
select........................................................................................42
symbol collection ........................................................................36
symbol set ....................................................................................36
define .......................................................................................37
select........................................................................................39
symbol set control command.....................................................39
symbol set ID code command ...................................................37
symbol set response...................................................................96
unbound font............................................................................... 34
unbound scalable font ............................................................... 94
underlining text ............................................................................ 45
unit of measure ............................................................................ 23
units .............................................................................................. 23
upper cassette ............................................................................. 16
upright .......................................................................................... 43
user default environment........................................................... 14
user settings ................................................................................ 18
user-defined pattern command ................................................. 68
user-defined pattern control...................................................... 69
user-defined pattern response.................................................. 96
T
V
test sheet ......................................................................................18
text area.........................................................................................20
text direction.................................................................................31
text length.....................................................................................26
text wrap........................................................................................12
TIFF.........................................................................................74, 78
top margin.....................................................................................24
top offset registration.................................................................17
transfer start
vector graphics............................................................................ 83
vertical cursor position .............................................................. 28
vertical motion index................................................................... 25
vertical plot size........................................................................... 84
VMI............................................................................................... 25
W
width
raster imge...............................................................................79
transparent print data .................................................................44
type of character spacing
raster image............................................................................. 74
select........................................................................................41
typeface ........................................................................................36
select........................................................................................43
Y
y-offset
raster image............................................................................. 74
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 110
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 3
PCL5C
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CONTENTS
1. INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................................................................3
2. COLOR MODES.....................................................................................................................................4
2.1. Using Simple Color Mode - Set Simple Color....................................................................................4
2.2. Using PCL Color Mode - Set PCL Color Setting................................................................................5
2.3. Using HP-GL/2 Color Mode................................................................................................................9
3. COLOR PALETTES ........................................................................................................................... 10
3.1. Set Color #1 .....................................................................................................................................10
3.2. Set Color #2 .....................................................................................................................................10
3.3. Set Color #3 .....................................................................................................................................10
3.4. Set Color to Palette..........................................................................................................................10
3.5. Select Color......................................................................................................................................10
3.6. Push/Pop Palette .............................................................................................................................11
4. COLOR GRAPHICS ........................................................................................................................... 12
4.1. Start Raster Transfer.......................................................................................................................12
4.2. Set Destination Raster Width ..........................................................................................................12
4.3. Set Destination Raster Height..........................................................................................................12
4.4. Set Scale Algorithm..........................................................................................................................13
4.5. Send Raster Data by Plane .............................................................................................................13
4.6. Enter HP-GL/2 Mode........................................................................................................................13
5. ENHANCE OUTPUT.......................................................................................................................... 14
5.1. Set Render Algorithm.......................................................................................................................14
5.2. Set Monochrome Mode....................................................................................................................14
5.3. Set Gamma Correction....................................................................................................................15
5.4. Download Dither Matrix....................................................................................................................15
5.5. User-defined Pattern Command......................................................................................................15
6. HP-GL/2 ................................................................................................................................................ 16
6.1. IN (Initialize Set Instruction) Command............................................................................................16
6.2. PC (Pen Color) Command ..............................................................................................................16
6.3. NP (Number of Pens) Command ....................................................................................................17
6.4. CR (Color Range) Command..........................................................................................................17
7. INDEX.................................................................................................................................................... 18
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
1.
INTRODUCTION
This chapter describes the enhanced commands for the PCL5C emulation.
PCL5C is upwards-compatible with PCL5e. For the commands of PCL5e, refer to “Chapter 2 PCL” which
describes the PCL5e emulation.
If you are reading this technical manual for the first time, it is recommended that you read Chapter 2 first before
reading this Chapter.
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
2.
COLOR MODES
The PCL5C emulation provides a B/W mode, which is the default, and three color modes as follows;
1) Simple Color Mode
2) PCL Color Mode
3) HP-GL/2 Color Mode
Simple Color Mode allows you to use a maximum of 8 colors easily. PCL Color Mode allows you to use a
maximum of 16,000,000 colors logically. HP-GL/2 Mode allows you to use vector graphics in color.
It is possible to switch between these modes in a single page, which enables you to use each of them for your
purpose.
When handling colors in those modes, use palette. For details on palette, refer to Section 3 ‘Color Palettes’ of
this chapter.
This section describes the details about each color mode.
2.1. Using Simple Color Mode - Set Simple Color
Command
ESC*r#U (27)(42)(114)#(85) <1Bh><2Ah><72h>#<55h>
# = -4
# = -3
# = 1
*
CMYK mode
CMY mode
B/W mode
# =
3
RGB mode
* Default value = 1
·
·
The # value specifies the palette and the colors for the palette. For specific colors, refer to the table below;
This command specifies each color corresponding to the index number. The color is fixed and
unchangeable.
·
The colors which were specified in the palette by the PCL or HP-GL/2 command are cancelled.
Index No
-4 (CMYK)
White
Cyan
-3(CMY)
White
Cyan
1(B/W) *
3(RGB)
Black
Red
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
White
Black
Magenta
Blue
Magenta
Blue
-
-
-
-
-
-
Green
Yellow
Blue
Yellow
Green
Yellow
Green
Red
Magenta
Cyan
Red
Black
Black
White
* = default
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
2.2. Using PCL Color Mode - Set PCL Color Setting
Command
ESC*v#W (27)(42)(118)#(87) <1Bh><2Ah><76h>#<57h>
# = 6, 18
# stands for the number of bytes of data that follow this command.
This command sets the palette size and transformation between the entered value and device-specific value.
This command has two types of format, short format and long format. Here are the formats for the PCL color
setting.
1)
Short Format
MSB
LSB
0 - 1
Format (0)
Bits / index
Encoding mode
Bits / value #1
Bits / value #3
2 - 3
4 - 5
Bits / value #2
§
Format
This value must be 0.
§
·
Encoding mode
This value defines how to send the raster image data.
·
The value can be from 0 to 3 only, other values are ignored.
Encoding Mode
0
1
2
3
Send Index No by Plane *
Send Index No by Pixel
Send Direct Value by Plane
Send Direct Value by Pixel
* = default
Send Index No by Plane (= 0 default)
·
·
This mode assigns the Index No. to the Plane, then sends it.
The necessary number for the Plane is determined depending on the number of bits/index. 1 (one) plane
should be needed per 1 (one) bit/index. For instance, 4 planes are needed for 4 bits/index.
·
·
Bits/index must be 1, 2, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8.
This mode sends the plane data except the last one using the Send Raster Data by Plane command
(ESC*b#V).
·
This mode also sends the last plane data using the Send Raster Data command (ESC*b#W).
(i.e. 4 bits/index)
ESC*b#V d1, d1, d1, d1, d1 ...® Plane 1
ESC*b#V d2, d2, d2, d2, d2 ...® Plane 2
ESC*b#V d3, d3, d3, d3, d3 ...® Plane 3
ESC*b#W d4, d4, d4, d4, d4 ...® Plane 4
ESC*b#V d1, d1, d1, d1, d1 ...® Plane 1
ESC*b#V d2, d2, d2, d2, d2 ...® Plane 2
1st raster
2nd raster
MSB
LSB
Index No. d4
d3
d2
d1
** The Italic characters shown above are the index No. at the 4th pixel in the 1st raster.
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
[Example]
If you want to send index No. 7,6,5,4,3,2,1,0;
Enter ’ESC*v6W 00h 00h 04h 08h 08h 08h’, then select Send Index No by Plane.
Select 4 bits/index. (24 = 16 Palettes)
ESC*r1A
Start Raster Transfer
ESC*b1V 10101010B
ESC*b1V 11001100B
ESC*b1V 11110000B
ESC*b1W 00000000B
....
Send Plane1 data (The Index No Bit0 data)
Send Plane2 data (The Index No Bit1 data)
Send Plane3 data (The Index No Bit2 data)
Send Plane4 data (The Index No Bit3 data)
ESC*rC
End Raster Transfer
(xxh: hexadecimal, xxxxxxxxB: binary)
Send Index No by Pixel (= 1)
·
·
This mode sends the index No. by pixel.
Bits/index must be 1, 2, 4, 8.
(2 bits/index)
ESC*b#W d1, d2, d1, d2, d1, d2...® 1st raster
ESC*b#W d1, d2, d1, d2, d1, d2...® 2nd raster
ESC*b#W d1, d2, d1, d2, d1, d2...® 3rd raster
ESC*b#W d1, d2, d1, d2, d1, d2...® 4th raster
MSB
LSB
Index No. d2
d1
** The Italic characters shown above are the index No. at the 2nd pixel in the 3rd raster.
[Example]
If you want to send the index No. below;
Index No.
3, 2, 1, 0
2, 1, 0, 3
3, 0, 1, 2
0, 1, 2, 3
(1st raster)
(2nd raster)
(3rd raster)
(4th raster)
Enter ‘ESC*v6W 00h 01h 02h 08h 08h 08h’, then select Send Index No by Plane.
Select 2 bits/index. (22 = 4 Palettes)
ESC*r1A
Start Raster Transfer
Send 1st raster data
Send 2nd raster data
Send 3rd raster data
Send 4th raster data
ESC*b1V 11100100B
ESC*b1V 10010011B
ESC*b1V 11000110B
ESC*b1W 00011011B
....
ESC*rC
End Raster Transfer
(xxh: hexadecimal, xxxxxxxxB: binary)
Send Direct Value by Plane (= 2)
·
·
·
·
This mode sends each value of RGB by plane.
Bits/index must be 1.
This mode sends the plane data except the last one using the Send Raster Data by Plane command.
This mode sends the last plane data using the Send Raster Data command.
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
(i.e.)
ESC*b#V r, r, r, r, r...® Plane 1
ESC*b#V g, g, g, g, g...® Plane 2
ESC*b#W b, b, b, b, b...® Plane 3
ESC*b#V r, r, r, r, r...® Plane 1
ESC*b#V g, g, g, g, g...® Plane 2
1st raster
2nd raster
** The Italic characters shown above are the index No. at the 4th pixel in the 1st raster.
[Example]
If you want to send RGB=(1,1,1)(0,1,1)(1,0,1)(0,0,1)(1,1,0)(0,1,0)(1,0,0)(0,0,0);
** The values in the brackets show the RGB value of the pixel.
Enter ‘ESC*v6W 00h 02h 01h 01h 01h 01h’, then select Send Direct Value by Plane.
Select 1 bit/index.
ESC*r1A
Start Raster Transfer
ESC*b1V 10101010B
ESC*b1V 11001100B
ESC*b1W 11110000B
ESC*rC
Send Plane 1 data (Red data)
Send Plane 2 data (Green data)
Send Plane 3 data (Blue data)
End Raster Transfer
(xxh: hexadecimal, xxxxxxxxB: binary)
Send Direct Value by Pixel (= 3)
·
·
This sends each value of RGB pixel by pixel.
Bits/index must be 8.
(i.e.)
ESC*b#W r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b,...® 1st raster
ESC*b#W r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b,...® 2nd raster
ESC*b#W r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b,...® 3rd raster
ESC*b#W r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b,...® 4th raster
ESC*b#W r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b,...® 5th raster
** The Italic characters shown above are the index No. at the 4th pixel in the 1st raster.
[Example]
If you want to send the RGB value below;
RGB value.
1st raster
(0,0,0)(128,128,128)(128,64,0)(255,128,64)
(128,128,128)(128,64,0)(255,128,64) (0,0,0)
(128,64,0)(255,128,64) (0,0,0) (128,128,128)
2nd raster
3rd raster
** The values in the brackets show the RGB value of the pixel.
Enter ‘ESC*v6W 00h 03h 08h 08h 08h 08h’, then select Send Direct Value by Pixel.
Select 8 bits/index.
ESC*r1A
Start Raster Transfer
Send Plane 1 data (Red data)
ESC*b12V 00h 00h 00h 80h 80h 80h 80h 40h 00h ffh 80h 40h
ESC*b12V 80h 80h 80h 80h 40h 00h ffh 80h 40h 00h 00h 00h
ESC*b12W 80h 40h 00h ffh 80h 40h 00h 00h 00h 80h 80h 80h
ESC*rC
Send Plane 2 data (Green data)
Send Plane 3 data (Blue data)
End Raster Transfer
(xxh: hexadecimal, xxxxxxxxB: binary)
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
§
·
Bits/index
Specifies the palette size at 2n. n indicates bits/index. (n=4 à24=16 palettes)
·
When the encoding mode is 0 or 1, the palette size selected by the bits/index value specifies the range of the
index No., which can be used for raster data.
·
The values specified by the encoding mode are listed below;
Encoding Mode
Bits/Index
0
1
2
3
0,1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8
1,2,4,8
1
8
§
Bits/value (#1, #2, #3)
Each value indicates a color as follows;
#1:
#2:
#3:
red
green
blue
·
·
·
·
·
When the encoding mode is 0 or 1, it ignores this setting. The black/white reference, described later, is set.
When the encoding mode is 2, it shows the number of planes that are required to send each color.
When the encoding mode is 3, it shows the number of bits that are required to send each color.
It sets the black reference to 0. (Valid when the Encoding mode is 0 or 1.)
It sets the white reference to 2n-1. (Valid when the Encoding mode is 0 or 1.)
2)
Long Format
MSB
LSB
0 - 1
Format (0)
Bits / index
Encoding mode
Bits / value #1
Bits / value #3
2 - 3
4 - 5
Bits / value #2
6 - 7
White reference for value #1
8 - 9
White reference for value #2
White reference for value #3
Black reference for value #1
Black reference for value #2
Black reference for value #3
10 - 11
12 - 13
14 - 15
16 - 17
The long format allows you make the setting of the white/black reference in addition to the ones available in the
short format.
§
·
White reference for value #1, #2, #3
This mode specifies the white value (the lowest level of density).
Each value indicates a color as follows;
·
#1:
#2:
#3:
red
green
blue
Range: -32767 ~ 32767
·
When the encoding mode is 2 or 3, this setting is valid.
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
§
§
§
Black reference for value #1, #2, #3
This mode specifies the black value (the highest level of density).
Each value indicates a color as follows;
#1:
#2:
#3:
red
green
blue
Range: -32767 ~ 32767
·
When the encoding mode is 2 or 3, this setting is valid.
2.3. Using HP-GL/2 Color Mode
Two methods are provided to set the color mode in the HP-GL/2 mode. Set the color mode by the PCL
command, then transfer to the HP-GL/2 mode. Execute the NP command.
For the details on how to use the color selections in the HP-GL/2 mode, refer to Section 6 ‘HP-GL/2’.
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.
COLOR PALETTES
3.1. Set Color #1
Command
ESC*v#A (27)(42)(118)#(65) <1Bh><2Ah><76h>#<41h>
Range = -32767 ~ 32767
Default value = 0
·
·
This command sets the red value in the palette. Use the Set Color to Palette command to set the value
The value range to be set varies depending on the specified black/white reference.
3.2. Set Color #2
Command
ESC*v#B (27)(42)(118)#(66) <1Bh><2Ah><76h>#<42h>
Range = -32767 ~ 32767
Default value = 0
·
·
This command sets the green value in the palette. Use the Set Color to Palette command to set the value.
The value range to be set varies depending on the specified black/white reference.
3.3. Set Color #3
Command
ESC*v#C (27)(42)(118)#(67) <1Bh><2Ah><76h>#<43h>
Range = -32767 ~ 32767
Default value = 0
·
·
This command sets the blue value in the palette. Use the Set Color to Palette command to set the value.
The value range to be set varies depending on the specified black/white reference.
3.4. Set Color to Palette
Command
ESC*v#I (27)(42)(118)#(73) <1Bh><2Ah><76h>#<49h>
Range = 0 ~ (2n - 1) (The value n is specified by the Bit/Index setting in the Set PCL Color Setting command.)
Default value = 0
·
This command sets the red, green and blue values which are set by the Set Color #1, #2, #3 commands in the
palette.
·
·
When an out of range value is set, it is ignored in the palette.
This command sets the value which was set by the Set Color #1, #2, #3 commands to 0.
3.5. Select Color
Command
ESC*v#S (27)(42)(118)#(83) <1Bh><2Ah><76h>#<53h>
# = 0 ~ current palette size
Default value = 0
·
·
·
This command selects the color as the index number in the palette.
This command is valid for text, underline, rule and graphics.
This command does not affect the User-defined color pattern or HP-GL/2. (The HP-GL/2 command selects
the color using the SP command.)
·
The value to be selected by this command is never affected by the Set PCL Color Setting, Set Render
Algorithm, Download Dither Matrix or Set Gamma Correction commands.
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.6. Push/Pop Palette
Command
ESC*p#P (27)(42)(112)#(80) <1Bh><2Ah><70h>#<50h>
= 0 * Push palette
= 1 Pop palette
* Default value = 0
#
·
The value of 0 pushes the current palette onto the palette stack. This command does not affect the current
palette.
·
·
The value of 1 pops the palette from the top of the palette stack and replacesthe current palette with it.
If the Pop Palette command is executed without a Push palette having first having been executed, it is
ignored.
·
·
The palette stack is controlled as a First In Last Out stack.
The parameters below are pushed to the palette stack;
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
Color Mode (Simple Color / PCL Color Mode)
Parameters to be set by the Set PCL Color Setting command
Encoding Mode (mode 0, 1, 2, 3)
Bits / index
Bits / value #1
Bits / value #2
Bits / value #3
Black and White Reference
Parameter of Render Algorithm
Parameter of Gamma Correction
Color Palette
Dither to be downloaded by the Download Dither Matrix command
Pen Width (HP-GL/2)
·
The data below is pushed to the palette stack;
w
w
w
Colors to be selected by the Select Color command
Colors to be selected by the Set #1, #2, #3 command
Monochrome Print Mode
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.
COLOR GRAPHICS
4.1. Start Raster Transfer
Command
ESC*r#A (27)(42)(114)#(65) <1Bh><2Ah><72h>#<41h>
#
= 0 *
= 1
Prints the image from the left edge of the logical page.
Prints the image from the current cursor position.
= 2
= 3
Executes scaling. Prints the image from the left edge of the logical page.
Executes scaling. Prints the images from the current cursor position.
* Default value = 0
·
·
This command signals the start of the transfer of raster image data to the printer.
The transfer of raster data to the printer continues until either an End Raster Transfer command is sent or a
command other than Send Raster Data, Set Compression Mode or Y-Offset is sent.
·
The source width and height are set by the Set Raster Area Width (ESC*r#S) and Set Raster Area Height
(ESC*r#T) commands. When the # value is 2 or 3, the data with these source width/height values is
enlarged or reduced to the width and height set by the Set Destination Raster Width and Set Destination
Raster Height commands. (Refer to the following sections.)
4.2. Set Destination Raster Width
Command
ESC*t#H (27)(42)(116)#(72) <1Bh><2Ah><74h>#<48h>
Range = 0 ~ 32767 (number of decipoints in 1/720”)
Default value = 0
·
If value 2 or 3 is sent with the Start Raster Transfer command and graphic scaling is set, this command sets
the destination width.
·
·
·
Values outside the range are invalid.
If the setting is 0 or is omitted, this command uses the same width as the source width.
If the specified width is wider than the page, drawings are clipped by the right physical page boundary. The
scaling factor is dealt with correctly.
4.3. Set Destination Raster Height
Command
ESC*t#V (27)(42)(116)#(86) <1Bh><2Ah><70h>#<56h>
Range = 0 ~ 32767 (number of decipoints in 1/720”)
Default value = 0
·
If value 2 or 3 is sent with the Start Raster Transfer command and graphic scaling is set, this command sets
the destination height.
·
·
·
Values outside the range are invalid.
If the setting is 0 or is omitted, this command uses the same height as the source height.
If the specified height is longer than the page, drawings are clipped by the bottom of physical page boundary.
The scaling factor is dealt with correctly.
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.4. Set Scale Algorithm
Command
ESC*t#K (27)(42)(116)#(75) <1Bh><2Ah><70h>#<4Bh>
#
= 0 *
= 1
Takes the lighter overlying dots when reducing.
Takes the darker overlying dots when reducing.
* Default value = 0
·
·
This command sets which algorithmthe data is reduced by.
Any combinations, such as vertical only, horizontal only or vertical and horizontal are allowed to be reduced.
If the setting is vertical only or horizontal only, this command affects the set direction.
·
This command should be used after sending the Start Raster Transfer command after setting the scaling
(ESC*r2A or ESC*r3A).
4.5. Send Raster Data by Plane
Command
ESC*b#V [data] (27)(42)(98)#(87) <1Bh><2Ah><62h>#<56h>
Range = 0 ~ 32767
Default value = N/A
·
·
This command sends a plane of data to the printer and goes ahead to the next plane (not to the next row).
The # value represents the number of data bytes to be sent. The number of planes per row is specified by
the Set Simple Color command or the Set PCL Color command, depending on which color mode is used.
The first plane sent represents the least significant bit in the pixel.
·
·
Since this command does not affect the cursor position, it cannot be used for the last plane or for single-plane
rows. Only the ESC*b#Wcommand can progress the cursor to the next row.
The amount of data sent varies depending on the plane, and it is separate from the raster width. When the
data sent is shorter than the raster width, the data which was not filled within the specified raster width is
cleared to 0. Empty planes can be sent when the # value is 0.
4.6. Enter HP-GL/2 Mode
Command
ESC%#B (27)(37)#(66) <1Bh><2Ah><25h>#<4Ah>
#
= 0 *
= 1
Position the cursor at the previous HP-GL/2 cursor position.
Leave the cursor at its current PCL position.
= 2
= 3
Use current PCL coordinate system and previous HP-GL/2 pen position
Use PCL dot coordinate system and the current cursor position
Range = 0 ~ 3
* Default value = 0
·
·
Immediately after the printer receives this command, it switches to HP-GL/2 mode, interpreting commands as
HP-GL/2 commands until it receives an Enter PCL Mode, Reset or UEL command, or until the printer is turned
off and on.
The # value specifies the cursor position once HP-GL/2 mode is entered. Each value performs the following
functions;
• # = 0:
The cursor is positioned at the previous HP-GL/2 cursor position. If this is the first time you
have switched to HP-GL/2 mode since switching the printer on, the cursor is placed at the origin
of the HP-GL/2 graphics windows.
• # = 1:
• # = 2:
The cursor remains at its current position.
The PCL coordinate system is used when entering into HP-GL/2 mode from PCL mode. The HP-
GL/2 cursor position uses the previous HP-GL/2 position. It is separate from the P1 and P2
positions.
• # = 3:
The PCL coordinate system is used when entering into HP-GL/2 mode from PCL mode . The PCL
cursor position is used instead of the HP-GL/2 cursor position. It is separate from the P1 and P2
positions.
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.
ENHANCE OUTPUT
5.1. Set Render Algorithm
Command
ESC*t#J (27)(42)(116)#(74) <1Bh><2Ah><70h>#<4Ah>
#
= 0 Scatter dither
= 1
Snap to primaries
= 2
= 3 *
= 4
Snap black to white, all other colors to black
Scatter dither
Scatter dither
= 5
= 6
= 7
Monochrome device best dither
Monochrome scatter dither
Clustered dither
= 8
= 9
Monochrome clustered dither
User-defined dither
= 10
= 11
= 12
= 13
= 14
Monochrome user-defined dither
Scatter dither
Monochrome scatter dither
Scatter dither
Monochrome scatter dither
* Default value = 3
·
This command selects the halftone render algorithm.
• # = 1:
This does not use halftones. For 8 bits/pixe l, for instance, any value over 128 is
transferred to 255, and any value under 127 is transferred to 0.
This transfers black to white and other colors to black.
This selects the scatter dither. The scatter dither is the most crisp dither (device best
dither) for the HL-2400C/Ce and HL-3400CN.
• # = 2:
• # = 3:
• # = 0, 4, 11, 13: These show halftones using a dither method, which places dots in a dither pattern to
make the spacial frequency higher.
• # = 7:
• # = 9:
This shows halftones using a dither method, which enlarges dots from their center.
This shows halftones using the dither which is specified by the Download Dither
Matrix command.
• # = 5, 6, 8, 10,
12, 14, 1025:
This replaces the color value with gray scale data using the formula below;
gray value = 0.30 x red + 0.59 x green + 0.11 x blue
5.2. Set Monochrome Mode
Command
ESC&b#M (27)(38)(98)#(77) <1Bh><26h><62h>#<4dh>
= 0 * Monochrome mode off
= 1 Monochrome mode on
#
* Default value = 0
·
·
·
·
This command prints the color data by replacing it with gray scale data.
This command replaces the color data with gray scale data using the formula below;
gray value = 0.30 x red + 0.59 x green + 0.11 x blue
This command should be sent before sending the data to be printed. Failure to do so will cause the current
page to be closed and printed. This command may be sent on a page-by-page basis.
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.3. Set Gamma Correction
Command
ESC*t#I (27)(42)(116)#(73) <1Bh><2Ah><74h>#<49h>
#
= 0.0 ~ 32767.0 (command is ignored for invalid values)
Default value = 0 (gamma correction off)
This command does not destroy the contents of the current palette, but setting a gamma value replaces any
lookup table input in either Device CMY or Device RGB.
5.4. Download Dither Matrix
Command
ESC*m#W [data] (27)(42)(109)#(87) <1Bh><2Ah><6dh>#<57h>
Range = 7 ~ 32767 (Any other value is ignored.)
# stands for the number of pattern data bytes.
·
·
This command specifies a single matrix for the R, G, and B colors.
The dither which is specified by this command is valid when selecting the # value to 9 or 10 with the Set
Render Algorithm command.
·
The table below shows the format for a dither matrix that is applied to all three primary colors.
MSB
LSB
0 - 1
2 - 3
4 - 5
Format (0)
Dither matrix height in pixels
Dither matrix width in pixels
Number of planes (1)
w
w
w
w
Format:
set to 0.
set to 1.
Number of planes:
Dither matrix height in pixels: specifies the dither matrix height by the number of pixels.
Dither matrix width in pixels: specifies the dither matrix width by the number of pixels.
** The values for ‘Dither matrix height in pixels’ and ‘Dither matrix width in pixels’ should not be 0. The
multiple of these two values should not be more than 32767.
5.5. User-defined Pattern Command
Command
ESC*c#W (22)(42)(99)#(87) <1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<57h>
Range = 0 ~ 32767.
# stands for the number of pattern data bytes.
MSB
LSB
0 - 1
2 - 3
4 - 5
6 - 7
8 - 9
Format (1)
Continuation (0)
Reserved (0)
Pixel Encoding (1/8)
Height in Pixels
Width in Pixels
Pattern Image
w
NOTE:
w
Format:
set to 1. This command downloads the color pattern.
If the Format is set to 0 or 20, it sends monochrome format. For details, refer to ‘Chapter 2 PCL’.
Pixel encoding: set to either of 1 bit or 8 bits. If selecting 1 bit, 1 pixel is assigned to 1 bit (2 colors). If
selecting 8 bit, 1 pixel is assigned to 8 bits (256 colors).
w
w
w
Height in pixels: specifies the pattern height by the number of rows.
Width in pixels: specifies the pattern width by the number of pixels.
Pattern Image: sends the pattern image data as an index number of the palette. It uses the colors of
the current palette when the pattern is used.
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.
HP-GL/2
A few HP-GL/2 commands are added for the HL-2400C/Ce, HL-3400CN color laser printer, and the features of
some existing commands are also expanded.
The new or revised HP-GL/2 commands as follows are described in this chapter;
§
§
§
§
Initialize Set Instruction (IN) - resets all programmable functions to their default settings
Pen Color (PC) - changes the palette colors
Number of Pens (NP) - changes the palette size
Color Range (CR) - sets the range for specifying relative color data
For the basic commands of HP-GL/2, refer to ‘Chapter 8 HP-GL/2 Graphics Language’.
6.1. IN (Initialize Set Instruction) Command
Command
IN [;]
This command returns the graphics mode to initial conditions. It initializes the parameters listed on Page.9 of
‘Chapter 8 HP-GL/2’ and also those shown below.
Function
Equivalent
Instruction
NP
Condition
Number of Pens
Color Range
8
CR
Black reference (red, green, blue) ----> 0
White reference (red, green, blue) ----> 255
This command also initializes the parameters of the palette as follows;
Palette No.(Pen No.)
Color
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
White
Black
Red
Green
Yellow
Blue
Magenta
Cyan
6.2. PC (Pen Color) Command
Command
PC [pen, red, green, blue]
PC [pen;]
PC [;]
This command changes the pen colors in the palette and sets the colors of all pens to their default settings.
·
pen:
represents the palette number specified by this command. It ignores the command if it is out of the
range of the specified parameter.
·
red, green, blue: specifies the color. The range of the specified value is determined by the CR command.
Default range is 0 ~ 255.
·
PC [;]:
initializes all palettes.
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 16
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
PC [pen;]: sets the pen to the default color.
Number of pens in palette
2 (“NP 2;”)
Pen number
Color
0
1
0
1
2
3
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
White
Black
White
Black
Red
4 (“NP 4;”)
Green
White
Black
Red
8 (“NP 8;”)
Green
Yellow
Blue
Magenta
Cyan
** If the number of pens in the palette is over 8, the color is set to black.
6.3. NP (Number of Pens) Command
Command
NP [n;]
NP [;]
Range = 2 ~ 32768
Default value = 8
·
·
This command makes the palette the specified size after the Initialize Set Instruction command or Set PCL
Color Setting command is executed.
The n value represents the palette number with the value of 2n. When it cannot be indicated with the value
of 2n, the next value, 2n+1 is selected.
·
·
·
When a value over 257 is specified, 256 is selected.
When a value less than 2 is specified, it is ignored.
The specified palette can be selected by the Select Pen command. When the value specified by the Select
Pen command is bigger than the palette number specified by this command, the value of the remainder is used.
6.4. CR (Color Range) Command
Command
CR [....]
Range = - 32768 ~ 32767
Default value is listed below;
R
G
B
Black reference
White reference
0
255
0
255
0
255
Black reference:
White reference:
specifies the black value (the highest level of density)
specifies the white value (the lowest level of density)
·
·
This command sets the range for specifying relative color data.
The value specified by this command is reset to the default value by the CR [;]or IN [;]command.
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
7.
INDEX
A
M
algorithm....................................................................................13
monochrome mode................................................................... 14
B
N
B/W mo de....................................................................................4
black value...................................................................................9
blue value ..................................................................................10
NP command............................................................................. 17
number of pens......................................................................... 17
P
C
palette .......................................................................................... 4
palette size................................................................................... 5
PC command ............................................................................. 16
PCL color mode .......................................................................... 5
pen color.................................................................................... 16
pixel.............................................................................................. 6
Plane............................................................................................. 5
pop palette ................................................................................ 11
push palette .............................................................................. 11
color palette...............................................................................10
color range.................................................................................17
CR command .............................................................................17
D
destination raster height .........................................................12
destination raster width...........................................................12
dither matrix...............................................................................15
R
G
raster data
send ...................................................................................... 13
raster image................................................................................. 5
raster transfer
gamma ........................................................................................15
green value................................................................................10
start ....................................................................................... 12
red value.................................................................................... 10
render algorithm....................................................................... 14
H
HP-GL/2 color mode...................................................................9
HP-GL/2 command....................................................................16
HP-GL/2 mode
S
enter......................................................................................13
short format................................................................................. 5
simple color mode ...................................................................... 4
I
U
IN command ..............................................................................16
initialize set instruction............................................................16
User-defined Pattern command.............................................. 15
L
W
long format ..................................................................................8
white value.................................................................................. 8
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 18
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 4
HP-GL/2
GRAPHICS
LANGUAGE
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CONTENTS
1. COMMAND LIST....................................................................................................................................4
2. INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................................................................6
3. TERMINOLOGY......................................................................................................................................7
3.1. Picture Frame....................................................................................................................................7
3.2. Anchor Point.......................................................................................................................................7
3.3. Graphics Window...............................................................................................................................7
3.4. Hard Clip Limits..................................................................................................................................7
3.5. Soft Clip Limits ...................................................................................................................................7
3.6. Graphics Units....................................................................................................................................7
3.7. User Units...........................................................................................................................................7
3.8. Current Units ......................................................................................................................................7
3.9. Pens ...................................................................................................................................................7
3.10. Absolute and Relative Plotting..........................................................................................................8
3.11. Fills ...................................................................................................................................................8
4. COMMAND SYNTAX.............................................................................................................................9
4.1. Mnemonic...........................................................................................................................................9
4.2. Parameters ........................................................................................................................................9
4.3. Separators..........................................................................................................................................9
4.4. Terminator..........................................................................................................................................9
5. THE HP-GL GRAPHICS WINDOW.................................................................................................. 10
5.1. Units .................................................................................................................................................10
5.2. The Scaling Points P1 and P2.........................................................................................................10
5.3. Scaling..............................................................................................................................................10
5.4. Transformation.................................................................................................................................10
6. PREPARING TO PRINT GRAPHIC IMAGES ................................................................................ 11
6.1. Setting Up the Graphics Window.....................................................................................................11
6.2. Using Existing Image Plots ..............................................................................................................11
6.3. Printing an Image .............................................................................................................................11
6.4. Entering HP-GL/2 Mode ...................................................................................................................11
6.5. Quitting HP-GL/2 Mode ....................................................................................................................11
7. COMMANDS........................................................................................................................................ 12
7.1. Initialize Commands.........................................................................................................................12
7.2. Plot Area and Unit Setting Instructions.............................................................................................14
7.3. Pen Control and Plot Instructions ....................................................................................................18
7.4. The polygon group............................................................................................................................25
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
7.5. Plot Function Instructions.................................................................................................................30
7.6. Character Plot Instructions ..............................................................................................................39
7.6.1. Introduction ................................................................................................................................... 40
8. INDEX.................................................................................................................................................... 54
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
1.
COMMAND LIST
DF
IN
IP
Default set instruction
Initialize set instruction
Input scaling point
Input relative scaling points
Scale
Window
Rotate coordinate system
Pen up
12
13
14
14
15
17
17
18
18
19
19
20
21
21
22
22
24
24
25
25
26
26
26
27
28
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
34
35
35
35
36
37
37
39
42
42
42
43
43
43
44
44
IR
SC
IW
RO
PU
PD
PA
PR
AA
AR
AT
RT
PE
BR
BZ
PM
EA
ER
EP
Pen down
Plot absolute
Relative coordinate pen move
Draw absolute arc
Draw relative arc
Absolute arc three point
Relative arc three point
Polyline encoded
Bezier relative
Bezier absolute
Polygon mode
Edge rectangle absolute
Edge rectangle relative
Edge polygon
EW
RA
RR
WG
FP
Edge wedge
Fill rectangle absolute
Fill rectangle relative
Fill wedge
Fill polygon
Anchor corner
Fill type
Line attribute
Line type selection
Pen width
Raster fill definition
Symbol mode
AC
FT
LA
LT
PW
RF
SM
SP
SV
TR
UL
WU
SD
AD
SS
SA
FI
FN
LB
DT
LO
Select pen
Screened vectors
Transparency mode
User-defined line type
Select unit for pen width
Define standard font
Define alternate font
Select standard font
Select alternate font
Select primary font
Select secondary font
Character plot
Define label terminator
Label origin
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
DI
Absolute direction
Relative direction
45
46
47
47
48
48
49
49
50
50
50
DR
DV
CP
CF
SI
SR
SL
SB
ES
TD
Define variable text path
Relative character movement
Character fill mode
Set absolute character size
Set relative character size
Character slant
Scalable or bitmap fonts
Extra space
Transparent data
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
2.
INTRODUCTION
Some of the HL series printers can be used in HP-GL/2 graphics mode to produce vector graphics output
using the commands of the HP-GL/2 graphics language or to print out existing HP-GL/2 format images.
HP-GL/2 is a part of the PCL emulation, which includes graphics command.
The Default plotting measurement unit in the HP-GL/2 graphics mode is 1/1016" ( 0.025 mm).
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.
TERMINOLOGY
3.1. Picture Frame
The printer frame is the rectangular area of the page on which graphic output can be printed. This is based
on the logical page defined for the selected paper size.
3.2. Anchor Point
The anchor point of the picture frame is the top left hand corner of the frame. This can be moved on the
page using PCL language page control commands.
3.3. Graphics Window
The graphics window is the rectangular area of the page on which you can generate graphic output using
HP-GL/2 commands. Initially the graphics window is the same as the picture frame but may be altered using
the HP-GL/2 IW command.
3.4. Hard Clip Limits
Hard clip limits are the physical restrictions which define where printed output can appear on a page.
3.5. Soft Clip Limits
Soft clip limits are the user-defined restrictions which define where printed output can appear on a page.
3.6. Graphics Units
The initial coordinate system employs units of 1/1016" in both the x- and y-axes.
3.7. User Units
The HP-GL/2 graphics language uses a coordinate system. You can impose your own x- and y-scale units
on this system using the SC command.
3.8. Current Units
The units in use at a given time are called the current units. Current units are either user units or graphics
units, depending on whether scaling has been turned on or not. The SC command is used to turn scaling
on, that is, to make user units the current units.
3.9. Pens
By convention, certain HP-GL/2 graphics language commands are thought of as using a pen, which can be
either up or down. To produce plotted output the pen must be down. To move to a location on the page
without producing output the pen must be in the up position. Some HP-GL/2 commands require you to
specify the pen position before you use them, others have implied pen positions built into them, so that
you do not need to specify "Pen up" or "Pen down".
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.10. Absolute and Relative Plotting
Drawing commands are of two distinct types: absolute commands, in which the coordinates specified are
the absolute user or graphics coordinates and relative commands, whose coordinates are relative to the
coordinate position at which the previous graphics command terminated.
3.11. Fills
You can fill in the shapes you have drawn with the plotting commands by using the fill commands.
number of different shading options are available.
A
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.
COMMAND SYNTAX
An HP-GL and HP-GL/2 command can consist of up to four items: a mnemonic, a parameter field, a
separator and a terminator.
4.1. Mnemonic
The two-letter mnemonic is the name of the command and should help remind you of its function.
4.2. Parameters
Some commands have parameters following the instruction mnemonic. Multiple parameters must have
separators between them. Parameters are shown in italics. Optional parameters are surrounded by square
brackets. Parameters that can be repeated are followed by "...".
·
Integer - integers are allowed in the range -230 and 230 - 1. Real numbers specified for a parameter that should
be an integer are rounded to the nearest integer.
·
Clamped integer - integers are allowed in the range -32768 and 32767. Parameters outside this range are
converted (clamped) to the nearest integer within the range, for example 40,000 will be clamped to 32767.
Non-integers are converted to the nearest integer.
30
30
·
·
Real number - real numbers whose integer part is in the range -2 to 2 - 1. Accuracy to at least 6
significant digits is guaranteed. If a number outside the range is specified the entire command is ignored.
The decimal point can be omitted when the number has no fractional part.
Clamped real number - real numbers whose integer part is in the range -32768 to 32767. Parameters outside
this range are converted (clamped) to the nearest real number within the range. The decimal point can be
omitted when the number has no fractional part.
Text parameters are referred to as labels and can consist of any sequence of characters.
4.3. Separators
If an HP-GL/2 instruction accepts more than one parameter, you must put spaces or a comma between the
parameters to separate them.
4.4. Terminator
Most commands are terminated implicitly by the first letter of the next instruction mnemonic. A semi-colon
may be used to explicitly terminate a command. However, the final command issued before quitting HP-
GL/2 mode must be terminated with a semi-colon. Since a terminator is almost always optional it is shown
surrounded by square brackets.
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.
THE HP-GL GRAPHICS WINDOW
5.1. Units
When you first enter graphics mode, the prevailing coordinate system has its origin in the bottom left hand
corner of the graphics window and has x- and y-units of 1/1016". Using the SC command you can divide the
axes into more convenient units. The size of the graphics window remains unaltered.
5.2. The Scaling Points P1 and P2
Many instructions use two reference scaling points, P1 and P2. Initially these are in the bottom left and top
right hand corners of the graphics window respectively. You can alter the position of these points relative to
the graphics window, or relative to one another, by using the IP or IR commands.
5.3. Scaling
You can easily scale images up or down by increasing or decreasing the distance between P1 and P2. You
can do this both with existing images that are to be imported and with images that are generated by a string of
HP-GL and HP-GL/2 commands, identical commands can be used to create the same image in different sizes.
5.4. Transformation
You can transform images horizontally or vertically by changing the relative positions of P1 and P2. You can
do this both with existing images that are to be imported and with images that are generated by a string of HP-
GL/2 commands.
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.
PREPARING TO PRINT GRAPHIC IMAGES
6.1. Setting Up the Graphics Window
Before entering HP-GL/2 mode you will probably want to set the dimensions and position of the PCL picture
frame and hence the graphics window. (Remember that when you enter HP-GL/2 mode they are initially the
same). To do this you will need to send some preparatory PCL commands while in LaserJet mode. Use the
Esc*c0T command to position the picture frame and the Esc*c#X and Esc*c#Y commands to determine it's
horizontal and vertical dimensions respectively. These commands are described fully in the sub-section
Vector Graphics in the LaserJet section of this manual. ( Section 2 )
If you do not specify a position and dimensions for the picture frame, the default picture frame is used. This
is described in the sub-section ‘The Page in LaserJet mode’ section of this manual.
6.2. Using Existing Image Plots
If you are importing an existing HP-GL/2 plot you can easily determine the size and position on the page of the
resulting printed graphic. Images are automatically scaled and fitted to the picture frame ( the HP-GL/2
graphics window ) in either of the following two cases.
1)
If you use the Esc*c#K and Esc*c#L PCL commands to specify the width and height of the original plot
before entering HP-GL/2 mode. These commands are explained in the sub-section ‘Vector Graphics in
LaserJet mode’ section of this manual. Only use these commands if you are importing an existing
plot.
2)
If the imported image code is page-size independent.
An image is page-size independent if it's HP-GL/2 code satisfies the following conditions.
·
·
User units are used exclusively, that is, an SC command is used before any drawing commands
are issued. Note in particular that if the graphics window is changed from the default using the IW
command, it must be specified in user units.
No absolute units are used or implied, that is, drawing commands use relative movement only and
character size, pattern length and pen width are always specified as relative measurements.
Commands like IP and PA, which imply the use of absolute units even if none are explicitly supplied,
should not be used at all.
If you import an image without fulfilling these two criteria, that is, the image is not page size independent
and you do not specify its horizontal and vertical plot sizes, the plot will be drawn actual size. Any part of
the plot that falls outside the effective window will not appear on the printed page.
6.3. Printing an Image
When you have carried out any necessary preliminary steps that your particular application requires, as
described in the preceding sections, enter HP-GL/2 mode using the Esc%#B command and send the
sequence of HP-GL/2 commands to generate the image.
6.4. Entering HP-GL/2 Mode
To enter graphics mode from PCL printer control language use the Esc%#B command. Set # to 0 if you want
the pen to start from the previous HP-GL/2 pen position. Set # to 1 if you want to the pen to start from the
current PCL cursor position. You must specify either one setting or the other.
6.5. Quitting HP-GL/2 Mode
To quit graphics mode use the Esc%#A command. Set # to 0 if you want to place the cursor at the previous
PCL cursor position. This is the default setting. Set # to 1 if you want to place the cursor at the current HP-
GL/2 pen position.
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
7.
COMMANDS
7.1. Initialize Commands
DF - Default set instruction
DF[;]
·
Returns the graphics mode to default conditions. The following are the default settings.
Function
Equivalent
Instruction
PA;
Condition
Plot mode
Absolute plotting
Absolute direction
Line type
DI 1,0;
LT;
Horizontal
Solid line
Line pattern length
Anchor corner
Line Attributes
User-Defined line type
Window
Symbol mode
Character Fill Mode
Character set
Scalable or Bitmap
Fonts
LT;
AC;
LA;
UL;
IW;
SM;
CF ;
SS;
4% of distance from P1 to P2
Lower left corner of picture frame
Butt cap, mitered joints, miter limit = 5
All line types set to default
Set at limits of printable area according to paper size
Off
Solid, Fill, no edging
Standard character set selected
Scalable font only
SB 0;
Character slant
Scaling
SL 0;
SC ;
0 degrees
Off
Label terminator
Raster fill
Fill type
DT chr$(3)
RF;
chr$(3), non-printing
Solid black
solid fill
FT;
Transparency mode
Screened vectors
Polygon mode
Standard font
Alternate font
Character size
transformation
Label origin
TR1;
SV;
PM0PM2;
SD;
Transparency mode on
No screening
Polygon buffer empty
Stick font
Stick font
Off
AD;
SI;
LO1;
DV;
ES;
Current pen location
Left to right with normal line feed
No extra space
Text path
Extra space
Transparent data
TD;
Normal printing mode
NOTE:
The location of the scaling points(P1, P2) remains constant.
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
IN - Initialize set instruction
IN[;]
·
Returns the graphics mode to initial conditions;
Function
Equivalent
Instruction
PA;
DR 1,0;
LT;
Condition
Plot mode
Relative character direction
Line type
Absolute plotting
Horizontal
Solid line
Line pattern length
Window
LT;
IW;
4% of distance from P1 to P2
Set at limits of printable area according to
paper size
Symbol mode
Anchor corner
Line attributes
User-defined line type
Pen
SM;
AC;
LA;
UL;
SP;
PA0,0;
SS;
SI;
SB0;
SL 0;
CF;
Off
Lower left corner of picture frame
Butt caps, mitered joins, miter limit = 5
All line types set to default
Select white pen
HP-GL/2 origin
Standard character set selected
Off
Scalable only
Pen position
Character set
Character size transformation
Scalable or bitmap fonts
Character slant
Character fill
0 degrees
Solid fill
Scaling
SC ;
Off
Label terminator
Raster fill
DT chr$(3)
RF;
chr$(3)
Solid black
Fill type
FT;
TR1;
SV;
Bi-directional fill, type 1
Transparency mode on
No screening
Polygon buffer empty
Stick font
Stick font
Pen up
Metric
Set at 0.35 mm
Transparency mode
Screened vectors
Polygon mode
Standard font
Alternate font
Pen condition
Pen width type
Pen width
PM0PM2;
SD;
AD;
PU;
WU;
PW;
LO1;
DV;
Label origin
Text path
Rotation
Current pen location
Left to right with normal line feed
Set at 0 degrees
RO;
Extra space
ES;
No extra space
Transparent data
Scaling points
TD;
IP;
Normal printing mode
Initialized according to paper size
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
7.2. Plot Area and Unit Setting Instructions
Instruction
Function
IP
Scaling point
IR
Input relative scaling points
Scale
SC
IW
RO
Input window
Rotate coordinate system
IP - Input scaling point
IP [ P1X, P1Y [,P2X, P2Y]] [;]
P1X ; X coordinate of P1
P2X ; X coordinate of P2
P1Y ; Y coordinate of P1
P2Y ; Y coordinate of P2
·
·
·
·
The coordinates used are absolute values in graphics units.
Set the location of the scaling points(P1,P2).
Coordinate values for P1X,P1Y, P2X and P2Y are given as integer numbers.
You can set P1 and P2 to be anywhere that the range of allowable coordinates permits. However, only
parts of resulting images that lie within the effective window will be printed.
·
·
·
The default location of P1 is the lower left corner and P2 is the upper right corner of the PCL picture frame.
Using this instruction without a parameter field initializes the scaling points(P1,P2) to the default location.
P2X and P2Y may be omitted. If P2X and P2Y are omitted, P2 is set automatically so as not to alter the
distance between P1 and P2.
·
·
If P2x and P2y are omitted P2 is set to be in the same position relative to P1 that it was before the command
was invoked.
The IP command remains in effect until another IP command, an IR command or an IN command is used.
IR - Input relative scaling points
IR [ P1x, P1y [, P2x, P2y]][;]
P1x ; x-coordinate of P1
P2x ; x-coordinate of P2
P1y ; y-coordinate of P1
P2y ; y-coordinate of P2
·
The coordinate values are percentages relative to the bottom left and top right hand corners of the picture
frame.
·
·
Coordinate values for P1x, P1y, P2x, and P2y are treated as clamped real numbers.
Using this instruction without parameters sets the scaling points (P1, P2) to their initial positions, the bottom
left and top right hand corners of the picture frame.
·
·
·
If P2x and P2y are omitted P2 is set to be in the same position relative to P1 that it was before the command
was invoked.
You can set P1 and P2 to be anywhere that the range of allowable coordinates permits. However, only
parts of resulting images that lie within the effective window will be printed.
The IR command remains in effect until another IR command, and IP command or an IN command is used.
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
SC - Scale
<HP-GL/2>
SC [ Xmin, Xmax, Ymin, Ymax [, type ]] [;] (Type = 0)
SC [ Xmin, Xmax, Ymin, Ymax , type [ left, bottom]] [;] (Type =1)
SC [ Xmin, X factor, Y
Y
[, type ]] [;] (Type = 2)
factor
min
Xmin ; X coordinate of P1
Ymin ; Y coordinate of P1
Type ; type of scaling
Xmax ; X coordinate of P2
Ymax ; Y coordinate of P2
Left ; percentage of unused space to be left to the left of the scaling area
bottom ; percentage of unused space to be left below the scaling area
Xfactor ; number of graphics units per user unit on the x-axis.
Yfactor ; number of graphics units per user unit on the y-axis.
·
·
This command turns scaling on and establishes a user unit coordinate system. The coordinate system is
specified relative to the points P1 and P2. The origin need not necessarily be at P1. Three different types
of scaling are available.
The technical terms, user unit and graphics unit, as used in this manual are defined as follows:
User unit
: the unit of the coordinates set by the SC instruction.
Graphics unit
: the unit(1/1016 of an inch) of the coordinates not set by the SC
instruction.
All coordinates are in user units.
Coordinate values for Xmin, Xmax, Ymin, and Ymax are given as real numbers.
·
·
·
Xmin, Ymin, Xmax and Ymax specify the range of the X- and Y-axes.
and Ymax should be P2.
Xmin and Ymin value should be P1 and Xmax
·
·
·
Xmin must be different from Xmax, and Ymin must be different from Ymax.
Using this instruction without a parameter field turns the scaling off.
Type can be 0, 1 or 2, which select scaling types known as anisotropic, isotropic and point factor scaling
respectively.
·
Type 0 scaling (anisotropic scaling, the default) allows you to specify different sized x-axis and y-axis units.
Hence the area specified by Xmin, Xmax, Ymin, and Ymax will occupy the entire area defined by P1 and P2.
P2 (7,6)
P1 (0,0)
·
·
left and bottom settings have no effect in type 0 scaling.
Type 1 scaling (isotropic scaling) forces x-axis and y-axis units to be the same size. As a result the area
specified by Xmin, Xmax, Ymin, and Ymax (the isotropic area) may not fit exactly into the rectangular area
defined by P1 and P2.
(6,7)
P2
(0,0)
P1
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
·
·
With type 1 scaling you can specify the percentage of unused space that is to lie below, or to the left of,
the isotropic area.
left specifies the percentage of unused space you want to lie to the left of the isotropic area and can be from 0
to 100. If you do not specify the value for left, it is automatically set to the default value = 50%.
bottom specifies the percentage of unused space you want to lie below the isotropic area and can be from 0 to
100. If you do not specify the value for bottom, it is automatically set to the default value = 50%.
P2
P2
(10,10)
(10,10)
(0,10)
Extra space
Extra space
P1(0,0)
P1
SC0,20,0,10,1,100,100
SC 0,10,0,10,1,0,0
(10,10)
P2
P2
Extra space
Extra space
(20,10)
(10,0)
P1
P1(0,0)
SC 0,20,0,10,1,0,0
SC 0,10,0,10,1,100,100
·
·
·
You must either specify both left and bottom, or specify neither. However, the printer can only use one of
these two parameters at a time, depending where the extra space is on a page. \
If you do not specify a percentage for unused space to the left or at the bottom, the isotropic area is centred
in the rectangle defined by P1 and P2.
Type 2 scaling (point factor scaling) specifies the ratio of graphics units to user units and sets user units
coordinates for P1.
·
·
·
·
Xfactor specifies the number of graphics units that comprise a single user x-axis unit.
Yfactor specifies the number of graphics units that comprise a single user y-axis unit.
Valid values for Xfactor and Yfactor are real numbers.
An SC command remains in effect until another SC command is issued, until default settings are restored
with the DF command or until the printer is initialized with an IN command.
10 '-Scale-'
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;"
60 '-- Anisotropic scaling --
70 LPRINT "PA1500,6000;EA3500,8000;"
80 LPRINT "IP1500,6000,3500,8000;SC0,200,0,100,0;PA50,50;CI50;"
90 LPRINT "IN;PA1500,3000;EA3500,5000;"
100 LPRINT "IP1500,3000, 3500,5000;SC0,100,0,200,0;PA50,50;CI50;"
110 LPRINT"IN;PA1300,8200;DT#;LBAnisotropic scaling#";
120 '--Isotropic scaling--
130 'Left,Bottom= 0,0
140 LPRINT "PA4500,6000;EA6500,8000;"
150 LPRINT"IP4500,6000,6500,8000;SC0,200,0,100,1,0,0;PA50,50;CI50;"
160 'Left, Bottom = 100,100
170 LPRINT "IN;PA4500,3000;EA6500,5000;"
180 LPRINT"IP4500,3000,6500,5000;SC0,100,0,200,1,100,100;PA50,50;CI50;"
190 LPRINT "IN;PA4000,82;DT#;LBIsotrop00ic scaling#";
200 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0A";
210LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";
220 END
<Sample 21>
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 16
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
IW - Window
IW [ X , Y , X , Y ] [;]
1 1 2 2
X1-Window lower left X coordinate
X2-Window upper right X coordinate
Y -Window lower left Y coordinate
Y -Window upper right Y coordinate
2
1
·
·
·
·
This instruction sets the window inside which drawing can be performed (the soft clip limits).
Coordinates are specified in current units.
Using this instruction with no parameters sets the window to be the same as the picture frame.
You can set the corners of the window to lie outside the picture frame. However, only the portion of the
image which lies within both the picture frame and the window will appear on the page.
If scaling is turned on with the SC command before the window is defined with the IW command, you can
move the window on the physical page by specifying different locations for P1 and P2 with the IP and IR
commands. The user unit coordinates that bound the window remain the same.
·
·
·
If an SC command is used after the IW window definition, the window is fixed on the physical page and
does not move when subsequent IP and IR commands are invoked.
An IW command remains in effect until another IW command is issued, until default settings are restored
with the DF command or until the printer is initialized with an IN command.
10 '--Input Window--
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "SI0.2,0.35,PA2000,3200;;LBTHIS IS AN EXAMPLE OF IW";CHR$(3)
70 LPRINT "IW3000,1300,4500,3700;PD2000,1700;LBTHIS IS AN EXAMPLE OF
IW";CHR$(3)
80 LPRINT "PU3000,1300;PD4500,1300,4500,3700;PD3000,3700,3000,1300;PU;"
90 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0A";
100 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";
110 END
<Sample 22>
RO - Rotate coordinate system
RO [q][;]
q : Angle in degrees through which the coordinate system is rotated.
·
·
This instruction is used to rotate the graphics coordinate system anti-clockwise.
Using this instruction with no parameter sets the rotation of the coordinate system to 0 degrees (default
value).
·
·
·
The pen position does not change.
P1 and P2 rotate with the coordinate system and retain the same coordinate values.
To relocate P1 and P2 at the lower left and upper right hand corners of the picture frame, use the IP or IR
commands.
·
·
·
If you have previously used an IW command, the window is also rotated. Any part of the window that
falls outside the hard clip limits will be clipped.
The command remains in effect until another RO command is used or until the printer is initialized with the IN
instruction.
Valid values of q are 0, 90, 180 or 270.
10 '--Rotate Coordinate System--
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 FOR I = 0 TO 270 STEP 90
70 LPRINT "RO"; I; "PA1000,2000;PD3000,2000,2000,3000,1000,2000;PU;"
80 LPRINT "LB RO ="; I; CHR$(3)
90 LPRINT "PA600,1500;LBRotate Coordinate System";CHR$(3)
100 NEXT I
110 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0A";
120 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";
130 END
<Sample 23>
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
7.3. Pen Control and Plot Instructions
Instruction
PU
Function
Pen Up
PD
Pen Down
PA
Plot Absolute
PR
Relative Coordinate Pen Move
Absolute Arc Plot
Relative Arc Plot
Absolute Three Point Arc
Relative Three Point Arc
Polyline Encoded
Circle
AA
AR
AT
RT
PE
CI
BR
Bezier Relative
Bezier Absolute
BZ
PU - Pen up
PU [ X,Y [,...]] [;]
X ; X coordinate of the cursor movement destination
Y ; Y coordinate of the cursor movement destination
·
·
X and Y are either relative or absolute, depending on whether a PA or a PR was the last plot command
executed. The absolute coordinates are set as default.
You can specify as many coordinate pairs as you wish. The cursor moves to each point in turn without
drawing.
·
·
·
·
·
Using this instruction without a parameter field raises the pen without changing the cursor position.
Coordinates are specified in the currently selected unit.
In symbol mode PU draws the specified symbol at each point in the parameter list.
In polygon mode the specified coordinate pairs are placed in the polygon buffer.
If an odd number of coordinates are specified, the final (unpaired) coordinate is ignored.
PD - Pen down
PD [ X, Y [,...]] [;]
X ; X coordinate of the cursor movement destination
Y ; Y coordinate of the cursor movement destination
·
·
X and Y are either relative or absolute, depending on whether a PA or a PR was the last plot command
executed. The absolute coordinates are the default setting.
You can specify as many coordinate pairs as you wish. The cursor moves to each point in turn, drawing
lines on the page.
·
·
·
·
·
Using this instruction without a parameter lowers the pen without changing the cursor position.
Coordinates are specified in the currently selected unit.
In symbol mode PD draws the specified symbol at each defined point on the x- and y-axis.
In polygon mode the specified coordinate pairs are placed in the polygon buffer.
If an odd number of coordinates are specified, the final (unpaired) coordinate is ignored.
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 18
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
PA - Plot absolute
PA [ X, Y [,...]] [;]
X ; X coordinate of the cursor movement destination
Y ; Y coordinate of the cursor movement destination
·
·
·
Coordinates are absolute values in user or current units.
Whether used with or without parameters the command establishes absolute plotting as the plotting mode.
The command moves the cursor to the specified coordinates, drawing straight lines, only when the pen is
down.
·
·
·
In symbol mode PA draws the specified symbol at each point in the parameter list.
In polygon mode the specified coordinate pairs are placed in the polygon buffer.
If an odd number of coordinates are specified, the final (unpaired) coordinate is ignored.
10 ' -- Plot Absolute --
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "PA2000,6000;PD0,6000,2000,7500,2000,6000;PU2500,6000;";
70 LPRINT "PAPD4500,6000,2500,7500,2500,6000;PU10365,500;";
80 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0A";
90 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";
100 END
<Sample 24>
PR - Relative coordinate pen move
PR [X, Y [,...]] [;]
X ; X coordinate of the cursor movement destination
Y ; Y coordinate of the cursor movement destination
·
·
·
Coordinates used are relative values in current units.
Whether used with or without parameters the command establishes relative plotting as the plotting mode.
The command moves the cursor to the specified coordinates, drawing straight lines, only when the pen is
down.
·
You can specify any number of coordinated pairs and plotting is performed in the order the coordinates are
specified.
·
·
·
In symbol mode PR draws the specified symbol at each point in the parameter list.
In polygon mode the specified coordinate pairs are placed in the polygon buffer.
If an odd number of coordinates are specified, the final (unpaired) coordinate is ignored.
10 ' - Plot Relative -
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
20 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
40 LPRINT "IN;SP1;"
50 LPRINT "PA5000,4500,;PDPR-2000,0,2000,2000,0,-2000;PU500,0;"
60 LPRINT "PD2000,0,-2000,2000,0,-2000;PU;"
70 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
80 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
90 END
<Sample 25>
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
AA - Draw absolute arc
AA [ X, Y, qc [, qd ]] [;]
X ; Arc centre X coordinate
Y ; Arc centre Y coordinate
qc ; Arc angle in degrees
qd ; Chord angle in degrees
·
·
Coordinates are absolute coordinates in current units.
Starting from the current position, this command plots an arc centred on the absolute coordinates X, Y having
the specified arc angle and chord angle, with the radius being the distance between the current position and
the point X,Y.
·
After execution of the command the cursor position is at the opposite end of the arc from the point at which
plotting started.
·
·
Plotting takes place only when the pen is down.
If the command is invoked with the pen up, plotting is not performed, but the cursor position moves to
what would have been the plot end point.
qc = Arc Angle
qd = Chord Angle
(X,Y)
·
·
·
·
The value for qc is a clamped real number.
When qc is positive, plotting is counterclockwise.
When qc is negative, plotting is clockwise.
The value for qd is a clamped real number in the range 0.5° to 180°. The default value is 5°.
10 '-- Draw Absolute Arc --
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;IP1000,1000,6000,6000;"
60 LPRINT "SC0,100,0,100;"
70 LPRINT "PA0,30;"
80 LPRINT "PD;PA0,45;AA0,50,180;PA0,70;"
90 LPRINT "AA0,100,900;PA100,55;AA100,50,180;PA100,30;"
100 LPRINT "AA100,100,90;PA45,100;AA50,100,180;PA80,100;"
110 LPRINT "AA100,0,90;PA55,0;AA50,0,180;PA30,0;AA0,0,90;"
120 LPRINT "PU;PA50,50,CI20;"
130 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
140 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
150 END
<Sample 26>
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 20
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
AR - Draw relative arc
AR X, Y, qc(, qd)[;]
X ; Arc centre X coordinate
qc ; Arc angle in degrees
Y ; Arc centre Y coordinate
qd ; Chord angle in degrees
·
·
Coordinates are relative values in current units.
Starting from the current cursor position the command plots an arc whose centre is at the relative coordinate
position (X,Y) and which has the specified arc and chord angles. The radius of the arc is the distance
between the current position and the point (X,Y).
·
After execution of the command the cursor position is at the opposite end of the arc from the point at which
plotting started.
·
·
Plotting takes place only when the pen is down.
If the command is invoked with the pen up, plotting is not performed, but the cursor position moves to
what would have been the plot end point.
·
·
·
·
The value for qc is a clamped real number.
When qc is positive, plotting is counterclockwise.
When qc is negative, plotting is clockwise.
The value for qd is a clamped real number in the range 0.5° to 180°. The default value is 5°.
10 '--Draw Relative Arc --
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;IP1000,1000,6000,6000;"
60 LPRINT "SC-100,100,-100,100;"
70 LPRINT
"PA-100,70;PD;PR30,0;AR0,-70,-90,15;AR70,0,90;PR60,0;PU;"
80 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
90 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
100 END
<Sample 27>
AT - Absolute arc three point
AT X1, Y1, X2, Y2 [,qd] [;]
X1 ; x-coordinate of intermediate point
X2 ; x-coordinate of end point
Y ; y-coordinate of intermediate point
y2 ; y-coordinate of end point
2
qd ; the chord angle used to draw the arc
·
·
All coordinates are absolute and in current units.
The command draws an arc from the current position, through the specified intermediate position and
finishing at the specified end position.
·
·
·
·
·
After completion of the command the current cursor position is at the end of the arc.
An arc can be drawn clockwise or anti-clockwise.
If the current scaling mode is not isotropic, the arc may be elliptical rather than circular.
The chord angle must be in the range 0.5° to 180°.
The default chord angle is 5°.
10 '--Absolute Arc Three Point--
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "PA1000,100;PD2500,100;"
70 LPRINT "PU650,1150;PD1000,1150;"
80 LPRINT "PU650,450;PD1000,450;"
90 LPRINT "PU1000,100;PD1000,1500,2500,1500;"
100 LPRINT "AT3200,800,2500,1500;"
110 LPRINT "PU3200,900;PD;"
120 LPRINT "AT3300,800,3200,700;"
130 LPRINT "PU3300,800;PD3500,800;"
140 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0A";
150 LPRINT CHR&(27);"E";
160 END
<Sample 28>
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
RT - Relative arc three point
RT X1, Y1, X2, Y2 [,qd] [;]
X1 ; x-coordinate of intermediate point
Y ; y-coordinate of intermediate point
2
X2 ; x-coordinate of end point
y2 ; y-coordinate of end point
qd ; the chord angle used to draw the arc
·
·
The specified coordinates of the two points are relative to the current pen position.
The command draws an arc from the current position, through the specified intermediate position and
finishing at the specified end position.
·
·
·
·
·
After completion of the command the current cursor position is at the end of the arc.
An arc can be drawn clockwise or anti-clockwise.
If the current scaling mode is not isotropic, the arc may be elliptical rather than circular.
The chord angle must be in the range 0.5° to 180°.
The default chord angle is 5°.
10 '--Relative Arc Three Point--
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "&0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "PA1000,100;PR;PD1500,0;"
70 LPRINT "PU-1850,1050;PD350,0;"
80 LPRINT "PU-350,-700;PD350;0;"
90 LPRINT "PU0,-350;PD0,1500,1500,0;"
100 LPRINT "RT800,-750,0,-1500;"
110 LPRINT "PU700,850;PD;"
120 LPRINT "RT100,-100,0,-200;"
130 LPRINT "PU100,100;PD200,0;"
140 LPRINT CHR&(27); "%0A";
150 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
160 END
<Sample 29>
PE - Polyline encoded
PE [ [flag] [value] | XiYi ... [flag] [value] | XiYi ] ];
flag ; a command or mode that applies to the data that follows
value; parameter data for the preceding flag
X
Y
; X-coordinate of a cursor movement destination
; Y-coordinate of a cursor movement destination
·
·
This command allows you to combine a sequence of PA, PR, PU, PD and SP commands into a coded format.
This reduces file size and transmission time.
Do not use commas within the PE command. Parameters either have their own terminators or do not require
them.
·
·
·
The PE command must be terminated with a semi-colon.
The command draws lines using the current line type and current units.
The command draws lines to all coordinate points specified unless you precede the coordinate pair with a pen
up flag.
·
·
·
·
On completion of the command, the pen is down unless the final move was made with the pen up.
All coordinate points are interpreted as relative unless preceded by the absolute flag (=).
On completion of the command, the previous plotting mode is restored.
Flags are not encoded. They are sent as ASCII characters. The MSB of the code is ignored, thus 60 and
188 can both represent <, the flag for pen up.
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 22
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
The following flags are used:
':' - Select pen. The number which follows is the required pen number. A PE command that does not
include a select pen command uses the currently selected pen.
'<' - Pen up. The pen is raised and moved to the specified coordinate pair. All coordinate pair values
not preceded by this flag are automatically interpreted as pen down plotting commands.
'>' - Fractional data. The value following the flag specifies the number of fractional binary bits in the
coordinate data.
'=' - Absolute plotting mode. The pair of coordinates which follow this flag are absolute coordinates.
'7' -
7 bit mode. All subsequent coordinate values within this PE command are to be interpreted as 7-bit
values, that is, encoded in base 32.
·
·
If you use the ':' flag in polygon mode it is ignored as the SP command has no effect in this mode.
Values and coordinates are encoded in base 64 or base 32. Values determine the setting of the immediately
preceding flag. Legal values and coordinates are as follows:
Pen number -
0 (white) or 1(black)
Number of fractional binary bits -
x- and y-coordinates -
-26 to 26. The default is 0.
30
30
(-2 ) to 2 - 1 current units. If the pen position is moved
outside this range, subsequent plotting commands are ignored
until an absolute coordinate pair within the allowable range is
specified.
·
·
Flag and coordinate values are encoded as either base 64 or base 32 numbers and then transmitted as ASCII
character codes. Base 64 is the default. Use Base 64 if your computer can send data without a parity bit.
Use base 32 if your system requires a parity bit.
To encode an integer proceed as follows. If the number is negative, take the absolute value, multiply by
2 and add 1. Hence -x : = 2x+1. If the number is positive simply multiply by 2. Hence x :=2x. Convert
the new number into base 64 or base 32 according to your system and encode each base 64 or base 32 digit
as the corresponding ASCII character.
·
·
To encode a real number proceed as follows. Multiply the number of decimal places in your coordinate's
data by 3.33 and round the result up to the next highest integer (for example round 6.66 up to 7). This gives
the number of binary bits needed to represent the number's fractional part - the value that you will supply with
the '>' flag. Call this number n. Now multiply the number you are encoding by 2n. Round this number to
the nearest integer and then follow the procedure described above for encoding an integer.
Transmit each number to the printer least significant digits first. Terminate each number with the most
significant digit. This must be specified from a different ASCII range from the preceding digits in the
number. In base 64, non-terminating digits are represented by the numbers 63-126 and terminating digits by
the numbers 191-254. In base 32, non-terminating digits are represented by the numbers 63-94 and
terminating digits by the numbers 95-126. Hence if using a base 32 number whose least significant digit is
14, and whose most significant digit is 5, encode 14 as 77 (63+14) and 5 as 100 (95+5).
Non-terminator
63-126
63-94
Terminator
191-254
95-126
Base 64
Base 32
·
·
In symbol mode the PE command draws the specified symbol at each specified point.
In polygon mode the points specified within the PE command are not plotted. Instead they are stored in the
polygon buffer and used when a FP (Fill Polygon) or EP (Edge Polygon) command is used.
·
The PE command with no parameters simply updates the carriage return point.
CI - Circle plot
CI r(, qd)[;]
r ; Radius of circle ( in current units )
qd ; Chord angle ( in degrees )
·
·
·
·
·
The command plots a circle with the current position as the centre, with a radius r and chord angle qd.
After plotting, the cursor returns to the centre of the circle.
Plotting takes place irrespective of whether the pen is up or down.
Valid values for r are specified in the current unit.
Valid values for qd are clamped real numbers in the range 0.5° to 180°. The default value is 5°.
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
To avoid placing an unwanted dot at the centre of the circle precede the CI command with a PU command.
10 '-- Circle --
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "SC-75,75,-75,75,1;"
70 LPRINT "PA0,0;LT;CI5;LT0;CI-12;"
80 LPRINT "LT1;CI19;LT2;CI-26;"
90 LPRINT "LT3;CI33;LT4;CI-40;"
100 LPRINT "LT5;CI47;LT6;CI54;"
110 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0A";
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
130 END
<Sample 30>
BR - Bezier relative
BR [ X1, Y1, X2, Y2, X3, Y3 . . . [X1, Y1, X2, Y2, X3, Y3]] [;]
X1, X2, X3 ; X coordinate of the second (X1), third (X2), and forth (X3) control point
Y1, Y2, Y3 ; Y coordinate of the second (Y1), third (Y2), and forth (Y3) control point
·
·
Coordinates are relative values in current units.
Using the current pen position as the starting point, the bezier curve is geometrically drawn referring to the
other three points. The start point of the curve is at (X0,Y0), and the curve is tangential to the line from (X0,
Y0) to (X1, Y1) at that point, and it leaves the point in that direction. The end point of the curve is at
(X3,Y3), and the curve is tangential to the line from (X2,Y2) to (X3,Y3).
·
·
After execution of this command the cursor position is at the end of the bezier curve.
When drawing a bezier curve is repeated, the last (fourth) control point of the first curve is used as the first
control point for the second curve.
·
·
Plotting takes place only when the pen is down.
If the command is invoked with the pen up, plotting is not performed, but the cursor position moves to
what would have been the plot end point.
·
·
If the curve extends to the outside of the soft/hard clip limit, it is clipped.
This command can only be used in polygon mode.
BZ - Bezier absolute
BZ [ X1, Y1, X2, Y2, X3, Y3 . . . [X1, Y1, X2, Y2, X3, Y3]] [;]
X1, X2, X3 ; X coordinate of the second (X1), third (X2), and forth (X3) control point
Y1, Y2, Y3 ; Y coordinate of the second (Y1), third (Y2), and forth (Y3) control point
·
·
Coordinates are absolute values in current units.
Using the current pen position as the starting point, the bezier curve is geometrically drawn referring to the
other three points. The start point of the curve is at (X0,Y0), and the curve is tangential to the line from (X0,
Y0) to (X1, Y1) at that point, and it leaves the point in that direction. The end point of the curve is at
(X3,Y3), and the curve is tangential to the line from (X2,Y2) to (X3,Y3).
·
·
After execution of this command the cursor position is at the end of the bezier curve.
When drawing a bezier curve is repeated, the last (fourth) control point of the first curve is used as the first
control point of the second curve.
·
·
Plotting takes place only when the pen is down.
If the command is invoked with the pen up, plotting is not performed, but the cursor position moves to
what would have been the plot end point.
·
·
If the curve extends to the outside of the soft/hard clip limit, it is clipped.
This command can only be used in polygon mode.
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 24
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
7.4. The polygon group
Instruction
PM
Function
Polygon Mode
EA
Edge Absolute Rectangle
Edge Relative Rectangle
Edge Polygon
ER
EP
EW
Edge Wedge
RA
Fill Absolute Rectangle
Fill Relative Rectangle
Fill Wedge
RR
WG
FP
Fill Polygon
PM - Polygon mode
PM [ ms ] [;]
·
This command is used for entering and leaving polygon mode, the mode that allows you to access the
polygon buffer.
·
When in polygon mode you can use any of the vector group commands to define the vertices of a polygon.
The following commands can be used;
DF, IN, AA, AR, AT, BR, BZ, CI, PA, PD, PE, PR, PU, RT
·
·
The polygon you have defined is not printed until you exit polygon mode and fill or edge the polygon.
ms, the mode status, can have the value 0, 1 or 2. If ms = 0 the command empties the polygon buffer and
enters polygon mode. A value of 1 closes the current polygon and remains in polygon mode. All
commands sent following a PM1 before a PM2 or a further PM1 are used to build one sub-polygon. A value
of 2 closes the current polygon or sub-polygon and exits polygon mode.
·
Having exited polygon mode you can use the EP and FP commands to edge or fill the polygons you have
defined.
·
·
The EP command only draws between points defined when the pen was in the down position.
The FP command fills the area between the polygon vertices irrespective of whether the pen was up or down
when the polygon was defined.
·
·
·
·
The first point in the polygon buffer is the pen position when the PM0 command was invoked.
The next pen position specified after a PM1 command becomes the first vertex of the next sub-polygon.
When plotting a polygon the pen always moves to the first point in the up position.
Using the command with no parameters clears the polygon buffer and enters polygon mode. This is
equivalent to the PM0; command.
·
·
If a DF or IN command is invoked in the polygon mode, the printer quits polygon mode, clears the
polygon buffer and executes the subsequent command.
If an ESC E reset command is invoked while the printer is in polygon mode, the printer quits polygon
mode, clears the polygon buffer, exits HP-GL/2 and ejects the page.
EA - Edge rectangle absolute
EA X, Y[;]
X ; X coordinate of opposite corner for the rectangle
Y ; Y coordinate of opposite corner for the rectangle
·
·
·
·
X and Y coordinates are absolute coordinates in current units.
Plots the rectangle formed by the current position and the opposite corner specified by X and Y.
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin and pen up/down status remains as selected.
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
10 '-Edge Rectangle Absolute-
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "SC0,150,0,150,1;"
70 LPRINT "PA25;105;EA65;130;"
80 LPRINT "PA30;110;EA70,135;"
90 LPRINT "PA35;115;EA75;140;"
100 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
120 END
<sample 31>
ER - Edge rectangle relative
ER X, Y[;]
X ; X coordinate of opposite corner for the rectangle
Y ; Y coordinate of opposite corner for the rectangle
·
·
·
·
Coordinates are relative to the current position in current units.
Plots the rectangle formed by the current position and the opposite corner specified by X and Y.
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin.
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.
10 '-Edge Rectangle Relative -
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "SC0;150;0;150;1;"
70 LPRINT "PA25,105;ER40,25;"
80 LPRINT "PR 5, 5;ER40,25;"
90 LPRINT "PR 5, 5;ER40,25;"
100 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
120 END
<Sample 32>
EP - Edge polygon
EP [;]
·
·
·
·
·
This command plots the outline of the polygon currently stored in the polygon buffer.
The command only plots between points defined when the pen was down.
The command plots an outline irrespective of whether the pen is currently up or down.
The command does not affect the data in the polygon buffer.
On completion of the plot the cursor returns to the original position.
EW - Edge wedge
EW r,q1,qc(,qd)[;]
r ; Radius in current units
q1; Start point angle
qc ; Arc angle
qd ; Chord angle
·
Plots a wedge centred on the current position with radius r, start point angle q1, arc angle qc and chord angle
qd.
·
·
·
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin.
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.
You should use this command with the type "isotropic". Anisotropic type may make the wedge stretch.
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 26
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
·
r specifies the radius of the circle. A positive value for r places the 0° reference point onto the positive x-
axis and a negative value for r places the 0° reference point onto the negative x-axis.
The value for q1 is a clamped real number.
qc
q1
0° reference point
current
position
r
·
·
q1 specifies the wedge starting point relative to the 0 degree reference point.
When q1 is positive, the positive direction of the X axis relative to the current position is set at 0 degrees and
the start point is sought in the counterclockwise direction. The opposite occurs when q1 is negative: the
negative X axis is set at 0 degrees and the start point is sought by going clockwise.
·
·
·
·
·
qc specifies the angle of the wedge in degrees.
The value for qc is a clamped real number.
Plotting proceeds counterclockwise when qc is positive and clockwise when negative.
The value for qd must be an integer from -32,768 to +32,767.
When qd is not specified, the chord angle is the default value ( 5 degrees )
10 '- Edge Wedge -
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;"
60 LPRINT "PA2000,5000;"
70 LPRINT "EW1250,90,180,5;"
80 LPRINT "EW1250,270,120;"
90 LPRINT "EW1250,30,60;"
100 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
120 END
<Sample 33>
RA - Fill rectangle absolute
RA X, Y[;]
X ; X coordinate of opposite corner for the rectangle
Y ; Y coordinate of opposite corner for the rectangle
·
·
·
·
X and Y coordinates are absolute coordinates in current units.
Fill the rectangle formed by the current position and the opposite corner specified by X and Y.
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin.
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.
10 ' - Fill Absolute Rectangle -
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA5000,4000;"
60 LPRINT "FT1;RA4250,3250;"
70 LPRINT "FT3,100;RA5750,3250;"
80 LPRINT "FT2;RA5750,4750;"
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 27
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
90 LPRINT "FT4,100,45;RA4250,4750;"
100 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
120 END
<Sample 34>
RR - Fill rectangle relative
RR X, Y[;]
X ; X coordinate of opposite corner for the rectangle
Y ; Y coordinate of opposite corner for the rectangle
·
·
·
·
Coordinates relative to the current position in current units.
Fill the rectangle formed by the current position and the opposite corner specified by X and Y.
After plotting the cursor returns to its point of origin.
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.
10 ' - Fill Relative Rectangle -
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA5000,4000;"
60 LPRINT "FT1;RR750,750;"
70 LPRINT "PR750,0;"
80 LPRINT "FT3,100;RR750,750;"
90 LPRINT "PR0,750;"
100 LPRINT "FT2;RR750,750;"
110 LPRINT "FT4,100,45;RR-750,750;"
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
130 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
140 END
<Sample 35>
WG - Fill wedge
WG r,q1,qc(,qd)[;]
r ; Radius in current units
q1 ; Start point angle
qc ; Arc angle
qd ; Chord angle
·
Fill in a wedge centred on the current position with radius r, start point angle q1, arc angle qc and chord angle
qd.
·
·
·
·
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin.
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.
You should use this command with the type "isotropic". Anisotropic type may make the wedge stretch.
r specifies the radius of circle. A positive value places the 0° reference point onto the positive x-
axis and the negative value places it onto the negative x-axis.
·
·
·
The value for q1 is a clamped real number.
q1 specifies the wedge starting point related to the 0° reference point.
When q1 is positive, the positive direction of the X axis relative to the current position is set at 0 degrees and
the start point is sought in the counterclockwise direction. The opposite occurs when q1 is negative: the
negative X axis is set at 0 degrees and the start point is sought by going clockwise.
·
·
·
·
·
qc specifies the angle of the wedge.
The value for qc is a clamped real number.
Plotting proceeds counterclockwise when qc is positive and clockwise when negative.
The value for qd is a clamped real number.
When qd is not specified, the chord angle is the default value ( 5 degrees ).
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 28
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
10 ' - Fill Wedge -
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP2;FT3,100;"
60 LPRINT "PA2000,5000;"
70 LPRINT "WG1250,90,180,5;"
80 LPRINT "SP3;EW1250,90,180,5;"
90 LPRINT "SP4;FT4,100,45;"
100 LPRINT "WG1250,270,120;"
110 LPRINT "SP3;EW1250,270,120;"
120 LPRINT "SP1;FT1;"
130 LPRINT "WG1250,30,60;"
140 LPRINT "SP3;EW1250,30,60;"
150 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
160 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
170 END
<Sample 36>
FP - Fill polygon
FP [;]
FP [ n ] [;]
n ; fill method
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
This command fills the polygon currently stored in the polygon buffer.
The command does not clear the buffer or alter the data at all.
The command fills between points defined when the pen was up or down.
If a polygon is composed of sub-polygons, the command fills alternate areas.
On completion of the plot the cursor returns to the original position.
The command performs a fill irrespective of whether the pen is currently up or down.
You can specify the fill method. There are two types of fill method.
0 specifies the even/odd fill method.
Places a point within the polygon and draws a straight line from it to the outside of polygon. If the cross
point of the straight line and polygon edges are an odd count, the polygon which includes the start point is
filled.
1 time
*
*
2 times
*
·
1 specifies Non-zero winding fill method.
10 '- Fill Polygon -
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "PA1500,1500;PM0;CI1000,60;PM1;"
70 LPRINT "CI500;PM1;PM2;"
80 LPRINT "LT4;FT3,50,45;"
90 LPRINT "FP;"
100 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
120 END
<Sample 37>
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 29
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
7.5. Plot Function Instructions
Instruction
AC
FT
Function
Anchor Corner
Fill Type
LA
Line Attribute
Line Type
LT
PW
RF
Pen Width
Raster Fill Definition
Symbol Mode
Select Pen
SM
SP
SV
Screened Vectors
Transparency Mode
User-defined Line Type
Select Unit for Pen Width
TR
UL
WU
AC - Anchor corner
AC [ X, Y ] [;]
X ; x-coordinate of starting point of fill pattern
Y ; y-coordinate of starting point of fill pattern
·
·
This command specifies the anchor corner which is the starting position of a fill pattern.
If no parameters are specified the lower left hand corner of the PCL picture frame, according to the current
coordinate system, becomes the anchor position. This is equivalent to AC0,0;
·
·
User units or graphics units may be used.
The value of the coordinates are real numbers in the range (-230) to 230 - 1.
10 '-Anchor Corner -
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "PA3000,3000;FT3,400,45;"
70 LPRINT "RR1000,1000;ER1000,1000;"
80 LPRINT "PR1000,0;FT4,400,45;"
90 LPRINT "RR1000,1000;ER1000,1000;"
100 LPRINT "PR1000,0;FT3,400,45;"
110 LPRINT "RR1000,1000,ER1000,1000;"
120 LPRINT "PA3000,1500;AC3000,1500;"
130 LPRINT "RR1000,1000;ER1000,1000;"
140 LPRINT "PA4000,1500;AC4000,1500;FT4,400,45;"
150 LPRINT "RR1000,1000;ER1000,1000;"
160 LPRINT "PA5000,1500;AC5000,1500;FT3,400,45;"
170 LPRINT "RR1000,1000;ER1000,1000;"
180 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
190 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
200 END
<Sample 38>
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 30
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
FT - Fill type
FT n(, d(, q))[;]
n ; Fill type
d ; option 1
q ; option 2
·
·
Sets the fill type, interval and angle when filling an area. This setting is effective for the commands FP, RA,
RR, WG and CF.
The value for n must be a clamped integer number
Fill type Description
Option 1
Option 2
1
2
Solid black (bi-directional fill)
Solid black (single directional fill)
hatching (parallel line)
cross-hatching
3
fill interval
fill angle
fill angle
4
fill interval
10
11
21
22
130
shading
shading level
raster-fill index
pattern type
pattern ID
HP-GL/2 user-defined
PCL cross-hatching
PCL user-defined
shading (one of sixty-four gray scales)
Shading level
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
option 1 for n=3 or 4 is the setting for the interval of the lines in the fill. This is specified in current units.
If d is omitted or 0, it is set to the default value which is 1% of the diagonal distance between P1 and P2.
Option 2 for n=3 and 4 is the setting of the angle for the lines in degrees.
If q is omitted, the fill angle already specified will be used.
The value of q is a clamped real number.
Option 1 for n=10 is the setting for the shading density. It is specified as a percentage from 0 to 100.
Option 2 for n=10 is ignored.
Option 1 for n=11 specifies the HP-GL/2 user-defined raster fill pattern. This uses the index number which is
defined by the RF command.
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
Option 2 for n=11 is ignored.
Option 1 for n=21 specifies the PCL cross-hatch patterns. There are 6 types of PCL cross-hatch patterns.
Option 2 for n=21 is ignored.
Option 1 for n=22, the PCL user-defined patterns defined by the ESC*c#W command with a unique ID code.
Option 2 for n=22 is ignored.
Option 1 for n=130, the 64 gray scale shading density. It is specified as a percentage from 0 to 100.
Option 2 for n=130 is ignored.
10 ' - Fill Type -
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "PA2000,2000;FT;PR2500,300;ER2500,300;"
70 LPRINT "PR0,300;FT3,80,30;RR2500.300;"
80 LPRINT "PR0,300;FT10,36;RR2500,300;ER2500,300;"
90 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
100 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
110 END
<Sample 39>
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 31
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
LA - Line attribute
LA [ l, v [ , l , v [ , l , v]]] [;]
l; line attribute
v : value
This command specifies the shape of line joins and line ends.
These settings are effective for the line widths thicker than 0.35 mm.
·
·
· lspecifies the line attribute for which you are setting a value.
·
There are three line attributes - line end type, line join type and miter limit, specified by line attribute
values of 1, 2 and 3 respectively.
·
·
·
·
v specifies the value of the particular attribute.
Line ends are either butt (1), square (2,), triangular (3) or round (4).
Line joins are either mitered (1), mitered/beveled (2), triangular (3), round (4), beveled (5), or have no join (6).
Miter limit is the ratio of miter length to line width. When the miter limit is exceeded, the join is clipped to
the miter limit.
·
·
The miter limit is specified as a clamped real number.
If no parameters are specified, the line attributes are set as follows: line ends are butt, line joins are mitered
and the miter limit is 5. This is equivalent to the command LA1, 1, 2, 1, 3, 5;
Line width
Miter length
Miter limit = Miter length / Line width
·
·
Labels are always drawn with rounded ends and joins.
An LA command remains in effect until another LA command is issued, until default settings are restored
with the DF command or until the printer is initialized with an IN command.
10 '-Line Attributes-
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "PA4000,3000;PW2;LA1,3;PD3500,2500,4000,2000;"
70 LPRINT "PU3500,200;LA2,2,3,20;PD3000,2500,3000,2300;"
80 LPRINT "PU2500,2300;LA1,4;PD3500,2300;"
90 LPRINT "PU2700,2100;PD3300,2100;"
100 LPRINT "PU2900,1900;PD3100,1900;"
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
130 END
<Sample 40>
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 32
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
LT - Line type selection
LT [, n [, p [,m ]]] [;]
n ; Line pattern number
p ; Line pattern length (percentage or millimeters of distance between P1 and P2)
m : mode
·
·
·
This command specifies the line pattern for use when drawing lines with the vector group commands.
n defines the line type to be used. n is either in the range -8 to 8 or is 99.
Values of n from 1 to 8 specify a line type (as defined with the UL command) and use a fixed pattern length.
Any residual part of the pattern not used on a particular drawing operation is stored and used at the start of
the next line drawn.
·
Values of n from -1 to -8 specify a line type (as defined with the UL command) and use an adaptive pattern
length - that is, the pattern is scaled so as to fit one or more complete patterns into the line.
·
·
If n is 0, a dot is placed at the (X, Y) coordinates specified with any vector commands used.
p, the pattern length, specifies the length of one complete pattern, either as a percentage of the distance
between P1 and P2 or in millimeters. The unit system used is determined by the mode setting. If the length
is omitted, the printer uses the most recently specified pattern length.
·
·
If a zero or negative pattern length is specified the command is ignored.
m, the mode, defines whether the pattern length parameter, p, is interpreted as a reading in millimeters, (m=1),
or as a percentage of the distance between P1 and P2, (m=0). If no mode number is included in the
command, the most recently specified mode is used.
·
·
·
LT99; restores the previous line type (and, if it is a fixed line type, the residue), provided that the current line
type is solid and that the pen position is the same as it was when the current, solid line type was selected.
An LT command remains in effect until another LT command is issued, until the default settings are restored
with the DF command or until the printer is initialized with an IN command.
If no parameters are specified the line type is set to be solid. The previous line type, pattern length and
any line residue are saved.
10 ' - Line Type -
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;IP1000,1000,9000,7000;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "PA2000,7100;PDPR400,0;PU;" 'REM DEFAULT LINE = 400
70 LPRINT "LT8;PA2000,7000;PD5000,7000;PU;"
80 LPRINT "LT8,4,0;PA2000,6900;PD5000,6900;PU;"
90 LPRINT "LT8,8,1;PA2000,6800;PD5000L6800;PU;"
100 '
110 LPRINT "LT4,PA2000,6600;PD5000,6600;PU;"
120 LPRINT "LT4,4,0;PA2000;6500;PD5000;6600;PU;"
130 LPRINT "LT4,10,1;PA2000,6400;PD5000,6400;PU;"
140 '
150 LPRINT "LT0;PA2000,6300;PD5000,6200; PU;"
160 LPRINT "LT0,4,0;PA2000,6100;PD5000,61000;PU;"
170 LPRINT "LT0,10,1;PA2000,6000;PD5000,6000;PU;"
180 '
190 LPRINT "LT-4;PA2000,5800;PD5000,5800;PU;"
200 LPRINT "LT-4,4,0;PA2000,5700;PD5000;5700;PU;"
210 LPRINT "LT-4,10,1;PA2000,5600;PD5000,5600;PU;"
220 '
230 LPRINT "LT-8;PA2000,5400;PD5000,5400;PU;"
240 LPRINT "LT-8,4,0;PA2000,5300;PD5000,5300;PU;"
250 LPRINT "LT08,10,1;PA2000,5200;PD5000,5200;PU;"
260 '
270 LPRINT "LT99;PA2000,5000;PD5000,5000;PU;"
280 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
290 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
300 END
<Sample 41>
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 33
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
PW - Pen width
PW [w, [,p]] [;]
w ; width
p ; pen
·
·
This command specifies the width of the pen.
Pen width can either be specified as a fixed width in millimeters ( the default ) or relative to the distance
between the scaling points P1 and P2.
·
·
If a width of zero is specified the thinnest width possible ( 1 dot wide ) is set.
Metric widths are scaled by the ratio of the PCL picture frame to the HP-GL/2 plot size. If the ratio for the
two axes is different, the smaller one is used. If this is less than the thinnest width available then a width
of 1 dot is selected.
·
·
If no pen number is specified the new width applies to both pens.
If a pen number other than 0 or 1 is specified the command is ignored. There are six pens in the
specification.
·
If no parameters are specified the pen width defaults to either 0.35mm or 0.1% of the distance from P1 to P2
according to the current width unit setting.
·
·
·
Pen width settings are not affected by a DF command.
Pen width does not set the width of the lines that make up the characters in a label.
A PW command remains in effect until another PW command is issued, until a WU command is used or
until the printer is initialized with an IN command.
10 '-Pen Width-
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "PA3500,2500;PW1.5;"
70 LPRINT "PD4500,2800,4500,1800,3500,1500,3500,2500;"
80 LPRINT "PW0.8;PD2300,2900,2300,1900,3500,1500;"
90 LPRINT "PW0.5;PU2300,2900;PD3300,3200,4500,2800;"
100 LPRINT "PW0.25:PU4500,1800;PD3500,2100;"
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
130 END
<Sample 42>
RF - Raster fill definition
RF [ i [, w, h, p [,...]]] [;]
i : index
p: pen number
w : width
h : height
·
·
This command defines a rectangular pattern which may be used to fill the area.
i is the index number of the pattern that is to be defined and must be in the range 1-8. 8 patterns can exist
concurrently.
·
·
·
·
If used with an index parameter and no others, the pattern is defined as a solid black fill.
w is the width in pixels of the pattern that is to be defined and must be in the range 1- 255.
h is the height in pixels of the pattern that is to be defined an must be in the range 1 - 255.
p stands for a pixel in the defined fill. p = 0 signifies a white pixel, p>0 signifies a black pixel. The number
of pixels specified should equal the number of pixels in the fill pattern (w, h). The parameter defines
successive pixels' colors from left to right, top to bottom. If you do not supply enough pixel parameters
the trailing pixels default to white.
·
·
Use the FT command to select a fill type from those defined with the RF command.
Omitting parameters sets all raster fill patterns to solid fill.
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 34
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
10 '--Raster Fill Definition==
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "PU5,5;PA3500,2500;"
70 LPRINT
"RF2,8,4,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,1,1,0,0,0,0,0,1,1,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,
0,;"
80 LPRINT "FT11,2;RR4000,800;EP;"
90 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
100 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
110 END
<Sample 43>
SM - Symbol mode
SM c[;]
c ; ASCII character or symbol code
·
·
The command specifies the symbol to be drawn.
The specified symbol will be drawn at the end of each vector, irrespective of whether the pen is up or down
when the PA, PR, PD, PU or PE instructions are used.
·
·
·
·
·
Characters in the character code ranges 33 - 58, 60 - 126 and characters 161 and 254 can be used.
Character code 59 stands for the ';', which is the HP-GL/2 terminator. You cannot use it as a symbol.
The current character size, slant and direction settings affect the way the symbol is drawn.
Omitting the parameter cancels the symbol mode.
On quitting symbol mode the original pen up/down state is restored.
SP - Select pen
SP [ n ] [;]
n ; pen number
·
·
·
·
The command selects a pen for drawing.
You must use this command before performing any drawing or filling commands.
n should be either 0 or 1 ( although any other integers will be interpreted as 1.)
If n is 0 the white pen is selected. In this case drawing commands will have no effect, unless you are
plotting onto a dark background and transparency mode is off.
·
·
If n is 1 the black pen is selected and printing can proceed normally. Use SP1 at the start of HP-GL/2
programs.
Invoking the command with no parameter is equivalent to SP0.
SV - Screened vectors
SV [ s [, option_1[, option_2]]] [;]
s : screen type
option_1 and option_2: dependent on the screen type
·
·
This command selects the type of screening that will be applied to vectors, arcs, circles and edges of
polygons, rectangles and wedges.
The screen type must have the value 0, 1, 2, 21, 22 or 130. 0 = no screen, 1 = shaded fill ( one of eight gray
scales ), 2 = raster fill as defined by the RF command, 21 = a pre-defined PCL cross-hatch pattern and 130 =
shaded fill ( one of sixty-four gray scales ).
·
·
With screen type 1 option_1 specifies the percentage of shading (0-100): option_2 is ignored.
With screen type 2 option_1 is used to specify the index number of the fill pattern created using the RF
command. Option_2 is set to either 0 or 1: 0 means that the fill will appear in the colour of pen number 1, 1
means it should appear in the current pen's colour.
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 35
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
·
With screen type 21 option 1 specifies one of six predefined PCL cross-hatch patterns (patterns 1 - 6).
option 2 is ignored.
With screen type 22, option 1 specifies the ID number of PCL user-defined pattern which is defined by the
ESC*c#W command. option 2 is ignored.
·
·
With fill screen type 130 option 1 specifies the percentage of shading ( 0 - 100 ): option 2 is ignored.
If option 1 and option 2 are omitted, the most recently specified values for these parameters, for the
specified screen type, are used.
·
·
All screening patterns use the current anchor corner.
Invoking the command with no parameter turns screening off. This is equivalent to SV0;
10 '-Screened Vectors-
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "SV1,15;PA4000,5000;CI500;"
70 LPRINT "SV1,50;PA5000,4000;CI400;"
80 LPRINT "SV1,100;PA6000,6000;CI300;"
90 LPRINT "PW10;SV21,5;PA2000,1000;PD;AA0,0,90;PC;"
100 LPRINT "PW5;SV21,3;PA6000,6000;CI500;"
110 LPRINT "PW7;SV21,6;PA2000,8000;PDPA5000,8000;PU;"
120 LPRINT "PW7;SV21,6;PA2000,8000;PDPA5000,8000;PU;"
130 LPRINT "1,1,0,0,0,0,0,0,1,1,";
140 LPRINT "0,0,1,1,0,0,1,1,0,0,";
150 LPRINT "0,0,0,0,1,1,0,0,0,0,";
160 LPRINT "0,0,1,1,0,0,1,1,0,0,";
170 LPRINT "1,1,0,0,0,0,0,0,1,1;";
180 LPRINT
"PW15;SV2,3;PA4000,2000;PM0;PD6000,2000,6000,4000,4000,4000;PM1;PM2;EP;
"
190 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
200 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
210 END
<Sample 44>
TR - Transparency mode
TR [ n ] [;]
n ; transparency type
·
This command turns transparency mode on and off. Transparency mode defines how source and
destination graphics images interact.
·
·
n is either 0 (off) or 1(on).
When transparency mode is on, the white parts of a source image (the image that is being superimposed on
the destination image) do not affect the destination image - that is, part of the destination image will be
visible beneath the source image.
·
·
·
When transparency mode is off the destination image is not visible beneath the source image.
Invoking the command with no parameter turns transparency mode on. This is equivalent to TR1;
An Esc E reset, a control panel reset, the IN command and the DF command all turn transparency mode
on.
10 'Transparency Mode-
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0b";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 'PART1 TR1
70 'Original Destination 1
80 LPRINT "TR1;PA1900,4900;PM0;PM3100;4900,2500,6100;PM1;"
90 LPRINT "PM2;FP;"
100 'Source 1
110 LPRINT "FT10,50;PA2000,5000;RR500,500;PA2500,5500;RR500,500;"
120 LPRINT "FT10,1;PA2500,5000;RR500,500;PA2000,5500;RR500,500;FT;"
130 'PART2 TR0
140 'Original Destination 2
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 36
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
150 LPRINT "TR0;PA3900,4900;PM0;PA5100,4900,4500,6100;PM1;"
160 LPRINT "PM2;FP;"
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 37
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
170 'Source 2
180 LPRINT "FT10,50;PA4000,5000;RR500,500;PA4500,5500;RR500,500;"
190 LPRINT "FT10,1;PA4500,5000;RR500,500;PA4000,5500;RR500,500;FT;"
200 '
210 '( POLYGON )
220 LPRINT "PA2000,1000;PM0;PDPA4000,1000,3000,3000;PM1;"
230 LPRINT "PA2500,1200,3500,1200,3000,2500;PM1;"
240 LPRINT "PA3000,800,3700,2500,2300,2500;PM1;"
250 LPRINT "PM2;FP;"
260 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
270 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
280 END
<Sample 45>
UL - User-defined line type
UL [ i ] [,g [...,]] [;]
i ; unit type
g : gap length
·
·
·
·
This command allows you to define line types which you can then subsequently select with the LT command.
i must be in the range 1-8. i identifies the line type that is to be defined.
The index parameter uses absolute values.
g (the gap length) alternately specifies pen up and pen down parts of the defined line type. A maximum of
twenty line sections are permitted, the first of which is a pen down section. Numbers must be integers in
the range 0~32767. These numbers are converted to percentages by the LT command.
·
·
·
Maximum definition for the gap of each line type is 20.
The sum of the gap parameters must be greater than 0.
Specifying an index number with no gap parameters sets the line type to the default pattern for that index
number.
·
Using the command with no parameter sets all line types to the defaults.
10 '-User Defined Line Type-
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;;"
60 LPRINT "UL8,0,15,0,15,0,15,40,15;"
70 LPRINT "LT8,5;PA2000,2500;PDPA5000,2500;PU;"
80 LPRINT "UL4,40,15,0,15,0,15,40,15,0,15;"
90 LPRINT "LT4,10;PA2000,3000;PDPA5000,3000;PU;"
100 LPRINT "UL1,40,40,40,40,40;"
110 LPRINT "LT1,10;PA2000,3500;PDPA5000,3500;PU;"
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
130 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
140 END
<Sample 46>
WU - Select unit for pen width
WU [ t ] [;]
t ; unit type
·
·
·
This command specifies the pen width unit. It applies to all pens.
t must be either 0 or 1.
If t is 0 the pen width parameter which accompanies subsequent PW commands will be treated as a reading in
millimeters.
·
If t is 1 the pen width parameter which accompanies subsequent PW commands will be treated as percentage
of the distance between the scaling points P1 and P2. The default width is 0.1% of the diagonal distance
from P1 to P2.
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 38
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
·
·
The command sets all pen widths to a default of 0.35mm. Hence it should be used before the PW command.
Using the command with no parameter defaults the type to 0 (metric) and all pen widths to 0.35mm.
The unit type is not affected by a DF command.
10 '-Pen Width Unit Selection-
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 'metric
70 LPRINT PA2000,6000;PDPA6000,6000;PU;" 'Default 0.35mm
80 LPRINT "WU0;PA2000,5700;PDPA6000,5700;PU;"'0.35mm
90 LPRINT "WU0;PW1.5;PA2000,5400;PDPA6000,5400;PU;"'1.5mm
100 LPRINT "WU0;PW0.8;PA2000,5100;PDPA6000,5100;PU;"'0.8mm
110 "-relative unit
120 LPRINT "PW;PA2000,4600;PDPA6000,4600;PU;"'Default 0.35mm=4dot
130 LPRINT "IP1000,1000,9000,7000;"
140 LPRINT "WU1;PA2000,4300;PDPA6000,4300;PU;"'300*10/1016=2dot
150 LPRINT "IP1000,1000,5000,4000;"
160 LPRINT "WU1;PA2000,4000;PDPA6000,4000;PU;"'300*5/1016=1dot
170 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
180 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
190 END
<Sample 47>
7.6. Character Plot Instructions
Instruction
SD
AD
SS
Function
Define Standard Font
Define Alternate Font
Select Standard Font
Select Alternate Font
Select Primary Font
Select Secondary Font
Define Label
SA
FI
FN
LB
DT
LO
DI
Define Label Terminator
Label Origin
Absolute Direction
Relative Direction
Define Variable Text Path
Character Plot
DR
DV
CP
CF
Character Fill Mode
Set Absolute Character Size
Set Relative Character Size
Set Character Slant
Scalable or Bitmap Fonts
Extra Space
SI
SR
SL
SB
ES
TD
Transparent Data
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 39
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
7.6.1. Introduction
The character group commands enable you to print text to accompany your HP-GL/2 generated graphics
without leaving graphics mode. You can use any font that would be available to you in LaserJet emulation
mode and you can modify various printing characteristics of the text such as the size, direction and slant of
the characters.
SD - Define standard font
SD [ attribute, value ] [..] [;]
attribute ; a font attribute to be defined
value ; the value of the attribute
·
·
This command allows you to define the standard font and its attribute.
attribute takes a value from 1-7. 1=symbol set, 2=spacing, 3=pitch, 4=height, 5=posture, 6=stroke weight and
7=typeface.
·
·
value selects an option for the specified attribute.
If the defined font is not available another font is selected that matches the defined font's specified attributes
as closely as possible. The symbol set attribute has the highest priority for matching and typeface has the
lowest.
·
If you omit all parameters, the default standard font attributes are used. These are shown below.
Attribute
Meaning
Symbol set
Spacing
Default value
Description
Roman-8
1
2
277
0
Monospacin
g
3
4
5
Pitch
Height
Posture
9
11.5
0
9 cpi
11.5 point
Upright
characters
6
7
Stroke
weight
0
Medium
Typeface
48
Stick font
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 40
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
attribute = 1 : Symbol set
Value
Name
ISO
Value
Name
ISO
number
number
1
3
Math - 7
HP Large Characters
Roman Extensions
HP German
-
2
4
Line Draw - 7
Norwegian v1
French v1
Hebrew - 7
JIS ASCII
Math - 7
-
60
25
-
-
5
-
6
7
-
15
8
9
Italian
11
13
15
14
-
12
14
Line Draw - 7
-
ECMA-94 Latin1 (8-bit
version)
8859/1
OCR - A
-
16
19
21
25
36
38
43
45
48
51
57
76
79
85
APL (typewriter paired)
Swedish for names
ASCII
-
11
6
18
20
22
26
37
39
44
47
50
53
75
78
83
89
Cyrillic ASCII
Thai - 8
-
-
Arabic (MacKay's Version)
Not used
-
3 of 9 Barcode
Danish/Norwegian v2
French v2
-
-
61
69
13
-
United Kingdom
German
4
21
Katakana
HP Block Characters
OCR - B
-
Tech - 7
-
APL (bit paired)
HP Spanish
-
Cyrillic
-
-
Legal
-
57
Industrial 2 of 5 Barcode
Tax Line Draw
OCR-M
-
Chinese
-
ECMA-94 Latin 2
Spanish
8859/2
17
-
International Reference
Version
2
Matrix 2 of 5 Barcode
-
114
147
173
179
185
205
217
243
263
266
268
275
277
281
309
332
341
405
PC Cyrillic
Portuguese
-
16
-
115
153
174
181
202
211
234
249
264
267
269
276
278
299
330
334
373
428
Swedish
Interleaved 2 of 5 Barcode
ECMA-128 Latin 5
HPL Language Set
Microsoft Publishing
Spanish
10
-
PS Math
8859/9
Portuguese
84
-
-
CODABAR Barcode
Ventura Math
MSI/Plessey Barcode
HP European Spanish
Greek - 8
-
-
85
-
DeskTop
-
-
Code 11 Barcode
Hebrew - 8
-
-
-
Document
-
Kana - 8
-
Line Draw 8
-
Math - 8
-
HP Latin Spanish
Roman - 8 (Default)
UPC/EAN Barcode
Windows
-
Turkish - 8
-
-
Arabic - 8
-
-
Korean - 8
-
-
PS Text
-
PS ITC Zapf Dingbats
PC-8
-
ECMA-113/88 Latin/Cyrillic
PC-8 D/N
8859/5.2
-
-
-
PC-850
-
ITC Zapf Dingbats Series
300
458
505
563
Ventura U.S.
USPS Zip
-
-
-
501
531
595
Pi Font
-
-
-
HP-GL Download
HP-GL Special Symbols
HP-GL Drafting
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 41
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
attribute = 2 : Spacing
Value
Meaning
0
1
Monospacing
Proportional spacing
·
·
attribute = 3 : Pitch
Specify pitch in characters per inch (cpi). The pitch value you specify can be in the range 0 to 32767.9999.
Pitch only applies to monospaced fonts.
attribute = 4 : Height
Specify height in points. One point is 1/72". The height value you specify can be in the range 0 to
32767.9999. Proportionally spaced fonts are scaled according to the height you select. Monospaced fonts
ignore this setting value.
·
·
attribute = 5 : Posture
value
Meaning
Upright
0
1
2
Italic
Alternate italic
attribute = 6 : Stroke weight
Attribute
Meaning
Ultra Thin
Extra thin
thin
-7
-6
-5
-4
-3
-2
-1
Extra light
Light
Demi light
Semi light
0
1
Medium, Book or Text
Semi bold
Demi bold
2
3
Bold
4
Extra bold
5
Black
6
Extra black
7
Ultra black
9999
Stick font at current pen width*
* This attribute value is only effective if the stick font is the current font.
·
attribute = 7 : Typeface
You can select any typefaces available in LaserJet mode, from the internal fonts, card/cartridge fonts or
download fonts.
10 '-Standard Font Definition-
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "PA2200,7000;SD2,0,4,11.5,5,0;"
70 LPRINT "DT#;LBLaser printer#"
80 LPRINT "PA2000,5000;SD2,1,4,20,5,1;"
90 LPRINT "LBLaser printer#"
100 LPRINT "PA1000,3000;SD2,1,4,50,5,1;"
110 LPRINT "LBLASER PRINTER#"
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
130 LPRINT CHR$927); "%0A";
140 END
<Sample 48>
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 42
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
AD - Define alternate font
AD [ attribute, value ] [..] [;]
attribute : a font attribute to be defined
value : the value of the attribute
·
·
This command allows you to define the alternate font and its attribute.
attribute takes a value from 1-7.
1 = symbol set, 2 = spacing, 3 = pitch, 4 = height, 5 = posture, 6 = stroke weight and 7 = typeface.
·
·
value selects an option for the specified attribute. For further explanation about attribute values see the
previous SD command.
If the defined font is not available, another font is selected that matches the defined font's specified attributes
as closely as possible. The symbol set attribute has the highest priority for matching and typeface has the
lowest.
·
If you omit all parameters, the default alternate font attributes are used.
10 '-Define Alternate Font -
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 '- Standard font -
70 LPRINT "PA1000,5000;"
80 LPRINT "LBStandard font"; CHR$(3);
90 ' - Alternate font -
100 LPRINT "AD2,1,4,24,7,4101;"
110 LPRINT "PA1000,4000;"
120 LPRINT "SA";
130 LPRINT "LBAlternate font"; CHR$(3);
140 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
150 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
160 END
<Sample 49>
SS - Select standard font
SS [;]
·
This command allows you to select the standard font, as defined by the SD command. All subsequently
printed labels will appear in the standard font.
·
·
·
The SS command is equivalent to including the SI control code (ASCII 15) in a label.
The default standard font is the HP-GL stick font.
The font remains current until the printer is initialized with an IN command, until the default conditions are
resorted with the DF command or until an SA command is used.
SA - Select alternate font
SA [;]
·
This command allows you to select the alternate font, as defined by the AD command. All subsequently
printed labels will appear in the alternate font
·
·
The SA command is equivalent to including the SO control code (ASCII 14) in a label.
The font remains current until the printer is initialized with an IN command, until the default conditions are
restored with the DF command or until an SS command is used.
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 43
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
FI - Select primary font
FI font-ID [;]
font-ID ; the identity number of any accessible font.
·
This command allows you to select any accessible font, which has previously been given an identity
number in LaserJet mode, as the primary (standard) font. All subsequently printed labels will appear in the
primary font.
·
·
For scalable fonts this command must be preceded by an SD command specifying the font's point size or
pitch.
When the FI command is issued the primary (standard) font's attributes are set to be those of the selected
font (provided it is available).
10 '-Select Primary Font & Select standard Font -
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "*c15D";
50 LPRINT CHR$(27); "(s1p18v0s3b52T";
60 LPRINT CHR$(27); "*c6F";
70 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
80 LPRINT "IN;SP1;"
90 LPRINT "PA1500,1500;DT#;LBLaser Printer"; CHR$(13);CHR$(10); "#"
100 LPRINT "SD4,18;FI15;LBLaser Printer#"
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
130 END
<Sample 50>
FN - Select secondary font
FN font-ID [;]
font-ID : the identity number of any accessible font
·
This command allows you to select any accessible font, which has previously been given an identity
number in PCL mode, as the secondary (alternate) font. All subsequently printed labels will appear in the
secondary font.
·
·
For scalable fonts the FN command must be preceded by an AD command specifying the font's point size or
pitch.
When the FN command is issued the secondary (alternate) font's attributes are set to be those of the selected
font (provided it is available).
LB - Character plot
LB [ cs ] < terminator > [;]
cs : character string
·
·
This command enables you to print character strings.
You must supply a terminator at the end of your string. You can either use the default terminator, ETX
(ASCII 3), or define your own terminating character using the DT command.
·
·
·
A label can include non-printing characters such as a carriage return or line feed.
Printing takes place irrespective of whether the pen is currently up or down.
The label is printed starting from the current cursor position and using any label origin setting that you have
made with the LO command.
10 '-Label-
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "PA2500,2500;DT*;"
70 LPRINT "SD1,21,2,1,4,25,5,0,6,3,7,52;SS;"
80 LPRINT "LBLaser printer*"
90 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
100 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
110 END
<Sample 51>
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 44
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
DT - Define label terminator
DT [ c [, m ]] [;]
c : Character
m : mode
·
·
This command allows you to specify the character that terminates strings printed with the LB instruction.
The character immediately following DT is taken to be the terminator. Hence, do not put a space between
the DT and your chosen character. If you do, space will be interpreted as the terminator in all subsequent
LB commands.
·
m, the mode, determines whether the terminating character is printed as part of the label or not. If m = 0 the
character is printed ; if m = 1 it is not.
·
·
·
If you do not specify a value for m the terminating character is not printed.
If you leave out the character parameter the default character ETX (ASCII 3 ) is used as the terminator.
This setting is effective until the another DT is invoked or IN or DF is performed.
10 REM - Define Label Terminator -
20 WIDTH "LPT:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP2;";
60 LPRINT "IN;SP2;SC0,5000,0,5000;"
70 LPRINT "PA0,4500;LBDefault control character ETX"; CHR$(13);CHR$(3);
80 LPRINT "LBterminates by performing end-"; CHR$(13);CHR$(3);
90 LPRINT "LBof-text function.";CHR$(3);
100 LPRINT "PA0,3500;DT@;LBPrinting characters terminate,"; CHR$(13);
"@";
110 LPRINT "LBbut are also printed.@";
120 LPRINT "PA0,3000;DT"; CHR$(7); "LBcontrol characters terminate";
CHR$(13);chr(7);
130 LPRINT "LBand perform their function."; CHR$(7)
140 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%01";
150 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
160 END
<Sample 52>
LO - Label origin
LO [ p ] [;]
·
·
This instruction allows you to position labels in different ways relative to the current pen location.
You can centre, left justify or right justify labels relative to the current pen location and print them on,
above or below the current location.
·
·
You can combine an offset distance, equal to 25% of the current font's point size, with any of the above
origin positions.
p must either be in the range 1 - 9, 11 - 10 and 21. The label origin position specified by each p parameter
value is shown below. 21 sets the label origin to the same one in PCL.
P=1
P=2
P=3
P=4
P=5
P=6
P=7
P=8
P=9
P=11
P=12
P=13
P=14
P=15
P=16
P=17
P=18
P=19
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 45
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
When you use an LO instruction the carriage return point is set to be the new label origin. To send the pen
back to a label's origin when you have finished printing it, include a carriage return between the last character
of the label and the terminating character.
·
·
·
If a label contains embedded carriage returns, each character string following a carriage return is printed
starting from the label origin.
If you omit the parameter the label origin is the bottom left hand corner of the first character's character cell -
equivalent to LO11;.
The command remains in effect until the printer is initialized with an IN command, until the default
conditions are restored with the DF command or until another LO command is used.
10 '-Label Origin-
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP;";
60 LPRINT "SC-4000,4000,-5000,5000;SI0.17,0.26;"
70 LPRINT "PA0,500;PD-500,0,0,-500,500,0,0,500;DT#;"
80 LPRINT "CI10;LO4;LBCentred on point#"
90 LPRINT "PU-500,0;CI10;LO18;LBleft centre offset#"
100 LPRINT "PU0,-500;CI10;LO13;LBRight offset from point#"
110 LPRINT "PA500,0;CI10;LO3;LBright hang from point#"
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
130 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
140 END
<Sample 53>
DI - Absolute direction
DI [ run, rise ] [;]
run : X direction component rise : Y direction component
·
This command determines the direction in which subsequent labels will be printed.
rise
run
·
·
gives the tangent of the angle between the base line of a label's characters and the horizontal.
run is equivalent to cos q and rise is equivalent to sin q.
sin q
tan
q=
rise
cosq
q
run
·
·
·
·
Values for run and rise are clamped real numbers.
When you issue a DI instruction the carriage return point is set to the current pen location.
The instruction is ignored if run and rise are both 0.
Any text path that you set with the DV instruction will combine with the current printing direction to
determine the layout of characters on the page.
·
·
If you omit the parameters the printing direction is horizontal.
The label direction which is specified by this command is not affected by changes in the location of P1 and
P2.
10 ' -Absolute Direction -
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 DEG = -45
70 RAD = 3.1416 / 180 * DEG
80 LPRINT "IN;SP2;PA3050,4450;"
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 46
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
90 LPRINT "DT";"
100 LPRINT "DT0,2;LB_*_1988#"; "DI2,2;LB_*_1989#";
110 LPRINT "DT2,0;LB_*_1990#"; "DI2,-2;LB_*_1991#";
120 LPRINT "DT0,-2;LB_*_1992#"; "DI-2,-2;LB_*_1993#";
130 LPRINT "DT-2,0;LB_*_1994#"; "DI-2,2;LB_*_1995#";
140 LPRINT "PA3500,5350;DI", COS(0),SIN(0); "LB_*_2000"; CHR$(13); "#";
150 LPRINT "DI", COS(RAD); SIN(RAD); "LB_RETURN POINT"; CHR$(13); "#";
160 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
170 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
180 END
<sample 54>
DR - Relative direction
DR [ run, rise ] [;]
run : X-component of the printing direction expressed as a percentage of the x-component of the distance
between P1 and P2.
rise : Y-component of the printing direction expressed as a percentage of the y-component of the distance
between P1 and P2.
·
·
·
·
·
This command determines the direction in which subsequent labels will be printed.
Values for run and rise are clamped real numbers.
The instruction is ignored if run and rise are both 0.
When you issue a DR instruction the carriage return point is set to the current pen location.
Any text path that you set with the DV instruction will combine with the current printing direction to
determine the layout of characters on the page.
·
·
·
If you change the positions of P1 and P2 the printing direction will change accordingly.
If you omit the parameters the printing direction is horizontal and the run = 1% of |P2X-P1X|.
Actual values for run and rise are changed relative to the P1 and P2 value. It is calculated as below:
actual run = run parameter ÷ 100 x (P2x - P1x)
actual rise = rise parameter ÷ 100 x (P2y - P1y)
(0, 100)
(100, 100)
(0,60)
rise = 60%
q
(70,0)
(0, 100)
run=70%
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 47
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
DV - Define variable text path
DV [ path [,line]] [;]
path : text printing path - horizontal or vertical, and left to right, right to left, upwards or downwards.
line: the effect of a line feed.
·
·
This command determines the printing direction for labels and the carriage return point.
Permissible values of path are 0, 1, 2 and 3. If path = 0 labels are printed horizontally and left to right -
normal printing. If path = 1 labels are printed vertically downwards - characters appear in a vertical
column. If path = 2 labels are printed horizontally and right to left - words appear backwards. If path =
3 labels are printed vertically upwards - characters appear in a vertical column, reading from bottom to
top.
·
The value of line must be either 0 or 1. If line = 0, each time a line feed is encountered the current pen
position is moved at an angle of 90° to the path in a clockwise direction. Hence, if path = 1 the second
line of text is printed to the left of the first line. If line = 1 each time a line feed is encountered the
current pen position is moved at an angle of 90° to the path in an anticlockwise direction. Hence, if
path = 2 the second line of text is printed below the first line.
·
·
If you do not use a DV command the default text path is horizontal, left to right: line feeds will move the
pen position at 90° to the text clockwise. This is equivalent to using the command DV0,0;
If you omit both parameters the text path is horizontal, left to right.
CP - Relative character movement
CP [ spaces [,lines]] [;]
spaces ; the number of text spaces the pen position is moved.
lines ; the number of text lines the pen position is moved.
·
Use this command to re-position the pen. The command moves the pen the specified number of lines
and spaces corresponding to the currently selected font's pitch and line spacing. (For proportionally
spaced fonts the width of the space character is used to determine the distance moved horizontally). All
movement is relative to the current label printing direction.
·
·
spaces is the number of spaces that the pen moves. A positive value of spaces moves the pen right
from the current pen location: a negative value moves it to the left.
lines is the number of lines that the pen moves. A negative value offset moves the pen down from the
current pen location: a positive value moves it upwards.
·
·
Values for spaces and lines are clamped real numbers.
The command only moves the pen and does not draw lines, irrespective of whether the pen is currently
up or down.
·
·
On completion of the command, the previous pen status (up or down) is restored.
The height of text lines (the vertical distance that a line feed moves the pen position) is fixed for every
font. However, it can be adjusted using the ES instruction.
·
If you omit all parameters, the pen position moves to the carriage return point and then down one line -
hence CP; is equivalent to a carriage return followed by a line feed.
10 '-Character Plot -
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "PA1000,5000;";
70 LPRINT "PD;PR2000,0;PU;";
80 LPRINT "CP-15,1;";
90 LPRINT "LBAbove the line"; CHR$(3);
100 LPRINT "CP-14,-2;";
110 LPRINT "LBBelow the line"; CHR$(3);
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
130 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
140 END
<Sample 55>
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 48
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CF - Character fill mode
CF [ fill [, pen ]] [;]
fill : the fill pattern used to fill characters
pen : the pen used to edge characters
·
·
This command determines how characters are edged and filled.
Only scalable fonts can be both filled and edged - bitmap fonts and the stick font cannot be edged and
can only be filled with raster fill, shading or PCL cross-hatch patterns. Scalable characters can be filled
with any pattern specified by the FT command.
·
·
Permissible values of fill are 0, 1, 2 and 3. If fill = 0 characters are filled with a solid fill and edged. If
fill = 1 characters are edged but not filled. (Bitmap characters and stick font characters are filled as they
cannot be edged.) If fill = 2 characters are filled using the current fill type, but not edged. If fill = 3
characters are filled, using the current fill type and edged.
pen can be either 0 or 1. A value of 0 specifies the edging pen to be white; a value of 1 selects the
black pen for edging. If no pen is specified in the instruction the current pen, as selected with the SP
command, is used.
·
·
·
·
·
The width of the edging pen is proportional to the character's point size.
The fill line width used for cross hatch patterns is set with the PW command.
If you omit both parameters solid fill and the white edging pen are selected - this is equivalent to CF0.0;
If the command is not used all characters are solid and unedged.
A CF command remains in effect until an IN command is used to initialize the printer, a DF command is
used to restore the default settings or another CF command is invoked.
10 '-Character Fill Mode -
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "SD1,21,2,1,4,140,5,0,6,3,7,52;SS;"
70 LPRINT "PA1000,3000;DT*;FT3,50,45;"
80 LPRINT "CF1,1;LBA*;"
90 LPRINT "PW0.1;CF3,1;LBB*;"
100 LPRINT "PW0.5;LBC*;"
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
130 END
<sample 56>
SI - Set absolute character size
SI [ width, height ] [;]
width : the width in centimeters of printed characters
height : the height in centimeters of printed characters
·
·
·
This command allows you to specify the size of the characters that you print with the LB instruction in
centimeters.
width specifies character width and is a clamped real number. Negative values of width produce right-to-left
mirror image characters.
height specifies the height of a capital letter and is a clamped real number. Negative values of height
produce upside-down mirror image characters.
·
·
·
If you change character size, the line width used to draw stick font characters may also change.
If you omit the parameters, the character size is as specified by the most recent SD or AD command.
If an SB1; command has previously been issued, printed characters may not be exactly the size that you
specify.
·
If an SB1; command has been issued, specifying a negative value will not produce mirror image characters.
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 49
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
10 ' -Absolute Character Size-
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "PA700,3000;DT#;LBPrinter#"
70 LPRINT "PA700,2000;SI0.75,1;LBPrinter#"
80 LPRINT "SI;SD1,21,2,1,3,12,5,0,6,0,7,52;SS;"
90 LPRINT "PA40003000;LBPrinter#"
100 LPRINT "PA4000,2000;SI1,1.5;LBPrinter#"
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
130 END
<Sample 57>
SR - Set relative character size
SR [ width, height ] [;]
width ; the width of printed characters expressed as a percentage of the x-component of the distance between
P1 and P2.
height ; the height of printed characters expressed as a percentage of the y-component of the distance
between P1 and P2.
·
·
·
·
This command allows you to specify the size of the character that you print with the LB instruction
relative to the scaling points P1 and P2.
width sets the character width to a percentage of |P2x-P1x| and is a clamped real number. Negative
values of width produce right-to-left mirror image characters
height sets the character height to a percentage of |P2y-P2y| and is a clamped real number. Negative
values of height produce upside-down mirror image character.
If you change the positions of P1 and P2, the character size will change unless the scaling points remain
in the same relative positions.
·
·
·
If you move P2 to the left of, or below P1, characters will appear in mirror image.
If you change the character size, the line width used to draw stick font characters may also change.
If you omit the parameters, the character size is as specified by the most recent SD or AD command.
10 '-Relative Character Size-
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "IP2000,2000,6500,6500;DT@;"
70 LPRINT "SR;PA0,2700;LBRELATIVE LABEL SIZE@"
80 LPRINT "IP0,0,5500,5500;PA0,2000;"
90 LPRINT "LBNEW P1 AND P2 CHANGE LABEL SIZE@"
100 LPRINT "PA0,1000;SR2.5;LBNEW SR INSTRUCTION`;CP;"
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
140 END
<Sample 58>
SL - Character slant
SL [ tan f ] [;]
tan f - tangent of character slant angle (f)
·
·
This command determines the slant of characters printed with subsequent LB commands.
f is the angle between characters and the vertical. A positive value of f ( and tan f ) produces forward
sloping characters, while a negative value results in characters which slant backwards.
·
·
·
Values of tan f are clamped real numbers.
A value of 0 for tan f results in upright characters.
If you omit the parameter, tan f is take to be 0 and any characters printed will be upright.
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 50
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 51
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
10 ' -Character Slant-
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27; "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";
60 LPRINT "SD1,21,2,1,4,25,5,0,6,0,7,5;SI0.7,1;"
70 LPRINT "PA1000,1000;DT#,1;SL0.36,LBPrinter#"
80 LPRINT "PA1000,300;SL-0.36;LBPrinter#"
90 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
100 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
110 END
<Sample 59>
SB - Scalable or bitmap fonts
SB [ n ] [;]
n : font category selection
·
·
This command enables you to restrict the range of selectable fonts to scalable fonts and the stick font only.
n can be 0 or 1. If n = 0 you may only select scalable fonts (or the stick font). If n = 1 you may select any
type of font.
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
An SB command can alter the current standard and alternate font selections.
Setting n to 1 allows the selection of bitmapped fonts and has the following side-effects:
Bitmap characters cannot be edged.
Bitmap characters can only be printed in orientations of 0°, 90°, 180° or 270°.
The SL (character slant) command is not applied to bitmap fonts.
Bitmap font character sizes are approximate only.
The DF and IN commands set n to 0, - only scalable fonts and the stick fonts may be selected.
The FI and FN commands implicitly set n to 1 if you use either of them to select a bitmap font.
If you omit n from the command, only scalable fonts and the stick font may be selected. This is equivalent
to an SB0; command.
·
The default setting is scalable fonts and stick font only.
ES - Extra space
ES [ width [,height]] [;]
width : factor by which character spacing is changed.
height : factor by which line spacing is changed
·
·
This command enables you to adjust the space between label characters and lines.
width specifies the factor by which to increase or decrease the character spacing. Positive numbers specify
an increase and negative numbers a decrease.
·
·
·
height specifies the factor by which to increase or decrease the line spacing. Positive numbers specify an
increase and negative numbers a decrease.
If you use the command without parameters, no extra space is used when labels are printed. This is
equivalent to ES0,0;
An ES command remains in effect until another ES command is executed, a DF or IN command is executed or
the printer is reset, either with the EscE command or from the control panel.
TD - Transparent data
TD [ mode ] [;]
mode : normal or transparent data mode.
·
This command enables you to specify whether control characters should perform their normal function or
should be printed.
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 52
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
·
mode is set to either 0 or 1. If mode is set to 0, control codes perform their normal functions and are
not printed. If mode=1, all characters are printed, if possible. No control characters perform any
function except the label terminator. Any non-printing or undefined characters appear as a space.
If you use the command without parameters, control codes will perform their normal functions and will
not be printed. This is equivalent to TD0;
10 '-Transparent Data-
20 WIDTH "LPT:", 255
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;"
60 '-TD=1 (Transparent) -
70 LPRINT "PA1000,5000;LBMODE : TD1 (Transparent)"; CHR$(13)
80 LPRINT "<Print as characters when labeling>"; CHR$(3)
90 X=1000
100 FOR I = &H0 O &H8
110 LPRINT "SD1,341,2,1,4,10,7,5;PA";X;",4000;TD1;DT@;LB";CHR$(I);"@";
120 X = X + 150
130 NEXT I
140 LPRINT "TD0;"
150 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";
160 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";
170 END
<Sample 60>
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 53
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
8.
INDEX
graphics window............................................................ 7, 10, 11
A
H
Absolute arc three point .........................................................21
absolute commands ...................................................................8
Absolute direction ...................................................................45
Anchor corner...........................................................................30
anchor point................................................................................7
hard clip limits............................................................................. 7
I
image plots ................................................................................ 11
Initialize command.................................................................... 12
Initialize set instruction........................................................... 13
Input relative scaling points................................................... 14
Input scaling point................................................................... 14
B
Bezier absolute..........................................................................24
Bezier relative............................................................................24
C
L
Character fill mode....................................................................48
Character plot............................................................................43
Character slant..........................................................................49
Circle plot...................................................................................23
current units ................................................................................7
Label origin ............................................................................... 44
Line attribute............................................................................. 32
Line type selection................................................................... 33
M
mnemonic .................................................................................... 9
D
Default set instruction.............................................................12
Define alternate font ................................................................42
Define label terminator.............................................................44
Define standard font................................................................39
Define variable text path..........................................................47
Draw absolute arc.....................................................................20
Draw relative arc .......................................................................21
P
parameters ................................................................................... 9
pen................................................................................................ 7
Pen down................................................................................... 18
Pen up........................................................................................ 18
Pen width................................................................................... 34
Plot absolute............................................................................. 19
Polygon mode........................................................................... 25
Polyline encoded...................................................................... 22
printer frame ................................................................................ 7
E
Edge polygon............................................................................26
Edge rectangle absolute..........................................................25
Edge rectangle relative ............................................................26
Edge wedge...............................................................................26
Extra space.................................................................................50
R
Raster rill definition.................................................................. 34
Relative arc three point ........................................................... 22
Relative character movement ................................................. 47
relative commands ..................................................................... 8
Relative coordinate pen move................................................ 19
Relative direction ..................................................................... 46
Rotate coordinate system....................................................... 17
F
fill commands ..............................................................................8
Fill polygon ...............................................................................29
Fill rectangle absolute..............................................................27
Fill rectangle relative................................................................28
Fill type ......................................................................................31
Fill wedge...................................................................................28
S
Scalable or bitmap fonts.......................................................... 50
Scale ........................................................................................... 15
scaling point ............................................................................. 10
Screened vectors...................................................................... 35
G
graphic units ...............................................................................7
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 54
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Select alternate font .................................................................42
Select pen ..................................................................................35
Select primary font ...................................................................43
Select secondary font..............................................................43
Select standard font.................................................................42
Select unit for pen width .........................................................37
separators ....................................................................................9
Set absolute character size......................................................48
Set relative character size ........................................................49
soft clip limits ..............................................................................7
Symbol mode.............................................................................35
syntax...........................................................................................9
T
terminator.....................................................................................9
Transparency mode .................................................................36
Transparent data ......................................................................50
U
user units .....................................................................................7
User-defined line type .............................................................37
W
Window.....................................................................................17
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 55
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 56
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 5
PJL
PRINTER JOB LANGUAGE
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CONTENTS
1. INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................................................................4
1.1. About PJL............................................................................................................................................4
1.2. In Case of Using PJL with a Non-PJL Printer.....................................................................................5
1.2.1. PCL jobs......................................................................................................................................... 5
1.2.2. Postscript jobs ................................................................................................................................ 5
1.2.3. Other printer languages .................................................................................................................... 5
1.3. PJL Syntax and Format ......................................................................................................................6
1.4. Variables .............................................................................................................................................7
1.4.1. Alphanumeric variables..................................................................................................................... 7
1.4.2. Numeric variables............................................................................................................................. 7
1.4.3. Strings............................................................................................................................................ 7
1.5. Invalid Commands ..............................................................................................................................7
1.5.1. Syntax errors................................................................................................................................... 7
1.5.2. Syntax warning and semantic warning ............................................................................................... 7
2. HOW TO USE PJL.................................................................................................................................8
2.1. Overview .............................................................................................................................................8
2.2. PJL Job Requirement .........................................................................................................................8
3. COMMAND GROUP..............................................................................................................................9
4. KERNEL COMMANDS...................................................................................................................... 10
4.1. Introduction........................................................................................................................................10
4.2. UEL Command.................................................................................................................................10
4.3. EXECUTE Command.......................................................................................................................10
4.4. ENTER Command............................................................................................................................11
4.5. COMMENT Command......................................................................................................................11
4.6. Printer Language Switching..............................................................................................................12
4.6.1. Explicit switching........................................................................................................................... 12
4.6.2. Implicit switching ........................................................................................................................... 12
4.6.3. Context switching .......................................................................................................................... 12
5. JOB SEPARATION COMMANDS.................................................................................................... 13
5.1. Introduction........................................................................................................................................13
5.2. JOB Command.................................................................................................................................13
5.3. EOJ Command.................................................................................................................................14
6. ENVIRONMENT COMMANDS......................................................................................................... 15
6.1. Introduction........................................................................................................................................15
6.1.1. Print environment ........................................................................................................................... 15
6.1.2. PJL reset conditions....................................................................................................................... 16
6.1.3. Remember these points about environments..................................................................................... 16
6.1.4. PJL environment variables............................................................................................................... 17
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.2. Variables ...........................................................................................................................................18
6.2.1. Variables for HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500 .............................................................. 18
6.2.2. Variables for HL-1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN......................................................................... 31
6.3. Default Command.............................................................................................................................35
6.4. Initialize Command ...........................................................................................................................35
6.5. Reset Command ..............................................................................................................................36
6.6. Set Command...................................................................................................................................36
7. STATUS READBACK COMMANDS............................................................................................... 38
7.1. Introduction........................................................................................................................................38
7.1.1. Synchronization with the printer....................................................................................................... 38
7.1.2. Basic format of status readback responses ...................................................................................... 38
7.2. Inquire Command .............................................................................................................................39
7.3. DINQUIRE Command.......................................................................................................................40
7.4. ECHO Command .............................................................................................................................41
7.5. INFO Command................................................................................................................................42
7.5.1. ID category.................................................................................................................................... 43
7.5.2. CONFIG category .......................................................................................................................... 43
7.5.3. MEMORY category........................................................................................................................ 46
7.5.4. STATUS category .......................................................................................................................... 47
7.5.5. VARIABLES category .................................................................................................................... 47
7.5.6. USTATUS category........................................................................................................................ 49
7.6. USTATUS Command .......................................................................................................................50
7.6.1. Device variable............................................................................................................................... 51
7.6.2. JOB variables ................................................................................................................................ 52
7.6.3. PAGE variable............................................................................................................................... 53
7.6.4. TIMED variable............................................................................................................................... 53
7.7. USTATUSOFF Command................................................................................................................54
7.8. JOB Recovery...................................................................................................................................54
8. DEVICE ATTENDANCE COMMANDS........................................................................................... 55
8.1. Introduction........................................................................................................................................55
8.2. RDYMSG Command ........................................................................................................................55
8.3. OPMSG Command...........................................................................................................................56
8.4. STMSG Command ...........................................................................................................................56
9. INDEX.................................................................................................................................................... 58
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
1.
INTRODUCTION
1.1. About PJL
Printer Job Language(PJL) provides job status control by sending the printer status information to the
application. PJL can be a valuable tool for the single-user environment, but is a much more useful tool for the
networking / sharing environment.
PJL
Emulations ( BR-Script,
PCL, IBM, EPSON etc... )
Printer
PJL allows job-level control that cannot be accomplished with PCL, Postscript or other emulations. PJL
includes five major features.
(1)
Printer language switching
With PJL, it is possible to switch positively between the printer languages such as PCL, Postscript, Epson,
IBM and Diablo directly from applications.
(2)
Printer status readback
PJL can provide information such as printer model, configuration, printer feature setting, error information and
other status information to the application.
(3)
Front panel control
PJL can remotely control the printer's control panel settings and messages.
(4)
Easy of utilization
All PJL commands except the UEL command have a user-friendly construction using printable characters and
English words.
(5)
Spooler control
PJL provides an improved spooler which can manage the printer better, particularly in a network environment.
Note :
The commands for Printer status readback or Front panel control can be invoked in modes other than PCL
or BR-Script. However, the commands for printer status readback get the information from PCL or BR-
Script and the commands for front panel control perform the settings for PCL or BR-Script.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
1.2. In Case of Using PJL with a Non-PJL Printer
Our recent printer models support PJL, however, earlier models do not . If the PJL commands are sent to a
non-PJL printer, the printer acts as follows;
1.2.1. PCL jobs
For a PCL printer which does not support the PJL language, the PJL command is printed as ASCII text until
initial PCL printer reset command (<ESC>E) is received. After receiving the PCL reset command, the printer
ejects the page and proceeds with the PCL print job on a new page.
The print job is possibly followed by more printed PJL commands.
Without the PCL reset command, the PJL commands are printed as ASCII text on the same page as the PCL
print job.
1.2.2. Postscript jobs
For Postscript printers, when the printer receives a PJL command, a Postscript error is reported. The
Postscript job is discarded.
1.2.3. Other printer languages
According to the active emulation, the PJL command is understood differently. To avoid the problem, you
should not use PJL commands on any non-PJL printer.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
1.3. PJL Syntax and Format
Syntax
<For Example>
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = emulation [<CR>]<LF>
@PJL
PJL Prefix
ENTER
Command name
Option name
LANGUAGE
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE
[ ]
Enter this portion verbatim
The words in brackets [ ... ] indicates optional parameters. You should not
type the brackets themselves in the command.
< .. >
<LF>
The words in < .. > indicates a control code character
Required line feed
< HT >
< LF >
< CR >
< SP >
< ESC >
< FF >
< WS >
Horizontal tab character (ASCII 9)
Line feed character ( ASCII 10 )
Carriage Return ( ASCII 13 )
Space ( ASCII 32 )
Escape ( ASCII 27 )
Form Feed ( ASCII 12 )
White space which consists of some < SP >
and < HT >
< words >
Printable characters
Format
PJL commands have 4 types of formats as shown below.
Format 1 <ESC>%-12345X
This format is only used for the Universal Exit Language(UEL) command.
Format 2 @PJL[<CR>]<LF>
This format allows a PJL line without a command, and is used to break several PJL command lines visually, to
make it easier to see the PJL command lines.
Format 3 @PJL command [<words>] [<CR>] <LF>
This format is used only for the COMMENT and ECHO commands.
Format 4 @PJL command [command modifier : value]
option=value[<CR>]<LF>
This format is used for all other PJL commands.
PJL Syntax Rules:
PJL Syntax should be written according to the following rules.
·
·
"@PJL" must be uppercase. The other words of a PJL command are not case-sensitive.
Spacing between characters consists of one or more of either the space character (ASCII 32) or the
horizontal tab character(ASCII 9).
·
White space should be placed as follows, depending on the location within the command.
w
White space must be placed between @PJL and the PJL command name and between the PJL command
and command modifiers.
w
w
If a white space is placed in any other place in a command, it is optional.
If a white space is not placed between two portions of a command, the command is not valid.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
1.4. Variables
PJL can use alphanumeric variables, numeric variabless and strings.
1.4.1. Alphanumeric variables
The first character must always be a character in the allowable range of letters and digits. Letters consists
of the uppercase characters (ASCII 65-90) and lowercase characters (ASCII 97-122). Digits consists of the
numbers 0-9 (ASCII 48-57).
<Example>
Brother2245
1.4.2. Numeric variables
The number consists of digits with one optional decimal point and an optional + or - sign preceding the
first digit.
<Example>
0.1234
<Wrong>
-123.4
+123.0
+.05
-.05
1.4.3. Strings
Strings consist of any combination of characters from ASCII 32 to 255, plus ASCII 9, except ASCII 34
(quotation marks), which are used to define the start and end of a string.
<Example>
"Print Job KKK"
"This is a sample string"
1.5. Invalid Commands
There are two general types of invalid commands. Each type operates differently.
Syntax errors include :
· unrecognized command and command modifier
· strings which are missing quotation marks
· numeric values which are missing digits before the decimal point
1.5.1. Syntax errors
Commands received with Syntax errors cause the printer to ignore the entire PJL command.
1.5.2. Syntax warning and semantic warning
Syntax warnings and semantic warnings are issued for commands which include unsupported options, values
which are out of range, or wrong or missing commands, etc. When the printer receives commands which
would create a syntax warning or semantic warning, it operates the command as long as possible, however,
the portion of the command which would create a warning is ignored.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
2.
HOW TO USE PJL
2.1. Overview
PJL resides "above" printer languages such as Postscript and PCL. Each job can be distinguished from the
other jobs by PJL, and it can switch between PJL commands and printer language commands for each job.
PJL Code
PCL Job
PJL Code
Postscript Job
PJL Code
2.2. PJL Job Requirement
Some conditions are required in order for PJL commands to work correctly. Jobs which follow these
conditions will work correctly with a PJL printer in both single user and network environments.
·
·
All PJL jobs must begin and end with a UEL command.
The @PJL prefix must be placed immediately after the UEL command which starts PJL jobs, and can be
followed by <CR> and <LF>. Characters, including control characters, must not be placed between the UEL
command and the @PJL prefix.
·
·
Nothing must be placed after the UEL command which ends a PJL job.
<LF> is required to terminate all PJL commands. <CR> can be placed before <LF>, however, <CR> is
optional and is ignored.
·
Blank lines must not exist. If a blank line is required, the @PJL <CR><LF> line can be used.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.
COMMAND GROUP
Command Group
Command
Command Description
Kernel Commands
UEL
Exits current printer language and returns control
to PJL.
EXECUTE
Orders the printer to execute the specified
operation.
SUPERUSER
SUPERUSEROFF
WNVRAM
Moves to the SUPERUSER mode.
Exit from the SUPERUSER mode.
Write the specified data to the specified address
of the printer’s NVRAM.
RNVRAM
Retrieve the data from the specified address of the
printer’s NVRAM.
COMMENT
ENTER
JOB
Comments can be placed in the command line
Selects a printer language
Informs printer of job start
Job Separation
Commands
EOJ
DEFAULT
Informs printer of job end
Sets default value
Environment
Commands
SET
Sets an environment value which is available
during a PJL job
INITIALIZE
Resets the current and default PJL variables to
factory values
RESET
INQUIRE
Resets current PJL variables to default values
Requests the current value for a specified
environment
Status Readback
Commands
DINQUIRE
Requests the default value for a specified
environment
ECHO
INFO
USTATUS
Returns the <words> to the host computer
Requests a specified category.
Allows the printer to send unsolicited status
information
USTATUSOFF
RDYMSG
OPMSG
Stops the printer sending all unsolicited status
information
Replaces the READY message on the control
panel
Displays altered message on the control panel and
takes the printer off-line
Device Attendance
Commands
STMSG
Displays altered message on the control panel and
takes the printer off-line. If status readback is
enabled, returns name of the key.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.
KERNEL COMMANDS
4.1. Introduction
This section explains three PJL command, UEL, ENTER and COMMENT. These commands provide the
minimum set of tools to operate job control.
UEL command (Universal Exit Command)
ENTER command
COMMENT command
4.2. UEL Command
The Universal Exit Command causes the printer to exit the current printer language and sets the printer into
PJL mode.
Syntax
<ESC>%-12345X
·
·
The UEL command is a data stream sequence.
The UEL command indicates to the current printer language to finish a job. If PJL is available, PJL commands
which have not yet been executed are cancelled and the printer is ready to accept the next PJL command.
·
·
The UEL command must be placed in the first and last position of all PJL job command sequences.
Printers which have an Automatic I/O switching feature can use the UEL command in order to set job
boundaries.
·
·
·
The @PJL prefix which is placed at the beginning of a PJL job must follow immediately after the UEL
command .
If the printer receives codes other than the PJL prefix, it enables the default printer language and prints the
job.
ENTER command should be used in order to specify the printer language.
Example
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>
<ESC>E.......PCL JOB........<ESC>E
<ESC>%-12345X
4.3. EXECUTE Command
The EXECUTE command orders the printer to execute the specified operation.
This command is supported only by HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500 printers.
Syntax
@PJL ENTER operation [<CR>]<LF>
Parameters
·
operation
SHUTDOWN : The printer goes into sleep mode.
DEMOPAGE :
RESIFONT :
PERMFONT:
PRTCONFIG:
The printer prints the demo page.
The printer prints the list of resident fonts.
The printer prints the list of permanent download fonts.
The printer prints the list of printer settings.
·
·
If the printer receives this command, it immediately executes the specified operation.
If this command specifies an operation which is not supported, this command is ignored.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Example
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>
@PJL EXECUTE DEMOPAGE <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
4.4. ENTER Command
The ENTER command specifies which emulation the printer uses to print data.
Syntax
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = emulation [<CR>]<LF>
Parameters
·
emulation
The variables depend on the printer model.
·
·
·
The ENTER command must be placed immediately before print data.
The specified emulation will be used immediately after the terminating <LF> of the ENTER command.
If the printer does not receive the ENTER command, it uses the default printer language which is set by the
control panel or the printer language which is set by the SET PERSONALITY command.
·
·
When a printer emulation is selected by the ENTER command, the printer must switch to the defined printer
language.
If this command specifies an emulation which is not supported, data after this command is ignored until the
next UEL command.
Example
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>
<ESC>E.......PCL JOB........<ESC>E
<ESC>%-12345X
@PJL COMMENT Start of Postscript job <CR><LF>
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = POSTSCRIPT <CR><LF>
%!PS-ADOBE......Postscript JOB.....^D
<ESC>%-12345X
@PJL COMMENT End of Postscript job <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
4.5. COMMENT Command
The COMMENT command is used to add an information line, such as an explanation for the PJL command.
Syntax
@PJL COMMENT remarks [<CR>]<LF>
Parameters
·
remarks
Printable characters (ASCII 33-255) and White space which contains <HT> and <SP>)
·
·
The COMMENT command is helpful for placing an explanation of a PJL command.
The COMMENT command can be placed on the PJL line anywhere between the UEL command and the
ENTER command.
·
·
The COMMENT command is terminated by <LF>.
Comments can only be one line long. If you wish to add more text, start a new comment line.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Example
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT -----------------------------<CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT -- PCL & PS JOB --<CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT -----------------------------<CR><LF>
@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL SET RET = ON <CR><LF>
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>
<ESC>E.......PCL JOB........<ESC>E
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT Start of Postscript job <CR><LF>
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = POSTSCRIPT <CR><LF>
%!PS-ADOBE......Postscript JOB.....^D
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT End of Postscript job <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
4.6. Printer Language Switching
There are three methods of switching printer languages.
4.6.1. Explicit switching
Explicit switching means the method which uses the PJL ENTER LANGUAGE command to switch to the
desired emulation. As the desired emulation is explicitly specified, this method is the most reliable.
4.6.2. Implicit switching
If a default printer language is configured, and the PJL ENTER command is not described on a PJL line, the
printer uses the default printer emulation. This may not always select your desired emulation.
4.6.3. Context switching
If the printer is set to 'automatic emulation selection' and the PJL ENTER command is not described in the PJL
command, the printer investigates the incoming data and decides the required printer emulation. The printer
can select the printer language by this switching, however, the PJL ENTER command is recommended to
select the printer language accurately.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.
JOB SEPARATION COMMANDS
5.1. Introduction
This section explains two PJL command, JOB and EOJ. These commands are used to determine the
boundaries of a job. When these commands are used with status readback, the printer also can send status
information at the beginning and end of each job.
5.2. JOB Command
The JOB Command sends information at the start of a PJL job to the printer and aligns the job with the page
status information. It also specifies which pages of a job are to be printed.
Note:
JOB and EOJ command are always used in pairs. You must not use one without the other.
Syntax
@PJL JOB [NAME = "job name"][START = first page] [END = last page]
[PASSWORD = "password"][<CR>]<LF>
·
·
·
NAME = "job name"
This option NAME describes the print job as a job name. Printable characters (ASCII 33-255) and spaces or
horizontal tab characters can be used for the job name. It can contain 80 characters max. and must be
enclosed in double quotes. If the NAME option is set, the job name is included in the unsolicited job.
START = first page
This option START is used to provide a non-printing mode. You can specify from which page printing is to
start. If the START option is not set, the printer starts printing at the beginning of the job.
first page = 1 to 2,147,483,647 Default value = 1
END = last page
The END option indicates the page number of the last page to be printed. If the END option is not set, the
printer prints to the end of the job. If the end of job is encountered before the START page, no pages are
printed. If the end of job is encountered before the END page, printing terminates.
last page = 1 to 2,147,483,647 Default value = prints entire job
·
PASSWORD = password ( HL-1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN only )
When the password is set by the DEFAULT command, modifying the NVRAM by using the DEFAULT or
INITIALIZE commands is locked with the password. Sending the correct password with this command can
unlock this until the EOJ command is executed.
password = 0 to 65,535 Default value = 0
When the printer receives the JOB command, the UEL command is not recognized as a job boundary until an
EOJ command is received.
·
If the UEL command is placed between the PJL JOB and EOJ commands, it is handled as a printer language
reset. In this case, UEL resets the printer environment to the PJL Current environment, not to the User
Default Environment.
·
·
If your application supports status readback capabilities, you can monitor the job status by the USTATUS
command with the JOB option.
If job status is available and a JOB command is received, the printer returns a job status message.
Note:
Resetting the page count according to unsolicited page status information does not affect the current page.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Example
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>
@PJL JOB NAME = "KKK data from spooler" <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT Postscript Job <CR><LF>
@PJL JOB NAME = "YYY data from spooler 2" <CR><LF>
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = POSTSCRIPT <CR><LF>
%!PS.......PS JOB........^D
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>
@PJL EOJ NAME = "End of YYY data" <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>
<ESC>E.........PCL JOB........<ESC>E
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL EOJ NAME = "End of KKK" <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
5.3. EOJ Command
The EOJ command indicates to the printer that the job is completed. You must use this command whenever
you use the JOB command.
Note:
JOB and EOJ command always are used in pairs. You must not use one without the other.
Syntax
@PJL EOJ [NAME = "job name"] [<CR>]<LF>
·
NAME = "job name"
The EOJ command can name the print job. The job name is a string and must be enclosed in double quotes in
the command syntax. The job name need not be same as the "job name" of the JOB command. If the NAME
option is described, the unsolicited end-of-job status includes the job name. Job names can use printable
characters (ASCII 33-255) and spaces or horizontal tab characters up to a maximum of 80 characters.
·
·
·
·
·
The EOJ command indicates the end of a job.
Resets the PJL Current Environment variables to the default values.
Terminates the non-printing mode.
When the EOJ command is received, the printer returns unsolicited job status information.
The EOJ command resets the page number associated with unsolicited page status.
Example
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>
@PJL JOB NAME = "KKK data from spooler" <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT Postscript Job <CR><LF>
@PJL JOB NAME = "YYY data from spooler 2" <CR><LF>
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = POSTSCRIPT <CR><LF>
%!PS.......PS JOB........^D
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>
@PJL EOJ NAME = "End of YYY data" <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>
<ESC>E.........PCL JOB........<ESC>E
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>
@PJL EOJ NAME = "End of KKK" <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.
ENVIRONMENT COMMANDS
6.1. Introduction
Our recent printers have many features which you are able to set using printer commands, through the printer
control panel or by using the remote printer console program. A combination of PJL commands and printer
emulation commands allows you to set printer features to the desired state.
This chapter describes the setting of printer features known as printer environments, PJL commands you are
able to use to set printer features to a desired state are as follows;
·
·
·
·
DEFAULT
Set the default value for environment variables. (storing them in non volatile RAM , so called NV-RAM)
INITIALIZE
Reset the current and default PJL variables to the factory default values
RESET
Reset the current PJL values to the default values
SET
Set an environment variable to a specified value until the next PJL reset condition.
6.1.1. Print environment
The printer constantly maintains four environments, which are listed below in priority order
1.
Factory Default Environment
These environment setting values are permanently stored in the printer. The printer uses these settings when
it is powered on for the first time after shipping from the factory, and after the
@PJL INITIALIZE command is performed.
2.
User Default Environment
These environment setting values are stored in the printer's NV-RAM and can be altered through the printer's
control panel or by using the Remote Printer Console software or the @PJL DEFAULT command. These
values are placed into the PJL Current Environment following any PJL reset condition.
3.
PJL Current Environment
These environment setting values contain the current PJL feature settings. Current settings are based on the
User Default values and include any settings modified by the @PJL SET command. These settings are
changed to the User Default values when a PJL reset occurs.
4.
Modified Print Environment
These environment settings become active just after a printer language is entered. At that time, the PJL
Current environment values are loaded into the Modified Print Environment and act as a base set of features.
Then, Printer language commands are used to change or modify feature settings to the desired state.
Whenever an emulation is activated or a reset command is received (a reset command includes any printer
language reset or PJL reset), the PJL Current environment settings are loaded into the Modified Print
environment.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
The diagram below illustrates how the environments interact and how the modified print environment is
affected.
FACTORYDEFAULT ENVIRONMENT
@PJL INITIALIZE
CONTROL PANEL
USER DEFAULT ENVIRONMENT
OR @PJL DEFAULT
@PJL RESET
@PJL SET
PJL CURRENT ENVIRONMENT
LANGUAGE RESET, @PJL ENTER, OR ANY LANGUAGE SWITCH
MODIFIED PRINT ENVIRONMENT
6.1.2. PJL reset conditions
The result of PJL reset condition is different from that of a printer language reset (for example, ESC E). Printer
language reset loads the PJL Current Environment values into the Modified Print Environment. PJL reset
conditions load the User Default values into the PJL Current Environment, which are then loaded into the
Modified Print Environment.
PJL reset occurs on the following events.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Power on
UEL command (when not between a JOB and EOJ command pair)
@ PJL INITIALIZE command
@ PJL RESET command
@ PJL JOB or EOJ command
Other printer-specific events
Reset from Control Panel
Language specific exit command
Emulation switching command
6.1.3. Remember these points about environments
Remember the following points when you use PJL to set the printer to a desired state.
1. The current feature settings are the same as the control panel values ( or values in the remote printer
console program) when beginning a PJL job.
2. The current feature settings (Modified Print Environment) become the same as the PJL Current
Environment when the printer enters a printer language. The feature settings are modified by the printer
language command once a printer language is started. All other settings are overridden by printer
language commands.
3. The SET command changes the PJL Current Environment settings. These settings are effective until the
next PJL reset condition.
4. Control Panel settings, the remote printer console program settings or the DEFAULT command changes
the User Default Environment.
5. Printer language commands change the Modified Print Environment. These settings are effective during a
printer language job. The PJL Current Environment settings are loaded into the Modified Print
Environment by a printer language specific reset, for example, ESC E for PCL.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 16
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6. Always use the PJL RESET command after a job is completed if the SET command is used in the PJL job.
6.1.4. PJL environment variables
This section lists the PJL environment variables. There are two kinds of PJL environment variables, General
PJL environment variables and Printer language -specific variables. For all variables, except the read-only
variables, value settings can be modified using @PJL SET, @PJL RESET, @PJL DEFAULT, and @PJL
INITIALIZE.
By using the @ PJL INQUIRE and @ PJL DINQUIRE, you can request value settings for the printer features.
For the details of these commands, see the next section.
Note:
1. Use PJL commands only when no printer language commands are available for a desired feature.
2. When setting printer features with PJL, use the SET and RESET commands when you want to affect the
current PJL job only.
If you want to affect more than the current job, use the DEFAULT and INITIALIZE commands.
3. Supported variables depend on your printer model.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.2. Variables
6.2.1. Variables for HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1670N/3260N/2460
1. General PJL Environment Variables
The PJL environment variables which are not printer language-specific are listed in the following table. When
using these variables, do not use LPARM.
Variables
COPIES
Description
Sample Value Range
Number of uncollated copies for each
page of the job.
1 to 200 (HL-1050/1070)
1 to 99 (HL-
1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500)
1 to 999 (HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
ON or OFF
MANUALFEED
ECONOMODE
Feeds the paper from manual feed slot.
Turn the economy mode (toner saving
mode) ON or OFF.
ON or OFF
ECONOLEVEL
PERSONALITY
Selects the toner saving level from 1
(high) to 3 (low).
1 to 3
0 to 3
(HL-1670N/3260N/HL-2460)
Sets the emulation mode.
AUTO, PCL, IBM, EPSON,
POSTSCRIPT (All models)
HPGL (HL-3260N/2460)
1 to 15 (HL-2460)
INPUTBUF
XOFFSET
Sets the receiving buffer size value.
Sets the X offset ( horizontal offset )
value.
-500 to 500 dots
(HL-
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/
P2500/1670N/2460
-104 to 500 (HL-3260N)
-500 to 500 dots
ON or OFF
YOFFSET
Sets the Y offset ( vertical offset ) value.
Auto Continue Mode
AUTOCONT
TIMEOUTEMU
Sets the time-out value for automatic
emulation switching.
1 to 99 seconds
PRIORITY
Sets the priority between EPSON or IBM
for automatic emulation switching.
EPSON or IBM
HPFSEL
ALL, LJ4 (HL-2460)
ON or OFF
AUTOFF
Sets the auto FF setting to ON or OFF.
Sets the timeout value for auto FF.
TIMEOUTFF
TIMEOUT
1 to 99 seconds
1 to 99 seconds
Sets the timeout value for Automatic
interface switching
CDCCHIGH
DTRCTRL
Sets the high-speed transfer mode of the
Centronics interface to ON or OFF.
ON or OFF
(HL-
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/
P2500)
Selects when DTR becomes low.
0 to 2
(HL-
0 = the printer is turned off-line by the SEL
switch, the input buffer is full, or when a
printer error occurs.
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/
P2500/1670N)
1 = the printer is turned off-line by the SEL
switch or when a printer error occurs.
2 = the printer is turned off-line by the SEL
switch.
AUTOSLEEP
Sets the automatic sleep mode ON or
OFF.
ON or OFF
TIMEOUTSLEEP
Sets the timeout value for automatic
sleep mode.
1 to 00 minutes
1 to 99 minutes (HL-1670N/2460)
1 to 240 minutes (HL-3260N)
BETA or ESSZET
IBMCHARE1
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 18
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Variables
REPRINT
Description
Sample Value Range
Sets the reprint function ON or OFF.
ON or OFF
(HL-
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/
P2500)
ON, OFF or JOB
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
DEMOPRINT
Enables the Demo page printing.
ON or OFF
(HL-
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/
P2500/2460)
PAGEPROTECT
RESOLUTION
Configuration of the Page protection
mode. This mode reserves a block of
printer memory to avoid 31 PRINT
OVERRUN errors.
AUTO, OFF, LETTER, LEGAL, A4
Printer resolution setting. If the printer
can not print a large file at 600 dpi
because of insufficient memory, the
printer decreases the resolution to 300
dpi automatically
300, 600 (All models)
1200 (HL-1670N/2460)
LANG
Selects the language for the RPC
program.
ENGLISH, FRENCH, GERMAN,
DUTCH, NORWEGIAN
(HL-
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N
P2500)
ENGLISH, FRENCH, GERMAN,
DUTCH, NORWEGIAN,
SPANISH, ITALIAN, SWEDISH,
DANISH, JAPANESE
(HL-1670N)
ENGLISH, FRENCH, GERMAN,
DUTCH, SPANISH, ITALIAN,
DANISH (HL-3260N)
ENGLISH, FRENCH, GERMAN,
DUTCH, SPANISH, ITALIAN,
NORWEGIAN, DANISH,
SWEDISH (HL-2460)
KEEP PCL
If set to ON, the printer keeps the
permanent fonts and macros of PCL
when the emulation is changed to
another mode.
ON or OFF
CONTEXTSWITCH
DOUBLESTRIKE
Auto emulation mode
ON or OFF (HL-2460)
ON or OFF
Enables bold printing in IBM or EPSON
mode
CPLOCK
Returns the lock status of the control
panel. If OFF, the control panel is
unlocked. If ON, the control panel is
locked.
OFF, ON
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
PASSWORD
Password for panel lock to write to the
0 to 65535
NVRAM with the DEFAULT/INITIALIZE (HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
command.
BIDI
ON or OFF
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
POWERSAVE
POWERSAVETIME
Sets the power save mode ON or OFF.
ON or OFF
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
Sets the time saving value for power
save mode.
1 to 99 (HL-1670N/2460)
1 to 240 (HL-3260N)
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Variables
Description
Sample Value Range
MEDIATYPE
Media Type. The temperature of fixing
unit is adjusted depending on this
setting.
REGULAR, THICK, THICK2,
THIN, BOND, TRANSPARENCY
(HL-1670N)
REGULAR, THICK,
TRANSPARENCY (HL-3260N)
REGULAR, THICK
TRANSPARENCY,THICK2,
ENVELOPES, BOND (HL-2460)
LIGHT, MEDIUM, DARK, OFF
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
OFF, ON AUTO
RET
Configuration of the High Resolution
Control hardware.
IMAGEADAPT
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
LOCKED, UNLOCKED
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
LOCKED, UNLOCKED
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
LOCKED, UNLOCKED
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
LOCKED, UNLOCKED
(HL-3260N/2460)
INTRAY 1
(Read Only)
INTRAY 2
(Read Only)
INTRAY 3
(Read Only)
INTRAY 4
(Read Only)
INTRAY 5
(Read Only)
INTRAY1SIZE
Returns the auto-selection lock status for
the MP tray.
Returns the auto-selection lock status for
the upper paper tray.
Returns the auto-selection lock status for
the optional lower paper cassette.
Returns the auto-selection lock status for
the optional lower paper cassette.
Returns the auto-selection lock status for
the optional lower paper cassette.
Selects the paper size in Tray1.
LOCKED, UNLOCKED
(HL-3260N/2460)
LETTER, LEGAL, EXECUTIVE,
A3, A4, B5, A5, A6, COM10, C5,
DL, MONARCH, LEDGER, JISB4,
LTRS, A4S, XECUTIVES, B5S (HL-
3260N)
LETTER, LEGAL, EXECUTIVE,
A4, JISB5, B5, A5, B6, A6, COM10,
DL, MONARC, C5, A4LONG,
CUSTOM
INTRAY2SIZE
INTRAY3SIZE
INTRAY4SIZE
Selects the paper size in Tray2.
Selects the paper size in Tray3.
Selects the paper size in Tray4.
LETTER, LEGAL, EXECUTIVE,
A3, A4, B5, A5, A6, COM10, C5,
DL, MONARCH, LEDGER, JISB4,
LTRS, A4S, XECUTIVES, B5S (HL-
3260N)
A4, LETTER, B5, EXECUTIVE,
ENVELOPES, LEGAL, A5, B6, A6,
A4LONG, NO CASSETTE (HL-
2460)
LETTER, LEGAL, EXECUTIVE,
A3, A4, B5, A5, A6, COM10, C5,
DL, MONARCH, LEDGER, JISB4,
LTRS, A4S, XECUTIVES, B5S (HL-
3260N)
A4, LETTER, B5, EXECUTIVE,
ENVELOPES, LEGAL, A5, B6, A6,
A4LONG, NO CASSETTE (HL-
2460)
LETTER, LEGAL, EXECUTIVE,
A3, A4, B5, A5, A6, COM10, C5,
DL, MONARCH, LEDGER, JISB4,
LTRS, A4S, XECUTIVES, B5S (HL-
3260N)
A4, LETTER, B5, EXECUTIVE,
ENVELOPES, LEGAL, A5, B6, A6,
A4LONG, NO CASSETTE (HL-
2460)
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 20
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Variables
Description
Sample Value Range
INTRAY5SIZE
Selects the paper size in Tray5.
LETTER, LEGAL, EXECUTIVE,
A3, A4, B5, A5, A6, COM10, C5,
DL, MONARCH, LEDGER, JISB4,
LTRS, A4S, XECUTIVES, B5S (HL-
3260N)
A4, LETTER, B5, EXECUTIVE,
ENVELOPES, LEGAL, A5, B6, A6,
A4LONG, NO CASSETTE (HL-
2460)
SOURCETRAY
MPTRAYSIZE
Selects the paper source tray.
AUTO, MPTRAY, TRAY1, TRAY2
(HL-1670N)
AUTO, TRAY1, TRAY2, TRAY3,
TRAY4, MPTRAY
(HL-3260N/2460)
TRAYID1, TRAYID2, TRAYID3,
TRAYID4 (HL-2460)
LETTER, LEGAL, EXECUTIVE,
A3, A4, B5, A5, A6, COM10, C5,
DL, MONARCH, LEDGER, JISB4,
LTRS, A4S, XECUTIVES, B5S (HL-
3260N)
MPTRAY
MP tray priority for AUTO feeder
selection mode.
CASSETTE, FIRST
(HL-3260N/2460)
MPPAPERIN
TRAY1SIZE
Continues printing by holding down Go
switch for manual feeding.
STOP, CONTINUE
(HL-3260N/2460)
A3, JISB4, LEDGER, A4, A4S, A5,
B5, B5S, LEGAL, LETTER, LTRS,
EXECUTIVE, EXECUTIVES (HL-
3260N)
TRAY2SIZE
TRAY3SIZE
A3, JISB4, LEDGER, A4, A4S, A5,
B5, B5S, A6, LEGAL LETTER,
LTRS, EXECUTIVE, EXECUTIVES,
COM10, C5, DL MONARCH (HL-
3260N)
<PS400 installed>
A3, JISB4, LEDGER, A4, A4S, A5,
B5S, LEGAL, LETTER, LTRS,
EXECUTIVE, EXECUTIVES
<PS420 installed>
A4, LETTER
<PS440 installed>
A3, JISB4, LEDGER, A4, A4S, A5,
B5, B5S, LEGAL, LETTER, LTRS,
EXECUTIVE, EXECUTIVES
(HL-3260N)
TRAY4SIZE
A3, JISB4, LEDGER, A4, A4S, A5,
B5, B5S, LEGAL, LETTER, LTRS,
EXECUTIVE, EXECUTIVES (HL-
3260N)
APT
ON or OFF
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
DENSITY
Returns the printing density level setting
from 1 to 15. The default value is 8.
-6, -5, -4, -3, -2, -1, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6
(HL-1670N)
-2, -1, 0, 1, 2 (HL-3260N/2460)
LOWTONER
Continues printing when the toner is low.
STOP, CONTINUE
(HL-3260N/2460)
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Variables
Description
Sample Value Range
RAS1200MODE
OFF, ON, TRUE
(HL-1670N)
PSBINARY
ON or OFF (HL-1670N/2460)
PSQUOTEBIN
ON or OFF
(HL-1670N)
DOWNFPROD
Creates bold and italic fonts from
download fonts.
ON or OFF (HL-1670N/2460)
BITMAPFPROD
Creates bold and italic fonts from bitmap
fonts.
ON or OFF (HL-1670N/2460)
OEMFONT
Enables EC font
ON or OFF (HL-1670N/2460)
ON or OFF (HL-1670N/2460)
COMPABITMAP
FSEL300DPI
LOW or HIGH
(HL-1670N)
DEFPAPER
A4, LETTER, DEFAULT
(HL-1670N/2460)
PSIMAGEMASK
ON or OFF
(HL-1670N/2460)
HPESCE
RESET, FF (HL-1670N/2460)
PROTECTOFF
AUTO, NORMAL
(HL-1670N/2460)
ISRFONT
Sets the Israeli font ON or OFF.
Selects the
ON or OFF
(HL-1670N/2460)
TRANSFER
AUTO, LOW, HIGH
(HL-1670N)
PARALLEL
FAST, SLOW
(HL-1670N)
ERRORPRINT
BOISEIDMODE
CONDENCESIZE
FXLFSETMODE
FXLFITAMODE
OFF, ON, EXCEPTCDCC
(HL-1670N)
WIN95, IEEE
(HL-1670N)
P1666, P1714
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
NORMAL, ALL
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
OBLIQUE, ITALIC
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
0, 1, 2, 3 (HL-1670N)
0 to 255 (HL-1670N)
DTRCTRL
ENVINTERVAL
PSCEILMODE
FLOOR, CEIL
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
PS300RESO
DUPLEX
NO, IF2M, FORCE
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
Duplex mode
ON or OFF
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
BINDING
Returns the setting of binding edge
selection for duplex printing.
LONGEDGE, SHORTEDGE
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
TRAYPRIORITY
MPT1T2T3T4, MPT4T3T2T1,
T1T2T3T4 MP, T4T3T2T1MP (HL-
2460)
FFSUPPRESS
ON or OFF (HL-3260N/2460)
0 to 2 (HL-2460)
LCDDENSITY
Sets the LCD angle value.
FAXRINGDELAY
FAXREDUCTION
0 to 4 (HL-3260N/2460)
AUTO, OFF, FIX90
(HL-3260N/2460)
FAXRAMSIZE
RECEIVEMODE
1 to 16 (HL-3260N/2460)
ON or OFF (HL-3260N/2460)
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 22
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
FAXINTERVAL
OFF, ON6H, ON12H, ON24H,
ON2D, ON4D, ON7D
(HL-3260N/2460)
GLPENSIZE1
GLPENSIZE2
GLPENSIZE3
GLPENSIZE4
GLPENSIZE5
GLPENSIZE6
GLPENGRAY1
1 to 16 (HL-3260N/2460)
1 to 16 (HL-3260N/2460)
1 to 16 (HL-3260N/2460)
1 to 16 (HL-3260N/2460)
1 to 16 (HL-3260N/2460)
1 to 16 (HL-3260N/2460)
G15, G30, G45, G75, G90, G100 (%)
(HL-3260N/2460)
GLPENGRAY2
GLPENGRAY3
GLPENGRAY4
GLPENGRAY5
GLPENGRAY6
G15, G30, G45, G75, G90, G100 (%)
(HL-3260N/2460)
G15, G30, G45, G75, G90, G100 (%)
(HL-3260N/2460)
G15, G30, G45, G75, G90, G100 (%)
(HL-3260N/2460)
G15, G30, G45, G75, G90, G100 (%)
(HL-3260N/2460)
G15, G30, G45, G75, G90, G100 (%)
(HL-3260N/2460)
STBBUSY
RISE, FALL (HL-2460)
RISE, FALL (HL-2460)
OFF, ON (HL-2460)
SCKBUSY
PSQUOTEBIN
DEFPAPER
A4, LETTER, DEFAULT
(HL-2460)
PICKUPRETRY
COLLATE
0 to 7 (HL-2460)
Sets the collate printing.
ON or OFF (HL-2460)
1998 to 2039 (HL-2460)
1 to 12 (HL-2460)
TIMESETYEAR
TIMESETMONTH
TIMESETDAY
TIMESETHOUR
TIMESETMIN
TIMESETSEC
TIMESTYLE
SUMMERTIME
ZONESET
1 to 31 (Hl-2460)
0 to 23 (HL-2460)
0 to 59 (HL-2460)
0 to 59 (HL-2460)
UMD, MDY, DMY (Hl-2460)
ON or OFF (HL-2460)
ON or OFF (HL-2460)
-24 to 24 (HL-2460)
TIMEZONE
OUTBIN
ALLSTACKER, ALLSORTER,
UPPER, OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN1,
OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN2,
OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN3,
OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN4,
OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN5,
OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN6,
OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN7,
OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN8,
OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN9,
OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN10
(HL-2460)
MAILBOXPROTECT
AVOIDMAILBOXFULL
TOWERFEED
ON or OFF (HL-2460)
ON or OFF (HL-2460)
0 to XX Mbyte(s)
RAMDISKSIZE
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
TRANSFERVOLT
MODE1, MODE2, MODE3,
MODE4
MODE1: Normal,
MODE2: Low,
MODE3: Middle,
MODE4: High
(HL-2460)
COLDSTARTMODE
Sets the cold start mode.
OFF, MODE1, MODE2
MODE1:
MODE2
(HL-2460)
TNCHARGETIME
TNCHARGEMODE
O9FF, SHORT, NORMAL, LONG
(HL-2460)
OFF, MODE1, MODE2, MODE3,
MDE4, MRDE5, MODE6, MODE7
(HL-2460)
FUSERSLEEPCTRL
THICKPRDLY
ON or OFF (HL-2460)
OFF, SHORT, NORMAL, LONG
(HL-2460)
BONDPRDLY
OFF, SHORT, NORMAL, LONG
(HL-2460)
FLICKER MODE
0 to 63 (HL-2460)
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 24
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
2.
PCL-Specific Variables
The following values are PCL (HP LaserJet emulation) specific and can be set and requested using PJL. These
variables must be set using the LPARM : PCL option.
Variables
PAPER
Description
Sample Value Range
Sets the paper size.
LETTER, A4, LEGAL, EXECUTIVE,
COM10, MONARCH, C5, DL,
JISB5, A4LONG (All models)
B5, DL, A5, A6, B6 (HL-1670N)
A3, B5, A5, A6, LEDGER, JISB4,
LTRS, EXECUTIVES, B5S
(HL-3260N)
B5, A5, B6, A6 (HL-2460)
ORIENTATION
LEFTMARIN
Sets the orientation.
Sets the left margin.
PORTRAIT or LANDSCAPE
0 to 126 columns (HL-1050/1070/
1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/3260
N/2460)
0 to 145 columns (HL-1670N)
RIGHTMARGIN
Sets the right margin
0 to 136 columns (HL-1050/1070/
1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500)
10 to 155 columns (HL-1670N)
10 to 136 columns
(HL-3260N/2460)
TOPMARGIN
BOTMARGIN
FORMLINES
FONTSOURCE
Sets the top margin
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch
5 to 128 lines
Sets the bottom margin.
Sets the number of lines.
Sets the font source to Internal
fonts or Permanent Soft Fonts
I or S (HL-
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/
P2500/1670N)
I, C1, C2, S (HL-3260N/2460)
FONTNUMBER
Sets the font number
0 to n (HL-
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/
P2500)
0 to 0x7FFFFFFF
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
PITCH
Pitch of the default font in units of
characters per inch. The pitch value
can be specified to two decimal
places
0.44, 0.45,.......99.99
PTSIZE
Height of the default font in units of
points. The point size can be
4.00, 4.25, .......999.75
specified to a quarter of a point
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
SYMSET
Sets the symbol set.
ROMAN8, ISOL1, ISOL2, ISOL5,
PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC852, PC8TK,
WINL1, WINL2, WINL5,
DESKTOP, PSTEXT, VNINTL,
VNUS, MSPUBL, MATH8,
PSMATH, VNMATH, PIFONT,
LEGAL, ISO2, ISO4, ISO6, ISO10,
ISO11, ISO 14, ISO15, ISO16, ISO17,
ISO21, ISO 25, ISO 57, ISO60,
ISO61, ISO69, ISO84, ISO85,
WIN30, HPGERM, HPSPAN,
MCTEXT (All models )
OCRA, OCRB, SYMBOL, WDINGS
(HL-1050/1070/
1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1670
N)
PC1004, WINBALT, ISOL6, PC775
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
HERBREW7 (HL-1670N)
ON or OFF
AUTOLF
Sets AUTO LF
AUTOCR
Sets AUTO CR
Sets AUTO WRAP
Sets AUTO SKIP
ON or OFF
AUTOWRAP
AUTOSKIP
ON or OFF
ON or OFF
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 26
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.
EPSON-Specific Variables
The following values are EPSON (EPSON FX-850 emulation) specific and can be set and requested using PJL.
These variables must be set using the LPARM : EPSON option.
Variables
PAPER
Description
Sample Value Range
Sets the paper size.
LETTER, A4, LEGAL, B5,
EXECUTIVE, COM10, MONARCH,
C5, DL, JISB5, A4LONG (All
models)
A5, A6, B6 (HL-1670N/2460)
A3, A5, A6, LEDGER, JISB4, LTRS,
EXECUTIVES, B5S (HL-3260N)
ORIENTATION
LEFTMARIN
Sets the orientation.
Sets the left margin
PORTRAIT, LANDSCAPE
0 to 126 (HL-1050/1070/1250/
1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/3260N/246
0)
0 to 145 (HL-1670N)
RIGHTMARGIN
Sets the right margin
0 to 136 (HL-1050/1070/1250/
1270N/1450/1470N/P2500)
10 to 155 (HL-1670N)
10 to 136 (HL-3260N/2460)
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch
5 to 128 lines
TOPMARGIN
BOTMARGIN
FORMLINES
FONTSOURCE
Sets the top margin
Sets the bottom margin.
Sets the number of lines.
Sets the font source to Internal
fonts or Permanent Soft Fonts
I C1, C2, S (HL-3260N/2460)
FONTNUMBER
Sets the font number
0 to n (HL-
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/
P2500)
0 to 0x7FFFFFFF
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)
PITCH
Pitch of the default font in units of
characters per inch. The pitch value
can be specified to two decimal
places
0.44, 0.45, .......99.99
PTSIZE
Height of the default font in units
of points. The point size can be
specified to a quarter of a point
4.00, 4.25, .......999.75
SYMSET
Sets the symbol set.
USASCII, GERMAN, UKASCI1,
FRENCH1, DANISH1, ITALY,
SPANISH, SWEDISH, JAPAN,
NORWEG, DANISH2, UKASCI2,
FRENCH2, DUTCH, SAFRICA,
PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC852, PC860,
PC863, PC865, PC8TK (All models)
SYMBOL, WDINGS, OCRA, OCRB
(HL-1050/1070/1250/
1270N/1450/1470N/P2500)
UKASCIT1, JAPANESE,
NORWEGIAN, UKASCIT2,
SOUTHAFRICAN (HL-1670N)
USASCII, GERMAN, UKASCII1,
FRENCH1, DANISH1, ITALY
SPANISH, SWEDISH, JAPANESE,
NORWEGIAN, DANISH2,
UKASCII2, FRENCH2, DUTCH,
SOUTHAFRICAN, PC8, PC8DN,
PC850, PC852, PC860, PC863, PC865,
PC8TK (HL-3260N/2460)
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 27
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
AUTOLF
Sets AUTO LF
ON or OFF
ON or OFF
ON or OFF
AUTOMASK
SELREADOUT
Sets AUTO MASK
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 28
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.
IBM-Specific Variables
The following values are IBM (IBM Proprinter XL emulation) specific and can be set and requested using PJL.
These variables must be set using the LPARM : IBM option.
Variables
PAPER
Description
Sample Value Range
Sets the paper size.
LETTER, A4, LEGAL, B5,
EXECUTIVE, COM10, MONARCH,
C5, DL, JISB5, A4LONG (All
models)
A5, A6, B6 (HL-1670N/2460)
A3, A5, A6, LEDGER, JISB4, LTRS,
EXECUTIVES B5S (HL-3260N)
ORIENTATION
LEFTMARIN
Sets the orientation.
Sets the left margin
PORTRAIT, LANDSCAPE
0 to 126 (HL-1050/1070/1250/
1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/3260N/246
0)
0 to 145 (HL-1670N)
RIGHTMARGIN
Sets the right margin
0 to 136 (HL-1050/1070/1250/
1270N/1450/1470N/P2500)
10 to 155 (HL-1670N)
10 to 136 (HL-3260N/2460)
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch
5 to 128 lines
TOPMARGIN
BOTMARGIN
FORMLINES
FONTSOURCE
Sets the top margin
Sets the bottom margin.
Sets the number of lines.
Sets the font source to Internal
fonts or Permanent Soft Fonts
I, C1, C2, S (HL-3260N)
FONTNUMBER
Sets the font number
0 to n (HL-
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/
P2500)
0 to 0x7FFFFFFF
(HL-1670N/3260N)
PITCH
Pitch of the default font in units of
characters per inch. The pitch value
can be specified to two decimal
places
0.44, 0.45, .......99.99
PTSIZE
Height of the default font in units of
points. The point size can be
4.00, 4.25, .......999.75
specified to a quarter of a point
SYMSET
Sets the symbol set.
PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC852, PC860,
PC863, PC865, PC8TK (All models)
OCRA, OCRB, SYMBOL, WDINGS
(HL-1050/1070/1250/
1270N/1450/1470N/P2500)
PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC852, PC860,
PC863, PC865, PC8TK (HL-
3260N/2460)
AUTOLF
Sets AUTO LF
ON or OFF
ON or OFF
ON or OFF
AUTOCR
Sets AUTO CR
Sets AUTO MASK
AUTOMASK
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 29
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.
PostScript-Specific Variables
The following values are PostScript ( BR-Script ) specific and can be set and requested using PJL. The BR-
Script mode is standard in some models but may be available only when the optional BR-Script 2 ROM board
is installed into the printer. These variables must be set using the LPARM : IBM option.
Variables
PAPER
Description
Sample Value Range
Sets the paper size.
LETTER, A4, LEGAL, B5,
EXECUTIVE, COM10, MONARCH,
C5, DL, JISB5, A4LONG (All models)
A5, A6, B6 (HL-1670N/2460)
A3, A5, A6, LEDGER, JISB4, LTRS,
A4S, EXECUTIVES, B5S
(HL-3260N)
ORIENTATION
PRTPSERRS
Sets the orientation.
PORTRAIT, LANDSCAPE
ON or OFF
The printing of a PostScript error
page is enabled or disabled by this
variable
CRLFCONV
When set to ON, CR codes in the
PostScript data are converted to LF
codes.
ON or OFF
ON or OFF
(HL-1050/1070/
1250/1270N/1450/1
470N/
P2500)
APPLETALKPS
When set to ON, the printer fixes
the emulation to BR-Script 2 mode
for accepting data from AppleTalk.
When set to OFF, the printer's auto
emulation switching function
judges the emulation.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 30
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.
HPGL-Specific Variables
The following values are HPGL (HP LaserJet emulation) specific and can be set and requested using PJL.
These variables must be set using the LPARM: HPGL option.
Variables
PAPER
Description
Sample Value Range
Sets the paper size.
LETTER, LEGAL, EXECUTIVE, A4,
JISB5, B5, A5, B6, A6, COM10, DL,
MONARCH, C5, A4LONG (HL-
3260N/2460)
A3, LEGER, JISB4, LTRS, A4S,
EXECUTIVES, B5S
(HL-3260N)
ORIENTATION
SYMSET
Sets the orientation.
Sets the symbol set.
PORTRAIT or LANDSCAPE
(HL-3260N/2460)
ANSIASCII, CHRSET9825,
FRENCHGERMAN,
SCANDINAVIAN,
SPANISHLATIN, JISASCII,
ROMAN8EXT, ISOIRV,
ISOSWEDISH, ISOSWEDISHN,
ISONORWAY1, ISOGERMAN,
ISOFRENCH, ISOUK,
ISOITALIAN, ISOSPANISH,
ISOPORTUGUESE, ISONORWAY2
(HL-3260N/2460)
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 31
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.2.2. Variables for HL-1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN
1. General PJL Environment Variables
The PJL environment variables which are not printer language-specific are listed in the following table. When
using these valuables, do not use the LPARM command.
Variables
COPIES
Description
Sample Value Range
1 to 999
Number of uncollated copies for
each page of the job.
Paper size.
PAPER
LETTER, LEGAL, A4, EXECTIVE,
COM 10, MONARCH, C5, DL, B5, A5,
A6, B6,
ORIENTATION
FORMLINES
MANUALFEED
RET
Page orientation.
Number of lines per page.
Manual feed mode.
PORTRAIT, LANDSCAPE
5 to 128
ON, OFF
Configuration of the High
Resolution Control hardware.
Configuration of the Page
protection mode. This mode
reserves a block of printer memory
to avoid 31 PRINT OVERRUN
errors.
Printer resolution setting. If the
printer cannot print a large file at
600 dpi because of insufficient
memory, the printer decreases the
resolution to 300 dpi automatically
Personality (emulation) can be
switched with the @ PJL ENTER
command or ESC CR ## command.
If the AUTO option is selected
(factory default), the printer senses
the data from the computer and
switches the emulation
LIGHT, MEDIUM, DARK, OFF
PAGEPROTECT
RESOLUTION
PERSONALITY
AUTO, OFF, LETTER, LEGAL, A4
300, 600
AUTO, PCL , POSTSCRIPT, IBM,
EPSON, HPGL
automatically.
TIMEOUT
The time out is the duration during
which another automatic emulation
change is not allowed. Duration of
the timeout is set in seconds.
Returns the configuration of the
Continue mode.
Returns the configuration for
TONER EMPTY message action. If
STOP, the printer stops printing. If
CONTINUE, the printer continues
printing.
1 to 99
AUTOCONT
LOWTONER
ON, OFF
CONTINUE, STOP
INTRAY 1
(Read Only)
INTRAY 2
(Read Only)
INTRAY 3
(Read Only)
Returns the auto-selection lock
status for the MP tray.
LOCKED, UNLOCKED
LOCKED, UNLOCKED
LOCKED, UNLOCKED
Returns the auto-selection lock
status for the upper paper tray.
Returns the auto-selection lock
status for the optional lower paper
cassette.
INTRAY1SIZE
(Read Only)
Returns the size of the paper
currently installed in the standard
paper tray.
LETTER, LEGA L, A4, EXECTIVE,
COM10, MONARCH, C5, DL, B5, A5,
A6, B6
INTRAY2SIZE
(Read Only)
Returns the size of the paper
currently installed in the lower
paper tray.
LETTER, LEGAL, A4, EXECTIVE,
COM10, MONARCH, C5, DL, B5, A5,
A6, B6
INTRAY3SIZE
(Read Only)
Returns the size information for the
optional lower paper cassette.
LETTER, LEGAL, A4, EXECTIVE,
COM10, MONARCH, C5, DL, B5, A5,
A6, B6
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 32
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Variables
DUPLEX
BINDING
Description
Sample Value Range
ON, OFF
Duplex mode
Returns the setting of binding edge
selection for duplex printing.
LONGEDGE, SHORTEDGE
FIRSTPRINT
First print mode. This makes the
first print speed faster by starting
the polygon mirror motor at Power
On. Setting to MIDDLE is effective
only for the first page after Power
ON. Setting to HIGH makes the
scanner motor rotate continuously.
NORMAL, MIDDLE, HIGH
DENSITY
LANG
Returns the printing density level
setting from 1 to 15. The default
value is 8.
1 (lighter) to 15 (darker)
Returns the language for control
panel and status readback
information.
ENGLISH, FRENCH, GERMAN,
DUTCH, SPANISH, ITALIAN,
FINNISH, NORWEGIAN,
PORTUGUESE, DANISH
CPLOCK
Returns the lock status of the
control panel. If OFF, the control
panel is unlocked. If ON, the control
panel is locked.
OFF, ON
PASSWORD
Password for panel lock to write to
the NVRAM with the
0 to65535
DEFAULT/INITIALIZE command.
ECONOMODE
ECONOLEVEL
Toner Saving Mode
OFF, ON
1, 2
Level for Toner saving mode. If set
to 1, approx. 50 % toner is saved. If
set to 2, approx. 25% toner is saved.
MPTRAY
MP Tray Priority For AUTO feeder
selection mode.
CASSETTE, FIRST
AUTOSLEEP
Power Save Mode
ON, OFF
1 to 99
TIMEOUTSLEEP
Timeout for Power Save mode. The
printer goes into the power save
mode after this time-out period
(minutes).
MEDIATYPE
HUMIDITY
Media Type. The temperature of
fixing unit is adjusted depending on
this setting.
REGULAR, THICK,
TRANSPARENCY
Depending on this setting, the fixing LOW, HIGH
voltage of the printer is adjusted.
COLLATE *
HOLD *
Sets collated printing.
ON, OFF
Specifies whether the received data
is stored in the hard disk or printed.
PROOF, STORE
HOLDTYPE *
Specifies the document type of the
received data which has been stored
in the optional hard disk. If
PRIVATE is selected, a password is
required for the data to be printed or
deleted.
PUBLIC, PRIVATE
HOLDKEY *
Specifies the password when the
document type is set to PRIVATE.
0 to 9 (4 digits to be selected)
TIMESETYEAR *
Clock: year setting
1998 to 2039
1 to 12
TIMESETMONTH
*
Clock: month setting
TIMESETDAY *
TIMESETHOUR *
Clock: date setting
Clock: hour setting
1 to 31
0 to 23
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 33
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Variables
Description
Sample Value Range
0 to 59
TIMESETMIN *
TIMESETSEC *
TIMESTYLE *
Clock: minute setting
Clock: second setting
Sets the display style of the clock.
0 to 59
YMD (YYYY/MM/DD hh/mm), MDY
(MM/DD/YYYY hh/mm), DMY
(DD/MM/YYYY hh/mm)
SUMMERTIME *
ZONESET *
Clock: summer time setting
Clock: time zone setting
OFF, ON
OFF, ON
-24 to +24
TIMEZONE *
Clock: time setting of time zone
NOTE:
The variables marked * are available for HL-2400Ce and HL-3400CN only.
2. PCL-Specific Variables
The following values are PCL (HP LaserJet emulation) specific and can be set and requested using PJL. These
variables must be set using the LPARM : PCL option.
Variables
Description
Sample Value Range
I, C, C1, S,
FONTSOURCE
The valid values for FONTSOURCE
are
I (Internal Fonts)
C (Cartridge Fonts)
C1 (Card Fonts)
S (Permanent Soft Fonts)
If the specified value becomes
invalid, it is automatically changed
to the default value.
FONTNUMBER
Font number. This value can be
seen on the Print Font Test selected
from the Control Panel. This value
is automatically changed to the
lowest value whenever the
0, 1, 2, ..n
FONTSOURCE setting is changed.
PITCH
Pitch of the default font in units of
characters per inch. The pitch value
can be specified to two decimal
places
0.44, 0.45,
99.99
PTSIZE
Height of the default font in units of
points. The point size can be
4.00, 4.25, .......999.75
specified to a quarter of a point
SYMSET
Symbol set
ROMAN8, ISOL1, ISOL2, ISOL5, PC8,
PC8DN, PC850, PC852, PC8TK, WINL1,
WINL2, WINL5, DESKTOP, PSTEXT,
VNINTL, VNUS, MSPUBL, MATH8,
PSMATH, VNMATH, PIFONT, LEGAL,
ISO2, ISO4, ISO6, ISO10, ISO11, ISO 14,
ISO15, ISO16, ISO17, ISO21, ISO 25, ISO 57,
ISO60, ISO61, ISO69, ISO84, ISO85, WIN30,
HPGERM, HPSPAN, MCTEXT
3.
PostScript-Specific Variable
The currently defined PostScript specific variable is listed as follows. This variable can be set using the
LPARM : POSTSCRIPT option.
Variable
Description
Sample Value Range
OFF, ON
PRTPSERRS
The printing of a PostScript error
page is enabled or disabled by this
variable
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 34
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.3. Default Command
The DEFAULT command changes the User-Default environment which is stored in NV-RAM and it is
activated following a PJL reset condition. The current print environment is not affected by the DEFAULT
command, but when a PJL reset condition happens, this command takes effect. This doesn't change the
current print environment, but is activated when a PJL reset condition happens.
It is recommended to restrict the use of the DEFAULT command when the printer is shared by several users
such as in a network environment. This allows use of the standard print environment and avoids changing
default features for each print job. If you have to change the default for a particular print job, use the SET
command.
Syntax
@PJL DEFAULT [LPARM : personality] variable = value [<CR>]<LF>
·
·
LPARM : Personality
This optional parameter is used to set personality-specific (emulation) environment variables.
variable = Value
This parameter is used to set one of the environment variables to the specified value. For example, the @
PJL DEFAULT RESOLUTION = 300 command sets the user-default resolution to 300 dpi. Use the @PJL
INFO VARIABLES command to obtain valid variables and the range of values for each variable. This
command can request the information directly from the printer.
Example
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT Control Panel Defaults <CR><LF>
@PJL DEFAULT PAGEPROTECT = LEGAL <CR><LF>
@PJL DEFAULT LPARM : PCL SYMSET = PC850 <CR><LF>
@PJL RESET <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
6.4. Initialize Command
The INITIALIZE command resets the PJL Current Environment and User Default Environment variables to the
Factory Default values. I/O configuration values and the unsolicited status settings are not affected by this
command.
It is recommended to restrict the use of the INITIALIZE command when the printer is shared by several users
such as in a networking environment in order to use a standard environment and avoid having default
features changed by different print jobs.
Syntax :
@PJL INITIALIZE [<CR>]<LF>
Parameters :
·
·
·
The INITIALIZE command has no parameters.
The INITIALIZE command resets the following environment variables to the Factory Default values.
If any additional personality (emulation) is added to the printer, the printer may support more personality-
specific variables than the variables listed. In any case, the INITIALIZE command resets the PJL Current and
User Default environment values for all personalities to their factory default.
Example :
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT setting to <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT factory defaults <CR><LF>
@PJL INITIALIZE <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 35
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.5. Reset Command
The PJL RESET command resets the PJL Current Environment variables to the User Default values.
Use this command at the end of any PJL jobs in which the PJL SET command was used.
Syntax
@PJL RESET [<CR>]<LF>
Parameters
·
·
The RESET command has no parameters
When an application such as a Spooler or Print Data Generator uses the SET command to set PJL variables,
the application has to conclude with the RESET command (before the UEL command) to return the variables
to the previous state.
·
·
The RESET command resets the environment variables to their user default values.
In any case, the RESET command resets the PJL Current settings for all personalities to the User Default
values.
Use the @PJL INFO VARIABLES command to obtain valid variables and the range of values for each
variable. This command requests this information directly from the printer.
Examples
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT Reset variables to <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT control panel settings <CR><LF>
@PJL SET RESOLUTION = 300 <CR><LF>
@PJL SET RET = DARK <CR><LF>
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>
<ESC>E ....PCL job ...<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT Reset to return to <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT control panel settings <CR><LF>
@PJL RESET <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
6.6. Set Command
The SET command enables you to change the value of PJL Current Environment variables during a PJL job
until a PJL reset condition resets the default values.
Use this command to make a job-specific environment.
Syntax
@PJL SET [LPARM : personality] variable = value
[<CR>]<LF>
·
·
LPARM : Personality
This optional parameter is used to set personality(emulation) -specific environment variables.
variable = value
This parameter sets one of the environment variables to the specified value.
For example, @ PJL SET RESOLUTION = 300 command sets the current resolution to 300 dpi. For a list of
variables and values, see the following table.
·
Use the @PJL INFO VARIABLES to obtain valid variables and the range of values for each variable. This
command can request this information directly from the printer.
Parameters
·
The printer control panel setting values and the feature settings stored in NV-RAM are not affected by the
values modified with the SET command.
·
·
The setting values selected with the SET command are valid until the next PJL reset condition occurs.
If the SET command is used in a job, use the RESET command after the job to reset the printer to User default
settings.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 36
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Examples:
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT Setting PCL job <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT to desired state <CR><LF>
@PJL SET RET = DARK <CR><LF>
@PJL SET PAGEPROTECT = OFF <CR><LF>
@PJL SET RESOLUTION = 600 <CR><LF>
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>
<ESC> E....PCL job .... <ESC>E
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL RESET <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 37
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
7.
STATUS READBACK COMMANDS
7.1. Introduction
Applications can request, by sending a PJL command to the printer, information such as the configuration
and status of the printer. The printer can be programmed to send back this information when requested and
also can send back voluntarily unsolicited information of its status such as cover open, off-line state, toner
empty, displayed prompt message on the LCD and other necessary information.
PJL Status Readback will help you to program the application to appropriately set the printer settings.
In this chapter, you can learn how to use PJL Status Readback in programming an application. The following
Status Readback Commands are described :
·
·
·
INQUIRE ... requests the information of the specified PJL Default setting (PJL Current Environment) set by
@PJL SET or @PJL RESET command
DINQUIRE ... requests the information of the specified User Default setting (User Default Environment)
set by @PJL DEFAULT or @PJL INITIALIZE command or control panel
ECHO ... request the printer to send back to the host computer a comment for the purpose of
synchronization with each other in order to start communication
·
·
·
INFO ... requests a specified category of information from the printer
USTATUS ... gives the printer permission to send back unsolicited information.
USTATUSOFF ... turns off all unsolicited status information set by USTATUS
Job Recovery is also described in this chapter.
7.1.1. Synchronization with the printer
The printer sends the status responses to the same I/O port as it received the request from. Therefore, in a
shared or network environment, if the I/O port was used by another user and the printer is still processing the
previous job, the printer may send a response of the status of the previous user's job against the request from
the current application. In order to make sure that an application can receive correct responses for its request,
it must synchronize itself with the printer by sending the ECHO command so as to be assured that the printer
is ready for communication to you.
7.1.2. Basic format of status readback responses
The printer sends its status information to the host computer in the following format :
·
·
·
starts with the @PJL prefix
ends with a <FF> character
All the data is in a readable ASCII format.
Each line in the PJL status responses is in the following format :
·
·
starts with a specific keyword
ends with <CR><LF>
For example, the readback response against the @PJL DINQUIRE is :
@PJL DINQUIRE [LPARM : personality] variable<CR><LF>
value<CR><LF>
<FF>
The application must read all the data between the @PJL and <CR><LF> codes. If the application can not
understand the meaning of the lines, it must ignore them. Future printers may send currently unused
keywords.
Refer to each command description to learn about the format of responses from the printer.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 38
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
7.2. Inquire Command
The INQUIRE command is used in order to get the information of the current value of a specified variable in
the PJL DEFAULT setting. (PJL environment). It is possible to get the information for variables the value of
which PJL cannot change (Read-only).
This INQUIRE command can request only one variable at a time. If you would like to get the information from
multiple variables, send multiple INQUIRE commands or the PJL INFO VARIABLES command which
responds with all the variables in the PJL Default settings (PJL Default Environment).
Syntax
@PJL INQUIRE [LPARM : personality] variable [<CR>]<LF>
Response Syntax
@PJL INQUIRE [LPARM : personality] variable <CR><LF>
value <CR><LF>
<FF>
If the variable is not supported by the printer, it returns the response in the following syntax :
@PJL INQUIRE [LPARM : personality] variable <CR><LF>
"?" <CR><LF>
<FF>
·
·
LPARM : personality
This optional parameter must be used when requesting the information of printer language-specific variables,
such as the font number in the PJL DEFAULT setting.
variable : variable
This is a parameter which specifies which variable you would like to get the information about among the PJL
Default settings (PJL Current Environment). The variables which can be used in this command are listed in
Appendix A. You can also check by sending the @PJL INFO VARIABLES command to the printer.
·
value
This is the value of the parameter requested by the variable parameter.
Examples
Example 1 :
This example requests the current print environment settings for RET, PAPER, and ORIENTATION :
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT ***Requesting*** <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT about PJL Default Settings** <CR><LF>
@PJL ECHO 19:15:00 02-20-1993 <CR><LF>
@PJL INQUIRE RET <CR><LF>
@PJL INQUIRE PAPER <CR><LF>
@PJL INQUIRE ORIENTATION <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
The printer may return, for examp le, the following response against the above INQUIRE commands :
@PJL ECHO 19:15:00 02-20-1993 <CR><LF>
<FF>
@PJL INQUIRE RET<CR><LF>
LIGHT<CR><LF>
<FF>
@PJL INQUIRE PAPER<CR><LF>
LETTER<CR><LF>
<FF>
@PJL INQUIRE ORIENTATION<CR><LF>
PORTRAIT<CR><LF>
<FF>
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 39
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Example 2 :
This example requests the PCL-specific settings.
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT ***Inquiring PCL settings*** <CR><LF>
@PJL ECHO 19:20:05 02-20-1993 <CR><LF>
@PJL INQUIRE LPARM:PCL FONTSOURCE<CR><LF>
@PJL INQUIRE LPARM:PCL FONTNUMBER<CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
The printer may return the following response for the above INQUIRE commands :
@PJL ECHO 19:20:05 02-20-1993 <CR><LF>
<FF>
@PJL INQUIRE LPARM:PCL FONTSOURCE <CR><LF>
I<CR><LF>
<FF>
@PJL INQUIRE LPARM:PCL FONTNUMBER <CR><LF>
13<CR><LF>
<FF>
7.3. DINQUIRE Command
The DINQUIRE command is used to get the information of the default value of a specific variable in the PJL
Environment. (User Default Settings). It is also possible to get the value for variables which PJL cannot
change (Read-only).
The returned value of User Default Settings is identical to the Control Panel Setting.
This DINQUIREcommand can request only one variable at a time. If you would like to get information from
more variables, send multiple DINQUIRE commands.
Syntax:
@PJL DINQUIRE [LPARM : personality] variable [<CR>]<LF>
Response Syntax:
@PJL DINQUIRE [LPARM : personality] variable <CR><LF>
value <CR><LF>
<FF>
If the variable is not supported by the printer, it returns the response in the following syntax :
@PJL DINQUIRE [LPARM : personality] variable <CR><LF>
"?" <CR><LF>
<FF>
·
·
·
LPARM : personality
This optional parameter must be used when requesting information about printer language-specific variables
such as the font number in the User Default setting.
variable
Variable is a parameter which specifies what you would like to get the information about among the User
Default settings (User Default Environment). The valid variables are listed in the following tables.
value
Value is the returned value for the requested variable. See the following tables to learn about values for
specific variables.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 40
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Examples
Example 1 :
This example requests the current print environment settings for RET, PAPER, and ORIENTATION :
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT ***Requesting*** <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT about User Default Settings** <CR><LF>
@PJL ECHO 20:30:00 02-20-1993<CR><LF>
@PJL DINQUIRE RET<CR><LF>
@PJL DINQUIRE PAPER<CR><LF>
@PJL DINQUIRE ORIENTATION<CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
The printer may return, for example, the following response against the above DINQUIRE commands:
@PJL ECHO 20:30:00 02-20-1993 <CR><LF>
<FF>
@PJL DINQUIRE RET<CR><LF>
LIGHT<CR><LF>
<FF>
@PJL DINQUIRE PAPER<CR><LF>
LETTER<CR>LF>
<FF>
@PJL DINQUIRE ORIENTATION<CR><LF>
LANDSCAPE<CR><LF>
<FF>
Example 2 :
This example requests the PCL-specific settings.
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT ***Inquiring PCL settings*** <CR><LF>
@PJL ECHO 20:33:05 02-20-1993 <CR><LF>
@PJL DINQUIRE LPARM:PCL FONTSOURCE <CR><LF>
@PJL DINQUIRE LPARM:PCL FONTNUMBER <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
The printer may return the following response for the above DINQUIRE commands :
@PJL ECHO 20:33:05 02-20-1993 <CR><LF>
<FF>
@PJL DINQUIRE LPARM : PCL FONTSOURCE <CR><LF>
I<CR><LF>
<FF>
@PJL DINQUIRE LPARM : PCL FONTNUMBER <CR><LF>
15<CR><LF>
<FF>
7.4. ECHO Command
The ECHO command requests the printer to send back a specified message, in order to ensure that the printer
is ready for communication with the application and that the received answer from the printer is what the
application requested. The application must send this command before starting PJL communication.
After sending the ECHO command, the application must ignore any status information from the printer before
it receives the response from this command, because not receiving the response from this command means
that the printer is still processing the previous job and its status information is for the previous job
environment. When the application receives the correct response for the requested ECHO command, the
printer is now ready for the application and you can be sure that the status information following is for the
requested command by the application.
Syntax
@PJL ECHO [< words >] [<CR>]<LF>
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 41
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Response Syntax
@PJL ECHO [< words >] <CR><LF>
<FF>
·
< words >
The beginning of this parameter must be a printable character. Then this parameter consists of characters
from ASCII 33 to 255, space characters and horizontal tab characters.
This < words > parameter can be written without quotation marks as this is not a string of variables.
The parameter is recommended to be unique, distinguishable words from other print jobs, such as the time
determined by the real time clock and user name, so as to confirm the received message from the printer is
definitely the answer for the ECHO command which the application sent.
The length of the < word > must be within 80 characters.
Parameters
Parameter
Valid characters
< words >
ASCII 33 to 255, <SP>, <HT>
Example
The application sends the following example to the printer :
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT the ECHO command follows <CR><LF>
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 22:03:00 <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
The printer sends back the answer for the above ECHO command :
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 22:03:00 <CR><LF>
<FF>
After receiving the above answer, all the messages from the printer are the requested information from the
application, except for unsolicited status information.
7.5. INFO Command
The INFO command requests the printer to send back information on a specific category of the printer such
as 'ID' (model name), 'CONFIG' (printer configuration), 'MEMORY' (available printer memory), 'STATUS'
(current printer status), 'VARIABLES' (list of setting variables), 'USTATUS' (list of unsolicited status
variables), 'PAGECOUNT' (total printing page number of the printer), 'PHYSICALMEMORY' (Physical memory
size of printer) as shown in the following table.
This INFO command can request the information from only one category at a time. If you would like to get
the information from more categories, send multiple INFO commands.
Syntax
@PJL INFO category [<CR>]<LF>
Response Syntax
@PJL INFO category <CR><LF>
[lines of printable characters or <WS> with <CR><LF> at the end of
each line]
<FF>
If the variable is not supported by the printer, it returns the response in the following syntax :
@PJL INFO category <CR><LF>
"?"<CR><LF>
<FF>
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 42
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Parameters
Category
Information requesting
ID
The printer model number. For example the HL-1660e will return 'Brother
HL-1660e'.
CONFIG
A list of the printer configuration information (available options) within
the format of the number of types and/or the description of each
available type of;
paper sources
paper sizes
languages
USTATUS (unsolicited status) commands
font sources
RAM
number of lines and characters on the LCD
MEMORY
STATUS
The total number of bytes of free memory space (user memory) and the
largest free memory block.
The printer status of the current message displayed on the LCD, on-
line/off-line status and the status code.
VARIABLES
A list of the current settings of all the environmental & language-specific
variables and the selectable values for each variable
USTATUS
A list of the current settings of all the unsolicited status variables and
selectable values for each variable
PAGECOUNT
Total number of pages the printer has printed.
PHYSICALMEMORY
Physical printer memory. This value is the same as the response for
INFO CONFIG.
FEATURES
OPTIONS
The list of the printer features.
The information of the options (HL-2460,3260N,1650/1670N)
The information of the paper cassette (HL-2460,3260N,1650/1670N)
The information of the paper output tray (HL-2460,3260N,1650/1670N)
The information of the Duplex unit (HL-2460,3260N,1650/1670N)
The information of the memory device (HL-2460,3260N,1650/1670N)
INTRAYCONFIG
OUTTRAYCONFIG
DXCONFIG
STORAGECONFIG
7.5.1. ID category
The application can use @PJL INFO ID command to find out the printer model name. As the features of the
printer may be changed by future revisions, the application should check them by using the @PJL INFO
CONFIG command.
Example
The application sends the following command to the printer :
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL INFO ID <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
The printer sends back the answer for the above INFO command if the printer name is HL-1660e:
@PJL INFO ID<CR><LF>
"Brother HL-1660e"<CR><LF>
<FF>
7.5.2. CONFIG category
The application can use @PJL INFO CONFIG command to have the printer return a list of printer
configuration information. The list consists of the information on paper sources, paper sizes, languages,
USTATUS (unsolicited status) commands, font sources, RAM size, number of lines and characters on the
LCD supported by the printer, with the format of the number of available types and/or the description of each
type. The printer sends back a list of multiple information for one @PJL INFO CONFIG command.
Syntax:
@PJL INFO CONFIG <CR><LF>
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 43
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 44
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Response Syntax:
@PJL INFO CONFIG <CR><LF>
feature[=value][value feature information] <CR><LF>
[<HT>returned option[ attribute] <CR><LF>]
...
...
...
...
feature[=value][value feature information] <CR><LF>
[<HT>returned option[ attribute] <CR><LF>]
<FF>
Parameters
Parameter
Range of Characters
Description
feature
alphabetical letters
(ASCII 65-90 or 97-122),
numbers (ASCII 48-57)
Name of an item of the printer configuration :
for example )
IN TRAYS (paper sources)
OUT TRAYS (output trays)
PAPER (paper sizes)
* Beginning with a letter
LANGUAGES (printer languages)
USTATUS (unsolicited status)
FONT CARTRIDGE SLOTS
MEMORY (RAM size)
DISPLAY LINES (number of lines available on the
LCD)
DISPLAY CHARACTER SIZE (number of characters
available on the LCD)
etc.
value
numbers
Value for the feature, or value which shows a
number or range of options to follow
feature
alphabetical letters
Type of the following information:
(ASCII 65-90 or 97-122),
numbers (ASCII 48-57)
information
ENUMERATED
RANGE
* separated from others
by spaces
READONLY
etc.
returned
option
alphabetical letters
(ASCII 65-90 or 97-122),
numbers (ASCII 48-57)
An option of the item, such as PCL of the item of
LANGUAGES
attribute
alphabetical letters
(ASCII 65-90 or 97-122),
numbers (ASCII 48-57)
Further information for a returned option. For
example, a PC attribute following an INTRAY2
returned option indicates INTRAY2 means LC
(optional tray2)
Example
The application sends the following command to the printer :
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>
@PJL INFO CONFIG<CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 45
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
The printer may send back the answer for the above INFO command :
@PJL INFO CONFIG<CR><LF>
IN TRAYS [1 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
INTRAY1 PC<CR><LF>
INTRAY2 LC<CR><LF>
OUT TRAYS [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
NORMAL FACEDOWN<CR><LF>
PAPER [9 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
LETTER<CR><LF>
LEGAL<CR><LF>
A4<CR><LF>
EXECUTIVE<CR><LF>
MONARCH<CR><LF>
COM10<CR><LF>
DL<CR><LF>
C5<CR><LF>
B5<CR><LF>
LANGUAGES [5 EMULATED]<CR><LF>
PCL<CR><LF>
POSTSCRIPT<CR><LF>
IBM<CR><LF>
EPSON<CR><LF>
HPGL<CR><LF>
USTATUS [4 ENUMERATED]
DEVICE<CR><LF>
JOB<CR><LF>
PAGE<CR><LF>
TIMED<CR><LF>
FONT CARTRIDGE SLOTS [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
CARTRIDGE<CR><LF>
CARTRIDGE1<CR><LF>
MEMORY=2097152<CR><LF>
DISPLAY LINES=1<CR><LF>
DISPLAY CHARACTER SIZE=16<CR><LF>
<FF>
In this example, IN TRAYS [2 ENUMERATED] indicates that there are two options in IN TRAYS (paper
sources) and MEMORY=2097152 indicates the RAM size in the printer is 2097152 bytes.
7.5.3. MEMORY category
The application can use the @PJL INFO MEMORY command to check the size of total free memory and the
largest free memory block in the printer.
The free memory size may vary according to the personality (printer language). In order to know the free
memory size in PCL, use the <ESC>*s1M(Free Space command) in the PCL status readback commands.
Example
The application sends the following command to the printer :
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT the INFO MEMORY command follows<CR><LF>
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 2-28-1993 19:03:00<CR><LF>
@PJL INFO MEMORY<CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
The printer sends back the answer for the above command :
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 2-28-1993 19:03:00<CR><LF>
<FF>
@PJL INFO MEMORY<CR><LF>
TOTAL=159984<CR><LF>
LARGEST=53322<CR><LF>
<FF>
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 46
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
7.5.4. STATUS category
The application can use the @PJL INFO STATUS command to check the printer on-line/off-line status, the
current message on the LCD and a status code. The ONLINE=TRUE indicates the printer is online, while the
ONLINE=FALSE shows it is off-line. Refer to the list of the PJL Status Codes in the Appendix for the
meanings of the returned status codes.
Example
The application sends the following command to the printer :
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT the INFO STATUS command follows<CR><LF>
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 2-28-1993 19:10:00<CR><LF>
@PJL INFO STATUS<CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
The printer sends back the answer for the above command when BR-Script mode and letter sized paper are
selected and it is in idle status:
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 2-28-1993 19:10:00<CR><LF>
<FF>
@PJL INFO STATUS<CR><LF>
CODE=10001<CR><LF>
DISPLAY="00 IDLE 001P LT"<CR><LF>
ONLINE=TRUE<CR><LF>
<FF>
7.5.5. VARIABLES category
The application can send the @PJL INFO VARIABLES command to get a list of possible variables for printer
environment settings, possible language-specific variables, the current settings for both and the possible
values or range for those variables. Refer to the "Environment Variables" in Chapter 6 for more information
about the variables for the environment settings.
The language-specific variables returned from the printer depend on the current environment and are
indicated with LPARM: personality.
The value and options for the FONTSOURCE variable depend on the installed font sources such as cartridge,
downloaded permanent soft fonts.
The range of fonts listed for FONTNUMBER variable is only for the current font source. The upper limit
value of the range varies according to the number of fonts in the current font source.
Example
The application sends the following command to the printer :
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT the INFO VARIABLES command <CR><LF>
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 2-28-1993 19:35:00 <CR><LF>
@PJL INFO VARIABLES <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
The printer may send back the answer for the above command :
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 2-28-1993 19:35:00 <CR><LF>
<FF>
@PJL INFO VARIABLES<CR><LF>
COPIES=3 [2 RANGE]<CR><LF>
1<CR><LF>
999<CR><LF>
PAPER=LETTER [9 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
LETTER<CR><LF>
LEGAL<CR><LF>
A4<CR><LF>
EXECUTIVE<CR><LF>
MONARCH<CR><LF>
COM10<CR><LF>
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 47
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
C5<CR><LF>
DL<CR><LF>
B5<CR><LF>
ORIENTATION=PORTRAIT [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
PORTRAIT<CR><LF>
LANDSCAPE<CR><LF>
FORMLINES=60 [2 RANGE]
5<CR><LF>
128<CR><LF>
MANUALFEED=OFF [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
OFF<CR><LF>
ON<CR><LF>
RET=MEDIUM [4 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
OFF<CR><LF>
LIGHT<CR><LF>
MEDIUM<CR><LF>
DARK<CR><LF>
PAGEPROTECT=OFF [4 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
OFF<CR><LF>
LETTER<CR><LF>
LEGAL<CR><LF>
A4<CR><LF>
RESOLUTION=600 [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
300<CR><LF>
600<CR><LF>
PERSONALITY=AUTO EPSON [8 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
AUTO<CR><LF>
PCL<CR><LF>
POSTSCRIPT<CR><LF>
Interactive<CR><LF>
IBMProprinterXL<CR><LF>
EPSONFX850<CR><LF>
HPGL<CR><LF>
TIMEOUT=10 [2 RANGE]<CR><LF>
1
99
INTRAY1=UNLOCKED [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
UNLOCKED<CR><LF>
LOCKED<CR><LF>
INTRAY2=UNLOCKED [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
UNLOCKED<CR><LF>
LOCKED<CR><LF>
AUTOCONT=ON [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
OFF<CR><LF>
ON<CR><LF>
LOWTONER=OFF [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
OFF<CR><LF>
ON<CR><LF>
INTRAY1SIZE=LETTER [9 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
LETTER<CR><LF>
LEGAL<CR><LF>
A4<CR><LF>
EXECUTIVE<CR><LF>
MONARCH<CR><LF>
COM10<CR><LF>
C5<CR><LF>
DL<CR><LF>
B5<CR><LF>
INTRAY2SIZE=LEGAL [9 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
LETTER<CR><LF>
LEGAL<CR><LF>
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 48
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
A4<CR><LF>
EXECUTIVE<CR><LF>
MONARCH<CR><LF>
COM10<CR><LF>
C5<CR><LF>
DL<CR><LF>
B5<CR><LF>
LPARM:PCL FONTSOURCE=I [4 EMULATED]<CR><LF>
I<CR><LF>
C<CR><LF>
C1<CR><LF>
S<CR><LF>
LPARM:PCL FONTNUMBER=0 [2 RANGE]<CR><LF>
0<CR><LF>
70<CR><LF>
LPARM:PCL PITCH=10.00 [2 RANGE]<CR><LF>
0.44<CR><LF>
99.99<CR><LF>
LPARM:PCL PTSIZE=12.00 [2 RANGE]<CR><LF>
4.00<CR><LF>
999.75<CR><LF>
LPARM:PCL SYMSET=ROMAN8 [43 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
ROMAN8<CR><LF>
ISOL1<CR><LF>
ISOL2<CR><LF>
....
....
WIN30<CR><LF>
HPGERM<CR><LF>
HPSPAN<CR><LF>
MCTEXT<CR><LF>
LPARM:POSTSCRIPT PRTPSERRS=OFF [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
OFF<CR><LF>
ON<CR><LF>
<FF>
7.5.6. USTATUS category
The application can send the @PJL INFO USTATUS command to check the possible unsolicited status
types of the printer and the current setting value and possible values for them.
Syntax
@PJL INFO USTATUS [<CR>]<LF>
Response Syntax
@PJL INFO USTATUS <CR><LF>
variable=value [value feature information] <CR><FF>
[<HT>returned option <CR><LF>]
...
...
...
...
variable=value [value feature information] <CR><FF>
[<HT>returned option <CR><LF>]
<FF>
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 49
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Parameters
Variable
Value
Description
DEVICE
ON
Makes unsolicited device status valid for any status
change
VERBOSE
OFF
Makes unsolicited device status valid for any of PJL
parser warning, error and status change
Makes unsolicited device status invalid for any
status change
JOB
ON
Makes unsolicited job status (reporting job start/job
end) valid
OFF
ON
Makes unsolicited job status invalid
PAGE
TIMED
Makes unsolicited page status (reporting respective
page printed and ejected) valid
OFF
Makes unsolicited page status invalid
5 to 300
Makes timed unsolicited status (allowing the printer
to send back unsolicited status after an interval
specified in seconds) valid
0
Turns TIMED USTATUS off (Makes timed
unsolicited status invalid)
Example
The application sends the following command to the printer :
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT the INFO USTATUS command <CR><LF>
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 2-28-1993 21:15:00 <CR><LF>
@PJL INFO USTATUS <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
The printer may send back the following answer for the above command :
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 2-28-1993 21:15:00 <CR><LF>
<FF>
@PJL INFO STATUS<CR><LF>
DEVICE=VERBOSE [3 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
OFF<CR><LF>
ON<CR><LF>
VERBOSE<CR><LF>
JOB=ON [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
OFF<CR><LF>
ON<CR><LF>
PAGE=ON [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>
OFF<CR><LF>
ON<CR><LF>
TIMED=0 [2 RANGE]<CR><LF>
5<CR><LF>
300<CR><LF>
<FF>
7.6. USTATUS Command
Sending the USTATUS command makes unsolicited printer status (sending the printer status information to
the host computer automatically without being requested for it) valid or invalid. If the unsolicited status is set
to ON with the USTATUS command, the printer sends unsolicited status information to the host computer at
the time interval set by USTATUS TIMED command from when the status changes. On the other hand, the
DINQUIRE, INQUIRE and INFO commands make the printer send a response only once, just after they are
received.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 50
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
The printer status to be sent to the host computer are ;
·
·
·
Device status changes - printer cover open, paper jams, paper out, etc
Job status changes - completion of the printing of a job, receiving a JOB command
Page status changes - ejecting a printed page
All the unsolicited status information (USTATUS DEVICE, JOB, PAGE and TIMED) is turned off at once by
the USTATUSOFF command. Each status can be turned off individually by the corresponding USTATUS
command.
The USTATUS TIMED command specifies after which time period the printer sends the unsolicited status
information and is turned off by setting the time increment to zero with this command.
To get information about the current settings or possible settings for unsolicited status, use the INFO
USTATUS command.
Syntax
@PJL USTATUS variable = value [<CR>]<LF>
Response Syntax
@PJL USTATUS variable <CR><LF>
returned option [printable characters or <WS>] <CR><LF>
...
...
...
...
returned option <CR><LF>
<FF>
Parameters
Variable
Value
Description
DEVICE
ON
Makes unsolicited device status valid for any status change (printer
errors)
VERBOSE
Makes unsolicited device status valid for any PJL parser warning, error
and status changes
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
Makes unsolicited device status invalid for any status change
Makes unsolicited job status (reporting job start/job end) valid
Makes unsolicited job status invalid
Makes unsolicited page status (reporting respective page printed and
ejected) valid
JOB
PAGE
OFF
Makes unsolicited page status invalid
TIMED
5 to 300
Makes timed unsolicited status (allowing the printer to send back
unsolicited status after an interval specified in seconds) valid
Turn TIMED USTATUS off (Makes timed unsolicited status invalid)
0
7.6.1. Device variable
The @PJL USTATUS DEVICE command allows the printer to send status messages when the printer status
changes. The printer will send the status by the status code shown in the table below.
Status code
10000 - 10999
11000 - 11999
Status
Status information such as printer on-line or off-line.
Status of available paper in paper input sources, such as paper empty and auto-
switching to another paper source.
20000 - 20999
PJL parser errors. The entire command line of a PJL command is ignored when an
error (except for code 20004 ) occurs.
25000 - 25999
27000 - 27999
PJL parser errors. Part of a PJL command is ignored when the error occurs.
PJL semantic errors, which means that they are grammatically acceptable but
cannot be executed. For example, attempting to lock the only unlocked paper
tray causes this error.
30000 - 30999
Errors which do not stop the printing procedure if the CONTINUE is set to AUTO
(auto continue mode). If the CONTINUE mode is set to STOP, the printer stops
printing and goes to off-line status and only resumes when the CONTINUE or
SEL key are pressed.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 51
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Status code
Status
35000 - 25999
Errors which may cause incorrect printing results, such as loss of some print data
on a page. The operator's intervention may be required.
40000 - 40999
41000 - 41999
Errors such as paper empty, cover open or paper jams which suspend printing
until the operator takes the corresponding corrective action.
Errors in the paper source such as running out of paper in the current paper tray
and none available from any other paper sources.
Example
Example 1 :
The application sends the following command to the printer :
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL USTATUS DEVICE = VERBOSE <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
The printer may send back the answer for the above command :
@PJL USTATUS DEVICE<CR><LF>
CODE=40021<CR><LF>
DISPLAY='12 COVER OPEN '<CR><LF>
ONLINE=FALSE<CR><LF>
<FF>
Example 2 :
When the following wrong PJL command is sent :
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL USTATUS DEVICE = VERBOSE <CR><LF>
@PJL ECO wrong sample 3-6-1993 23:12:00 <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
The printer may send back the answer for the above command :
@PJL USTATUS DEVICE<CR><LF>
CODE=20002<CR><LF>
<FF>
7.6.2. JOB variables
The @PJL USTATUS JOB = ON command allows the printer to send the job processing status. This is sent
to the application whenever a JOB and EOJ command is issued so that the application knows when a job
starts and ends.
Example
The application sends the following commands to the printer.
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL USTATUS JOB = ON <CR> <LF>
@PJL JOB NAME = "JOB 88554" <CR> <LF>
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR> <LF>
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR> <LF>
<ESC>E . . . PCL Job . . . <ESC>E <ESC>%-12345X
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL EOJ NAME = "JOB 88554" <CR> <LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
The printer may send back the answer for the above command.
@PJL USTATUS JOB<CR><LF>
START<CR><LF>
NAME="JOB 88554"<CR><LF>
<FF>
[ . . time period while job is printing . . . ]
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 52
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
@PJL USTATUS JOB<CR><LF>
END<CR><LF>
NAME = "JOB 88554"<CR><LF>
PAGES=5<CR><LF>
<FF>
7.6.3. PAGE variable
The @PJL USTATUS PAGE = ON command allows the printer to send the information about the print
completion of a particular page. Using this command, you can monitor the job process on a page-by-page
basis.
Example
The application sends the following commands to the printer.
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL USTATUS PAGE = ON <CR> <LF>
@PJL JOB <CR><LF>
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>
<ESC>E . . . Four-page PCL Job . . . <ESC>E
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL EOJ <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
The printer may send back the answer for the above command.
@PJL USTATUS PAGE<CR><LF>
1<CR><LF>
<FF>
@PJL USTATUS PAGE<CR><LF>
2<CR><LF>
<FF>
@PJL USTATUS PAGE<CR><LF>
3<CR><LF>
<FF>
@PJL USTATUS PAGE<CR><LF>
4<CR><LF>
<FF>
7.6.4. TIMED variable
The @PJL USTATUS TIMED = XXX command enables the printer to send printer status information to the
application at the specified time period.
This time interval can be set to 0 and from 5 to 300 seconds. If set to 0, this function is turned off. If set to
any value between 5 and 300, the printer automatically sends to the application "CODE = XXXXX" (a status
code number), "DISPLAY = XXXXXXXXXX" (the message currently displayed on the printer's control
panel), and "ON LINE = XXXXXXX" ( printer's on-line/off-line status) at the specified time interval.
Example
The application sends the following commands to the printer.
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL USTATUS TIMED = 30 <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
The printer may send back the answer for the above command.
@PJL USTATUS TIMED<CR><LF>
CODE=10001<CR><LF>
DISPLAY="00 READY 001P LT"<CR><LF>
ONLINE=TRUE<CR><LF>
<FF>
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 53
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
7.7. USTATUSOFF Command
The @PJL USTATUSOFF command makes all unsolicited status reporting inactive.
Syntax
@PJL USTATUSOFF [<CR>]<LF>
Parameters
There are no parameters for this command.
Example
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL USTATUSOFF <CR><LF>
@PJL USTATUS DEVICE = ON <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
7.8. JOB Recovery
You can recover a failed job with the combination of JOB and EOJ commands and the USTATUS PAGE
command. JOB/EOJ commands inform the printer of the beginning and ending of each job and the
USTATUS PAGE command informs the application of completion of printing of each page of a job.
When the spooler finds a job failure, it can recover the failed job. It can send the JOB command with the
START option. The START page should be set to the last printed page, which can be found by the
USTATUS PAGE command.
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 54
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
8.
DEVICE ATTENDANCE COMMANDS
8.1. Introduction
You can change dis play messages on the printer control panel by using PJL. The Operator can be alerted by
this feature to what specific actions should be taken. This chapter shows you three device attendance
commands.
RDYMSG
By using this command, you can change the message "00 READY" on the printer control panel into whatever
message you like. This command does not change the printer's online/offline state.
OPMSG
By using this command, the printer can display a message you specify on the printer switch panel LCD and
set the printer to off-line ( non-ready state for printing ).
STMSG
By using this command, the printer can display a message you specify on the printer control panel LCD and
the printer will go off-line. After the operator puts the printer back on-line by the on-line / off-line key, the
printer name is returned by the printer to the application.
8.2. RDYMSG Command
With the RDYMSGcommand, you can change the message "00 READY" on the printer control panel into a
specified message. The printer will be kept online.
Syntax
@PJL RDYMSG DISPLAY = "message" [<CR>]<LF>
Parameters
Parameter
Functional Range
Default
N/A
DISPLAY = "message"
ASCII 33 and ASCII
35 through 255, <SP>,
<HT>
DISPLAY = "message"
You can use any combination of characters available on the printer except for the quotation marks (ASCII 34)
up to 16 characters total including spaces or horizontal tab. Characters must be enclosed in double quotes.
Comments :
·
·
This RDYMSG command keeps the printer online. You can display whatever message you like, for example,
job name, person name etc..
@PJL RDYMSG DISPLAY = ""
This command returns the display to "00 READY".
Example :
The following example shows how to display the name of person who is printing the job.
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL JOB NAME = "Tom's job" <CR><LF>
@PJL RDYMSG DISPLAY = "TOM'S JOB" <CR><LF>
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 55
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
The following is an example of how to restore the display to the normal ready message.
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL COMMENT Normal READY message <CR><LF>
@PJL RDYMSG DISPLAY = "" <CR><LF>
@PJL EOJ NAME = "End of Tom's Job" <CR><LF>
<ESC>%-12345X
8.3. OPMSG Command
With the OPMSGcommand, you can display any message you like on the printer switch panel LCD. The
printer will go off-line and stop printing until the operator presses the ON LINE key or resets the printer (Press
SHIFT key and RESET key, then press SET key.)
Syntax
@PJL OPMSG DISPLAY = "message" [<CR>]<LF>
Parameters
Parameter
Functional Range
Default
N/A
DISPLAY = "message"
ASCII 33 and ASCII
35 through 255, <SP>,
<HT>
DISPLAY = "message"
You can use any combination of characters available on the printer except for the quotation marks (ASCII 34)
up to 16 characters in total including spaces or horizontal tab. Characters must be enclosed in double quotes.
Example
The following example shows how to display "LOAD C5 ENVELOPE" on the printer switch panel.
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL JOB NAME = "JOB C5 envelope" <CR><LF>
@PJL OPMSG DISPLAY = "LOAD C5 ENVELOPE" <CR><LF>
@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>
<ESC>E This is C5 Envelope<ESC>E
8.4. STMSG Command
With the STMSGcommand, you can display any message you like on the printer switch panel LCD. The
printer will go off-line and stop printing until the operator presses the ON LINE key or resets the printer (Press
SHIFT key and RESET key, then press SET key.) When the printer is put back to on-line by the operator, the
printer returns a status message giving the name of the key.
Syntax
@PJL STMSG DISPLAY = "message" [<CR>]<LF>
Return Syntax
@PJL STMSG DISPLAY = "message" <CR><LF>
key <CR><LF>
<FF>
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 56
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Parameters
Parameter
Functional Range
Default
N/A
DISPLAY = "message"
ASCII 33 and ASCII
35 through 255, <SP>,
<HT>
key
ONLINE, RESET
N/A
DISPLAY = "message"
You can use any combination of characters available on the printer except for the quotation marks (ASCII 34)
up to 16 characters total including spaces or horizontal tab. Characters must be enclosed in double quotes.
key
After the operator presses the key in order to put the printer back to on-line, this variable will be returned with
the status response.
Example
Following example shows how to display "LOAD LETTER SIZE" on the printer switch panel LCD.
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL STMSG DISPLAY = "LOAD LETTER SIZE" <CR><LF>
@PJL <CR><LF>
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>
<ESC>E... PCL job ...<ESC>E<ESC>%-12345X
If the operator press the ONLINE key,
@PJL STMSG DISPLAY = "LOAD LETTER SIZE"<CR><LF>
ONLINE<CR><LF>
<FF>
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 57
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
9.
INDEX
C
K
COMMENT command..................................................................................K...e..r.n..e..l...c.o...m...m...a..n..d..........................................................................1..1.............
conditions............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 8
context switching .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 12
O
OPMSG command....................................................................................
D
DEFAULT command......................................................................................................................................................................................... 25
P
DEMOPAGE....................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10
Device Attendance command ......................................................................................................................................................................... 44
PCL-specific variables .............................................................................
DINQUIRE command........................................................................................................................................................................................ 30
PERMFONT..............................................................................................
PJL RESET command...............................................................................
PostScript-specific variable ....................................................................
print environment.....................................................................................
E
ECHO command.............................................................................................P..R...T..C...O...N...F...I.G.................................................................................3..1.............
emulation switching.......................................................................................................................................................................................... 11
end of Job........................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14
R
ENTER command............................................................................................................................................................................................... 11
Environment commands................................................................................................................................................................................... 15
RDYMSG command.................................................................................
EOJ command..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14
reset conditions........................................................................................
EPSON-specific variables................................................................................................................................................................................. 20
RESIFONT.................................................................................................
EXECUTE command ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 10
explicit switching............................................................................................................................................................................................... 12
S
F
SET command...........................................................................................
SHUTDOWN............................................................................................
format .................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6
start of job.................................................................................................
Status Readback commands...................................................................
STMSG command ....................................................................................
syntax.........................................................................................................
I
IBM-specific variables.......................................................................................r..u..l.e..s.........................................................................................2..1.............
implicit switching............................................................................................................................................................................................... 12
INFO command.................................................................................................................................................................................................. 32
U
CONFIG category......................................................................................................................................................................................... 33
ID category ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 33
UEL command...........................................................................................
MEMORY category ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 35
Universal Exit Command .........................................................................
STATUS category ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 36
USTATUS command...............................................................................
USTATUS category .................................................................................................................................................................................... 38
Device variable....................................................................................
VARIABLES category................................................................................................................................................................................. 36
JOB variables.......................................................................................
information line.................................................................................................................................................................................................. 11
PAGE variables ...................................................................................
INITIALIZE command...................................................................................................................................................................................... 25
TIMED variable...................................................................................
INQUIRE command........................................................................................................................................................................................... 29
USTATUSOFF command .......................................................................
invalid command.................................................................................................................................................................................................. 7
V
J
variable ......................................................................................................
JOB Command.................................................................................................................................................................................................... 13
variables ....................................................................................................
job name.............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 13
JOB recovery...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 43
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 58
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 59
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 6
EPSON FX-850
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CONTENTS
1. COMMAND LIST....................................................................................................................................3
2. INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................................................................5
3. EMULATION DETAILS.........................................................................................................................6
3.1. Ignored Commands ................................................................................................................................ 6
3.2. Resolution............................................................................................................................................. 6
4. TERMINOLOGY......................................................................................................................................7
4.1. Syntax.................................................................................................................................................. 7
4.2. Conventions........................................................................................................................................... 7
5. CONTROLLING THE PRINTER .........................................................................................................8
5.1. The Control Panel .................................................................................................................................. 8
5.2. Control codes ........................................................................................................................................ 8
5.3. Escape sequence.................................................................................................................................. 8
6. COMMANDS...........................................................................................................................................9
6.1. Basic printer operations.......................................................................................................................... 9
6.2. Page set up......................................................................................................................................... 12
6.3. Line Spacing ....................................................................................................................................... 14
6.4. Using Tabs.......................................................................................................................................... 16
6.5. Using Standard Characters ................................................................................................................... 17
6.6. Using customized characters................................................................................................................ 22
6.7. Graphics............................................................................................................................................. 24
7. INDEX.................................................................................................................................................... 30
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
1.
COMMAND LIST
NUL
BEL
Null
Bell
9
9
SP
Space
9
BS
Backspace
9
CR
Carriage return
9
LF
Line Feed
9
FF
Form Feed
9
Esc SP n
Esc a n
Esc $ n1 n2
Esc \ n1 n2
Esc <
Esc U
Esc =
Esc >
Esc #
Set inter-character space
Select justification mode
Set absolute print position
Set relative print position
Select unidirectional printing
Select / cancel unidirectional printing
Set data MSB to 0
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
11
11
11
11
11
11
11
11
12
12
12
12
12
13
13
13
13
13
13
13
14
14
14
14
14
15
Set data MSB to 1
Cancel MSB setting
Select near letter quality or draft
Select / cancel half speed mode
Enable printer
Disable printer
Initialize printer
Reset printer / change emulation mode
User reset
Paper input control
Enable out-of-paper sensor
Disable out-of-paper sensor
Set page length
Esc x n
Esc s n
DC1
DC3
Esc @
Esc CR mode
Esc CR ! # R
Esc EM n
Esc 9
Esc 8
Esc C n
Esc C NUL n
Esc n
Esc Q n
Esc N n
Esc O
Esc 2
Esc 0
Esc 1
Esc A n
Esc 3 n
Esc J n
Esc j n
Set page length
Set left margin
Set right margin
Set perforation skip
Cancel perforation skip
Select 1/6" line spacing
Select 1/8" line spacing
Select 7/72" line spacing
Select n/72" line spacing
Select n/216" line spacing
Perform n/216" line feed
Perform n/216" reverse line feed
Esc D n1 n2 n3 ... NUL
Set horizontal tab stops
Horizontal tab
Esc B n1 n2 n3 ... NUL
Set vertical tab stops
Esc b n m1 m2 m3 ... NUL
Set vertical channel tab stops
HT
15
15
15
Esc / n
VT
Esc P
Esc M
Esc p n
SI
Select vertical tab channel
Vertical tab
16
16
16
16
16
17
17
Set pitch to 10 characters per inch
Set pitch to 12 characters per inch
Select / cancel proportional spacing
Select condensed character mode I
Select condensed character mode II
Esc SI
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
DC2
Cancel condensed character mode
Select emphasized character mode
Cancel emphasized character mode
Select double-strike mode
17
17
17
17
17
17
18
18
18
18
18
18
19
19
19
19
20
20
20
20
20
21
Esc E
Esc F
Esc G
Esc H
Esc W n
SO
Esc SO
DC4
Esc 4
Cancel double-strike mode
Select / Cancel double-width printing
Select single-line double-width printing (I)
Select single-line double-width printing (II)
Cancel single-line double-width printing
Select italic mode
Esc 5
Cancel italic mode
Esc S n
Esc T
Esc w n
Esc - n
Esc ! n
Esc 6
Select superscript / subscript mode
Cancel superscript / subscript mode
Select / cancel double-height printing
Select / cancel underline mode
Select printing mode
Select expansion of printable code area
Cancel expansion of printable code area
Expand printable code area
Esc 7
Esc l n
Esc R n
Esc t n
Select international character set
Select italic / graphic character table
Esc & NUL n1 n2 ( n3 <character definition data> )
Define characters
Esc % n NUL
Esc : 0 0 0
Esc * m n1 n2 < image data >
Select image mode
Select standard / downloaded characters
Copy ROM character to RAM
21
22
22
Esc ? n m
Esc ^ a n1 n2
Reassign image mode
Print 9 bit image
22
23
24
Esc K n1 n2 <image data>
Print single-density image
Esc L n1 n2 <image data>
Print double-density image
Esc Y n1 n2 <image data>
Print double-speed double-density image
Esc Z n1 n2 <image data>
Print quadruple-density
24
25
25
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
2.
INTRODUCTION
In this mode you can control the HL-Series printers that support this emulation directly by incorporating
control codes and escape sequences into your program. Alternatively, applications software (for example,
your word-processing or spreadsheet software) may send the necessary commands to the printer
automatically. Check the manual that came with your software for instructions on how to use your
application with an Epson FX-850 printer.
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.
EMULATION DETAILS
The following points should be borne in mind when using the printer in Epson FX-850 mode.
3.1. Ignored Commands
The following commands are ignored: the BEL control code (ASCII code 7) which is normally used to
sound a printer’s bell, the DC1 (ASCII 17) and DC3 (ASCII 19) control codes, used to enable and disable
a printer, the Esc 9 and Esc 8 commands, which normally enable and disable the out-of-paper sensor, the
Esc < and Esc U commands for enabling unidirectional printing and the Esc x control code for choosing
between near letter quality and draft printing.
In addition, commands that try to change the printer’s printing speed cannot do so, since the HL-Series
printers always print as fast as they can. Hence, the Esc s command, to select or cancel half-speed
printing mode, is also ignored, and the Esc Y escape sequence (Print Double-Speed, Double-Density
Image), performs the same function as the Esc L (Print Double-Density Image) command.
3.2. Resolution
The resolution of our recent printers is 600 dots per inch. (HL-2060 supports 1200dpi.) Some instructions
use fractions of an inch by which 600 is not exactly divisible, for example Esc J performs a line feed using
a line spacing of n/216". Similarly, there are graphics commands which specify resolutions of 72, 120 and
240 dots per inch. When a line spacing or graphic cannot be implemented exactly at 600 dots per inch the
printer approximates as closely as possible using 600 dots per inch.
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.
TERMINOLOGY
4.1. Syntax
The following conventions are used in this description of the Epson FX-850 mode software commands:
A single letter, two or three-letter control code mnemonic, or number in upright bold text is a literal
character and should be sent to the printer as the character code.
A letter or word in italics is a variable and you must substitute an appropriate value when you use the
command.
A statement element enclosed in angle brackets <> consists of a stream of data whose length is defined
within the same command. The data consists of numbers represented by bytes which are sent to the
printer as if they were ASCII character codes.
4.2. Conventions
Although the machine is a laser printer and does not physically have a print head, for the purposes of this
emulation description, we refer to the location on the page at which the printer is currently positioned to
print as the print position.
The printable area is the area of the page where the printer can place a dot.
The bits that comprise a byte of data are numbered 1 to 8. Bit 1 is the least significant bit (LSB) and bit 8
is the most significant bit (MSB).
The lower case ‘L’ character is shown as an ‘ l ’ in the Esc l printer command, to distinguish it from the
character ‘1’ (one).
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.
CONTROLLING THE PRINTER
Commands are invoked using either control codes or escape sequences. You can send them to the printer
as part of a program using the same command that you would use to print a string on the printer. For
example in BASIC you would use the LPRINT command.
The printer’s control panel can also be used to set various operating parameters. Try to ensure that the
control panel settings and computer generated settings do not conflict with one another, or you may not
get the results you require.
5.1. The Control Panel
Refer to the printer User’s Guide for a description of how to use the printer’s control panel switches. You
should be aware, however, that the following can be set using the control panel: automatic line feed (a line
feed is performed with every carriage return), auto mask (two-line top and bottom margins are
automatically used on every page), paper size, top, bottom, left and right margins, the number of lines of
text per page, orientation (portrait or landscape), the current font and the emulation mode. Conflict
between control panel settings and the settings you establish with software commands (or from
applications software) is by far the most likely cause of unexpected printing results. Use this manual in
conjunction with the printer User's guide to resolve these conflicts.
5.2. Control codes
Control codes are ASCII codes that instruct the printer to perform a particular operation, such as a line
feed. You can send a control code to the printer by sending the same type of instruction you would use
to print a character using its ASCII code number. For example, the ASCII code for a form feed is 12, so to
make the printer perform a form feed use the following BASIC statement:
LPRINT CHR$(12);
The CHR$ operator is normally used to convert an ASCII code into its corresponding character.
5.3. Escape sequence
Escape sequences tell the printer what Epson FX-850 mode function to perform. An escape sequence
consists of the Esc character followed by one or more characters which define the operation to be
performed. Send an escape sequence to the printer by sending the same type of instruction you would
use to print characters using their ASCII codes. Some escape sequences require parameter values or data
following them, for example, commands which turn a particular feature on and off, or commands for
printing graphic images. Numerical parameter data, too, is sent to the printer as if it were a character code
to be printed. For example, to move the print position to the third column position on the page the
required escape sequence is Esc HT 3. In BASIC this would be:
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(9); CHR$(3);
In some instances where a numerical parameter can only take the values 0 or 1, you have a choice between
sending the number or the character code itself as the numerical parameter. Hence you can use CHR$(0)
or CHR$(48) to represent 0, and use CHR$(1) or CHR$(49) to represent 1. The practice of using character
code numbers CHR$(48) and CHR$(49) is not recommended, however, as it is not conducive to clear
programming and, in any case, is not universally available on commands whose parameters can only be
either 0 or 1.
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.
COMMANDS
6.1. Basic printer operations
The most common printer operations are described in this section. Some are invoked using control codes
alone - the rest require escape sequences. For the sake of completeness, several instructions which are
part of the Epson FX-850 mode instruction sets, but which an HL Series printer ignores are included.
Null
NUL
(0)
<00h>
NUL (ASCII code 0) is ignored.
Bell
BEL
(7)
<07h>
BEL (ASCII code 7) is ignored.
Space
SP
(32)
<20h>
The SP control code (ASCII code 32) moves the current print position one space to the right.
LPRINT CHR$(32); 'Print a space
Backspace
BS
(08)
<08h>
·
·
The BS control code (ASCII code 8) moves the current print position one space to the left.
This code is only effective when used with left justification, which is the default justification mode.
LPRINT CHR$(8); 'Backspace
Carriage return
CR
(13)
<0Dh>
·
·
The CR control code (ASCII 13) moves the print position to the left margin on the current line.
If automatic line feed is on, this code moves the current print position to the left margin on the next
line. On some printers you can turn on automatic line feed using the control panel switches.
LPRINT CHR$(13); 'Carriage return
Line feed
LF
(10)
<0Ah>
·
The LF control code (ASCII code 10) moves the current print position down one line, using the
current line space setting.
·
·
This code does not cause a carriage return to be performed.
If the print position is such that this operation would move it below the bottom margin, the current
page is ejected and the print position is moved to the top of the next page instead.
Form feed
FF
(12)
<0Ch>
·
·
·
The FF control code (ASCII code 12) ejects the current page and moves the current print position to
the top of the next page, unless the current page is blank.
This code does not cause a carriage return to be performed, hence the print position does not change
horizontally.
If the current page is blank this control code has no effect.
LPRINT CHR$(12); 'Form feed
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Set inter-character space
EscSPn (27)(32)n <1Bh><20h>n
This command allows you to set the space between successive characters.
·
·
·
n is the space between characters in multiples of 1/120".
n must be in the range 0 to 127.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(32); CHR$(5); 'Set 1/24" char space
Select justification mode
Escan (27)(97)n
<1Bh><61h>n
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
This command allows you to select the justification mode for subsequent text.
Set n to 0 to select left justification.
Set n to 1 to centre subsequent text.
Set n to 2 to select right justification.
Set n to 3 to select full justification (text will be both left and right justified).
The default justification mode is left justification.
The horizontal tab, HT, and backspace, BS, control codes can only be used in left justification mode.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(97); CHR$(2); 'Right justify text
Set absolute print position
Esc$n1n2 (27)(36)n1n2
<1Bh><24h>n1n2
·
·
·
This command allows you to print characters a specified distance in from the left margin.
The unit of movement is 1/60".
The specified distance to be moved is n1+(n2*256)/120".
·
If the specified position is to the right of the right margin the command is ignored.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(36); CHR$(120); CHR$(0); 'Print a line 2" in
Set relative print position
Esc\n1n2 (27)(92)n1n2
<1Bh><5Ch>n1n2
·
This command allows you to print characters a specified distance to the left or right of the current
print position.
·
·
The unit of movement is 1/120".
If you wish to move the print position to the right, the distance the print position is to be moved is
calculated as (n1+(n2*256))/120".
·
·
If you wish to move the print position to the left, the distance the print position is to be moved is
calculated as (65536 – (n1+(n2*256)))/120".
If the specified position is beyond the left or right margin the command is ignored.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(36); CHR$(180); CHR$(0); 'Print a line 1.5" to
the right
Select unidirectional printing
Esc< (27)(60)
This command has no effect.
<1Bh><3Ch>
Select / cancel unidirectional printing
EscU
(27)(85)
<1Bh><55h>
This command has no effect.
Set data MSB to 0
Esc=
(27)(61)
<1Bh><3Dh>
·
·
This command enables you to set the most significant bit of incoming data bytes to 0.
This command does not affect data comprising a graphics image or data that defines a downloadable
character.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(61); 'Set MSB to 0
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Set data MSB to 1
Esc> (27)(62)
<1Bh><3Eh>
·
·
This command enables you to set the most significant bit of incoming data bytes to 1.
This command does not affect data comprising a graphics image or data that defines a downloadable
character.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(62); 'Set MSB to 1
Cancel MSB setting
Esc# (27)(35)
<1Bh><23h>
This command cancels the two commands that set the most significant bit of incoming data bytes (Esc =
and Esc >).
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(35); 'Cancel MSB setting
Select Near Letter Quality or Draft
Escxn
(27)(120)n
<1Bh><78h>n
<1Bh><73h>n
The printer ignores this command.
Select / cancel half speed mode
Escsn
(27)(115)n
The printer ignores this command.
Enable printer
DC1
(17)
<11h>
The printer ignores this command.
Disable printer
DC3
(19)
<13h>
The printer ignores this command.
Initialize printer
Esc@
(27)(64) <1Bh><40h>
·
·
This command resets the printer.
All remaining data is printed out and the printer default settings are restored.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(64); 'Printer reset
Reset printer / change emulation mode
EscCR<mode> (27)(13)mode
<1Bh><0Dh>mode
·
·
This command enables you to switch emulation mode or to reset the printer.
Change emulation mode by setting mode to the appropriate letter or pair of letters. Set mode to ‘D’ to
switch to Diablo mode, ‘H’ to switch to LaserJet mode, ‘I’ to switch to IBM Proprinter XL mode, 'AB'
to switch to BR-Script Batch mode, 'AI' to switch BR-Script Interactive mode, 'GL' to switch to HP-GL
mode.
·
·
If you set mode to ‘E’ in Epson FX-850 mode , a printer reset is performed.
If you set mode to ‘FD’, to reset the printer to its factory default settings, LaserJet mode (the factory
default emulation mode) is selected and the LaserJet factory default environment is restored. For a list
of the factory default settings see the sub-section “Factory default environment” in Chapter 2 "PCL"
of this manual.
·
On receiving this command the printer prints any remaining data and performs a page eject (unless the
current page is blank). The newly selected emulation mode’s default settings come into effect, except
when mode is set to ‘FD’.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(13); CHR$(73); 'Change to IBM Proprinter mode
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
User reset
EscCR!#R
(27)(13)(33)#(82)
<1Bh><0Dh><21h>#<52h>
·
·
·
# = 0, the printer restores to the current user setting.
# = 1, the printer restores to user settings 1.
# = 2, the printer restores to user settings 2.
Paper Input Control
EscEMn
(27)(25)n
<1Bh><19h>n
n Value
HL-1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/3260N/2460
n = 0
n = 1
n = 2
n = 3
n = 4
n = 5
n = R
Initialize the feeder mode.
Feed from the MP tray.
Feed from Tray 1.
Feed from Tray 2.
Feed from Tray 3.
Feed from Tray 4.
Eject paper.
n Value
HL-1050
n = 0
Initialize the feeder mode.
Feed from the tray.
Eject paper.
n = 1/2
n = R
n Value HL-1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1650/1670N
n = 0
n = 1
n = 2
n = R
Initialize the feeder mode.
Feed fromthe Tray 1.
Feed from the Tray 2.
Eject paper.
Enable out-of-paper sensor
Esc9 (27)(57)
<1Bh><39h>
<1Bh><38h>
The printer ignores this command.
Disable out-of-paper sensor
Esc8
(27)(56)
The printer ignores this command.
6.2. Page set up
Set page length
EscCn
(27)(67)n
<1Bh><43h>n
This command sets the page length in lines.
or
EscCNULn (27)(67)(00)n <1Bh><43h><00h>n
·
·
·
This command sets the page length in inches.
The top of form position is set to be the current line.
n is the number of lines that make up one page, or the length of the page in inches, according to which
form of the command is used.
·
·
If the first form of the command is used (n = the number of lines in the page) the current line spacing
setting is used to determine the length of the page.
If the first form of the command is used, n must be in the range 1 to 127.
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
If the second form of the command is used (n = page length in inches), n must be in the range 1 to 14.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(67); CHR$(40); '40 lines per page
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(67); CHR$(0); CHR$(11); '11 inches per page
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Set left margin
Escln (27)(108)n
<1Bh><6Ch>n
·
This command sets the left margin in columns from the left edge of the page. The width of a column is
the current character width.
·
·
·
In proportional spacing mode a column width of 1/10" is adopted.
This command clears all tab settings.
The minimum space allowed between the left and right margins is 1/5".
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(108); CHR$(10); 'Left margin 1" at 10 cpi
Set right margin
EscQn (27)(81)n
<1Bh><51h>n
·
This command sets the right margin in columns from the left edge of the page. The width of a column
is the current character width.
·
·
·
In proportional spacing mode a column width of 1/10" is adopted.
This command clears all tab settings.
The minimum space allowed between the left and right margins is 1/5".
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(81); CHR$(72); 'Right margin 6" at 12 cpi
Set perforation skip
EscNn (27)(78)n
<1Bh><4Eh>n
·
This command sets the bottom margin and enables perforation skip, that is, whenever the print
position reaches the bottom margin the printer performs a page eject and moves the print position to
the top of the next page.
·
n = the number of lines at the current line spacing setting between the bottom margin and the bottom
edge of the paper.
·
·
·
n must be in the range 1 to 127.
Esc C (Set Page Length) and Esc O (Cancel Perforation Skip) cancel automatic perforation skip.
If the bottom margin specified by this command would be located above the top margin, the command
is ignored.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(78); CHR$(4); 'Set bottom margin to 4 lines.
Cancel perforation skip
EscO (27)(79)
<1Bh><4Fh>
This command cancels the automatic perforation skip feature.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(79); 'Cancel perforation skip.
6.3. Line Spacing
Select 1/6" line spacing
Esc2
(27)(50)
<1Bh><32h>
·
This command sets the line spacing to 1/6". All subsequent line feed operations will move the print
position 1/6" down the page.
·
This line spacing is the default setting when the printer is switched on or reset.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(50); 'Set line spacing to 1/6".
Select 1/8" line spacing
Esc0 (27)(48)
<1Bh><30h>
This command sets the line spacing to 1/8". All subsequent line feed operations will move the print
position 1/8" down the page.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(48); 'Set line spacing to 1/8".
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Select 7/72" line spacing
Esc1 (27)(49)
<1Bh><31h>
·
This command sets the line spacing to 7/72". All subsequent line feed operations will move the print
position 7/72" down the page.
·
Since the printer resolution is 600 dots per inch the line spacing will not be exactly 7/72".
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(49); 'Set line spacing to 7/72".
Select n/72" line spacing
EscAn (27)(65)n
<1Bh><41h>n
·
This command sets the line spacing to n/72". All subsequent line feed operations will move the print
position n/72" down the page.
·
·
·
Since the printer’s resolution is 600 dots per inch the line spacing will not be exactly n/72".
n must be in the range 1 to 85.
If n is outside the range 1 to 85 the default line spacing, 1/6" is selected.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(65); CHR$(10); 'Set line spacing of 10/72".
Select n/216" line spacing
Esc3n (27)(51)n
<1Bh><33h>n
·
This command sets the line spacing to n/216". All subsequent line feed operations will move the print
position n/216" down the page.
·
·
Since the printer’s resolution is 600 dots per inch the line spacing will not be exactly n/216".
n must be in the range 1 to 255.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(51); CHR$(25); 'Select line spacing of 25/216".
Perform n/216" line feed
EscJn (27)(74)n
<1Bh><4Ah>n
·
·
·
·
·
This command performs a single line feed, moving the print position down the page by n/216".
This command does not perform a carriage return.
The current line spacing setting is not affected.
n must be in the range 0 to 255.
The actual vertical distance moved may not be exactly the distance you specify due to the printer’s
600 dots per inch resolution.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(74); CHR$(54); '1/4" line feed
Perform n/216" reverse line feed
Escjn (27)(106)n
This command performs a single reverse line feed, moving the print position up the page by n/216".
<1Bh><6Ah>n
·
·
·
·
This command does not perform a carriage return.
The current line spacing setting is not affected.
n must be in the range 0 to 255.
The actual vertical distance moved may not be exactly the distance you specify due to the printer’s
600 dots per inch resolution.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(106); CHR$(108); '1/2" line feed
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.4. Using Tabs
Set horizontal tab stops
EscDn1n2n3...NUL
(27)(68)n1n2n3...(00)
<1Bh><44h>n1n2n3...<00h>
·
·
This command enables you to set up to 32 horizontal tab stops based on the current character width.
The character width setting is determined by the combination of the current pitch (10 or 12 characters
per inch) and the current character mode (condensed, normal or double-width). If proportional
spacing is being used the character width is based on a pitch of 10 characters per inch.
·
The tab stops must be set in ascending order. If you invoke the command with the tabs in any other
order all horizontal tab settings are cleared.
·
·
The value of ni must be in the range 0 to 255.
Once you have selected the tab settings they remain fixed - their position does not change if you
change the character pitch or character width settings.
·
·
·
To set up a group of equally spaced tab stops use the Esc e 0 command.
Esc D 0 clears all horizontal tab settings.
The default tab stop settings are at every eighth column, starting at the ninth column. The default
column width is 1/10".
·
·
The default settings are adopted when the printer is first switched on or when you perform a reset with
the Esc @ instruction.
You can move the print position to the tab stops using the HT control code.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(68); CHR$(10); CHR$(20); CHR$(0);
'Set tab stops at columns 10 and 20.
Horizontal tab
HT
(09)
<09h>
·
·
The HT control code (ASCII code 9) moves the current print position one tab stop to the right.
The command is ignored if there are no tab stops to the right of the current print position or if the next
tab stop is beyond the right margin.
LPRINT CHR$(9); 'Tab
Set vertical tab stops
EscBn1n2n3...NUL
(27)(66)n1n2n3...(00) <1Bh><42h>n1n2n3...<00h>
·
·
·
This command enables you to set up to sixteen vertical tab stops based on the current line space
setting.
The tab stops must be set in ascending order. If you specify the tab settings in any other order, any
settings made with a previous Esc B command are cleared.
The value of ni must be in the range 0 to 255.
·
·
·
·
Vertical tab settings are not affected by subsequent changes in the line spacing setting.
To set up a group of equally spaced tab stops use the Esc e 1 command.
Esc B 0 clears the vertical tab settings set with a previous Esc B command.
You can move the print position to the tab stops using the VT control code.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(66); CHR$(12); CHR$(24); CHR$(0);
'Set tab stops at lines 12 and 24.
Set vertical channel tab stops
Escbnm1m2m3...NUL (27)(98)nm1m2m3...(00) <1Bh><62h>nm1m2m3...<00h>
·
You can set up to eight different sets of vertical tab stops and select any of these sets for use at any
time. Each set of tab stops is called a channel - channels are numbered from 0 to 7.
·
Channel 0 normally holds the settings you have selected with the Esc B command, or equally spaced
tab settings that you have set with the Esc e 1 command. However, you can also set the channel 0 tab
settings using the Esc b command.
·
·
To set the tab stops held in channels 1 to 7 you must use the Esc b command.
This command enables you to set up to sixteen vertical tab stops for each channel based on the
current line space setting.
·
n is the channel number whose tab stops are to be set.
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 16
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
·
·
mi specifies the tab based on the current line space setting.
The value of mi must be in the range 0 to 255.
The tab stops must be set in ascending order. If you specify a channel’s tab settings in any other
order, any previous settings made for that channel are cleared.
·
·
·
Vertical tab settings are not affected by subsequent changes in the line spacing setting.
Esc b n 0 clears the vertical tab settings set for channel n.
You can select a channel using the Esc / command and move the print position to its tab stops using
the VT control code.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(98); CHR$(1); CHR$(10); CHR$(20); CHR$(0);
'Set tab stops at lines 10 and 20.
Select vertical tab channel
Esc/n (27)(47)n
<1Bh><2Fh>n
·
This command allows you to select a set of vertical tabs (or channel) that you defined using the Esc b
command.
·
·
·
All subsequent vertical tab commands use the selected tab channel’s settings.
n must be in the range from 0 to 7.
The default channel is channel 0. Channel 0 is the current channel when the printer is first switched
on or after a reset with the Esc @ command.
·
There are no default vertical tab settings for any channel.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(47); CHR$(5); 'Select vertical tab channel 5
Vertical tab
VT
(11)
<0Bh>
·
·
·
The VT control code (ASCII 11) moves the current print position one vertical tab stop down the page.
The current vertical tab channel’s settings are used.
If you have not previously selected a vertical tab channel with the Esc / command, channel 0, the
default channel is used.
If you have not set any vertical tab stops for the current channel with either the Esc B, Esc b, or Esc e
1 commands, the print position is moved down one line using the current line space setting.
·
·
If there are no tab stops below the current print position a line feed is performed.
If no tab stops have been set a carriage return and line feed are performed.
LPRINT CHR$(11); ' Vertical tab
6.5. Using Standard Characters
Set pitch to 10 characters per inch
EscP
(27)(80)
<1Bh><50h>
This command sets the printing pitch to 10 characters per inch (cpi).
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(80); 'Set pitch to 10 cpi
Set pitch to 12 characters per inch
EscM
(27)(77)
<1Bh><4Dh>
This command sets the printing pitch to 12 characters per inch (cpi).
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(77); 'Set pitch to 12 cpi
Select / cancel proportional spacing
Escpn
(27)(112)n
<1Bh><70h>n
·
·
·
·
This command allows you to turn proportional spacing on or off.
Setting n to 1 turns proportional spacing on. Subsequent text is printed proportionally spaced.
Setting n to 0 turns proportional spacing off. Subsequent text is printed monospaced.
When you specify the value for n you can use the character codes for ‘0’ and ‘1’ (48 and 49) instead
of 0 and 1.
·
Selecting proportional spacing cancels condensed character mode.
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
·
You cannot use the backspace, BS, code in proportional spacing mode.
If you change the character pitch using Esc P or Esc M, proportional spacing is automatically turned
off.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(112); CHR$(1); 'Turn proportional spacing on
Select condensed character mode I
SI
(15)
<0Fh>
·
This command selects condensed character mode. Subsequent text characters are condensed
horizontally when printed.
·
Selecting proportional spacing cancels condensed character mode.
LPRINT CHR$(15); 'Set condensed character mode
Select condensed character mode II
EscSI (27)(15) <1B><0F>
·
This command selects condensed character mode. Subsequent text characters are condensed
horizontally when printed.
·
·
Selecting proportional spacing cancels condensed character mode.
This command functions exactly like the SIcontrol code.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(15); 'Set condensed character mode
Cancel condensed character mode
DC2 (18) <12h>
This command cancels condensed character mode. Subsequent text characters are printed normally.
LPRINT CHR$(18); 'Cancel condensed character mode
Select emphasized character mode
EscE
(27)(69)
<1Bh><45h>
This command turns emphasized character mode on. Subsequent text is printed with a bold stroke width.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(69); 'Turn emphasized character mode on
Cancel emphasized character mode
EscF
(27)(70)
<1Bh><46h>
This command turns emphasized character mode off. Subsequent text is printed with a medium stroke
width.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(70); 'Turn emphasized character mode off
Select double-strike mode
EscG
(27)(71)
<1Bh><47h>
This command turns double-strike mode on. Subsequent text is printed with a bold stroke width.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(71); 'Turn double-strike printing mode on
Cancel double-strike mode
EscH
(27)(72)
<1Bh><48h>
This command turns double-strike mode off. Subsequent text is printed with a medium stroke width.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(72); 'Turn double-strike printing mode off
Select / cancel double-width printing
EscWn
(27)(87)n
<1Bh><57h>n
·
·
This command turns double-width printing on or off.
If n is set to 1 subsequent text is printed using double-width characters. The line spacing setting is
doubled.
·
If n is set to 0 subsequent text is printed using normal sized characters. The previous character pitch
setting is restored.
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 18
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
When you specify a value for n you may also use the character codes for ‘0’ and ‘1’ (48 and 49)
instead of 0 and 1.
·
·
Only Esc W 0 can be used to cancel double-width printing mode set using the Esc W 1 instruction.
Esc W 0 cancels double-width printing mode set using the Esc W 1 instruction, the SO control code
or the Esc SO instruction.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(87); CHR$(1); 'Set double-width printing mode
Select single-line double-width printing (I)
SO
(27)
<0Eh>
·
This command turns double-width printing mode on for one line only. The subsequent line of text is
printed using double-width characters and with the line spacing setting doubled.
·
·
The following commands cancel double-width printing mode set using the SO control code: LF, FF,
VT, Esc W 0, DC4, and ESC @.
If the “auto LF” (automatic line feed) function has been turned on from the control panel, the carriage
return control code, CR, will also cancel double-width printing mode selected with the SO control
code.
LPRINT CHR$(14); 'Set double-width printing mode for one line
Select single-line double-width printing (II)
EscSO (27)(14) <1Bh><03h>
·
·
·
This command turns double-width printing mode on for one line only. The subsequent line of text is
printed using double-width characters and with the line spacing setting doubled.
The following commands cancel double-width printing mode set using the SO escape sequence: LF,
FF, VT, Esc W 0, DC4, and ESC @.
If the “auto LF” (automatic line feed) function has been turned on from the control panel, the carriage
return control code, CR, will also cancel double-width printing mode selected with the Esc SO escape
sequence.
·
This command functions exactly like the SO control code.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(14); 'Set double-width printing mode for one line
Cancel single-line double-width printing
DC4 (20) <14h>
·
This control code cancels single-line double-width mode set with the SO control code or with the Esc
SO escape sequence. Subsequent text is printed using normal sized characters.
·
The previous character pitch is restored.
LPRINT CHR$(20); 'Cancel enlarged character mode set with SO
Select italic mode
Esc4 (27)(52)
<1Bh><34h>
·
·
This command enables the italic printing mode. Subsequent text is printed in italic style.
You can still use italic text even after selecting the extended character set with the Esc t command.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(52); 'Italic mode
Cancel italic mode
Esc5 (27)(53)
<1Bh><35h>
This command cancels the italic printing mode. Subsequent text is printed upright.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(53); 'Cancel italic mode
Select superscript / subscript mode
EscSn
(27)(83)n
<1Bh><53h>n
·
·
·
·
This command allows you to print superscripts or subscripts.
Set n to 0 to print subsequent text using superscript characters.
Set n to 1 to print subsequent text using subscript characters.
When you specify the value for n you may use the character codes for ‘0’ and ‘1’ (48 and 49) instead
of 0 and 1.
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
·
Selecting either superscript or subscript mode cancels double-height printing mode.
You can cancel either superscript or subscript mode with the Esc T command.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(83); CHR$(0); 'Turn on superscript mode
Cancel superscript / subscript mode
EscT (27)(84) <1Bh><54h>
·
·
This command cancels superscript or subscript printing mode.
Subsequent text is printed using normal characters.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(84); 'Turn off superscript mode
Select / cancel double-height printing
Escwn (27)(119)n <1Bh><77h>n
·
·
This command turns double-height printing on or off.
If n is set to 1 subsequent text is printed using double-height characters. The line space setting is
doubled.
·
·
·
If n is set to 0 subsequent text is printed using normal sized characters. The previous line spacing is
restored.
When you specify a value for n you may also use the character codes for ‘0’ and ‘1’ (48 and 49)
instead of 0 and 1.
You cannot use superscript, subscript or condensed printing modes in conjunction with double-
height printing. If you try to select any of these three modes while in double-height printing the
command will be ignored.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(119); CHR$(1); 'Set double-height printing mode
Select / cancel underline mode
Esc–n (27)(45)n
<1B><2D>n
·
·
This command turns character underlining on or off.
If n is set to 1 subsequent text is printed underlined. All characters, including space characters, are
underlined with a continuous line.
·
·
·
Horizontal tabbed spaces are never underlined.
If n is set to 0 subsequent text is not underlined.
When you specify a value for n you may also use the character codes for ‘0’ and ‘1’ (48 and 49)
instead of 0 and 1.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(45); CHR$(1); 'Underline following text
Select printing mode
Esc!n (27)(33)n
<1Bh><21h>n
·
·
This command allows you to select a combination of printing modes with just one command.
The various modes are weighted as shown. Add the numbers that correspond to each mode you
require and set n to the total.
10 characters per inch
12 characters per inch
Proportional spacing
Condensed mode
Emphasized mode
Double-strike mode
Double-width mode
Italic printing
0
1
2
4
8
16
32
64
128
Underline mode
·
·
·
Double-strike and emphasized modes are identical.
Proportional spacing overrides either character pitch setting (10 cpi or 12 cpi).
Proportional spacing and condensed mode cannot be combined. Proportional spacing has
precedence.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(33); CHR$(138); 'Proportionally space, emphasize
& underline following text.
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 20
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Select expansion of printable code area
Esc6 (27)(54) <1Bh><36h>
·
·
This command enables you to print characters whose character codes are in the range 128 to 159.
You can define your own characters and assign codes in this range to them.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(54); 'Expand printable area
Cancel expansion of printable code area
Esc7 (27)(55) <1Bh><37h>
This command prevents you from printing characters with codes in the range 128 to 159.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(55); 'Cancel codes 128–159
Expand printable code area
EscIn
(27)(73)n
<1Bh><49h>n
·
This command permits you to enable or disable the printing of characters whose character codes are in
the ranges 0 to 31 and 128 to 159. You can define your own characters and assign codes in these
ranges to them.
·
·
·
Set n to 1 to enable printing of characters in the ranges 0 to 31 and 128 to 159.
Set n to 0 to disable printing of characters in the ranges 0 to 31 and 128 to 159.
When you specify the value for n you can use the character codes for ‘0’ and ‘1’ (48 and 49) instead
of 0 and 1 if you wish.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(73); CHR$(1); 'Expand printable area
Select international character set
EscRn (27)(82)n <1Bh><52h>n
·
·
·
·
·
This command selects one of the available international character sets, refer to the printer User Guide
for supported character sets.
Each character set varies slightly from the others and contains a small number of special characters
necessary for printing in that particular language.
The selection you make with this command does not affect any italic or graphics character table
selection that you may have made with the Esc t command.
The character sets listed below, plus several others, can also be selected from the printer’s control
panel.
The character sets available and the corresponding values of n are as follows:
US ASCII
French I
German
UK ASCII I
Danish I
Swedish
Italy
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Japanese
Norwegian
Danish II
UK ASCII II
French II
Dutch
8
9
10
13
14
15
South African 16
Spanish
·
If you have selected the graphics character table with the Esc t 1 command the following additional
character sets are available.
Norwegian set I
Norwegian set II
17
18
IBM set I
IBM set II
19
20
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(82); CHR$(3); 'Select British char set
Select italic / graphics character table
Esctn (27)(116)n <1Bh><74h>n
·
This command allows you to choose between two character tables - the italic character table and the
graphics character table.
·
·
The two tables are shown in the Epson FX-850 section of the appendix at the end of this manual.
Set n to 0 to select the italic character table. Character codes in the range 160 to 255 are now italic
characters.
·
·
Set n to 1 to select the extended character table. Character codes in the range 128 to 255 are now
foreign language and graphics characters.
You can still print italic characters using the Select Italic Mode, Esc 4, command even when you have
selected the graphics character table.
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.6. Using customized characters
Define characters
Esc&NULn1n2(n3<character definition data>) (27)(38)(00)n1n2(n3....)
<1Bh><26h><00h>n1n2(n3...)
·
·
This command enables you to define and download characters for printing.
Monospaced characters are designed on a grid eleven dots wide by nine dots high. Characters either
occupy the top 8 rows of the grid (ascending characters) or rows 2 to 9 of the grid (descending
characters).
Character width
Blank columns
1
2
3
4
Rows 1 - 8
5
6
7
Rows 2 - 9
8
9
10
11
12
Replication area
·
Proportionally spaced characters are subject to the same height constraints (that is, eight dots high
and either ascending or descending). The width of proportionally spaced characters is specified by
the value in n3.
·
·
·
n1 is the character code of the first character in the sequence to be defined.
n2 is the character code of the last character in the sequence to be defined.
It is assumed that you are defining a sequence of characters whose code numbers increment by one
for each character as default. If this is not the case, you must split the characters you are defining
into sets of characters with contiguous code numbers and use a separate command for each set.
Each character is defined as a series of bytes - each byte defining a column of dots. The columns are
read from left to right in the order in which they occur in the definition. The most significant bit of
each byte represents the top dot of the column, and the least significant bit represents the bottom dot.
Simply set a bit to 1 to print a dot in that position on the grid, or to 0 to print white space.
·
·
·
The MSB (bit 8) of n3 specifies whether the defined character is an ascender or a descender. Set bit 8
to 0 when defining an ascender, and to 1 for a descender. Ascending characters occupy the top 8
rows of the grid while descending characters occupy rows 2 to 9 of the grid.
Bits 5 to 7 of n3 specify the number of columns left blank to the left of the defined character in
proportional spacing mode. The number of columns to skip is the number held in bits 5 to 7 minus 1.
Up to six columns can be skipped. Hence, if you set this number to 4 it is equivalent to setting the first
three character definition data bytes to 0.
·
·
Bits 1 to 4 of n3 specify the width in columns of the defined character in proportional spacing mode.
The width in columns is the number held in bits 1 to 4. Characters can be up to fifteen columns wide,
including skipped blank columns.
Downloaded characters are selected using the Esc % 1 NUL command and then printed by sending
the appropriate character codes.
Select standard / downloaded characters
Esc%nNUL (27)(37)n(00) <1Bh><25h>n<00h>
·
Once you have defined and downloaded one or more customized characters using the Esc &
command, you can choose between the normal characters contained in the printer ROM and the
characters you have downloaded.
Set n to 0 to select the printer standard characters. In this mode you cannot print any of your own
defined characters.
·
·
Set n to 1 to select your own downloaded characters for printing. Now you can print using your user-
defined characters but you cannot print any of the printer standard characters unless you have
previously downloaded them to RAM as well, using the Esc : Copy ROM to RAM command.
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 22
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(37); CHR$(1); CHR$(0); 'Select downloaded
characters
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Copy ROM character to RAM
Esc:000 (27)(58)(00)(00)(00)
<1Bh><3Ah><30h><30h><30h>
·
In order to use your own customized characters in conjunction with the standard characters contained
in the printer, you must first download the printer standard ROM characters to the printer RAM, then
define and download your own customized characters, and finally select the downloaded characters
for printing using the Esc % 1 NUL escape sequence. This has the effect of inserting your custom
characters into the standard character set in place of the standard characters with the same character
codes.
This command enables you to download the printer current character set to its RAM. The printer
current character set consists of whichever combination of international character set and italic or
graphic character table you have selected.
·
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(58); CHR$(0); CHR$(0); CHR$(0); 'Copy printer’s
characters to its RAM
6.7. Graphics
Select image mode
Esc*mn1n2<image data>
(27)(42)mn1n2....
<1Bh><2Ah>mn1n2....
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line at a
selected horizontal resolution.
·
·
n1 and n2 define the number of bytes that comprise the image.
The image consists of 256*n2+n1 bytes of data, each byte representing a single vertical column of
4/30".
·
m defines the horizontal resolution at which the image will be printed. m must be in the range 0 to 7. A
value of 0 selects 60 dots per inch, 1 and 2 select 120 dots per inch, 3 selects 240 dots per inch, 4
selects 80 dots per inch, 5 selects 72 dots per inch, 6 selects 90 dots per inch and 7 selects 144 dots per
inch.
·
Each byte represents a vertical column of eight dots, the most significant bit representing the dot at
the top. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white
space to appear.
·
·
Images are printed left to right.
Images are printed at a horizontal resolution determined by your selection and at an approximate
vertical resolution of 72 dots per inch. The printer attempts to match your chosen horizontal
resolution as best it can using its 600 dpi resolution.
·
You can only use this command in portrait orientation.
10 WIDTH “LPT1:”,255
20 LPRINT “*** ESC * m n1 n2 ***”
30 FOR M=0 TO 6
40 LPRINT “m=”;M
50 ‘* SELECT BIT IMAGE MODE *
60 LPRINT CHR$(27);”*”;CHR$(M);CHR$(240);CHR$(0);
70 FOR I=1 TO 8
80 N=2^I-1
90 FOR J=1 TO 30
100 LPRINT CHR$(N);
110 NEXT J:NEXT I:LPRINT
120 NEXT M:END
*** ESC * m n1 n2 ***
Sample 9
Reassign image mode
Esc?cm (27)(63)cm
<1Bh><3Fh>cm
·
This command enables you to redefine the horizontal resolution attached to a particular image mode.
Hence, you could assign a density of 90 dots per inch to the image mode normally associated with 60
dots per inch, which is selected with the Esc K command. All subsequent Esc K commands would
then generate images with a horizontal density of 90 dots per inch.
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 24
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
·
c is the character which signifies the graphics mode: K = single-density (60 dpi), L = double-density
(120 dpi), Y = double-speed, double-density (120 dpi) and Z = quadruple-density (240 dpi).
m defines the new horizontal resolution to be assigned to the specified graphics mode. m must be in
the range 0 to 7. A value of 0 selects 60 dots per inch, 1 and 2 select 120 dots per inch, 3 selects 240
dots per inch, 4 selects 80 dots per inch, 5 selects 72 dots per inch 6 selects 90 dots per inch and 7
selects 144 dots per inch.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(63); CHR$(90); CHR$(7); 'Change quad density to
144 dpi
Print 9 bit image
Esc^an1n2
(27)(92)an1n2
<1Bh><5Eh>an1n2
·
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line.
n1 and n2 define the number of vertical 9-dot columns that comprise the image.
·
a defines the horizontal density of the image. Set a to 0 for a horizontal density of 60 dots per inch,
and to 1 for an approximate horizontal density of 120 dots per inch.
·
The image consists of 256*n2+n1 columns of data, each column representing a single vertical column
of 1/8".
·
Each pair of bytes represents a vertical column of nine dots, the most significant bit of the first byte
representing the dot at the top of the column, the least significant bit of the first byte representing the
second dot from the bottom, and the MSB of the second byte representing the dot at the bottom of
the column. Bits 1 to 7 of the second byte are not used. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to
appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white space to appear.
·
·
Images are printed from left to right.
Images are printed at a horizontal resolution of 60 or approximately 120 dots per inch and at an
approximate vertical resolution of 72 dots per inch.
·
You can only use this command in portrait orientation.
10 WIDTH “LPT1”, 255
20 LPRINT “*** ESC ^ m n1 n2 ***”
30 LPRINT “--STANDARD DENSITY--”
40 M=0
50 GOSUB 120
60 LPRINT
70 LPRINT
80 LPRINT “--DOUBLE-DENSITY--”
90 M=1
100 GOSUB 120
110 END
120 FOR A=1 TO 10
130 LPRINT CHR$(27); “^”;CHR$(M);CHR$(10);CHR$(0);
140 LPRINT CHR$(8);CHR$(128);CHR$(20);CHR$(0);
150 LPRINT CHR$(34);CHR$(128);CHR$(65);CHR$(0);
160 LPRINT CHR$(128);CHR$(128);CHR$(65);CHR$(0);
170 LPRINT CHR$(34);CHR$(128);CHR$(20);CHR$(0);
180 LPRINT CHR$(8);CHR$(128);CHR$(0);CHR$(0);
190 NEXT A
200 RETURN
** ESC ^ m n1 n2 ***
Sample 10
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Print single-density image
EscKn1n2<image data>
(27)(75)n1n2....
<1Bh><4Bh>n1n2....
·
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line.
n1 and n2 define the number of bytes that comp rise the image.
·
The image consists of 256*n2+n1 bytes of data, each byte representing a single vertical column of
4/30".
·
Each byte represents a vertical column of eight dots, the most significant bit representing the dot at
the top. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white
space to appear.
·
·
Images are printed from left to right.
Images are printed at a horizontal resolution of 60 dots per inch and at an approximate vertical
resolution of 72 dots per inch.
·
You can only use this command in portrait orientation.
10 WIDTH “LPT1:”, 255
20 LPRINT “*** ESC K n1 n2 ***”
30 FOR I=1 TO 5
40 ‘* STANDARD DENSITY BIT IMAGE MODE *
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);”K”;CHR$(160);CHR$(0);
60 FOR J=1 TO 8
70 FOR K=1 TO 20
80 N=2^J-1
90 LPRINT CHR$(N);
100 NEXT K
110 NEXT J
120 LPRINT
130 NEXT I:END
*** ESC K n1 n2 ***
Sample 11
Print double-density image
EscLn1n2<image data> (27)(76)n1n2....
<1Bh><4Ch>n1n2....
·
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line.
n1 and n2 define the number of bytes that comprise the image.
·
The image consists of 256*n2+n1 bytes of data, each byte representing a single vertical column of
4/30".
·
Each byte represents a vertical column of eight dots, the most significant bit representing the dot at
the top. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white
space to appear.
·
·
Images are printed from left to right.
Images are printed at an approximate horizontal resolution of 120 dots per inch and at an approximate
vertical resolution of 72 dots per inch.
·
You can only use this command in portrait orientation.
10 WIDTH “LPT1:”,255
20 LPRINT “*** ESC L n1 n2 ***
30 FOR I=1 TO 5
40 ‘* DOUBLE-DENSITY BIT IMAGE MODE *
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);”L”;CHR$(160);CHR$(0);
60 FOR J=1 TO 8
70 FOR K=1 TO 20
80 N=2^J-1
90 LPRINT CHR$(N);
100 NEXT K
110 NEXT J
120 LPRINT
130 NEXT I:END
*** ESC L n1 n2 ***
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 26
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Sample 12
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 27
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Print double-speed double-density image
EscYn1n2<image data> (27)(89)n1n2.... <1Bh><59h>n1n2....
·
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line.
n1 and n2 define the number of bytes that comprise the image.
·
The image consists of 256*n2+n1 bytes of data, each byte representing a single vertical column of
4/30".
·
Each byte represents a vertical column of eight dots, the most significant bit representing the dot at
the top. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white
space to appear.
·
·
Images are printed from left to right.
Images are printed at an approximate horizontal resolution of 120 dots per inch and at an approximate
vertical resolution of 72 dots per inch.
·
·
You can only use this command in portrait orientation.
The printer always prints as fast as possible, hence this command is the exact equivalent of the Esc L
command.
10 WIDTH “LPT1:”,255
20 LPRINT “*** ESC Y n1 n2 ***”
30 FOR I=1 TO 5
40 ‘* DOUBLE-SPEED & DOUBLE-DENSITY BIT IMAGE MODE *
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);”Y”;CHR$(160);CHR$(0);
60 FOR J=1 TO 8
70 FOR K=1 TO 20
80 N=2^J-1
90 LPRINT CHR$(N);
100 NEXT K
110 NEXT J
120 LPRINT
130 NEXT I:END
** ESC Y n1 n2 ***
Sample 13
Print quadruple-density image
EscZn1n2<image data> (27)(90)n1n2....
<1Bh><5Ah>n1n2....
·
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line.
n1 and n2 define the number of bytes that comprise the image.
·
The image consists of 256*n2+n1 bytes of data, each byte representing a single vertical column of
4/30".
·
Each byte represents a vertical column of eight dots, the most significant bit representing the dot at
the top. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white
space to appear.
·
·
Images are printed from left to right.
Images are printed at an approximate horizontal resolution of 240 dots per inch and at an approximate
vertical resolution of 72 dots per inch.
You can only use this command in portrait orientation.
10 WIDTH “LPT1;”,255
·
20 LPRINT “*** ESC Z n1 n2 ***”
30 FOR I=1 TO 5
40 ‘* QUADRUPLE-DENSITY BIT IMAGE MODE *
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);”Z”,CHR$(160);CHR$(0);
60 FOR J=1 TO 8
70 FOR K=1 TO 20
80 N=2^J-1
90 LPRINT CHR$(N);
100 NEXT K
110 NEXT J
120 LPRINT
130 NEXT I:END
*** ESC Z n1 n2 ***
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 28
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Sample 14
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 29
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
7.
INDEX
italic / graphics character table .............................................. 20
italic mode ................................................................................. 18
9
9 bit image..................................................................................23
J
justification mode..................................................................... 10
A
absolute print position ............................................................10
L
left margin.................................................................................. 13
Line feed................................................................................ 9, 14
line spacing............................................................................... 13
B
Backspace....................................................................................9
P
C
page length ............................................................................... 12
perforation skip ........................................................................ 13
pitch ........................................................................................... 16
printable code area................................................................... 20
printing mode............................................................................ 19
proportional spacing ............................................................... 16
Carriage return ............................................................................9
characters
define.....................................................................................21
condensed character................................................................17
control codes ..............................................................................8
control panel...............................................................................8
Q
D
quadruple-density image ........................................................ 25
data MSB...................................................................................10
double-density image ..............................................................24
double-height printing.............................................................19
double-speed double-density image.....................................25
double-strike mode...................................................................17
double-width printing..............................................................17
downloaded characters ...........................................................21
R
relative print position .............................................................. 10
resolution .................................................................................... 6
reverse line feed ....................................................................... 14
right margin ............................................................................... 13
ROM character......................................................................... 22
E
emphasized character mode....................................................17
emulation mode.........................................................................11
Escape sequences ......................................................................8
S
single-density image................................................................ 24
single-line double-width printing .......................................... 18
space............................................................................................ 9
subscript mode......................................................................... 18
superscript mode...................................................................... 18
syntax........................................................................................... 7
F
feeder mode...............................................................................12
Form feed.....................................................................................9
U
H
underline mode......................................................................... 19
unidirectional printing............................................................. 10
user reset................................................................................... 12
horizontal tab stops .................................................................15
I
image mode................................................................................22
Initialize ......................................................................................11
inter-character space................................................................10
international character set.......................................................20
V
vertical tab channel.................................................................. 16
vertical tab stops...................................................................... 15
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 30
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 7
IBM PROPRINTER
XL
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CONTENTS
1. COMMAND LIST....................................................................................................................................3
2. INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................................................................5
3. EMULATION DETAILS.........................................................................................................................6
3.1. Ignored Commands ...........................................................................................................................6
3.2. Resolution ..........................................................................................................................................6
3.3. Character Set selection .....................................................................................................................6
3.4. Controlling the Printer.........................................................................................................................6
3.5. Control Codes ....................................................................................................................................6
3.6. Escape sequences ............................................................................................................................6
4. NOTATION USED IN THIS EMULATION DESCRIPTION .............................................................7
4.1. Syntax.................................................................................................................................................7
4.2. Data Conventions...............................................................................................................................7
5. COMMANDS...........................................................................................................................................8
5.1. Basic Printer Operation......................................................................................................................8
5.2. Page Format ....................................................................................................................................11
5.3. Using Characters.............................................................................................................................14
5.4. Graphics...........................................................................................................................................18
6. INDEX.................................................................................................................................................... 21
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
1.
COMMAND LIST
NUL
BEL
Null
Bell
8
8
ESC
Escape
8
SP
Space
8
BS
Backspace
8
LF
Line Feed
8
FF
Form Feed
8
CR
Carriage return
8
Esc5n
DC1
Automatic line feed
Enable printer
9
9
EscQ22
EscQ3
EscCRmode
EscCR!#R
EscEMn
EscCn
EscCNULn
EscXmn
EscNn
EscO
Esc0
Esc1
EscAn
Esc2
Esc3n
EscJn
Disable printer
Disable printer
Reset printer / change emulation mode
User reset
Paper input control
Set page length
9
9
9
9
10
11
11
11
11
11
12
12
12
12
12
12
13
Set page length
Set left and right margins
Set perforation skip
Cancel perforation skip
Set 1/8" line spacing
Set 7/72" line spacing
Save n/72" line spacing
Activate n/72" line spacing
Set n/216" line feed
Execute n/216" line feed
EscDn1n2n3...NUL
Set horizontal tab stops
EscBn1n2n3...NUL
13
Set vertical tab stops
HT
VT
Horizontal tab
Vertical tab
Restore default tab settings
Select character set I
Select character set II
Set pitch to 10 cpi
Set pitch to 12 cpi
Proportional spacing
Set condensed character mode
Set emphasized character mode
Cancel emphasized character mode
Set enlarged character mode for a single line
Cancel enlarged character mode
Cancel
Enlarged character mode
Set superscript or subscript character mode
Cancel superscript or subscript character mode
Underline mode
13
13
13
14
14
14
14
14
14
14
14
15
15
15
15
15
15
16
16
16
EscR
Esc7
Esc6
DC2
Esc:
EscPn
SI
EscE
EscF
SO
DC4
CAN
EscWn
EscSn
EscT
Esc-n
Esc_n
Continuous overline mode
Esc[@n1n2n3n4n5n6
Select double-height / double-width mode
Esc\n1n2<character data>
Select character from the All Character Code table
16
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Esc^<char-code> Select a character from the All Character Code table
EscI Select character font
Esc=n1n220n3(n4n5<character definition data>...)
Define characters
17
17
17
EscKn1n2<image data>
Set single-density image mode
EscLn1n2<image data>
Set double-density image mode
EscYn1n2<image data>
Set double-speed, double-density image mode
EscZn1n2<image data>
Set quadruple-density image mode
18
18
19
20
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
2.
INTRODUCTION
Some of these HL Series printers offer a complete emulation of the IBM Proprinter. In Proprinter XL mode
you can drive the printer directly by incorporating control codes and escape sequences in your program,
or alternatively, applications software (for example, your word-processing software) may send the
necessary commands to the printer automatically. Check the manual that came with your software
package for instructions on how to use your software with an IBM Proprinter XL.
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.
EMULATION DETAILS
The following points should be borne in mind when running the HL Series printers in IBM Proprinter XL
mode.
3.1. Ignored Commands
A few IBM Proprinter XL commands have reduced effect, or no effect at all. In some cases this is due to
the physical nature of an HL Series printer. These commands are as follows. The BEL control code
(ASCII 7) which is used to sound the Proprinter’s bell, is ignored. The DC3 control code (ASCII 23), used
to disable the Proprinter, is also ignored. The Esc Y escape sequence, which enables double-speed,
double-density graphics mode has no effect on the printing speed, as HL Series printers always operate as
fast as they can. Hence the Esc Y has the same effect as the Esc L (enable double-density graphics mode)
sequence.
3.2. Resolution
The resolution of the HL Series printers is 600 dots per inch. Some IBM Proprinter commands use
fractions of an inch that not exactly divisible by 600, for example Esc 0 sets line spacing to 1/8" of an inch.
Similarly, the Proprinter graphics commands specify resolutions of 72, 120 and 240 dots per inch. When a
graphic cannot be represented exactly at 600 dots per inch the printer prints the closest possible
approximation to the specified image using 600 dots per inch.
3.3. Character Set selection
Using software commands you can select IBM character set I, IBM character set II or the IBM All
Character Code table. Using the printer control panel you can select a number of other character sets
depending on the printer model, consult the User's Guide to see if this emulation is supported and for a
description of how to do this. All available character sets are shown in the IBM Proprinter XL mode
section of the appendix at the end of this manual.
3.4. Controlling the Printer
Commands are invoked using either control codes or escape sequences. You can send them to the printer
as part of a program, using the same command that you would use to print a text string on the printer. For
example, in BASIC you would use the LPRINT command.
3.5. Control Codes
Control codes are ASCII codes that tell the printer to perform a particular function such as a line feed.
Send a control code to the printer by sending the same type of instruction you would use to print a
character using its ASCII code number. For example, the ASCII code for a form feed is 12, so to get the
printer to perform a form feed use the following BASIC statement:
LPRINT CHR$(12);
The CHR$ operator is normally used to convert an ASCII code into its corresponding character.
3.6. Escape sequences
Escape sequences tell the printer which Proprinter function to perform. An escape sequence consists of
the ESC character followed by one or more characters which define the operation to be performed. Send
an escape sequence to the printer by sending the same type of instruction you would use to print
characters using their ASCII codes. Some escape sequences require parameter values or data following
them, for example, commands which turn a particular feature on and off and commands for downloading
character descriptions to the printer or for printing graphic images. Numerical parameter data, too, is sent
to the printer as if it were a character code to be printed. For example, to set the left and right margin
settings to be at 10 and 70 columns across the page the required escape sequence is Esc X 10 70. In
BASIC this would be:
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(88); CHR$(10); CHR$(70);
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.
NOTATION USED IN THIS EMULATION DESCRIPTION
4.1. Syntax
The following conventions are used in this description of the Proprinter XL software commands.
A letter, word or number in upright bold text is the literal character which and should be sent to the printer
as a character code.
A letter or word in italics is a variable and you must substitute the appropriate value or values when using
the command.
An ellipsis, ..., indicates that an element may be repeated any number of times.
4.2. Data Conventions
The bits that comprise a byte of data are numbered 1 to 8. Bit 1 is the least significant bit (LSB) and bit 8 is
the most significant bit (MSB).
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.
COMMANDS
5.1. Basic Printer Operation
The most common printer operations are described in this section. Most are invoked using control codes.
For the sake of completeness the instructions which HL Series printers ignore are included.
Null
NUL
(0)
<0h>
NUL (ASCII 0) is ignored.
Bell
BEL
(07)
<07h>
BEL (ASCII 7) is ignored.
Escape
ESC
(27)
<1Bh>
The ESC control code (ASCII 27) marks the start of an escape sequence.
LPRINT CHR$(27);
Space
SP
(32)
<20h>
The SP control code (ASCII 32) moves the current print position one space to the right.
LPRINT CHR$(32);
Backspace
BS
(08)
<08h>
The BS control code (ASCII 8) moves the current print position one space to the left.
LPRINT CHR$(8);
Line feed
LF
(10)
<0Ah>
The LF control code (ASCII 10) moves the current print position down one line.
LPRINT CHR$(10);
Form feed
FF
(12)
<0Ch>
·
The FF control code (ASCII 12) ejects the current page (unless it is blank) and moves the current print
position to the top of the next page.
·
If the current page is blank this control code has no effect.
LPRINT CHR$(12);
Carriage return
CR
(13)
<0Dh>
·
The CR control code (ASCII 13) moves the current print position to the left margin on the current line.
·
If automatic line feed is ON, this code moves the current print position to the left margin on the next
line.
LPRINT CHR$(13);
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Automatic line feed
Esc5n (27)(53)n
<1Bh><35h>n
·
When automatic line feed is ON, a line feed is automatically performed every time a carriage return is
sent to the printer.
·
·
To turn the automatic line feed function ON, set n to 1.
To turn the automatic line feed function OFF, set n to 0.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(53); CHR$(1); 'Turn auto line feed on
Enable printer
DC1 (17)
(11h>
The DC1 control code (ASCII 17) enables the printer to accept data for printing again after a disable printer
instruction.
LPRINT CHR$(17);
Disable printer
EscQ22
or
EscQ3
(27)(81)(50)(50)
<1Bh><51h><32h><32h>
<1Bh><51h><32h>
(27)(81)(51)
·
·
These two commands stop the printer from accepting any data for printing or any control codes until it
has received a DC1 code (enable printer).
The DC3 code (ASCII 19) is not recognised by the printer.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(81); CHR$(22); 'Disable printer
Change emulation mode
EscCR<mode> (27)(13)mode
<1Bh><0Dh>mode
·
·
This command changes the printer emulation mode or performs a reset.
mode can be ‘E’ (Epson), ‘H’ (LaserJet), ‘I’ (IBM Proprinter XL), 'AB' (BR-Script Batch), 'AI' (BR-Script
Interactive), 'GL' (HP-GL) or ‘FD’ (factory default).
·
·
On receiving this command the printer prints any remaining data and performs a page eject (unless the
current page is blank). The new emulation mode default settings come into effect, except when the
mode is set to ‘FD’.
If you set the mode to ‘FD’ to reset the printer to its factory default settings, LaserJet mode (the
factory default emulation mode) is selected and the LaserJet factory default environment is restored.
For a list of the factory default settings see the sub-section “Factory default environment” in Chapter 2
"PCL" of this manual.
·
Selecting IBM Proprinter XL emulation with mode = ‘I’ causes the printer to be reset.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(13); CHR$(69); 'Change to Epson emulation
User Reset
EscCR!#R (27)(13)(33)#(82)
<1Bh><0Dh><21h>#<52h>
·
·
·
# = 0, restores to the current user setting.
# = 1, restores to User settings 1.
# = 2, restores to User settings 2.
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Paper input control
EscEMn
(27)(25)n
<1Bh><19h>n
n Value
HL-1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/3260N/2460
n = 0
n = 1
n = 2
n = 3
n = 4
n = 5
n = R
Initialize the feeder mode.
Feed from the MP tray.
Feed from Tray 1.
Feed from Tray 2.
Feed from Tray 3.
Feed from Tray 4.
Eject paper.
n Value
HL-1050
n = 0
Initialize the feeder mode.
Feed from the tray.
Eject paper.
n = 1/2
n = R
n Value HL-1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1650/1670N
n = 0
n = 1
n = 2
n = R
Initialize the feeder mode.
Feed from Tray 1.
Feed from Tray 2.
Eject paper.
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.2. Page Format
Set page length
EscCn
(27)(67)n
<1Bh><43h>n
This command sets the page length in lines.
or
EscCNULn (27)(67)(0)n
<1Bh><43h><00h>n
·
·
This command sets the page length in inches.
n is the number of lines that make up one page, or the length of the page in inches, according to the
form of the command.
·
If the first form of the command is used (n = the number of lines in the page) the current line spacing
setting is used to determine the length of the page.
·
·
If the first form of the command is used, n must be in the range 1 to 255.
If the second form of the command is used ( n = page length in inches ), n must be in the range 1 to
14.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(81); CHR$(22); 'Disable printer
Set left and right margins
EscXmn (27)(88)mn
<1Bh><88h>mn
·
·
This command sets the left and right margins.
m = the number of character positions at the current pitch (characters per inch) between the left edge
of the page and the left margin.
·
n = the number of character positions at the current pitch between the left edge of the page and the
right margin.
·
·
If you set m = 0 the current left margin setting is retained.
If you set n = 0 the current right margin setting is retained.
LPRINT CHR$(18); 'Set pitch to 10 CPI
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(88); CHR$(10); CHR$(70); 'Set margins to 1" and
7"
Set perforation skip
EscNn (27)(78)n
<1Bh><4Eh>n
·
This command sets the bottom margin and enables perforation skip, that is, whenever the print
position reaches the bottom margin the printer performs a page eject and moves the print position to
the top of the next page.
·
n = the number of lines at the current line space setting between the bottom edge of the page and the
bottom margin.
·
·
·
n must be in the range 1 to 255.
Esc C (set page length) and Esc O(Cancel perforation skip) cancel automatic perforation skip.
If the bottom margin is set to be above the top margin, the top margin is discarded and one line is
enabled for printing.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(78); CHR$(4); 'Set bottom margin to 4 lines.
Cancel perforation skip
EscO (27)(79)
<1Bh><4Fh>
This command cancels the automatic perforation skip feature.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(79); 'Cancel perforation skip.
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Line spacing and tabs
Set 1/8" line spacing
Esc0
(27)(48)
<1Bh><30h>
This command sets the line spacing to 1/8". All subsequent line feed operations will move the print
position 1/8" down the page.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(48); 'Set line spacing to 1/8".
Set 7/72" line spacing
Esc1
(27)(48)
<1Bh><31h>
·
This command sets the line spacing to 7/72". All subsequent line feed operations will move the print
position 7/72" down the page.
·
Since the printer's resolution is 600 dots per inch the line spacing will not be exactly 7/72".
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(49); 'Set line spacing to 7/72".
Save n/72" line spacing
EscAn (27)(65)n
<1Bh><41h>n
·
This command allows you to select a line spacing of n/72". Your selection does not take effect until
you activate it with the Esc 2 command.
·
·
·
Since the printer's resolution is 600 dots per inch the line spacing may not be exactly n/72".
n must be in the range 1 to 85.
If n is outside the range 1 to 85 the default line spacing, 1/6" is selected.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(65); CHR$(10); 'Select line spacing of 10/72".
Activate n/72" line spacing
Esc2 (27)(50)
<1Bh><32h>
This command allows you to activate the line spacing setting you specified with the Esc A command.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(50); 'Activate selected line spacing of n/72".
Set n/216" line spacing
Esc3n
(27)(51)n
<1Bh><33h>n
·
This command sets the line spacing to n/216". All subsequent line feed operations will move the print
position n/216" down the page.
·
·
Since the printer's resolution is 600 dots per inch the line spacing may not be exactly n/216".
n must be in the range 1 to 255.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(51); CHR$(25); 'Select line spacing of 25/216".
Execute n/216" line spacing
EscJn (27)(74)n
<1Bh><4Ah>n
·
·
This command moves the print position one line down the page using a line spacing of n/216".
The existing line space setting is not affected.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(50); CHR$(30); 'Move print position down 30/216".
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Set horizontal tabs
EscD<n1><n2><n3>...NUL
(27)(68)n1n2n3...(00)
<1Bh><44h>n1n2n3...<00h>
·
·
·
·
·
This command enables you to set up to 28 horizontal tab stops using the current character pitch.
The tab stops should be set in ascending order.
Esc D 0 clears all horizontal tab settings.
Esc R restores the default settings, which are at every eighth column, starting at the ninth column.
You can move the print position to the tab stops using the HT control code.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(68); CHR$(10); CHR$(20); CHR$(0); 'Set tab stops
at columns 10 and 20.
Set vertical tabs
EscB<n1><n2><n3> ...NUL (27)(66)n1n2n3...(00)
<1Bh><42h>n1n2n3...<00h>
·
·
·
·
This command enables you to set up to 64 vertical tab stops using the line feed pitch.
The tab stops should be set in ascending order.
Esc B 0 and Esc R both clear all vertical tab settings.
You can move the print position to the tab stops using the VT control code.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(66); CHR$(12); CHR$(24); CHR$(0); 'Set tab stops
at lines 12 and 24.
Horizontal tab
HT
(09)
<09h>
·
The HT control code (ASCII 9) moves the current print position one tab stop to the right.
·
The command is ignored if there are no tab stops to the right of the current print position or if the next
tab stop is beyond the right margin.
LPRINT CHR$(9);
Vertical tab
VT
(11)
<0Bh>
·
·
·
The VT control code (ASCII 11) moves the current print position one vertical tab stop down the page.
If there are no tab stops below the current print position a line feed is performed.
If no tab stops have been set a line feed is performed.
LPRINT CHR$(9);
Restore default tab settings
EscR (27)(82)
<1Bh><52h>
·
This command restores the default horizontal tab settings which are at every eight columns, starting at
the ninth column. There are no default vertical tab settings.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(82); 'Restore default tab stops.
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.3. Using Characters
Select character set I
Esc7
(27)(55)
<1Bh><37h>
This command selects IBM Character set I for use in subsequent printing operations.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(55); 'Select character set I
Select character set II
Esc6
(27)(56)
<1Bh><36h>
This command selects IBM character set II for use in subsequent printing operations.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(54); 'Select character set II
Set pitch to 10 cpi
DC2
(18)
<12h>
·
·
This command sets the printing pitch to 10 characters per inch (cpi).
If condensed character mode has previously been set, it is cancelled.
LPRINT CHR$(18); 'set pitch to 10 CPI
Set pitch to 12 cpi
Esc: (27)(58)
<1Bh><3Ah>
This command sets the printing pitch to 12 characters per inch (cpi).
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(58); 'set pitch to 12 CPI
Proportional spacing
EscPn
(27)(80)n
<1Bh><50h>n
·
·
·
·
This command allows you to turn proportional spacing on or off.
Setting n to 1 turns proportional spacing on. Subsequent text is printed proportionally spaced.
Setting n to 0 turns proportional spacing off. Subsequent text is printed monospaced.
If you change the character pitch using DC2, SI or Esc :, proportional spacing is automatically turned
off.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(80); CHR$(1); 'Turn proportional spacing on
Set condensed character mode
SI
(15)
<0Fh>
·
This command selects condensed character mode. Subsequent text characters are condensed
horizontally when printed.
·
The DC2 code, used to select a character pitch of 10 cpi, cancels condensed character mode.
LPRINT CHR$(15); 'Set condensed character mode
Set emphasized character mode
EscE (27)(69)
<1Bh><45h>
This command turns emphasized character mode on. Subsequent text is printed with a bold stroke width.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(69); 'Turn emphasized character mode on
Cancel emphasized character mode
EscF
(27)(70)
<1Bh><46h>
This command turns emphasized character mode off. Subsequent text is printed with medium stroke width.
LPRINT CHR$(27)l CHR$(70); 'Turn emphasized character mode off
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Set enlarged character mode for a single line
SO
(14)
<0Eh>
·
This command turns enlarged character mode on for one line only. The subsequent line of text is
printed using double-width characters and with the line space setting doubled.
·
The following commands cancel enlarged character mode set using the SO control code: CR, CAN,
LF, FF, VT, Esc W 0, DC4 and Esc [@.
LPRINT CHR$(14); 'Set enlarged character mode for one line
Cancel enlarged character mode
DC4 (20) <14h>
·
This control code cancels the single-line enlarged character mode set with the SO control code.
Subsequent text is printed using normal sized characters. The previous line spacing setting is restored.
·
The previous character pitch is restored.
LPRINT CHR$(20); 'Cancel enlarged character mode set with SO
Cancel
CAN
(24)
<18h>
This control code cancels single-line enlarged character mode set with the SO control code. Subsequent
text is printed using normal sized characters and the previous line spacing setting is restored.
LPRINT CHR$(24); 'Cancel enlarged character mode set with SO
Enlarged character mode
EscWn
(27)(87)n
<1Bh><57h>n
·
·
This command turns enlarged character mode on or off.
If n is set to 1 subsequent text is printed using double-width characters. The line spacing setting is
doubled.
·
If n is set to 0 subsequent text is printed using normal sized characters. The previous line spacing and
character pitch settings are restored.
·
·
Only Esc W 0 can be used to cancel enlarged character mode set using the Esc W 1 instruction.
Esc W 0 cancels enlarged character mode set using the Esc W 1 instruction, the SO control code or
the Esc [@ instruction.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(87); CHR$(1); 'Set enlarged character mode
Set superscript or subscript character mode
EscSn (27)(83)n <1Bh><53h>n
·
·
·
This command allows you to print superscripts or subscripts.
Set n to 0 to print subsequent text using superscript characters.
Set n to 1 to print subsequent text using subscript characters.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(83); CHR$(1); 'Turn on subscript mode
Cancel superscript or subscript character mode
EscT (27)(84) <1Bh><54h>
·
·
This command stops superscript or subscript printing if either had been enabled.
Subsequent text is printed using normal characters.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(84); 'Turn off superscript/subscript mode
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Underline mode
Esc-n (27)(126)n
<1Bh><7Eh>n
·
·
·
·
This command turns character underlining on or off.
If n is set to 1 subsequent text is underlined.
Horizontal tab spaces are not underlined irrespective of whether underlining mode is on or off.
If n is set to 0 subsequent text is not underlined.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(45); CHR$(1); 'Underline following text
Continuous overline mode
Esc_n (27)(95))n
<1Bh><5Fh>n
·
·
·
This command turns character overline printing on or off.
If n is set to 1 subsequent text is printed with a continuous line above it.
Horizontal tab spaces are not printed overlined irrespective of whether overline printing mode is on or
off.
·
If n is set to 0 subsequent text is not printed with an overline.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(95); CHR$(1); 'Print following text with an
overline
Select double-height / double-width mode
Esc[@n1n2n3n4n5n6 (27)(91)(64)n1n2n3n4n5n6
<1Bh><5Bh><40h>n1n2n3n4n5n6
·
This command enables you to select single or double line spacing and single or double character
height and width.
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
n1 should be set to 4 and n2,n3 and n4 to 0.
To set double line spacing and select double-height characters set n5 to 34.
To set double line spacing and select normal height characters set to n5 to 33.
To set single line spacing and select double-height characters set to n5 to 18.
To set single line spacing and select normal height characters set n5 to 17.
To select double-width characters set n6 to 2.
To select single-width characters set n6 to 1.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(91); CHR$(64); CHR$(4); CHR$(0); CHR$(0);
CHR$(0); CHR$(34); CHR$(1); 'Set double line spacing and print double-
height, double-width characters.
Select character from the All Character Code table
Esc\n1n2<Character data>
(27)(92)n1n2<Character data>
<1Bh><5Ch>n1n2<Character data>
·
·
This command enables you to print characters from the All Character Code table.
n1 and n2 specify the number of characters to be printed.
·
·
The number of characters printed is 256*n2+n1.
Control codes included in the character data are not executed.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(92); CHR$(64); CHR$(1); CHR$(65); CHR$(66);
CHR$(67); CHR$(68); CHR$(69); 'Print 320 characters starting ABCDE...
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 16
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Select a character from the All Character Code table
Esc^<char-code> (27)(94)<Char-code>
This command enables you to print a single character from the All Character Code table.
<1Bh><5Eh><Char-code>
·
·
A control code is not executed if the code is sent immediately following this instruction.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(94); CHR$(36); 'Printed a dollar sign
Select character font
EscIn (27)(73)n
<1Bh><49h>n
·
·
·
·
This command enables you to select a font and choose the print quality.
If n is set to 0 the printer's standard font and draft quality are selected.
If n is set to 2 the printer's standard font and letter quality are selected.
If n is set to 4 the download font (the characters you sent to the printer using the Esc = command) and
draft quality are selected.
·
If n is set to 6 the download font ( the characters you sent to the printer using the Esc = command) and
letter quality are selected.
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(73); CHR$(2); 'Selected letter quality printer
font
Define characters
Esc=n1n220n3(n4n5<character definition data>...)
(27)(61)n1n220n3(...
<1Bh><3Dh>n1n220n3(...
·
·
This command enables you to define and download characters for printing.
Monospaced characters are designed on a grid eleven dots wide by twelve dots high. The width of
proportionally spaced characters is specified in n5.
Character width
Blank columns
1
2
3
4
Rows 1 - 8
5
6
7
Rows 2 - 9
8
9
10
11
12
Replication area
·
·
n1 and n2 define the number of characters to be defined as follows: number of characters =
((n1+(n2*256)-2)/13.
n3 is the character code of the first character in the sequence to be defined. It is assumed that you are
defining a sequence of characters whose code numbers increment by one for each character to be
defined.
·
·
If bits 1 and 2 of n4 are 0 and bit 8 is set to 1, the bytes that make up the character definition define the
top eight rows of the grid, the most significant bit representing the top dot, and the least significant
bit representing the eighth dot down. Simply set a bit to 1 to print a dot in that position on the grid, or
to 0 to print white space.
If bits 1 and 2 of n4 are 00 and bit 8 is set to 0 the bytes that make up the character definition define
rows 2 to 9 of the grid, the most significant bit representing the second dot, and the least significant
bit representing the ninth dot down. Simply set a bit to 1 to print a dot in that position on the grid, or
to 0 to print white space.
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
If bits 1 and 2 of n4 are 01 the least significant bit of each data byte is replicated in rows 9 to 12 of the
grid.
·
·
If bits 1 and 2 of n4 are 10 the bits 1 to 4 of each data byte are replicated in rows 9 to 12 of the grid.
Bits 5 to 7 of n5 specify the number of columns left blank to the left of the defined character in
proportional spacing mode. Up to seven columns can be skipped.
·
·
Bits 1 to 4 of n5 specify the width in columns of the defined character in proportional spacing mode.
Up to fifteen columns can be used to define the character.
Downloaded characters are selected using the Esc I command and then printed by sending the
appropriate character codes.
5.4. Graphics
Set single-density image mode
EscKn1n2<image data> (27)(75)n1n2<image data>
data>
<1Bh><4Bh>n1n2<image
·
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line.
n1 and n2 define the number of bytes that comprise the image.
·
The image consists of 256*n2+n1 bytes of data, each byte representing a single vertical column of
4/30".
·
·
Images are printed left to right.
Images are printed at a horizontal resolution of 60 dots per inch and at an approximate vertical
resolution of 72 dots per inch.
·
Each byte represents a vertical column of eight dots, the most significant bit representing the dot at
the top. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white
space to appear.
10 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
20 LPRINT "*** ESC K n1 n2 ***";CHR$(10);
30 FOR i=1 TO 5
40 '* STANDARD DENSITY BIT IMAGE MODE *
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);"K";CHR$(160);CHR$(0);
60 FOR J=1 TO 8
70 FOR K=1 TO 20
80 N=2^J-1
90 LPRINT CHR$(N);
100 NEXT K
110 NEXT J
120 LPRINT CHR$(10);
130 NEXT I:END
< Sample 15 >
Set double-density image mode
EscLn1n2<image data> (27)(76)n1n2<image data>
data>
<1Bh><4Ch>n1n2<image
·
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line.
n1 and n2 define the number of bytes that comprise the image.
·
The image consists of 256*n1+n2 bytes of data, each byte representing a single vertical column of
4/30".
·
Images are printed left to right.
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 18
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
·
Images are printed at an approximate horizontal resolution of 120 dots per inch and at an approximate
vertical resolution of 72 dots per inch.
Each byte represents a vertical column of eight dots, the most significant bit representing the dot at
the top. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white
space to appear.
10 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
20 LPRINT "***ESC L n1 n2 ***"CHR$(10);
30 FOR I=1 TO 5
40 '*DOUBLE-DENSITY BIT IMAGE MODE *
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);"L";CHR$(160);CHR$(0);
60 FOR J=1 TO 8
70 FOR K=1 TO 20
80 N=2^J-1
90 LPRINT CHR$(N);
100 NEXT K
110 NEXT J
120 LPRINT CHR$(10);
130 NEXT I:END
< Sample 16 >
Set double-speed, double-density image mode
EscYn1n2<image data> (27)(89)n1n2<image data>
data>
<1Bh><59h>n1n2<image
·
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line.
n1 and n2 define the number of bytes that comprise the image.
·
The image consists of 256*n2+n1 bytes of data, each byte representing a single vertical column of
4/30".
·
·
Images are printed left to right.
Images are printed at an approximate horizontal resolution of 120 dots per inch and at an approximate
vertical resolution of 72 dots per inch.
·
·
Each byte represents a vertical column of eight dots, the most significant bit representing the dot at
the top. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white
space to appear.
This printer always prints as fast as possible, hence this command is the exact equivalent of the Esc L
command.
10 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
20 LPRINT "*** ESC Y n1 n2 ***", CHR$(10);
30 FOR I=1 TO 5
40 '*DOUBLE-SPEED & DOUBLE-DENSITY BIT IMAGE MODE *
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);"Y";CHR$(160);CHR$(0);
60 FOR J=1 TO 8
70 FOR k=1 TO 20
80 N=2^J-1
90 LPRINT CHR$(N);
100 NEXT K
110 NEXT J
120 LPRINT CHR$(10);
130 NEXT I:END
< Sample 17 >
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Set quadruple-density image mode
EscZn1n2<image data> (27)(90)n1n2<image data>
data>
<1Bh><5Ah>n1n2<image
·
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line.
n1 and n2 define the number of bytes that comprise the image.
·
The image consists of 256*n1+n2 bytes of data, each byte representing a single vertical column of
4/30".
·
·
Images are printed left to right.
Images are printed at an approximate horizontal resolution of 240 dots per inch and at an approximate
vertical resolution of 72 dots per inch.
·
Each byte represents a vertical column of eight dots, the most significant bit representing the dot at
the top. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white
space to appear.
10 WIDTH "LPT1:",255
20 LPRINT "*** ESC Z n1 n2 ***";CHR$(10);
30 FOR I=1 TO 5
40 '* QUADRUPLE-DENSITY BIT IMAGE MODE *
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);"Z";CRH$(16);CHR$(0);
60 FOR J=1 TO 8
70 FOR K=1 TO 20
80 N=2^J-1
90 LPRINT CHR$(N);
100 NEXT K
110 NEXT J
120 LPRINT CHR$(10);
130 NEXT I:END
< Sample 18 >
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 20
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
6.
INDEX
A
O
Automatic line feed....................................................................9
overline mode ........................................................................... 16
B
P
Backspace....................................................................................8
page length ............................................................................... 11
paper input control.................................................................. 10
perforation skip ........................................................................ 11
pitch ........................................................................................... 14
print quality............................................................................... 17
proportional spacing ............................................................... 14
C
cancel.........................................................................................15
Carriage return ............................................................................8
character set..........................................................................6, 14
characters ..................................................................................17
condensed character................................................................14
control codes ..............................................................................6
Q
quadruple-density image mode.............................................. 20
D
R
double-density image mode....................................................18
double-height / double-width mode......................................16
resolution .................................................................................... 6
right margin ............................................................................... 11
E
S
emphasized character...............................................................14
emulation mode...........................................................................9
enlarged character....................................................................15
Escape..........................................................................................8
Escape sequences ......................................................................6
single-density image mode..................................................... 18
Space............................................................................................ 8
subscript character mode........................................................ 15
superscript character mode .................................................... 15
syntax........................................................................................... 7
F
T
feeder mode...............................................................................10
Form feed.....................................................................................8
tab settings ............................................................................... 13
U
G
underline mode......................................................................... 16
User reset .................................................................................... 9
graphics .....................................................................................18
H
V
horizontal tab ............................................................................13
vertical tab................................................................................. 13
L
left margin ..................................................................................11
Line feed ......................................................................................8
line spacing ...............................................................................12
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 22
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 8
BAR CODE
CONTROL
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CONTENTS
1. INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................................................................3
2. PRINT BAR CODES OR EXPANDED CHARACTERS .................................................................4
3. DEFINITION OF PARAMETERS.........................................................................................................5
3.1. Bar Code Mode ..................................................................................................................................5
3.2. Bar Code Style, Expanded Character Shading, Line Block Drawing & Box Drawing Shading.........5
3.3. Bar Code Scaling (Width only)...........................................................................................................6
3.4. Bar Code Human Readable Line On or Off.......................................................................................6
3.5. Quiet Zone..........................................................................................................................................6
3.6. Bar Code, Expanded Character Unit, Line Block Drawing & Box Drawing Units..............................6
3.7. Bar Code, Expanded Character, Line, Block Drawing & Box Drawing Offset in the X-axis .............7
3.8. Bar Code & Expanded Character Offset in the Y-axis ......................................................................7
3.9. Bar Code, Expanded Character, Line, Block Drawing & Box Drawing Height..................................7
3.10. Expanded Character, Line Block Drawing & Box Drawing Width...................................................7
3.11. Expanded Character Rotation..........................................................................................................7
3.12. Bar Code Data Start.........................................................................................................................8
3.13. Box Drawing.....................................................................................................................................9
3.14. Line Block Drawing ..........................................................................................................................9
3.15. Expanded Character Data Start.......................................................................................................9
4. EXAMPLE PROGRAM LISTINGS ................................................................................................... 10
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
1.
INTRODUCTION
Some of the HL series printers can print bar codes in the HP LaserJet, EPSON FX-850, and IBM Proprinter XL
emulation modes, refer to the printer User guide for information.
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
2.
PRINT BAR CODES OR EXPANDED CHARACTERS
ESC i n ... n \ (27)(105)n ... n (92)
<1Bh><69h>n ... n <5Ch>
Creates bar codes or expanded characters according to the parameters “n ... n”. For further information about
the parameters, see the following “Definition of Parameters.” This command must end with the “ \ ” code (5CH).
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.
DEFINITION OF PARAMETERS
This bar code command can have the following parameters in the parameter segment (n ... n). Parameters are
effective only within the single command sequence using the syntax ESC i n ... n \. They do not take effect in
any subsequent bar code commands. If any parameters are not specified, they take the default settings. The
last parameter must be the bar code data start identifier (“b” or “B”) or the expanded character data start identifier
(“l” or “L”). Other parameters can be specified in any sequence. The prefix of each parameter can be either a
lower-case or upper-case character, - for example, “t0” or “T0”, “s3” or “S3”, etc.
3.1. Bar Code Mode
n = “t0” or “T0”
n = “t1” or “T1”
n = “t3” or “T3”
n = “t4” or “T4”
n = “t5” or “T5”
n = “t6” or “T6”
n = “t9” or “T9”
n = “t12” or “T12”
n = “t13” or “T13”
n = “t14” or “T14”
n = “t130” or “T130”
CODE 39 (default)
Interleaved 2 of 5
FIM (US-Post Net)
Post Net (US-Post Net)
EAN 8, EAN 13, or UPC A
UPC E
Codabar
Code 128 set A
Code 128 set B
Code 128 set C
ISBN (EAN)
n = “t131” or “T131”
n = "t132" or "T132"
n = "t133" or "T133"
n = "t134" or "T134"
ISBN (UPC-E)
EAN 128 set A
EAN 128 set B
EAN 128 set C
This parameter selects the bar code mode as above. When n is “t5” or “T5”, the bar code mode (EAN 8, EAN
13, or UPC A) varies according to the number of characters in the data.
3.2. Bar Code Style, Expanded Character Shading, Line Block Drawing & Box
Drawing Shading
ŸBar Code Style
n = “s0” or “S0”
n = “s1” or “S1”
n = “s3” or “S3”
3 : 1 (default)
2 : 1
2.5 : 1
This parameter selects the bar code style as above. When the EAN 8, EAN 13 or UPC-A bar code mode is
selected, this bar code style parameter is ignored.
ŸExpanded Character shading
“S” 0 = White
1 = Black
2 = Vertical stripes
3 = Horizontal stripes
4 = Cross hatch
e.g. “S” n1 n2
n1 = Background fill pattern
n2 = Foreground fill pattern
If “S” is followed by only one parameter, the parameter is a foreground fill pattern.
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
ŸLine Block Drawing & Box Drawing Shading
“S” 1 = Black
2 = Vertical stripes
3 = Horizontal stripes
4 = Cross hatch
3.3. Bar Code Scaling (Width only)
n = “mnnn” or “Mnnn” (nnn = 0 ~ 32767)
This parameter specifies the bar code width scaling. The unit of "nnn" is %. The default value is m100
(100%).
3.4. Bar Code Human Readable Line On or Off
n = “r0” or “R0”
n = “r1” or “R1”
Human readable line OFF
Human readable line ON
Default:
Human readable line ON when the following barcode types are selected.
(1) “T5” or “t5”
(2) “T6” or “t6”
(3) “T130” or “t130”
(4) “T131” or “t131”
Default:
Human readable line OFF
All others
This parameter specifies whether or not the printer prints the human readable line below the bar code. Human
readable characters are always printed with OCR-B font at 10 cpi pitch and all the current character style
enhancements are masked. Note that the default setting is subject to the bar code mode selected by “t” or “T”.
3.5. Quiet Zone
n = “onnn” or “Onnn” (nnn = 0 ~ 32767)
Quiet Zone is the space on both side of the bar codes. Its width can be specified using the units which are set
by the "u" or "U" parameter. ( For the description of "u" or "U" parameter, see the next section.) The
default setting of Quiet Zone width is 1 inch.
3.6. Bar Code, Expanded Character Unit, Line Block Drawing & Box Drawing
Units
n = “u0” or “U0”
n = “u1” or “U1”
n = “u2” or “U2”
n = “u3” or “U3”
n = “u4” or “U4”
n = “u5” or “U5”
n = “u6” or “U6”
n = “u7” or “U7”
Millimeters (default)
1/10”
1/100”
1/12”
1/120”
1/10 Millimeter
1/300”
1/720”
This parameter specifies the measurement units of X-axis offset, Y-axis offset and bar code height.
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.7. Bar Code, Expanded Character, Line, Block Drawing & Box Drawing Offset in
the X-axis
n = “xnnn” or “Xnnn”
This parameter specifies the offset from the current print position in the “u”- or “U”-specified units.
3.8. Bar Code & Expanded Character Offset in the Y-axis
n = “ynnn” or “Ynnn”
This parameter specifies the downward offset from the current print position in the “u”- or “U”-specified units.
3.9. Bar Code, Expanded Character, Line, Block Drawing & Box Drawing Height
n = “hnnn”, “Hnnn”, “dnnn”, or “Dnnn”
Default heights
(1)
EAN13, EAN8, UPC-A, ISBN (EAN13, EAN8, UPC-A),
ISBN (UPC-E):
UPC-E:
22 mm
18 mm
12 mm
(2)
(3)
Others:
Expanded characters
Ý
Ý
2.2 mm (default)
1 dot
Line Block Drawing & Box Drawing
This parameter specifies the height of bar codes or expanded characters as above. It can take the prefix “h”,
“H”, “d”, or “D”. The height is specified in the “u”- or “U”-specified units. Note that the default setting of
the bar code height (12 mm, 18 mm or 22 mm) is subject to the bar code mode selected by “t” or “T”.
3.10. Expanded Character, Line Block Drawing & Box Drawing Width
n = “wnnn” or “Wnnn”
Default widths
Expanded character
Ý
1.2 mm
Line Block Drawing & Box Drawing Ý
1 dot
This parameter specifies the width of expanded characters in the selected units as above.
3.11. Expanded Character Rotation
n = “a0” or “A0”
n = “a1” or “A1”
n = “a2” or “A2”
n = “a3” or “A3”
Upright (default)
Rotated 90 degrees clockwise
Upside down, rotated 180 degrees clockwise
Rotated 270 degrees clockwise
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.12. Bar Code Data Start
n = “b” or “B”
·
·
Data that follows “b” or “B” is read in as bar code data. Bar code data must end with the “ \ ” code (5CH),
which also terminates this command. The acceptable bar code data is subject to the bar code mode selected
by “t” or “T” as listed below.
When the CODE 39 is selected with the parameter “t0” or “T0”:
Forty three characters “0” to “9”, “A” to “Z”, “–”, “ . ”, “ (space)”, “$”, “ / ”, “+”, and “%” can be accepted
as bar code data. Other characters cause data error. The number of characters for bar codes is not limited.
The bar code data automatically starts and ends with an asterisk “ * ” (start character and stop character). If
the received data has an asterisk “ * ” at its beginning or end, the asterisk is regarded as a start character or
stop character. When you put "?" on the end of the data, a check digit is automatically added.
·
When the Interleaved 2 of 5 is selected with the parameter “t1” or “T1”:
Ten numerical characters “0” to “9” can be accepted as bar code data. Other characters cause data error.
The number of characters for bar codes is not limited. Since this mode of bar codes require even characters,
if the bar code data has odd characters, the zero character “0” is automatically added to the end of the bar
code data. When you put "?" on the end of the data, a check digit is automatically added.
·
·
·
When the FIM (US-Post Net) is selected with the parameter “t3” or “T3”:
Characters “A” to “D” are valid and 1 digit of data can be printed. Uppercase and lowercase alphabet
characters can be accepted.
When the Post Net (US-Post Net) is selected with the parameter “t4” or “T4”:
Characters “0” to “9” can be accepted as bar code data and it must be terminated by a check digit. “?” can
be used in place of a check digit.
When the EAN 8, EAN 13, or UPC A is selected with the parameter “t5” or “T5”:
Ten numerical characters “0” to “9” can be accepted as bar code data. The number of characters for bar
codes is limited as follows.
EAN 8:
EAN 13:
UPC A:
Total 8 digits (7 digits + 1 check digit)
Total 13 digits (12 digits + 1 check digit)
Total 12 digits (11 digits + 1 check digit)
Any number of characters other than as above causes a data error and the bar code data is printed as normal
print data. If the check digit is incorrect, the printer calculates it and replaces it with the correct check digit
so that the correct bar code data will be printed. When EAN13 is selected, adding “+” and a 2-or 5-digit
number after the data will create the add-on code.
When UPC-E is selected with the parameter “t6” or “T6”:
The numerical characters “0” to “9” can be accepted as bar code data.
8 digits
Standard format. The first character must be “0” and the data must be terminated by a
check digit.
Total 8 digits = "0" + 6 digits + 1 check digit
6 digits
*1:
The first character "0" and the last check digit are removed from the 8 digit data.
For 8 digits, “?” can be used in place of a check digit.
*2:
Adding “+” and 2- or 5-digit number after the data creates an add-on code
for all 6 and 8 digit formats.
·
When Codabar is selected with the parameter “t9” or “T9”:
Characters “0” to “9”, “–”, “ . ”, “$”, “/”, “+”, “ : ” can be printed. Characters “A” to “D” can be printed as a
start-stop code, which can be uppercase or lowercase. If there is no start-stop code, an error will occur.
The check digit cannot be added and “?” causes an error.
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
When Code 128 Set A, Set B, or Set C is selected with the parameter “t12” or “12,” “t13” or “T13,” or “t14” or
“T14” respectively:
Code sets A, B and C are individually selectable. Set A encodes characters in the range Hex 00 to 5F. Set
B encodes characters in the range Hex 20 to 7F. Set C encodes numeric pairs in the range 00 to 99.
-
-
-
Switching is allowed between the code sets by sending %A, %B, or %C.
FNC 1, 2, 3, and 4 are produced with %1, %2, %3, and %4.
The SHIFT code, %S, allows temporary switching (for 1 character only) between set A and set B and
vice versa.
-
To print the “%” character, it must be sent twice.
·
When ISBN (EAN) is selected with the parameter “t130” or “T130”:
The rules are the same as for “t5” or “T5”
·
·
When the ISBN (UPC-E) is selected with the parameter “t131” or “T131”:
The rules are the same as for “t6” or “T6”
When EAN 128 set A, set B or set C is selected with the parameter "t132" or "T132," "t133" or "T133" or
"t134" or "T134" respectively: Same rules apply as for "t12" or "T12," "t13" or "T13", or "t14" or "T14."
3.13. Box Drawing
ESC i ... E (or e)
“E” or “e” is a terminator.
3.14. Line Block Drawing
ESC i ... V (or v)
“V” or “v” is a terminator.
3.15. Expanded Character Data Start
n = “l” or “L”
Data that follows “l” or “L” is read in as expanded character data (or labeling data). Expanded character data
must end with the “ \ ” code (5CH), which also terminates this command. To print the '\' character, you must
input '\\'.
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.
EXAMPLE PROGRAM LISTINGS
10 ' Barcode
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255
30 ' CODE 39
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it0r1s0x00y00b123456\";
50 'INTER LEAVED
60 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it1r1s0x70y00b123456\";
70 ' EAN-13
80 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it5r1s0x00y020b123456789012?\";
90 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it5r1s0x70y020b123456789012?+12345\";
100 ' UPC-A
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it5r1s0x00y050b12345678901?\";
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it5r1s0x70y050b12345678901?+12345\";
130 ' EAN-8
140 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it5r1s0x00y080b1234567?\";
150 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it5r1s0x70y080b1234567?+12345\";
160 ' UPC-E
170 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it6r1s0x00y110b0123456?\";
180 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it6r1s0x70y110b0123456?+12344\";
190 ' CODABAR
195 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it9r1s0x00y140bA123456A\";
210 ' POST NET
220 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it4r1x70y140b1234567?\";
230 ' FIM
240 LPRINT CHR$(27); "iT3R1x130Y140BA\";
250 ' ISBN
260 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it130r1s0x00y170b123456789012?+12345\";
270 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it130r1s0x70y170b12345678901?+12345\";
280 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it130r1s0x00y200b1234567?+12345\";
300 ' LABEL PRINT
310 LPRINT CHR$(27); "ih10w10x25y230lSample\";
320 LPRINT CHR$(27); "ix90y230s4h10w10f2g2e";
330 LPRINT CHR$(27); "ix105y230s4h10w10v";
400 LPRINT CHR$(&HC);
< Sample 19 >
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CHAPTER 9
HP-GL
GRAPHICS
LANGUAGE
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CONTENTS
1. COMMAND LIST....................................................................................................................................3
2. INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................................................................4
2.1. HP-GL Syntax.....................................................................................................................................4
2.2. Font Selection ....................................................................................................................................4
2.3. Coordinate System and Printing Area................................................................................................4
2.3.1. Coordinate system........................................................................................................................... 4
2.3.2. Printing area.................................................................................................................................... 5
3. COMMANDS...........................................................................................................................................6
3.1. Initialization and Default Setting Instructions......................................................................................6
3.2. Plot Area and Unit Setting Instructions...............................................................................................7
3.3. Pen Control and Plot Instructions ......................................................................................................8
3.4. The polygon Group...........................................................................................................................13
3.5. Plot Function Instructions.................................................................................................................18
3.6. Character Plot Instructions ..............................................................................................................20
3.7. Dual Context Extensions..................................................................................................................26
4. INDEX.................................................................................................................................................... 27
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
1.
COMMAND LIST
DF
IN
IP
Default set instruction
Initialize set instruction
Input scaling point
Scale
Input window
Rotate coordinate system
Page feed
Pen up
Pen down
Plot absolute
Relative coordinate pen move
Draw absolute arc
Draw relative arc
Circle plot
Edge rectangle absolute
Edge rectangle relative
Edge wedge
Fill rectangle absolute
Fill rectangle relative
Fill wedge
Fill type
Line type selection
Pen width
Symbol mode
Select pen
6
6
7
7
8
8
8
9
9
SC
IW
RO
PG
PU
PD
PA
PR
AA
AR
CI
EA
ER
EW
RA
RR
WG
FT
LT
PW
SM
SP
TL
XT
YT
PT
CS
CA
SS
9
10
11
11
12
13
14
15
16
16
17
18
18
19
19
19
19
20
20
20
20
20
21
21
21
22
22
23
23
23
24
24
25
Tick length
X-axis tick
Y-axis tick
Pen thickness select
Standard character set
Alternate character set
Select standard character set
Select alternate character set
Define label terminator
Character plot
Absolute direction
Relative direction
Character plot
SA
DT
LB
DI
DR
CP
SI
SR
SL
UC
Set absolute character size
Set relative character size
Character slant
User-defined character
EscCRRO, EscCRRL, EscCRRM, EscCRRD
Set high resolution control (Brother original)
26
26
26
EscCR!#R
EscCRFD
User reset (Brother original)
Factory reset (Brother original)
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
2.
INTRODUCTION
The HP-GL graphics mode emulates 40 out of 56 instructions for the HP 7475A plotter made by Hewlett-Packard.
Default measurement unit in the HP-GL graphics mode is 1/1016"(0.025mm).
2.1. HP-GL Syntax
A command consists of a two-letter instruction mnemonic, a parameter field (not needed for some instructions)
and a terminator. Parameters following the instruction mnemonic must be separated from each other by at least a
single space or comma.
Parameter Field
Instruction Mnemonic
Terminator
P
A
10
20 ;
At least one space or
comma (,) must be used
Numeric values used in the parameter field are in one of the following four formats.
(1) Integer - integers between -230 and 230 -1. Real numbers specified for a parameter that should be an integer are
rounded to the nearest integer.
(2) Clamped integers - integers between -32768 and 32767. Values outside this range are converted to the nearest
integer within the range. Real numbers are rounded to the nearest integer.
(3) Real - real numbers between -230 and 230 -1.
(4) Clamped Real - real numbers between -32768 and 32767. Values outside this range are converted to the
nearest real number within the range.
2.2. Font Selection
Eighteen character sets compatible with the HP 7454A are available.
2.3. Coordinate System and Printing Area
2.3.1. Coordinate system
Paper feed direction
Y
Home Position
X
The home position is at the upper left corner of the area where printing is possible.
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
2.3.2. Printing area
c
d
a
b
a
4
b
5
c
5
d
5
(mm)
A4
A3
4
5
5
5 (HL-3400CN/3260N)
Letter
Legal
6
6
5
5
5
5
5
5
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.
COMMANDS
3.1. Initialization and Default Setting Instructions
DF - Default set instruction
DF[;]
·
·
Returns the graphics mode to the default conditions.
The following are the default settings.
Function
Equivalent
Instruction
PA;
DR 1,0;
LT;
Condition
Plot mode
Relative character direction
Line type
Absolute plotting
Horizontal
Solid line
Line pattern length
Window
LT;
IW;
4% of distance from P1 to P2
Set at limits of printable area
according to paper size
Width=0.75% of |P2x - P1x|
Height=1.5% of |P2y - P1y|
Off
X-axis: 0.5% of |P2y - P1y|
Y-axis: 0.5% of |P2x - P1x|
Character set 0
Relative character size
SR;
Symbol mode
Tick length
SM;
TL;
Standard character set
Alternate character set
Character set
Character slant
Scaling
CS 0;
CA 0;
SS;
SL 0;
SC;
Character set 0
Standard character set selected
0 degrees
Off
Label terminator
Chord angle
DT chr$(3)
-----
chr$(3)
5 degrees
Fill type
Fill distance
Fill slant
FT;
FT;
FT;
Bi-directional fill, type 1
1% of distance from P1 to P2
0 degrees
Pen Thickness
PT;
Set at 0.3 mm
NOTE:
The location of the scaling points(P1, P2) remains constant.
IN - Initialize set instruction
IN[;]
·
Returns the graphics mode to the following initial conditions;
Function
Equivalent
Instruction
PA;
Condition
Plot mode
Absolute
Relative character direction
Line type
DR 1,0;
LT;
Horizontal
Solid line
Line pattern length
Window
LT;
IW;
4% of distance from P1 to P2
Set at limits of printable
area according to paper size
Width=0.75% of |P2x-P1X|
Height=1.5% of |P2y-P1y |
Off
X-axis: 0.5% of |P2y-P1y |
Y-axis: 0.5% of |P2x-P1x|
Character set 0
Character set 0
Standard character set
selected
Relative character size
SR;
Symbol mode
Tick length
SM;
TL;
Standard character set
Alternate character set
Character set
CS 0;
CA 0;
SS;
Character slant
Scaling
SL 0;
SC ;
0 degrees
Off
Label terminator
Chord angle
DT chr$(3)
-----
chr$(3)
5 degrees
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Function
Equivalent
Instruction
FT;
FT;
FT;
Condition
Fill type
Fill distance
Fill slant
Bi-directional fill, type 1
1% of distance from P1 to P2
0 degrees
Pen thickness
Pen condition
Rotation
PT;
PU;
RO;
IP;
Set at 0.3 mm
Pen up
Set at 0 degrees
Initialized according to
paper size
Scaling points
3.2. Plot Area and Unit Setting Instructions
Instruction
Function
IP
Scaling point
Scale
Input window
Rotate coordinate system
Page output
SC
IW
RO
PG
IP - Input scaling point
IP [ P1X, P1Y [,P2X, P2Y]] [;]
P1X ; X coordinate of P1
P2X ; X coordinate of P2
P1Y ; Y coordinate of P1
P2Y ; Y coordinate of P2
·
·
·
The coordinate values used are absolute values in graphics units.
Sets the location of the scaling points(P1, P2).
Coordinate values for P1X, P1Y, P2X and P2Y are given as integer numbers.
The IP instruction is ignored when the set coordinates are outside the print area.
·
·
Using this instruction without a parameter field initializes the scaling points(P1, P2).
P2X and P2Y may be omitted. (If P2X and P2Y are omitted, P2 is set automatically so as not to alter the distance
between P1 and P2).
SC - Scale
SC Xmin, Xmax, Ymin, Ymax
Xmin ; X coordinate of P1
Ymin ; Y coordinate of P1
Xmax ; X coordinate of P2
Ymax ; Y coordinate of P2
·
·
·
·
Sets the scale for the coordinates the user wants to establish.
Coordinate values for Xmin, Xmax, Ymin and Ymax are given as real numbers.
Using this instruction without a parameter field turns the scaling off.
The technical terms user unit and graphics unit as used in this manual are defined as follows;
User unit
: the unit of the coordinates set by the SC instruction
Graphics unit
: the unit (1/1016 of an inch) of the coordinates not set by the SC
instruction
10 '*** SCEX ***
20 LPRINT "IN; IP3000,2000,4500,3500;SP1;SC0,120,0,120;"
30 FOR T=0 TO 2*3.1416+3.1416/20 STEP 3.1416/20
40 X=COS(T)*100
50 Y=SIN(T)*100
60 LPRINT "PA";X;",";Y;";PD;"
70 NEXT T
80 LPRINT "PU;"
90 END
<Sample 61>
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
IW - Input window
IW [ X1, Y1, X2, Y2 ] [;]
X1-Window lower left X coordinate
X2-Window upper right X coordinate
Y1-Window lower left Y coordinate
Y2-Window upper right Y coordinate
·
·
·
·
This instruction sets the window inside which plotting can be performed.
Graphic units are always used.
Coordinate values for X1, Y1, X2 and Y2 are integer numbers from 0 to 32,767.
The order of the pairs (X1, Y1) and (X2, Y2) may be reversed with no change in the window created: "IW X1,
Y1, X2, Y2" is identical in effect to "IW X2, Y2, X1, Y1".
·
Using this instruction without a parameter field releases any previous limitations on the plot area.
(X2,Y2)
(X1,Y1)
Print paper
Window
RO - Rotate coordinate system
RO [q][;]
q : Angle in degrees through which the coordinate system is rotated.
·
·
·
This instruction rotates the coordinate system.
A value of 0 or 90 must be used for q.
Using this instruction without a parameter field sets the rotation of the coordinate system to 0 degrees.
PG - Page feed
PG [;]
·
·
Executes a page feed
After page feeding, the cursor position return to the home position (0, 0).
3.3. Pen Control and Plot Instructions
Instruction
Function
PU
PD
PA
PR
AA
AR
CI
Pen Up
Pen Down
Plot Absolute
Relative Coordinate Pen Move
Absolute Arc Plot
Relative Arc Plot
Circle
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
PU - Pen up
PU [ X,Y [,...]] [;]
X ; X coordinate of the cursor movement destination
Y ; Y coordinate of the cursor movement destination
·
X and Y are either relative or absolute, depending on whether a PA or a PR was the last plot command
executed. The absolute coordinates are set as default.
·
·
·
·
·
·
Moves the cursor to the specified coordinates after raising the pen.
Using this instruction without a parameter field raises the pen without changing the cursor position.
When scaling is on, user coordinates are used.
Also, when scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are real numbers.
When scaling is off graphics units are used.
When there is no scaling, the coordinates values for X and Y are integer numbers.
(X1, Y1)
(Xn, Yn)
(X2,Y2)
(X3, Y3)
Current position
PD - Pen down
PD [ X, Y [,...]] [;]
X ; X coordinate of the cursor movement destination
Y ; Y coordinate of the cursor movement destination
·
X and Y are either relative or absolute, depending on whether a PA or a PR was the last plot command
executed. The absolute coordinates are set as default.
·
·
Moves the cursor to the specified coordinates after lowering the pen. (This plots a straight line.)
Using this instruction without a parameter lowers the pen without changing the cursor position. ( One dot is
plotted.)
·
·
·
·
When scaling has been performed, the cursor is moved by user coordinates.
Also, when scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are real numbers.
When there is no scaling, the cursor is moved by absolute coordinates in graphics units.
When there is no scaling, the coordinate values for X and Y are integer numbers.
(X1, Y1)
(Xn, Yn)
(X2,Y2)
(X3, Y3)
Current position
PA - Plot absolute
PA [X, Y [,...]] [;]
X ; X coordinate of the cursor movement destination
Y ; Y coordinate of the cursor movement destination
·
·
·
·
·
·
X and Y are absolute values in user units or graphics units.
Moves the cursor to the specified coordinates.
Plots a straight line only when the pen is down.
When scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are integer numbers.
When there is no scaling, the cursor is moved by absolute coordinates in graphics units.
When there is no scaling, the coordinate values for X and Y are integer numbers.
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
(X1, Y1)
(X2,Y2)
(Xn, Yn)
(X3, Y3)
Current position
10 '*** PAEX1 ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;"
30 LPRINT "PA2000,6000;PD0,6000,2000,7500,2000,6000;PU2500,6000;"
40 LPRINT "PAPD4500,6000,2500,7500,2500,6000;PU10365,500;"
50 END
<Sample 62>
10 ' *** PAEX2 ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;SC0,100,0,100;"
30 LPRINT "PA50,30;PD25,30,50,50,50,30;PU55,30;"
40 LPRINT "PAPD80,30,55,50,55,30,PU;"
50 END
<Sample 63>
PR - Relative coordinate pen move
PR [X, Y [,...]] [;]
X ; X coordinate of the cursor movement destination
Y ; Y coordinate of the cursor movement destination
·
·
·
·
·
·
Coordinates are relative to the current position in user units or graphics units.
Plots a straight line only when the pen is down.
When scaling has been performed, the cursor is moved by relative coordinates in user units.
Also, when scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are real numbers.
When there is no scaling, the cursor is moved by relative coordinates in graphics units.
When there is no scaling, the coordinate values for X and Y are integer numbers.
X1
Y2
Y
Y3
Current position
X3
10 ' *** prex 1 ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;"
30 LPRINT "PA5000,4500,;PDPR-2000,0,2000,2000,0,-2000;PU500,0;"
40 LPRINT "PD2000,0,-2000,2000,0,-2000;PU;"
50 END
<Sample 64>
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
AA - Draw absolute arc
AA [ X, Y, qc [, qd ]] [;]
X ; Arc centre X coordinate
qc ; Arc angle in degrees
Y ; Arc centre Y coordinate
qd ; Chord angle in degrees
·
·
X and Y coordinates are absolute coordinates in user units or graphics units.
Starting from the current position, plots an arc centred on the absolute coordinates X, Y having the specified
arc angle and chord angle, with the radius being the distance between the current position and the point X,Y.
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
After plotting, the cursor position moves to the plot end point.
Plotting is performed only when the pen is down.
When the pen is up, plotting is not performed but the cursor position moves to the plot end point.
When scaling has been performed, the cursor is moved by absolute coordinates in user units.
Also, when scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are real numbers.
When there is no scaling, the cursor is moved by absolute coordinates in graphics units.
When there is no scaling, the coordinate values for X and Y are integer number.
The value for pc is a clamped real number.
When qc is positive, counterclockwise plotting from the current point is performed.
When qc is negative, plotting is made clockwise from the current position.
The value for qd is a clamped real number.
When qd is not specified, the chord angle is the default value ( 5 degrees ).
qc = Arc Angle
qd = Chord Angle
(X,Y)
10 '*** AAEX ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;IP2650,1325,7650,6325;"
30 LPRINT "SC0,100,0,100;"
40 LPRINT "PA0,30;"
50 LPRINT "PD;PA0,45;AA0,50,180;PA0,70;"
60 LPRINT "AA0,100,90;PA45,100;AA50,100,180;PA70,100;"
70 LPRINT "AA100,100,90;PA100,55;AA100,50,180;PA100,30;"
80 LPRINT "AA100,0,90;PA100,55;AA100,50,180;PA70,100;"
90 LPRINT "AA100,0,90;PA55,0;AA50,0,180;PA30,0;AA0,0,90;"
100 LPRINT "PU;PA50,50,CI20;"
110 END
<Sample 68>
AR - Draw relative arc
AR X, Y, qc(, qd)[;]
X ; Arc centre X coordinate
qc ; Arc angle in degrees
Y ; Arc centre Y coordinate
qd ; Chord angle in degrees
·
·
X and Y coordinates are relative coordinates in user units or graphics units.
Starting from the current cursor position the command plots an arc whose centre is at the relative coordinate
position (X,Y) and which has the specified arc and chord angles. The radius of the arc is the distance
between the current position and the point (X,Y).
·
After plotting the cursor position changes to the plot end point.
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
Plotting is performed only when the pen is down.
When the pen is up, plotting is not performed but the cursor position moves to the plot end point.
When scaling has been performed, the cursor is moved by relative coordinates in user units.
Also, when scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are real numbers.
When there is no scaling, the cursor is moved by relative coordinates in graphics units.
When there is no scaling, the coordinate values for X and Y are integer numbers.
The value for qc is a clamped real number.
When qc is positive, counterclockwise plotting from the current point is performed.
When qc is negative, plotting is made clockwise from the current position.
The value for qd is a clamped real number.
When qd is not specified, the chord angle is the default value ( 5 degrees ).
10 '*** AREX1 ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;IP2650,1325,7650,6325;"
30 LPRINT "SC-100,100,-100,100;"
40 LPRINT "PA-80,-80;PD;AR0,50,90;AR50,0,90;PU;"
50 END
<Sample 69>
10 ' *** AREX2 ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;IP2650,1325,7650,6325;"
30 LPRINT "SC-100,100,-100,100;"
40 LPRINT "PA-100,70;PD;PR30,0;AR-,-70,-90;AR70,0,90;PR60,0;PU;"
50 END
100 END
<Sample 70>
CI - Circle plot
CI r(, qd)[;]
r : Radius of circle ( in user units or graphic units )
qd : Chord angle ( in degrees )
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
Plots a circle centred on the current position with a radius r and chord angle qd.
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin at the centre of the circle.
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.
When scaling has been performed, the circle is plotted in user units.
Also, when scaling has been performed, the value for r is a real number.
When scaling is off, the circle is plotted in graphics units.
When there is no scaling, the coordinate value for r is an integer number.
When qd is not specified, the chord angle is the default value (5 degrees).
Radius
Chord angle
Current position
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
10 '*** CIEX1 ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;IP2650,1325,7650,6325;"
30 LPRINT "SC-100,100,-100,100;"
40 LPRINT "PA-60,50;CI40,45;"
50 LPRINT "PA60,50;CI40,30;"
60 LPRINT "PA-60,-50;CI40,15;"
70 LPRINT "PA60,-50;CI40,5;"
80 END
<Sample 65>
10 '*** CIEX2 ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;IP2650,1325,8650,7325;"
30 LPRINT "SC0,170,0,170;"
40 LPRINT "PA100,100;LT;CI10,5;LT0;CI-20,5;LT1;CI30,5;"
50 LPRINT "LT2;CI-40,5;LT3;CI50,5;LT4;CI-
60,5;LT5;CI70,5;LT6;CI80,5;"
60 END
<Sample 66>
10 '*** CIEX3 ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;IP2650,1325,7650,6325;"
30 LPRINT "SC-1000,1000,-1000,1000;"
40 LPRINT "PA-800,800;"
50 GOSUB 130
60 LPRINT "PA200,800;"
70 GOSUB 130
80 LPRINT "PA-800,-200;"
90 GOSUB 130
100 LPRINT"PA200,-200;"
110 GOSUB 130
120 END
130 LPRINT "CI70;PR600,0;CI70;PR-300,-300;CI250;"
140 LPRINT "PR-300,-300;CI70;PR600,0;CI70;"
150 RETURN
<Sample 67>
3.4. The polygon Group
Instruction
Function
EA
ER
EW
RA
RR
WG
Edge Absolute Rectangle
Edge Relative Rectangle
Edge Wedge
Fill Absolute Rectangle
Fill Relative Rectangle
Fill Wedge
EA - Edge rectangle absolute
EA X, Y[;]
X ; X coordinate of opposite angle for the rectangle
Y ; Y coordinate of opposite angle for the rectangle
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
X and Y coordinates are absolute coordinates in user units or graphics units.
Plots the rectangle formed by the current position and the opposite angle specified by X and Y.
After plotting the cursor returns to its point of origin.
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.
When scaling has been performed, the rectangle is plotted in user units.
Also, when scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are real numbers.
When there is no scaling, the rectangle is plotted in graphics units.
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
·
When there is no scaling, the coordinate values for X and Y are integer numbers.
(X, Y)
Current position
10 '*** EAEX ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA7000,4000;"
30 LPRINT "PT.3;FT1;RA6000,3000;"
40 LPRINT "SP3,;EA6000,3000;"
50 LPRINT "SP4;FT3,100;RA8000,3000;"
60 LPRINT "SP3,;EA8000,3000;"
70 LPRINT "SP5;PT.3;FT2;RA8000,5000;"
80 LPRINT "SP3;EA8000,5000;"
90 LPRINT "SP6;FT4,100,45;RA6000,5000;"
100 LPRINT "SP3;EA6000,5000;PG"
110 END
<Sample 72>
ER - Edge rectangle relative
ER X, Y[;]
X ; X coordinate of opposite angle for the rectangle
Y ; Y coordinate of opposite angle for the rectangle
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
Coordinates are relative to the current position in user units or graphics units.
Plots the rectangle formed by the current position and the opposite angle specified by X and Y.
After plotting the cursor returns to its point of origin.
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.
When scaling has been performed, the rectangle is plotted in user units.
Also, when scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are real numbers.
When there is no scaling, the rectangle is plotted in graphics units.
When there is no scaling, the coordinate values for X and Y are integer numbers.
Y increment
Current position
X increment
10 '*** EREX ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA5000,5000;"
30 LPRINT "PT.3;FT1;RR500,500;"
40 LPRINT "SP3,;ER500,500;"
50 LPRINT "PR500,0"
60 LPRINT "SP4;FT3,;RR500,500;"
70 LPRINT "SP3,;ER500,500;"
80 LPRINT "PR0,500;"
90 LPRINT "SP5;PT.3;FT2;RR500,500;"
100 LPRINT "SP3;ER500,500;"
110 LPRINT "SP6;FT4,100,45;RR-500,500;"
120 LPRINT "SP3;ER-500,500;PG"
130 END
<Sample 74>
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
EW - Edge wedge
EW r,q1,qc(,qd)[;]
r ; Radius in user units or graphics units
q1; Start point angle
qc ; Arc angle
qd ; Chord angle
·
Plots a wedge centred on the current position with radius r, start point angle q1, arc angle qc and chord angle
qd.
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin.
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.
When scaling has been performed, the circle is plotted in user units.
Also, when scaling has been performed, the value for r is a real number.
When there is no scaling, the circle is plotted in graphics units.
When there is no scaling, the coordinate value for r is an integer number.
The value for q1 is a clamped real number.
qc
q1
0° reference point
current
position
r
·
·
q1 specifies the wedge starting point related to the 0 degree reference point.
When q1 is positive, the positive direction of the X axis relative to the current position is set at 0 degrees and
the start point is sought in the counterclockwise direction. The opposite occurs when q1 is negative: the
negative X axis is set at 0 degrees and the start point is sought by going clockwise.
·
·
·
·
·
qc specifies the angle of the wedge in degrees.
The value for qc is a real number.
Plotting proceeds counterclockwise when qc is positive and clockwise when negative.
The value for qd is a clamped real number.
When qd is not specified, the chord angle is the default value ( 5 degrees )
10 ' *** EWEX ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP2;FT3,100;"
30 LPRINT "PA5000,4000;"
40 LPRINT "WG1250,90,180,5;"
50 LPRINT "SP3;EW1250,90,180,5;"
60 LPRINT "SP4,FT4,100,45;"
70 LPRINT "WG1250,270,120;"
80 LPRINT "SP3;EW1250,270,120;"
80 LPRINT "SP1;PT.3;FT1;"
100 LPRINT "WG1250,30,60;"
110 LPRINT "SP3;EW1250,30,60;PG;"
120 END
<Sample 76>
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
RA - Fill rectangle absolute
RA X, Y[;]
X ; X coordinate of opposite angle for the rectangle
Y ; Y coordinate of opposite angle for the rectangle
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
X and Y coordinates are absolute coordinates in user units or graphics units.
Fill in the rectangle formed by the current position and the opposite angle specified by X and Y.
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin.
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.
When scaling has been performed, the rectangle is plotted in user units.
Also, when scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are real numbers.
When there is no scaling, the rectangle is plotted in graphics units.
When there is no scaling, the coordinate values for X and Y are integer numbers.
(X, Y)
Fill pattern specified by FT and PT
Current position
10 '*** RAEX ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA5000,4000;"
30 LPRINT "PT.3;FT1;RA4250,3250;"
40 LPRINT "FT3,100;RA5750,3250;"
50 LPRINT "FT2;RA5750,4750;"
60 LPRINT "FT4,100,45;RA4250,4750;"
70 END
<Sample 71>
RR - Fill rectangle relative
RR X, Y[;]
X ; X coordinate of opposite angle for the rectangle
Y ; Y coordinate of opposite angle for the rectangle
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
Coordinates are relative to the current position in user units or graphics units.
Fill in the rectangle formed by the current position and the opposite angle specified by X and Y.
After plotting the cursor returns to its point of origin.
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.
When scaling has been performed, the rectangle is plotted in user units.
Also, when scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are real numbers.
When there is no scaling, the rectangle is plotted in graphics units.
When there is no scaling, the coordinate values for X and Y are integer numbers.
Fill pattern specified by FT and PT
Y increment
Current position
X increment
10 '*** PREX ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA5000,5000;"
30 LPRINT "PT.3;FT1;RR500,500;"
35 LPRINT "PR500,0;"
40 LPRINT "FT3,70;RR500,500;"
45 LPRINT "PR0,500;"
50 LPRINT "FT2;RR500,500;"
60 LPRINT "FT4,70,45;RR-500,500;"
70 END
<Sample 73>
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 16
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
WG - Fill wedge
WG r,q1,qc(,qd)[;]
r ; Radius in user units or graphics units
q1 ; Start point angle
qc ; Arc angle
qd ; Chord angle
·
Fill in a wedge centred on the current position with radius r, start point angle q1, arc angle qc and chord angle
qd.
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin.
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.
When scaling has been performed, the circle is plotted in user units.
Also, when scaling has been performed, the value for r is a real number.
When there is no scaling, the circle is plotted in graphics units.
When there is no scaling, the coordinate value for r is an integer number.
The value for q1 is a clamped real number.
When q1 is positive, the positive direction of the X axis relative to the current position is set at 0 degrees and
the start point is sought in the counterclockwise direction. The opposite occurs when q1 is negative: the
negative X axis is set at 0 degrees and the start point is sought by going clockwise.
·
·
·
·
The value for qc is a clamped real number.
Plotting proceeds counterclockwise when qc is positive and clockwise when it is negative.
The value for qd is a clamped real number.
When qd is not specified, the chord angle is the default value ( 5 degrees ).
Fill pattern specified
by FT and PT
Radius
Start point angle
0 degrees
Current position
Arc angle
10 ' *** WGEX ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP2;FT3,100;"
30 LPRINT "PA5000,4000;"
40 LPRINT "WG1250,90,180,5;"
50 LPRINT "SP4;FT4,100,45;"
60 LPRINT "WG1250,270,120;"
70 LPRINT "SP1;PT.3;FT1;"
80 LPRINT "WG1250,30,60;PG;"
90 END
<Sample 75>
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.5. Plot Function Instructions
Instruction
FT
Function
Fill Type
LT
PW
SM
SP
TL
Line Type
Pen Width
Symbol Mode
Select Pen
Tick Length
X Tick
XT
YT
Y Tick
PT
Pen Thickness
FT - Fill type
FT [ n [, d [, q]]] [;]
n : Fill type
d : Fill interval (interval between the parallel lines of the area being filled)
q : Fill angle (degrees )
·
·
Sets the fill type, interval and angle when filling an area.
The value for n is a clamped integer number.
Solid lines (bi-directional fill)
Solid lines (single direction fill)
Parallel lines
Crosshatching
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
The fill interval when n is 1 or 2 is the interval set by the pen thickness (PT) instruction.
Any value given for d when n is 1 or 2 will be ignored.
If d is omitted, the fill interval already specified will be used.
If d is 0, the default value will be used ( 1% of distance from P1 to P2. )
The value of d is a clamped real number .
If q is omitted, the fill angle already specified will be used.
The value of q is a clamped real number.
LT - Line type selection
LT [, n [, p ]] [;]
n ; Line pattern number
p ; Line pattern length (percentage or millimeters of distance between P1 and P2)
·
·
·
Specifies the line type and pattern length.
When the n parameter field is omitted a solid line is selected.
When the p parameter field is omitted the pattern length is 4% of the distance between P1 and P2 (default
value ).
·
·
·
The value of n is a clamped integer number.
The value of p is a clamped real number from 0.0000 to 127.9999.
When p is omitted the previously set line pattern length is used.
Default :Solid line
:For straight line, start and end points are plotted.
:For an arc, plotting takes place for every chord angle that is set.
1 :
2 :
3 :
4 :
5 :
6 :
P
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 18
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
PW-Pen width
PW n[;]
w ; width (unit = 1/300 inch)
·
·
This command specifies the width of the currently selected pen.
The value of w is an integer number from 1 to 10.
SM - Symbol mode
SM c[;]
c ; ASCII character or symbol code
·
·
·
The command specifies the symbol to be drawn.
When the PA, PR, PD or PU instruction is used, the specified symbol will be drawn at the end of each vector.
The specified symbol will be drawn at the end of each vector even if the pen is up when the PA or PR
instructions are used.
·
Omitting the parameter field cancels the symbol mode.
10 '*** SMEX ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;SM*;PA500,1500;"
30 LPRINT "PD600,1590,670,1860,850,1960,1320,1900,1940,2350:"
40 LPRINT "PU;SM;PA500,500;SM3;"
50 LPRINT "PA550,800,680,720,800,950,1150,1230,1870,1350;PU;"
60 LPRINT "SM;PA1850,600;PD;SMY;PA3000,1450;"
70 LPRINT "SMZ;PA3300,1150;SMX;PA1850,600;PU;"
80 END
<Sample 78>
SP - Select pen
SP [ n ] [;]
n ; Pen number
·
·
Selects the pen specified by the pen number.
The value for n must be an integer from 0 to 6.
TL - Tick length
TL l1(,l2)[;]
1-Length of ticks in the positive X- and Y-axes
2-Length of ticks in the negative X- and Y-axes
·
·
·
Tick length is a percentage of the vertical and horizontal distances between P1 and P2.
Sets the length of tick marks for the XT and YT instructions.
Values for 1 and 2 are clamped real numbers.
·
When the parameter field is omitted, the default values for tick length are used, for both l1 and l2, these are
0.5% of the horizontal and vertical distances between P1 and P2.
10 '*** TLEX ***
30 FOR I=1 TO 10
40 LPRINT "PR800,0;XT;"
50 NEXT I
60 LPRINT "TL;PU;PA300,279;PD;"
70 GOSUB 1000
80 LPRINT "TL1,0;PU;PA1100,279;PD;"
20 LPRINT "IN;PA300,279;SP2;PD;TL90;XT;";
90 GOSUB 1000
100 LPRINT "TL0,5;PU;PA1900,279;"
110 GOSUB 1000
120 LPRINT "PA300,6759;TL80;YT;PU;"
130 END
1000 '* SUBROUTINE DRAW TICKS *
1010 FOR J=1 TO 8
1020 LPRINT "PRO,720;YT;"
1030 NEXT J
1040 RETURN
<Sample 77>
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
XT - X-axis tick
XT [;]
·
·
·
Plots vertical tick marks as specified by the TL instruction from the current position.
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin.
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.
YT - Y-axis tick
YT [;]
·
·
·
Plots horizontal tick marks as specified by the TL instruction from the current position.
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin.
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.
10 '*** XTYTEX ***
20 LPRINT "IN;PA300,279;SP2;PD";
30 LPRINT "PR1300,0;XT;PR1300,0;XT;PU;"
40 END
PT - Pen thickness select
PT [d] [;]
d : Fill line interval (mm)
·
·
·
Sets the line interval when filling in with solid lines.
The value for d is a clamped number from 0.0000 to 5.0000.
The default value (0.3 mm) is used when d is omitted.
3.6. Character Plot Instructions
Instruction
CS
CA
SS
SA
DT
LB
Function
Standard Set Definition
Alternate Set Definition
Select Standard Font
Select Alternate Font
Define Label Terminator
Define Label
DI
DR
CP
Absolute Direction
Relative Direction
Character Plot
SI
SR
SL
UC
Set Absolute Character Size
Set Relative Character Size
Set Character Slant
User-defined Character
CS - Standard character set
CS n[;]
n ; Character set number(*)
·
·
·
Specifies the standard character set.
When the parameter field is omitted, character set 0 is specified.
The value for n is a clamped integer number in the range of 0 to 4, 6 to 7, 9 or 30 to 39.
CA - Alternate character set
CA n[;]
n ; Character set number (*)
·
·
·
Specifies the alternate character set.
When the parameter field is omitted, character set 0 is specified.
The value for n is a clamped integer number in the range of 0 to 4, 6 to 7, 9 or 30 to 39.
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 20
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
n
0
Character Set
ANSI ASCII
1
2
3
9825 Character Set
French/German
Scandinavian
4
6
Spanish/Latin American
JIS ASCII
7
9
ROMAN 8 Extensions
ISO IRV
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
ISO Swedish
ISO Swedish for Names
ISO Norway, Version 1
ISO German
ISO French
ISO Kingdom
ISO Italian
ISO Spanish
ISO Portuguese
ISO Norway, Version 2
SS - Select standard character set
SS [;]
Selects the standard character set specified by the CS instruction.
SA - Select alternate character set
SA [;]
Selects the alternate character set specified by the CA instruction.
10 '*** SASSEX ***
20 LPRINT "PA5000,5000;"
30 LPRINT "SP2;CS4;CA9;SS;LBS_E_T_4";CHR$(14);"S_E_T_9";CHR$(3)
40 ENDø
<Sample 79>
DT - Define label terminator
DT c [;]
c : Character
·
·
·
·
The specified character is used as the character plotter terminator.
The character plot mode is canceled by sending a terminator at the end of a character plot string.
The parameter field used for this command must be only one character in length.
The default value (chr$(3)) is used when the parameter field is omitted.
10 '*** DTEX ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP2;SC0,5000,0,5000;"
30 LPRINT "PA0,4500;LBDefault control character
ETX";CHR$(13);CHR$(3);
40 LPRINT "LBterminates by performing end-";CHR$(13);CHR$(3):
50 LPRINT "LBof-text function.";CHR$(3);
60 LPRINT "PA0,3500;DT@;LBPrinting characters
terminate,";CHR$(13):"@";
70 LPRINT "LBbut are also printed.@";
80 LPRINT "PA0,3000;DT";CHR$(13);";LBcontrol characters
terminate";CHR$(10);CHR$(13)
90 LPRINT "LBand perform their function.";CHR$(13)
100 END
<Sample 80>
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
LB - Character plot
LB [ cs ] < terminator > [;]
cs : character string
·
·
·
Plots character strings, numerical expressions, variables etc.
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.
After plotting, the cursor moves to the position of the next character.
10 '*** LBEX1 ***
20 LPRINT "SP2;PA1000,4000;"
30 X=30
40 LPRINT "LB",X,X+1,X+2,CHR$(3)
50 END
<Sample 81>
10 '*** LBEX2 ***
20 LPRINT "SP2;PA4000,5000;"
30 X=30
40 LPRINT "LB";X;X+1;X+2,CHR$(3)
70 END
<Sample 82>
10 '*** LBEX3 ***
20 LPRINT "SP2;PA5000,6000;"
30 X=30
40 LPRINT "LB";X;" ";X+1;" ";X+2,CHR$(3)
70 END
<Sample 83>
DI - Absolute direction
DI [ run, rise ] [;]
run : X direction component
rise : Y direction component
·
·
·
·
Specifies the character plot direction.
Values for the run and rise are clamp ed real numbers.
The instruction is ignored when the values for both run and rise are 0.
When the parameter field is omitted, the default value (horizontal direction) is used.
sin q
tan
q=
rise
cosq
q
run
10 '*** DIEX ***
15 DEG=-45
16 RAD3.1416/180*DEG
20 LPRINT "IN;SP2;PA3050,4450;"
30 LPRINT "DI0,2;LB_*_1988";CHR$(3);"DI2,2;LB_*_1989";CHR$(3)
40 LPRINT "DI2,0;LB_*_1990";CHR$(3);"DI2,-2;LB_*_1991";CHR$(3)
50 LPRINT "DI0,-2;LB_*_1992";CHR$(3);DI-2,-2;LB_*_1993";CHR$(3)
60 LPRINT "DI-2,0;LB_*_1994";CHR$(3);"DI-2,2;LB_*_1995";CHR$(3)
70 LPRINT
"PA3500,5350;DI",COS(0),SIN(0);"LB_*_2000";CHR$(13);CHR$(3);
80 LPRINT "DI",COS(RAD);SIN(RAD);"LB_RETURN
POINT";CHR$(13);CHR$(3)
90 END
<Sample 84>
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 22
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
DR - Relative direction
DR [ run, rise ] [;]
run : X direction component
rise : Y direction component
·
·
·
·
·
A percentage of the distance in the X and Y directions between P1 and P2 is used as the units
Specifies the character plot direction.
Values for the run and rise are clamped real numbers.
The instruction is ignored when values for both run and rise are 0.
When the parameter field is omitted, the default value (horizontal direction) is used.
(0, 100)
(100, 100)
(0,60)
rise = 60%
q
(70,0)
(0, 100)
run=70%
CP - Character plot
CP X,Y [;]
X ; the number of text spaces the pen position is moved.
Y ; the number of text lines the pen position is moved.
Moves the cursor the specified number of characters.
Values for X and Y are clamped real numbers.
·
·
·
When the parameter field is omitted, the cursor is not moved along the X-axis but it is moved 1 character in
the negative direction along the Y-axis (identical to executing CP 0, -1;).
X increment
Current position
Y increment
10 '*** CPEX ***
20 LPRINT "DF;SP1;PA1000,3000;PDPR3000,0;PU;PR-3000,0;"
30 LPRINT "CP5,.55;LBABOVE THE LINE";CHR$(3);"PA2000,3000;"
40 LPRINT "XT;CP0,-1.15;LBBELOW THE LINE";CHR$(13);CHR$(10);"AND
WITH A NEAT";CHR$(3)
50 LPRINT "CP;LBMARGIN";CHR$(3)
60 END
<Sample 85>
SI - Set absolute character size
SI [ width, height ] [;]
width : the width in centimeters of printed characters
height : the height in centimeters of printed characters
·
·
·
Specifies the size of characters to be plotted.
Values for width and height are clamped real numbers.
When the parameter field is omitted, the default values are used (width: 0.1879 cm, height: 0.2690 cm).
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
10 '*** SIEX1 ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA1000,1000;"
30 LPRINT "SI2,1.5;LBLASER";CHR$(3)
40 END
<Sample 86>
10 '*** SIEX2 ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA5000,3000:"
30 LPRINT "SI-.35,.35;LBCHARACTER";CHR$(3)
40 END
<Sample 87>
10 '*** SIEX3 ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA5000,3000;"
30 LPRINT "SI.35,-.35;LBCHARACTER";CHR$(3)
40 END
<Sample 88>
10 '*** SIEX4 ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA5000,3000;"
30 LPRINT "SI-.35,-.35;LBCHARACTER";CHR$(3)
40 END
<Sample 89>
SR - Set relative character size
SR [ width, height ] [;]
width ; the width of printed characters expressed as a percentage of the x-component of the distance
between P1 and P2.
height ; the height of printed characters expressed as a percentage of the y-component of the distance
between P1 and P2.
·
·
·
Specifies the size of characters to be plotted.
Values for width and height are clamped real numbers.
When the parameter field is omitted, the default values are used (width: 0.7500%, height: 1.5000%).
10 ' *** SREX ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP2;PA100,7000;LBDEFAULT SIZE";CHR$(3)
30 LPRINT "IP 2000,2000,6500,6500;PA100,6500;"
40 LPRINT "LBNEW P1 AND P2 CHANGE LABEL SIZE";CHR$(3);"SR5,5;"
50 LPRINT "PA100,6000;LBNEW SR INSTRUCTION";CHR$(13);CHR$(3);
60 LPRINT "LBCHANGE LABEL SIZE";CHR$(3);
<Sample 90>
SL - Character slant
SL [ tan f ] [;]
tan f - tangent of character slant angle (f)
·
·
·
Specifies the slant of characters to be plotted.
Va lue for tanq is a clamped real number.
When the parameter field is omitted, the default value is used (0 degree character slant).
q
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 24
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
10 '"*** SLEX ***
20 LPRINT "DF;SP1;SI1.3,1.3;PA100,6000;"
30 LPRINT "SL2;LBLASER";CHR$(3)
40 LPRINT "SL-2;PR3000,0;LBLASER";CHR$(3)
50 END
<Sample 91>
UC - User-defined character
UC X1, Y1, X2, Y2..., Xn, Yn[;]
Xi : Number of grids in X direction
Yi : Number of grids in Y direction
·
·
·
Draws user-generated character or symbol.
Values for Xi and Yi are clamped real numbers.
If a value between 99.0000 and 127.9999 is entered between(Xi, Yi) and (Xi+1, Yi+1), the pen will be lowered at
that point.
·
If a value between -128.0000 and -99.0000 is entered between (Xi, Yi) and (Xi+1, Yi+1), the pen will be raised at
that point.
(-4,0)
UC 4, 99, 0, 1, -4, 0, 2, -4, -2, -4, 4, 0, 0, 1;
(0, 1)
(2, -4)
(-2, -4)
(0, 1)
Character point of origin
(4, 0)
10 '*** UCEX1 ***
20 LPRINT "IN;SP2;PA2000,2000;"
30 FOR AA=19 TO 89 STEP 10
40 A=AA/100
50 LPRINT "SI",A,A*1.7
60 LPRINT "UC4,7,99,0,1,-4,0,2,-4,-2,-4,4,0,0,1;"
70 NEXT AA
80 LPRINT "PA2000,3750;"
90 FOR BB=19 TO 89 STEP 10
100 B=BB/100
110 LPRINT "SI",B,B*1.7
120 LPRINT "LBE";CHR$(3)
130 NEXT BB
140 END
<Sample 92>
10 '*** UCEX2 ***
20 LPRINT "SP1;PA3000,5000;SI.5,.8"
30 LPRINT "UC0,4,99,1.75,0,1.5,4,3,-8,3,8,3,-8,3,8,3,-
8,1.5,4,1.75,0;"
40 LPRINT "CP5,0;LB1000 ohms";CHR$(3)
50 END
<Sample 93>
10 '*** UCEX2 ***
20 LPRINT "SP1;PA3000,4500;SI.5,.8"
30 LPRINT "UC0,8,99,3.5,0,3,8,6,-16,6,16,6,-16,6,16,6,-
16,3,8,3.5,0;"
40 END
<Sample 94>
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.7. Dual Context Extensions
Set High resolution control
(Brother original)
EscCRRO
This command sets high resolution control off.
EscCRRL
This command sets high resolution control light level.
EscCRRM
This command sets high resolution control medium level.
EscCRRD
This command sets high resolution control dark level.
User reset (Brother original)
EscCR!#R
·
·
·
·
# can be 0, 1 or 2.
#0 indicates the current setting are restored.
#1 indicates the user settings 1 are restored.
#2 indicates the user settings 2 are restored.
Factory reset
(Brother original)
EscCRFD
·
·
This command causes a factory reset to be performed, restoring all the printer's factory default settings.
You can also perform a factory reset using the printer's control panel (see the User Guide).
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 26
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.
INDEX
A
P
Absolute direction ...................................................................22
Alternate character set ............................................................20
Pen down..................................................................................... 9
Pen thickness select ................................................................ 20
Pen up.......................................................................................... 9
Pen width................................................................................... 19
Plot absolute............................................................................... 9
printing area................................................................................ 5
C
Character plot......................................................................22, 23
character set................................................................................4
Character slant..........................................................................24
Circle plot...................................................................................12
R
Relative coordinate pen move................................................ 10
Relative direction ..................................................................... 23
Rotate coordinate system......................................................... 8
D
Default set instruction...............................................................6
Define label terminator.............................................................21
Draw absolute arc.....................................................................11
Draw relative arc .......................................................................11
S
Scale ............................................................................................. 7
Select alternate character set.................................................. 21
Select pen.................................................................................. 19
Select standard character set ................................................. 21
Set absolute character size ..................................................... 23
Set relative character size........................................................ 24
Standard character set............................................................. 20
Symbol mode ............................................................................ 19
syntax........................................................................................... 4
E
Edge rectangle absolute..........................................................13
Edge rectangle relative ............................................................14
Edge wedge...............................................................................15
F
T
Factory reset .............................................................................26
Fill rectangle absolute..............................................................16
Fill rectangle relative................................................................16
Fill type ......................................................................................18
Fill wedge...................................................................................17
Tick length ................................................................................ 19
U
User rest.................................................................................... 26
User-defined character............................................................ 25
H
High resolution control...........................................................26
home position .............................................................................4
X
X-axis tick.................................................................................. 20
I
Initialize set instruction .............................................................6
Input scaling point.....................................................................7
Input window..............................................................................8
Y
Y-axis tick.................................................................................. 20
L
Line type selection...................................................................18
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 27
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
APPENDIX A
COMPARISON LIST
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
ONTENTS
C
PCL5/5E................................................................................................... 3
Typeface Selection (PCL).........................................................................15
HP-GL/2..................................................................................................17
EPSON FX-850........................................................................................19
IBM PROPRINTER XL...........................................................................22
BAR CODE.............................................................................................24
HP-GL.....................................................................................................25
PJL..........................................................................................................27
General PJL Environment Variables...........................................................33
PCL Specific Variables.............................................................................38
PostScript Specific Variables.....................................................................40
EPSON Specific Variables........................................................................41
IBM Specific Variables.............................................................................42
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
In this chapter, you can find which commands are supported by your printer.
PCL5/5e
COMMAND
HL-
1050
HL-
1070
HL-
1250/
HL-
1270N/
HL-
P2500
HL-
1660e
HL-
2060
HL-
2400
C/Ce
HL-
3400CN
HL-
1650/
1670N
HL-
3260N
HL-
2460
1450
v
1470N
v
Esc&k#G
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Line Termination
Esc&s#C
End of Line Wrap
EscY
Display Function ON
EscZ
Display Function OFF
Esc&l1A
Paper Size
Executive
Esc&l2A
Paper Size
Letter
Esc&l3A
Paper Size
Legal
Esc&l6A
Paper Size
Ledger
Esc&l25A
Paper Size
A5
Esc&l26A
Paper Size
A4
Esc&l27A
Paper Size
A3
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
COMMAND
HL-
1050
HL-
1070
HL-
1250/
HL-
1270N/
HL-
P2500
HL-
1660e
HL-
2060
HL-
2400
C/Ce
HL-
3400CN
HL-
1650/
1670N
HL-
3260N
HL-
2460
1450
v
1470N
v
Esc&l45A
Paper Size
JIS B5
Esc&l46A
Paper Size
JIS B4
Esc&l100A
Paper Size
B5
Esc&l1024A
Paper Size
B6
Esc&l1025A
Paper Size
A5
Esc&l1026A
Paper Size
A6
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc&l1028A
Paper Size
13”X19"
Esc&l2048A
Paper Size
A4 Long
Esc&l80A
Paper Size
Monarch
Esc&l81A
Paper Size
COM 10
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
COMMAND
HL-
1050
HL-
1070
HL-
1250/
HL-
1270N/
HL-
P2500
HL-
1660e
HL-
2060
HL-
2400
C/Ce
HL-
3400CN
HL-
1650/
1670N
HL-
3260N
HL-
2460
1450
v
1470N
v
Esc&l90A
Paper Size
DL
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc&l91A
Paper Size
C5
Esc&l101A
Paper Size
Free Size
Esc&l0H
Paper Eject
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc&l1H
Primary Tray
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Upper
Cassette
Upper
Cassette
Feeder1
Tray1
Tray1
Tray1
Tray1
Tray1
Tray1
Tray1
Esc&l2H
Manual Feed
Esc&l3H
Envelope
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Feed
from
v
Feed
from
v
Feed
from
v
Feed
from
Manual
Feed
v
MP
Tray
v
Tray2
(LT-
1600)
v
v
Feed
from
Manual
Feed
v
MP
Tray
v
Tray2
(LT-
2000)
v
v
Feed
from
Manual Manual
Feed
v
Tray2
v
Feed
from
v
Feed
from
v
Feed
from
v
Feed
from
Manual Manual Manual
Feed
Manual Manual Manual
Feed
v
Lower
Cassette
Feed
Feed
Feed
v
Tray2
Feed
v
Tray2
Feed
v
Tray2
v
v
v
Esc&l4H
Secondary Tray
v
Lower
Lower
Lower
Feeder2
Cassette Cassette Cassette
v
v
v
v
Esc&l5H/6H
Optional Tray
v
v
v
v
Lower
Lower
Lower
Lower
Cassette
Tray2
Tray2
Tray2
Tray2
Cassette Cassette Cassette
Esc&l7H
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Automatic Selection
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
COMMAND
HL-
1050
HL-
1070
HL-
1250/
HL-
1270N/
HL-
P2500
HL-
1660e
HL-
2060
HL-
2400
C/Ce
HL-
3400CN
HL-
1650/
1670N
HL-
3260N
HL-
2460
1450
1470N
Esc&l8H
v
v
v
Optional Tray
Tray3
Tray3
Tray3
Esc&l9H
v
v
Optional Tray
Tray4
Tray4
Esc&l100H
Tray ID 1
v
v
Tray ID TrayID
1
v
1
v
Esc&l101H
Tray ID 2
Tray ID TrayID
2
v
2
v
Esc&l102H
Tray ID 3
Tray ID TrayID
v
v
Esc&l103H
Tray ID 4
Tray ID TrayID
4
v
4
v
Esc&l0S
Simplex
Esc&l1S
Duplex Long-Edge Binding
Esc&l2S
Duplex Short-Edge Binding
Esc&l#U
Long-edge Offset
Esc&l#Z
Short-edge Offset
Esc&l#X
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Copy Volume
#:1~327 #:1~327 #:1~327 #:1~327 #:1~327 #:1~327 #:1~327 #:1~327
67
v
67
v
67
v
67
v
67
v
67
v
67
v
67
v
Esc&l#T
v
v
v
v
Job Separation
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
COMMAND
HL-
1050
HL-
1070
HL-
1250/
HL-
1270N/
HL-
P2500
HL-
1660e
HL-
2060
HL-
2400
C/Ce
HL-
3400CN
HL-
1650/
1670N
HL-
3260N
HL-
2460
1450
v
1470N
v
EscE
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Printer Reset
EscCR!#R
User Reset
Escz
Self-test
Esc%-12345X
UEL
Esc&u#D
Unit of Measure
Esc&a#L
Left Margin
Esc&a#M
Right Margin
Esc9
Clear Side Margin
Esc&l#E
Top Margin
Esc&l#C
Line Pitch
Esc&k#H
Character Pitch
Esc&l#D
Line Spacing
Esc&l#F
Text Length
Esc&l#P
Page Length
Esc&l#L
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Perforation Skip
Esc&a#R
Vertical Position(line)
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
COMMAND
HL-
1050
HL-
1070
HL-
1250/
HL-
1270N/
HL-
P2500
HL-
1660e
HL-
2060
HL-
2400
C/Ce
HL-
3400CN
HL-
1650/
1670N
HL-
3260N
HL-
2460
1450
v
1470N
v
Esc*p#Y
Position(dot)
Esc&a#V
Vertical Position(decipoint)
Esc&a#C
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Horizontal Position(column)
Esc&a#H
Horizontal
Position(decipoint)
Esc*p#X
Horizontal Position(dot)
Esc&f0S
Push Cursor Position
Esc&f1S
Pop Cursor Position
Esc=
Half-line Feed
Esc&l#O
Print Orientation
Esc&a#G
Paper Side Selection
EscCR!#H
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
#:0,1,2,3 #:0,1,2,3 #:0,1,2,3 #:0,1,2,3 #:0,1,2,3 #:0,1,2,3 #:0,1,2,3 #:0,1,2,3
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Scalable Font
Ratio(Horizontal)
EscCR!#V
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Scalable Font
Ratio(Vertical)
EscCR!#E
Execute Card Data
Esc&a#P
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Print Direction
Esc(3@, Esc)3@
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
COMMAND
HL-
1050
HL-
1070
HL-
1250/
HL-
1270N/
HL-
P2500
HL-
1660e
HL-
2060
HL-
2400
C/Ce
HL-
3400CN
HL-
1650/
1670N
HL-
3260N
HL-
2460
1450
v
1470N
v
SO
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Secondary Font Select
SI
Primary Font Select
Esc*c#R
Symbol Set ID Set
Esc(f#W
Define Symbol Set
Esc*c#S
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Symbol Set Control
Esc(symbol ID
Esc(s#C,
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc)s#C
Character Set
Esc(s#P,
Esc)s#P
Fixed Pitch or PS
Esc(s#H,
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc)s#H
Character Pitch Selection
Esc&k#S
Character Pitch Selection
Esc(s#V,
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc)s#V
Point Size
Esc(s#S,
Esc)s#S
Italics or Upright
Esc(s#B,
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc)s#B
Stroke Weight
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
COMMAND
HL-
1050
HL-
1070
HL-
1250/
HL-
1270N/
HL-
P2500
HL-
1660e
HL-
2060
HL-
2400
C/Ce
HL-
3400CN
HL-
1650/
1670N
HL-
3260N
HL-
2460
1450
v
1470N
v
Esc(s#T,
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc)s#T
Typeface
Esc&p#X
Transparent Print
Esc&d#D,
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc&d@
Auto Underline
Esc*c#D
Download Font
Font ID Set
Esc*c#F
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
#:0~6,10
26,
1028,
1029
v
v
v
v
v
Download Font Control
#:0~6
#:0~6
#:0~6
#:0~6
#:0~6,10 #:0~6,10 #:0~6,10
26,
1028,
1029
v
26,
1028,
1029
v
26,
1028,
1029
v
Esc(#X
Set to Primary Font
Esc)#X
Set to Secondary Font
Esc(#@
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Font Default
Setting(Primary)
Esc)#@
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Font Default
Setting(Secondary)
Esc)s#W
Download Font Header
Esc*c#E
Character Code Set
Esc(s#W
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Download Character
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
COMMAND
HL-
1050
HL-
1070
HL-
1250/
HL-
1270N/
HL-
P2500
HL-
1660e
HL-
2060
HL-
2400
C/Ce
HL-
3400CN
HL-
1650/
1670N
HL-
3260N
HL-
2460
1450
v
1470N
v
Esc*v#N
Select Source Transparency
Mode
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc*v#O
v
v
v
v
Select Pattern Transparency
Mode
Esc*c#G
Pattern ID Setting
Esc*c#W
Define Pattern
Esc*p#R
Set Pattern Reference Point
Esc*c#Q
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
User-defined Pattern
Control
Esc*v#T
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Select Pattern
#:0~4,13 #:0~4,13 #:0~4,13 #:0~4,13 #:0~4,13 #:0~4,13 #:0~4,13 #:0~4,13 #:0~4,13
0
v
0
v
0
v
0
v
0
v
0
v
0
v
0
v
0
v
Esc*c#A
Pattern Horizontal Size(dot)
Esc*c#H
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Pattern Horizontal
Size(decipoint)
Esc*c#B
Pattern Vertical Size(dot)
Esc*c#V
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Pattern Vertical
Size(decipoint)
Esc*c#P
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Print Pattern
#:0~5,13 #:0~5,13 #:0~5,13 #:0~5,13 #:0~5,13 #:0~5,13 #:0~5,13 #:0~5,13 #:0~5,13
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
COMMAND
HL-
1050
HL-
1070
HL-
1250/
HL-
1270N/
HL-
P2500
HL-
1660e
HL-
2060
HL-
2400
C/Ce
HL-
3400CN
HL-
1650/
1670N
HL-
3260N
HL-
2460
1450
v
1470N
v
Esc*t#R
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Resolution Setting
#:75,100, #:75,100, #:75,100, #:75,100, #:75,100, #:75,100, #:75,100, #:75,100, #:75,100,
150,
200,
150,
200,
150,
200,
150,
200,
150,
200,
150,
200,
150,
200,
150,
200,
150,
200,
300,600 300,600 300,600 300,600 300,600 300,600 300,600 300,600 300,600
Esc*r#F
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Raster Graphics
Presentation
Esc*r#T
Raster Height
Esc*r#S
Raster Width
Esc*b#Y
Raster Y Offset
Esc*b#M
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Set Compression Mode
#:0,1,2,3, #:0,1,2,3, #:0,1,2,3, #:0,1,2,3, #:0,1,2,3, #:0,1,2,3, #:0,1,2,3, #:0,1,2,3, #:0,1,2,3,
5,9,
1027,
1028,
1152
v
5,9,1027,
1028,
1024,
1152
v
5,9,
1027,
1028,
1152
v
5,9,
1027,
1028,
1152
v
5,9,
1027,
1028,
1152
v
5,9,
1024,
1027,
1152
v
5,9,
1024,
1027,
1152
v
5,9,
1024,
1027,
1152
v
5,9,
1024,
1027,
1152
v
Esc*r#A
Begin Raster Graphics
Esc*b#W
Transfer Data
Esc*b#C
Compression Transfer
Esc*rB
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
End Raster Graphics
Esc*rC
End Raster Graphics
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
COMMAND
HL-
1050
HL-
1070
HL-
1250/
HL-
1270N/
HL-
P2500
HL-
1660e
HL-
2060
HL-
2400
C/Ce
HL-
3400CN
HL-
1650/
1670N
HL-
3260N
HL-
2460
1450
v
1470N
v
Esc%#B
Enter HP-GL/2 Mode
Esc*c0T
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Set Picture Frame Anchor
Point
Esc*c#Y
Picture Frame Vertical size
Esc*c#X
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Picture Frame Horizontal
size
Esc*c#L
HP-GL2 Plot
Vertical Size
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc*c#K
HP-GL2 Plot Horizontal
Size
Esc&f0X
Start Macro Definition
Esc&f1X
End Macro Definition
Esc&f2X
Execute Macro
Esc&f3X
Call Macro
Esc&f4X
Macro Overlay ON
Esc&f5X
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Macro Overlay OFF
Esc&f6X
Delete All Macros
Esc&f7X
Delete Temporary Macro
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
COMMAND
HL-
1050
HL-
1070
HL-
1250/
HL-
1270N/
HL-
P2500
HL-
1660e
HL-
2060
HL-
2400
C/Ce
HL-
3400CN
HL-
1650/
1670N
HL-
3260N
HL-
2460
1450
v
1470N
v
Esc&f8X
Delete Current Macro
Esc&f9X
Make Temporary Macro
Esc&f10X
Make Permanent Macro
Esc&f1030X
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Delete All Macro from Card
Esc&f1036X
Delete Current Macro from
Card
Esc&f1038X
Save Current Macro into
Card
Esc*s#T
Set Status Readback
Location Type
Esc*s#U
Set Status Readback
Location Unit
Esc*s#l
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Inquire Status Readback
Entity
Esc*s1M
Free Memory Space
Esc&r#F
Flush All Pages
Esc*s#X
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Echo
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
Typeface Selection (PCL)
COMMAND TYPEFACE
HL-
1050
HL-
1070
HL-
1250/
1450
HL-
1270N/
1470N
HL-
P2500
HL-
1660e
HL-
2060
HL-
2400
C/Ce
HL-
HL-
HL-
3260N
HL-
2460
3400CN 1650/
1670N
Esc(s129T
Esc(s128T
Anelia
Brougham
Esc(s130T
Esc(s104T
Esc(s110T
Letter Gothic
OCR-A
OCR-B
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc(s152T
Esc(s153T
Esc(s154T
Esc(s155T
Esc(s156T
Esc(s157T
Esc(s158T
Esc(s159T
Helsinki
Tennessee
Helsinki Narrow
Atlanta
Brussels
Copenhagen
Portugal
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Calgary
Esc(s4101T
Esc(s4143T
Esc(s4148T
Esc(s4362T
Esc(s4168T
Esc(s4099T
Esc(s4140T
PC Tennessee
PC Brussels
Utah
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Alaska
Antique Oakland
Brougham
Cleveland
Condensed
Connecticut
Guatemala
Letter Gothic
Maryland
Esc(s4116T
Esc(s4197T
Esc(s4102T
Esc(s4297T
Esc(s4113T
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Oklahoma
Esc(s16686T BR Symbol
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
COMMAND TYPEFACE
HL-
1050
HL-
1070
HL-
1250/
1450
v
v
v
HL-
1270N/
1470N
HL-
P2500
HL-
1660e
HL-
2060
HL-
2400
C/Ce
HL-
HL-
HL-
3260N
HL-
2460
3400CN 1650/
1670N
Esc(s16602T Helsinki
Esc(s16901T Tennessee
Esc(s31402T W Dingbats
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
ESC(s134T
ESC(s132T
ESC(s133T
ESC(s135T
Bermuda Script
Germany
San Diego
US Roman
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-16
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
HP-GL/2
COMMAND
DF
IN
IP
IR
HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
SC
IW
RO
PU
PD
PA
PR
AA
AR
AT
RT
PE
CI
BR
BZ
PM
EA
ER
EP
EW
RA
RR
WG
FP
AC
FT
LA
LT
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
COMMAND
PW
RF
SM
SP
HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
SV
TR
UL
WU
SD
AD
SS
SA
FI
FN
LB
DT
LO
DI
DR
DV
CP
CF
SI
SR
SL
SB
ES
TD
CO
PG
RP
NP
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-18
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
Epson FX-850
COMMAND
SP
BS
CR
LF
HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
FF
Esc SP n
Esc a n
Esc $ n1 n2
Esc \ n1 n2
Esc <
Esc >
Esc #
Esc @
Esc CR!#R
Esc EM n
Esc C n
Esc C NUL n
Esc l n
Esc Q n
Esc N n
Esc O
Esc 2
Esc 0
Esc 1
Esc A n
Esc 3 n
Esc J n
Esc j n
Esc D n1 n2 n3 ... NUL
HT
Esc B n1 n2 n3... NUL
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
COMMAND
Esc b n m1 m2 m3 ...
NUL
HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460
v
Esc / n
VT
Esc P
Esc M
Esc p n
SI
Esc SI
DC2
Esc E
Esc F
Esc G
Esc H
Esc W n
SO
Esc SO
DC4
Esc 4
Esc 5
Esc S n
Esc T
Esc w n
Esc -n
Esc ! n
Esc 6
Esc 7
Esc l n
Esc R n
Esc t n
Esc&NUL n1 n2
Esc % n NUL
Esc:000
Esc * m n1 n2
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-20
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
COMMAND
Esc ? n m
HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc ^ a n1 n2
Esc K n1 n2
Esc L n1 n2
Esc Y n1 n2
Esc Z n1 n2
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
IBM ProPrinter XL
COMMAND
HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460
ESC
SP
BS
CR
LF
FF
Esc 5 n
DC1
Esc Q 22
Esc Q 3
Esc CR ! #R
Esc EM n
Esc C n
Esc C NUL n
Esc X m n
Esc N n
Esc O
Esc 0
Esc 1
Esc A n
Esc 2
Esc 3 n
Esc J n
Esc D n1 n2 n3 ... NUL
Esc B n1 n2 n3 ... NUL
HT
VT
Esc R
Esc 7
Esc 6
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
DC2
Esc :
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-22
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
COMMAND
Esc P n
SI
Esc E
Esc F
SO
DC4
CAN
Esc W n
Esc S n
Esc T
Esc - n
Esc _ n
Esc [ @ n1n2n3n4n5n6
Esc \ n1 n2
Esc ^
HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc I n
Esc = n1 n2 20 n3
Esc K n1 n2
Esc L n1 n2
Esc Y n1 n2
Esc Z n1 n2
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
BAR CODE
COMMAND
CODE 39
Interleaved 2 of 5
FIM(US-Post Net)
Post Net
HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460
v
v
v
v
v
EAN8,EAN13,
UPC A
UPC E
Codabar
UPS Code128
set A
v
v
v
UPS Code128
set B
UPS Code128
set C
v
v
ISBN(EAN)
ISBN(UPC-E)
EAN128 set A
EAN 128 set B
EAN 128 set C
v
v
v
v
v
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-24
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
HP-GL
COMMAND
HL-1050 HL-1070
HL-
1250/
1450
HL-
1270N/
1470N
HL-
P2500
HL-
1660e
HL-2060
HL-
2400C/
Ce
HL-
3400CN
HL-
1650/
1670N
HL-
3260N
HL-2460
DF
IN
IP
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
SC
IW
RO
PG
PU
PD
PA
PR
AA
AR
CI
EA
ER
EW
RA
RR
WG
FT
LT
PW
SM
SP
TL
XT
YT
PT
CS
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
COMMAND
HL-1050 HL-1070
HL-
1250/
1450
HL-
1270N/
1470N
HL-
P2500
HL-
1660e
HL-2060
HL-
2400C/
Ce
HL-
3400CN
HL-
1650/
1670N
HL-
3260N
HL-2460
CA
SS
SA
DT
LB
DI
DR
CP
SI
SR
SL
UC
DC
DP
EX
IM
QA
QC
QD
QE
QF
QH
QI
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
QQ
QP
QS
QW
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-26
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
PJL
PJL commands are supported by HL-1050, HL-1070, HL-1250, HL-1270N/1450/1470N, HL-P2500, HL-1660e, HL-2060, HL-2400C, HL-2400Ce, HL-3400CN,
HL-1650, HL-1670N, HL-3260N and HL-2460. Other our printers does not support PJL.
COMMAND
HL-1050
HL-1070
HL-
HL-
HL-P2500 HL-1660e
HL-2060
HL-
2400C/Ce/,
3400CN
v
HL-1650/ HL-3260N HL-2460
1670N
1250/1450 1270N/1470
N
Esc%-
123245X
PJL ENTER
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
LANGUAGE PCL, IBM, PCL, IBM, PCL, IBM, PCL, IBM,
= personality EPSON EPSON, EPSON EPSON
PCLXL POSTSCRIP PCLXL PCLXLPOS
PCL
PCL, PCLXL, POSTSCRIPT, IBM,
EPSON, HPGL
PCL, PCLXL, POSTSCRIPT, IBM,
EPSON
T
TSCRIPT
PCLXL
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-27
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
@PJL
v
v
v
EXECUTE
operation
SHUTDOWN, DEMOPAGE, RESIFONT, PERMFONT, PRTCONFIG, TESTPRINT
DEMOPAG
E,
TESTPRINT
, RESIFONT,
PERMFONT
,
TESTPRINT
, RESIFONT,
PERMFONT
,
PRTCONFI
G,
PRTCONFI
G,
BRNETDEF
AULT,
LAMINATE,
ROTATERO
LLER,
BRNETDEF
AULT,
BRNETINIT
,
ENTBRNET
TEST,
EXITBRNE
TTEST,
NVCLR
BRNETINIT
,
ENTBRNET
TEST,
EXITBRNE
TTEST,
ITEM,
SERVICEIN
IT
@PJL
v
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
COMMENT
remarks
[<CR>]<LF>
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-28
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
COMMAND
HL-1050
HL-1070
HL-
1250/1450
HL-1270N/ HL-P2500 HL-1660e, HL-2060
1470N
HL-
2400C/Ce/,
HL-1650/ HL-3260N HL-2460
1670N
3400CN
@PJL JOB
[NAME =
"job name"]
[START =
first page]
[END = last
page]
v
[NAME = "job name"] [START = first page] [END = last page] [PASSWORD = "password"] [<CR>]<LF>
[PASSWOR
D =
"password"]
[<CR>] <LF>
@PJL EOJ
[NAME =
"job name"]
[<CR>]<LF>
@PJL
v
v
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
DEFAULT
[LPARM :
personality]
variable =
value
[<CR>]<LF>
@PJL
v
v
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
INITIALIZE
[<CR>]<LF>
@PJL
RESET
[<CR>]<LF>
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-29
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
@PJL SET
[LPARM :
personality]
variable =
value
[<CR>]<LF>
@PJL
v
v
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
INQUIRE
[LPARM :
personality]
variable
[<CR>]<LF>
COMMAND
HL-1050
v
HL-1070
<…
HL-
1250/1450
HL-1270N/ HL-P2500 HL-1660e, HL-2060
1470N
HL-
2400C/Ce/,
3400CN
<…
HL-1650/ HL-3260N HL-2460
1670N
@PJL
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
DINQUIRE
[LPARM :
personality]
variable
[<CR>]<LF>
@PJL ECHO
[<words>][<C
R>]<LF>
@PJL INFO
ID
[<CR>]<LF>
@PJL INFO
CONFIG
v
v
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
v
feature,
value,
[<CR>]<LF>
information,
returned
option,
attribute
v
@PJL INFO
MEMORY
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
[<CR>]<LF>
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-30
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
@PJL INFO
STATUS
v
v
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
[<CR>]<LF>
@PJL INFO
VARIABLES
[<CR>]<LF>
@PJL INFO
USTATUS
<…
<…
v
DEVICE,
[<CR>]<LF> JOB, PAGE,
TIMED
@PJL INFO
PAGECOUN
T
[<CR>]<LF>
@PJL INFO
PHYSICAL
MEMORY
[<CR>]<LF>
COMMAND
v
v
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
HL-1050
HL-1070
<…
HL-
1250/1450
HL-1270N/ HL-P2500 HL-1660e, HL-2060
1470N
HL-
2400C/Ce/,
3400CN
<…
HL-1650/ HL-3260N HL-2460
1670N
@PJL INFO
FEATURES
[<CR>]<LF>
@PJL INFO
DRUMLIFE
[<CR>]<LF>
@PJL
v
v
v
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
v
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
v
USTATUS
variable =
value
[<CR>]<LF>
@PJL
DEVICE,
JOB, PAGE,
TIMED
v
DEVICE,
JOB, PAGE
DEVICE, JOB, PAGE, TIMED
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
USTATUSO
FF
[<CR>]<LF>
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-31
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
@PJL
v
v
v
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
<…
RDYMSG
DISPLAY =
"message"
[<CR>]<LF>
@PJL
OPMSG
DISPLAY =
"message"
[<CR>]<LF>
@PJL
STMSG
DISPLAY =
"message"
[<CR>]<LF>
*1 This option is available only when the optional BR-Script 2 ROM Board is installed into the printer.
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-32
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
General PJL Environment Variables
GENERAL PJL
ENVIRONME
NT
HL-1050
HL-1070
HL-1250/
1270N/1450/
1470N
HL-P2500
HL-1660e/
2060
HL-
2400C/Ce
HL-3400CN HL-1650/
1670N
HL-3260N
HL-2460
VARIABLES
COPIES
PAPER
1~200
LETTER,
1~200
LETTER,
1~999
LETTER,
1~999
LETTER,
1~999
LETTER,
1~999
LETTER,
1~999
LETTER,
1~999
LETTER,
1~999
LETTER,
LEGAL,
1~999
LETTER,
LEGAL,
LEGAL, A4, LEGAL, A4, LEGAL, A4, LEGAL, A4, LEGAL, A4, LEGAL, A4, LEGAL, A4, LEGAL, A4,
EXECUTIVE EXECUTIVE EXECUTIVE EXECUTIVE EXECUTIVE EXECUTIVE EXICUTIVE, EXECUTIVE EXECUTIVE EXECUTIVE
, COM10,
, COM10,
, COM10,
, COM10,
, COM10,
, COM10,
DL, B5
B5, JISB5,
LEDGER, C5, COM10,
A3, JISB4, DL,
A3PLUS, MONARCH,
COM10, DL, A5, A6, B6 MONARCH, MONARCH,
, B5, JISB5, , A3, A4, B5, , A4, JISB5,
A5, A6, B5, A5, B6,
COM10, C5, A6, DOM10,
DL, DL,
MONARCH, MONARCH, MONARCH, MONARCH, MONARCH,
C5, DL, B5, C5, DL, B5, C5, DL, B5, C5, DL, B5, C5, DL, B5,
JIS B5, A4
LONG
JIS B5, A4
LONG
JIS B5, A4
LONG
JIS B5, A4
LONG
A5, A6, B6
A5, A6
A5, A6
LTRS, A4S
LEDGER,
JISB4, LTRS,
A4S,
C5, A4
LONG
EXECUTIVE
S, B5S
ORIENTATIO PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT,
N
LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
FORMLINES
MANUALFEE
D
5~128
ON, OFF
5~128
ON, OFF
5~128
ON, OFF
5~128
ON, OFF
5~128
ON, OFF
5~128
ON, OFF
5~128
ON, OFF
5~128
ON, OFF
5~128
ON, OFF
5~128
ON, OFF
HRC
LIGHT,
LIGHT,
LIGHT,
MEDIUM,
MEDIUM,
MEDIUM,
DARK, OFF DARK, OFF DARK, OFF
PAGEPROTEC AUTO, OFF, AUTO, OFF, AUTO, OFF, AUTO, OFF, AUTO, OFF, AUTO, OFF, AUTO, OFF, AUTO, OFF, AUTO, OFF, AUTO, OFF,
LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER,
T
LEGAL, A4 LEGAL, A4 LEGAL, A4 LEGAL, A4 LEGAL, A4 LEGAL, A4 LEGAL, A4 LEGAL, A4 LEGAL, A4 LEGAL, A4
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-33
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
RESOLUTION
300, 600
300, 600
300, 600,1200
300, 600
PCL
300, 600
(HL-1660e)
300, 600,
1200 (HL-
2060)
300, 600
300, 600
300, 600,
1200
300, 600
300, 600,
1200
PERSONALIT AUTO, PCL, AUTO, PCL, AUTO, PCL,
Y
AUTO, PCL, AUTO, PCL, AUTO, PCL, AUTO, PCL, AUTO, PCL, AUTO, PCL,
POSTSCRIP POSTSCRIP POSTSCRIP POSTSCRIP POSTSCRIP POSTSCRIP
IBM, EPSON
IBM,
EPSON,
POSTSCRIP
T
IBM, EPSON
T, IBM,
EPSON,
HPGL
T, IBM,
EPSON,
HPGL
T, IBM,
EPSON,
HPGL
T, IBM
EPSON
T, IBM,
EPSON,
HPGL
T, IBM,
EPSON,
HPGL
TIMEOUT
INTRAY1
1~99
LOCKED,
1~99
LOCKED,
1~99
LOCKED,
1~99
LOCKED,
1~99
LOCKED,
1~99
LOCKED,
1~99
LOCKED,
1~99
LOCKED,
1~99
LOCKED,
1~99
LOCKED,
UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED
LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED,
UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED
LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED,
UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED
LOCKED, LOCKED,
UNLOCKED UNLOCKED
LOCKED, LOCKED,
UNLOCKED UNLOCKED
ON, OFF ON, OFF
INTRAY2
INTRAY3
INTRAY4
INTRAY5
AUTOCONT
LOWTONER
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
CONTINUE, CONTINUE, CONTINUE,
STOP STOP STOP
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-34
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
INTRAY1SIZE
LETTER,
LETTER,
LETTER,
LETTER,
LEGAL,
EXECUTIVE EXECUTIVE
LETTER,
LEGAL,
LEGAL, A4, LEGAL, A4, LEGAL, A4,
EXECUTIVE EXECUTIVE EXICUTIVE,
, COM10,
MONARCH,
C5, DL, B5,
A5, A6, B6
, COM10,
DL, B5
B5, JIS B5,
LEDGER,
A3, JIS B4,
A3PLUS,
COM10, DL,
LTRS, A4S
, A3, A4, B5, , A4, JISB5,
A5, A6,
COM10, C5, A6, COM10,
DL, DL,
MONARCH, MONARCH,
B5, A5, B6,
LEDGER,
JISB4, LTRS,
A4S,
C5, A4
LONG,
CUSTOM
EXECUTIVE
S, B5S
INTRAY2SIZE
.
.
.
.
A4 LETTER,
B5
EXECUTIVE
,
ENVELOPE
S, LEGAL
A5, B6, A6,
A4 LONG,
NO
CASSETTE
INTRAY3SIZE
INTRAY4SIZE
INTRAY5SIZE
SOURCETRA
Y
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
AUTO,
AUTO,
AUTO,
MP TRAY, MP TRAY, MP TRAY,
TRAY1,
TRAY2
TRAY1,
TRAY2,
TRAY3,
TRAY4
TRAY1,
TRAY2,
TRAY3,
TRAY4,
TRAYID1,
TRAYID2,
TRAYID3,
TRAYID4
OFF, ON
ECONOMODE
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
OFF, ON
OFF, ON
OFF, ON
OFF, ON
OFF, ON
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-35
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
ECONOLEVE
L
0~3
0~3
0~3
0~3
0~3
0~3
0~3
0~3
0~3
0~3
XOFFSET
YOFFSET
TIMEOUTEM
U
-500~500
-500~500
1~99
-500~500
-500~500
1~99
-500~500
-500~500
1~99
-500~500
-500~500
-500~500
-500~500
1~99
-500~500
-500~500
1~99
-500~500
-500~500
1~99
-500~500
-500~500
1~99
-104~500
-500~500
1~99
-500~500
-500~500
1~99
PRIORITY
AUTOFF
TIMEOUTFF
CDCCHIGH
DTRCTRL
XOFFTIMING
SEL
EPSON, IBM EPSON, IBM EPSON, IBM
EPSON, IBM EPSON, IBM EPSON, IBM EPSON, IBM EPSON, IBM EPSON, IBM
ON, OFF
1~99
ON, OFF
1~99
ON, OFF
1~99
ON, OFF
1~99
ON, OFF
1~99
ON, OFF
1~99
ON, OFF
1~99
ON, OFF
1~99
ON, OFF
1~99
ON, OFF
1~99
ON, OFF
0~3
ON, OFF
0~3
ON, OFF
0~3
0, 1, 2, 3
0, 1, 2, 3
0, 1, 2, 3
(HL-1250
only)
AUTOSLEEP
TIMEOUTSLE
EP
ON, OFF
1 ~99
ON, OFF
1 ~99
ON, OFF
1 ~99
ON, OFF
1~99
ON, OFF
1~99
ON, OFF
1~99
ON, OFF
1~99
ON, OFF
1~240
ON, OFF
1~99
1 ~99
IBMCHARA1
BETA,
ESSZET
ON, OFF
ENGLISH,
FRENCH,
BETA,
ESSZET
ON, OFF
ENGLISH,
FRENCH,
BETA,
ESSZET
ON, OFF
ENGLISH,
FRENCH,
BETA,
ESSZET
ON, OFF
ENGLISH,
FRENCH,
BETA,
ESSZET
BETA,
ESSZET
BETA,
ESSZET
BETA,
ESSZET
ON, OFF
ENGLISH,
FRENCH,
BETA,
ESSZET
ON, OFF
ENGLISH,
FRENCH,
BETA,
ESSZET
ON, OFF
ENGLISH,
FRENCH,
DEMOPRINT
LANG
ENGLISH,
FRENCH,
ENGLISH,
FRENCH,
ENGLISH,
FRENCH,
GERMAN, GERMAN, GERMAN, GERMAN, GERMAN, GERMAN, GERMAN, GERMAN, GERMAN, GERMAN,
DUTCH,
SPANISH,
ITALIAN,
FINNISH,
DUTCH,
SPANISH,
ITALIAN,
FINNISH,
DUTCH,
SPANISH,
ITALIAN,
FINNISH,
DUTCH,
SPANISH,
ITALIAN,
FINNISH,
DUTCH,
SPANISH,
ITALIAN,
FINNISH,
DUTCH,
SPANISH,
ITALIAN,
FINNISH,
DUTCH,
SPANISH,
ITALIAN,
DUTCH,
SPANISH,
ITALIAN,
DUTCH,
SPANISH,
ITALIAN,
DUTCH,,
SPANISH,
ITALIAN,
FINNISH, NORWEGIA DANISH NORWEGIA
NORWEGIA NORWEGIA NORWEGIA NORWEGIA NORWEGIA NORWEGIA NORWEGIA
N,
N, DANISH,
N, N, N, N, N, N, N,
SWEDISH,
SWEDISH
PORTUGUE PORTUGUE PORTUGUE PORTUGUE PORTUGUE PORTUGUE PORTUGUE DANISH,
SE, DANISH SE, DANISH SE, DANISH SE, DANISH SE, DANISH SE, DANISH SE, DANISH JAPANESE
SWEDISH
CANADA,U
SA
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-36
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
KEEPPCL
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
(HL-1270N
only)
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
DOUBLESTRI
KE
DUPLEX
BINDING
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
LONGEDGE,
SHORTEDG
E
LONGEDGE, LONGEDGE LONGEDGE LONGEDGE
SHORTEDG
E
FIRSTPRINT
DENSITY
NORMAL, NORMAL, NORMAL,
NORMAL
MIDDLE,
HIGH
MIDDLE,
HIGH
MIDDLE,
HIGH
1~15
1~15
1~15
-6, -5, -4, -3, - -2, -1, 0, 1, 2 -2, -1, 0, 1, 2
2, -1, 0, 1, 2,
3, 4, 5, 6
CPLOCK
PASSWORD
MPTRAY
ON, OFF
0~65535
CASSETTE,
FIRST
ON, OFF
0~65535
ON, OFF
0~65535
ON, OFF
0~65535
ON, OFF
0~65535
ON, OFF
0~65535
0~65535
0~65535
0~65535
0~65535
CASSETTE CASSETTE CASSETTE
MEDIATYPE
REGULAR, REGULAR, REGULAR, REGULAR, REGULAR, REGULAR, REGULAR, REGULAR, REGULAR, REGULAR,
THICK,
THICK2,
THICK,
THICK2,
THIN,
THICK,
THIN,
THICK,
THICK2,
THICK,
THICK,
THICK,
THICK,
THICK,
THICK,
TRANSPAR TRANSPAR TRANSPAR THICK2, TRANSPAR THICK2,
TRANSPAR TRANSPAR THICK2,
ENCY
ENCY
ENCY
TRANSPAR
ENCY,
ENCY
TRANSPAR
ENCY,
ENVELOPE
S, BOND
ENCY ENCY
TRANSPAR TRANSPAR
ENCY ENCY
THIN,
BOND
*2 This option is available only when the optional BR-Script 2 ROM Board is installed into the printer.
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-37
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
PCL Specific Variables
PCL SPECIFIC VARIABLES HL-1050, HL-1070, HL-1250,
HL-1660e, HL-2060, HL-
2400C/Ce, HL-3400CN
HL-1650/1670N
HL-3260N, HL-2460
HL-1270N/1450/1470N, HL-
P2500
FONTSOURCE
FONTNUMBER
PITCH
PTSIZE
SYMSET
I, S
0,1,2, ...n
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75
ROMAN8, ISOL1, ISOL2,
I, C, C1, S
0,1,2, ...n
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75
ROMAN8, ISOL1, ISOL2,
I, S
0-0x7FFFFFF
I, C1, C2, S
0-0x7FFFFFF
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75
PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC852, PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC852,
PC8TK, PC1004, WINL1, PC8TK, PC1004, WINL1,
WINL2, WINL5, WINBALT, WINL2, WONL5, WINBALT,
ISOL5, ISOL6, PC8, PC8DN, ISOL5, ISOL6, PC8, PC8DN,
PC850, PC852, PC8TK,
PC775, PC1004, WINL1,
WINL2, WINL5, WINBALT, WINL2, WINL5, WINBALT, VNINTL, VNUS, MSPUBL,
DESKTOP, PSTEXT,
VNINTL, VNUS, MSPUBL,
MATH8, PSMATH,
PC850, PC852, PC8TK,
PC775, PC1004, WINL1,
DESKTOP, PSTEXT,
DESKTOP, PSTEXT,
VNINTL, VNUS, MSPUBL,
MATH8, PASMATH,
DESKTOP, PSTEXT,
MATH8, PSMATH,
VNINTL, VNUS, MSPUBL, VNMATH, PIFONT, LEGAL, VNMATH, PIFONT, LEGAL,
MATH8, PSMATH,
ISO2, ISO4, ISO6, ISO10,
ISO2, ISO4, ISO6, ISO10,
ISO11, ISO14, ISO15, ISO16,
ISO17, ISO21, ISO25, ISO57,
ISO60, ISO61, ISO69, ISO84,
ISO85, WIN30, HPGERM,
HPSPAN, MCTEXT,
VNMATH, PIFONT, LEGAL, VNMATH, PIFONT, LEGAL, ISO11, ISO14, ISO15, ISO16,
ISO2, ISO4, ISO6, ISO10,
ISO11, ISO14, ISO15, ISO16,
ISO17, ISO21, ISO25,ISO57,
ISO2, ISO4, ISO6, ISO10,
ISO11, ISO14, ISO15, ISO16,
ISO17, ISO21, ISO25,ISO57,
ISO17, ISO21, ISO25, ISO57,
ISO60, ISO61, ISO69, ISO84,
ISO85, WIN30, HPGERM,
HPSPAN, MCTEXT,
ISO60, ISO61, ISO69, ISO84, ISO60, ISO61, ISO69, ISO84,
ISO85, WIN30, HPGERM,
HPSPAN, MCTEXT
SYMBOL
ISO85, WIN30, HPGERM,
HPSPAN, MCTEXT
SYMBOL, OCRA, OCRB,
WDINGS, HEBREW7,
ROMAN8, ISOL1, ISOL2,
ISOL5, ISOL6, PC775
ROMAN8, ISOL1, ISOL2,
ISOL5, ISOL6, PC775
OCRA,OCRB
WDINGS
HEBREW7
LEFTMARGIN
RIGHTMARGIN
TOPMARGIN
BOTMARGIN
FORMLINES
AUTOLF
0 ~145columns
10 ~155 columns
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch
5~128
0 ~126 columns
10 ~136 columns
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch
5~128
0 ~145 columns
10 ~155 columns
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch
5~128
0 ~126 columns
10 ~136 columns
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch
5~128
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
AUTOCR
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
AUTOWRAP
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-38
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
AUTOSKIP
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-39
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
PostScript Specific Variables
POSTSCRIPT
SPECIFIC
HL-1050
HL-1070
HL-1250/1450
HL-
HL-P2500
HL-1660e,
HL-
HL-3260
ON, OFF
HL-2460
ON, OFF
1270N/1470N
1650/1670N
HL-2060,
HL-2400C/Ce,
HL-3400CN
VARIABLES
PRTPSERRS
ORIENTATION
ON, OFF
PORTRAIT,
LANDSCAP
E
ON, OFF
PORTRAIT,
LANDSCAP
E
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT,
LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP
E
E
E
E
CRLFCONV
APPLETALKPS
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-40
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
EPSON Specific Variables
EPSON SPECIFIC
VARIABLES
HL-1050, HL-1070,
HL-1250, HL-
HL-P2500
HL-1660e, HL-2060,
HL-2400C/Ce,
HL-3400CN
HL-1650/1670N
HL-2460
HL-3260N
1270N/1450/1470N
ORIENTAION
PORTRAIT
LANDSCAPE
0 ~145
PORTRAIT
LANDSCAPE
PORTRAIT
LANDSCAPE
0 ~126 columns
PORTRAIT
LANDSCAPE
0 ~145 columns
PORTRAIT
LANDSCAPE
0 ~126 columns
PORTRAIT
LANDSCAPE
0 ~126 columns
LEFTMARGIN
RIGHTMARGIN
TOPMARGIN
BOTMARGIN
columns
10 ~155
columns
10 ~136 columns
10 ~155
columns
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
10 ~136 columns
10 ~136 columns
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
FORMLINES
FONTNUMBER
PITCH
PTSIZE
SYMSET
5~128
0,1,2, ...n
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75
USASCII, GERMAN,
UKASCI1,
5~128
0,1,2, ...n
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75
5~128
5~128
5~128
0-0x7FFFFFFF
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75
0-0x7FFFFFFF
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75
0-0x7FFFFFFF
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75
USASCII, GERMAN, USASCII, GERMAN, USASCII, GERMAN, USASCII, GERMAN,
UKASCI1,
FRENCH1,
UKASCII1,
FRENCH1,
UKASCII1,
FRENCH1,
UKASCII1,
FRENCH1,
FRENCH1,
DANISH1, ITALY,
SPANISH,
DANISH1, ITALY,
SPANISH,
DANISH1, ITALY,
SPANISH,
DANISH1, ITALY,
SPANISH,
DANISH1, ITALY,
SPANISH,
SWEDISH, JAPAN,
SWEDISH, JAPAN,
SWEDISH,
SWEDISH,
SWEDISHM,
NORWEG,
NORWEG,
JAPANESE,
NORWEGIAN,
DANISH2,
JAPANESE,
NORWEGIAN,
DANISH2,
JAPANESE,
NORWEGIAN,
DANISH2,
DANISH2, UKASCI2,
FRENCH2, DUTCH,
SAFRICA, PC8,
PC8DN, PC850,
PC852, PC860, PC863,
PC865, PC8TK
DANISH2, UKASCI2,
FRENCH2, DUTCH,
SAFRICA, PC8,
PC8DN, PC850,
UKASCII2,
FRENCH2, DUTCH, FRENCH2, DUTCH,
SOUTHAFRICAN,
PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC8, PC8DN, PC850,
PC852, PC860, PC863, PC852, PC860, PC863, PC852, PC860, PC863,
UKASCII2,
UKASCII2, FENCH2,
DUTCH,
SOUTHAFRICAN,
PC852, PC860, PC863, SOUTHAFRICAN,
PC865, PC8TK
PC865, PC8TK
ON, OFF
PC865, PC8TK
ON, OFF
PC865, PC8TK
ON, OFF
AUTOLF
AUTOMASK
SELREADOUT
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-41
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10/5/2001
IBM Specific Variables
IBM SPECIFIC
VARIABLES
HL-1050, HL-1070,
HL-1250, HL-
1270N/1450/1470N
HL-P2500
HL-1660C, HL-2060,
HL-2400C/Ce, HL-
3400CN
HL-1650/1670N
HL-3260N
HL-2460
ORIENTATION
PORTRAIT,
LANDSCAPE
0 ~145 columns
10 ~155
PORTRAIT,
PORTRAIT,
LANDSCAPE
0 ~145 columns
10 ~155
PORTRAIT,
LANDSCAPE
0 ~126 columns
10 ~136 columns
PORTRAIT,
LANDSCAPE
0 ~126 columns
10 ~136 columns
LANDSCAPE
0 ~126 columns
10 ~136 columns
LEFTMARGIN
RIGHTMARGIN
columns
columns
TOPMARGIN
BOTMARGIN
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,
2.0 inch
FORMLINES
FONTNUMBER
PITCH
PTSIZE
SYMSET
5~128
0,1,2, ...n
5~128
0,1,2, ...n
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75
5~128
5~128
5~128
0-0x7FFFFFFF
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75
0-0x7FFFFFFF
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75
0-0x7FFFFFFF
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75
PC8, PC8DN, PC850,
PC852, PC860, PC863,
PC865, PC8TK
ON, OFF
PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC8, PC8DN, PC850,
PC852, PC860, PC863, PC852, PC860, PC863, PC852, PC860, PC863, PC852, PC860, PC863,
PC865, PC8TK
ON, OFF
PC865, PC8TK
ON, OFF
PC865
PC865, PC8TK
ON, OFF
AUTOLF
AUTOCR
AUTOMASK
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
ON, OFF
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-42
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
APPENDIX B
FLASH/PCMCIA
CARD COMMANDS
<For HL-1 2 7 0 N/ 1 4 7 0 N/ 1 6 6 0 e/ 2 0 6 0 / 2 4 0 0 C/ 2 4 0 0 Ce/ 3 4 0 0 CN
/ 1 6 5 0 / 1 6 7 0 N/ 2 4 6 0 / 3 2 6 0 N On ly>
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CONTENTS
1. INTRODUCTION ..........................................................................................................................3
2. HOW TO READ THE CARD COMMANDS SPECIFICATION..............................................4
2.1 Commands................................................................................................................................ 4
2.2 Available Devices ...................................................................................................................... 4
2.3 Description ................................................................................................................................ 4
2.4 Error........................................................................................................................................... 4
3. COMMANDS .................................................................................................................................5
3.1 Select Storage Dvice Command
(For HL-2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/2460/3260N Only)......................................................... 5
3.2 Format Command..................................................................................................................... 6
3.2.1 Physical format........................................................................................................................6
3.2.2 Logical format ..........................................................................................................................6
3.3 Save Data Command................................................................................................................ 7
3.3.1 Save specified type ..................................................................................................................7
3.4 Data........................................................................................................................................... 8
3.4.1 Save data................................................................................................................................8
3.4.2 Execute data...........................................................................................................................8
3.5 Font............................................................................................................................................ 9
3.5.1 Save primary font .....................................................................................................................9
3.5.2 Save secondary font .................................................................................................................9
3.5.3 Delete all download fonts ........................................................................................................10
3.5.4 Delete download font with specified ID......................................................................................10
3.5.5 Save download font with specified ID........................................................................................11
3.6 Macro....................................................................................................................................... 12
3.6.1 Delete all macros ...................................................................................................................12
3.6.2 Delete macro with specified ID.................................................................................................12
3.6.3 Save macro with specified ID...................................................................................................13
3.6.4 Save image (Fixed printing location) (For HL-1270N/1470N/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN only)
.....................................................................................................................................................13
3.6.5 Save image (Printing location not fixed) (For HL-1270N/1470N/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN
only)..............................................................................................................................................14
3.7 Copy Card (For HL-1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/2460/3260N Only)........................ 15
4. USE CARD COMMANDS FROM PCL...................................................................................16
4.1 Execute Macros....................................................................................................................... 16
4.2 Use Download Fonts............................................................................................................... 17
5. USE CARD COMMANDS FROM POSTSCRIPT .................................................................18
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
1.
INTRODUCTION
The Flash/Card Commands described in this chapter are applicable to the HL-1270N / 1470N / 1660e / 2060
/ 2400C / 2400Ce / 3400CN / 1650 / 1670N / 2460 / 3260N printers only. The following types of devices can
be used for the printers;
1) Flash memory card (HL-1660e / 2060 / 2400C / 2400Ce / 3400CN)
2) ATA flash memory card (HL-1660e / 2060 / 2400C / 2400Ce / 3400CN / 2460 / 3260N)
3) Internal flash memory (HL-1270N / 1470N / 1650 / 1670N)
4) Internal HDD (HL-2400Ce / 3400CN / 2460 / 3260N)
Both command and control panel operations allow you to read / write data onto these devices. The
PostScript emulation recognizes device types 2), 3)and 4) as a hard disk and the PostScript file operator
allows you to read / write data on these devices.
For the HL-1270N / 1470N / 1650 / 1670N printer, please note that the part of the internal printer flash
memory can be used as though it was a HDD.
APPENDIX B - FLASH/ PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
2.
HOW TO READ THE CARD COMMANDS SPECIFICATION
Each command is described in the following four sections of this manual.
2.1
Commands
Command data sequences and syntax.
ESC or CR stands for 0x1b or 0x0d as follows;
ESC ----0x1b
CR ---- 0x0d
2.2
Available Devices
The supported memory card devices which can be used for each command are represented in this manual
using the abbreviations as follows.
Abbreviation
Device Type
F
Flash memory card (HL-1660e / 2060 / 2400C / 2400Ce / 3400CN)
ATA flash memory card
A
(HL-1660e / 2060 / 2400C / 2400Ce / 3400CN / 2460 / 3260N)
Internal IDE HDD (HL-2400C / 2400Ce / 3400CN / 2460 / 3260N)
Internal flash memory (HL-1650 / 1670N / 1270N / 1470N)
H
I
2.3
2.4
Description
The detailed description about each command with command structure and syntax.
Error
Possible errors that may occur during cards operations.
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.
COMMANDS
3.1
Select Storage Device Command
(For HL-2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/2460/3260N Only)
Command
ESC CR ! 12358F Slot No
** Slot No = 1
Slot No = 2 (Slot No. 2 is not used for the HL-2460/3260N.)
Slot No = 3 (Internal HDD)
Default = 1
Available Devices
F, A, H
Description
The card is specified and controlled by the following commands.
For the detailed information on specific card operation commands, refer to the following sections which
describe each command in detail.
Command
ESC CR ! 12340F
ESC CR ! 12341F
ESC CR ! 12343F
ESC CR ! 12344F
ESC CR ! 12345F
ESC CR ! 12347F
ESC CR ! 12348F
ESC CR ! 12349F
ESC CR ! 12350F
ESC * c 1028F
ESC * c 1026F
ESC * c 1029F
ESC & f 1030X
ESC & f 1036X
ESC & f 1038X
ESC CR ! 12357F
Physical Format
Logical Format
Save Primary Font
Save Secondary Font
Save by Type
Save Data
Save Image (Fixed Printing Location)
Execute Data
Save Image (Infixed Printing Location)
Delete All Download Fonts
Delete Download Fonts of Specified ID
Save Download Fonts of Specified ID
Delete All Macros
Delete Macros of Specified ID
Save Macros of Specified ID
Copy Card
Default value is 1 (slot 1). The card is reset to the default value under the following circumstances:-
1) When the printer is turned on.
2) When the printer is reset on the control panel.
Error
N/A
APPENDIX B - FLASH/ PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.2
Format Command
3.2.1 Physical format
Command
ESC CR ! 12340F
Available Devices
F, A, H, I
Description
This command executes a physical format for the storage device. This will delete all existing data on the
device.
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command formats the device specified by the select
storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command formats that device.
Error
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:
43 CARD1 W ERROR
43 CARD2 W ERROR
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR
HL-2460/3260N:
43 CARD ERROR
43 HDD ERROR
HL-1650/1670N:
43 SERVICE E74
3.2.2 Logical format
Command
ESC CR ! 12341F
Available Devices
F, A, H, I
Description
This command executes a logical format.
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command formats the device specified by the select
storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command formats that device.
Error
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:
43 CARD1 W ERROR
43 CARD2 W ERROR
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR
HL-2460/3260N:
43 CARD ERROR
43 HDD ERROR
HL-1650/1670N:
43 SERVICE E74
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.3
Save Data Command
3.3.1 Save specified type
Command
ESC CR ! 12345F type(4byte) size(4byte) data...
** type = MCRO, DATA
Available Devices
F, A, H
Description
This command saves data of the specified type with the data ID which is set with the ESC & f # Y
(Macro ID Configuration) command.
If there is insufficient memory in the printer to store the data, a memory full error occurs.
When the printer supports two or more storage devices, the command saves the data onto the device
specified by the select storage device command. When only one device is enabled, the command saves
onto that device.
Error
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:
34 MEMORY FULL
43 CARD1 W ERROR
43 CARD2 W ERROR
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR
HL-2460/3260N:
43 CARD ERROR
43 HDD ERROR
HL-1650/1670N:
43 SERVICE E74
APPENDIX B - FLASH/ PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.4
Data
3.4.1 Save data
Command
ESC CR ! 12347F ID(2byte) size(4byte) data...
Available Devices
F, A, H
Description
This command saves data which is sent from the PC with the specified ID onto the device.
If there is insufficient memory in the printer to store the data, a memory full error occurs.
When the printer supports two or more storage devices, the command saves the data onto the device
specified by the select storage device command. When only one device is enabled, the command saves
onto that device.
Error
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:
34 MEMORY FULL
43 CARD1 W ERROR
43 CARD2 W ERROR
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR
HL-2460/3260N:
43 CARD ERROR
43 HDD ERROR
HL-1650/1670N:
43 SERVICE E74
3.4.2 Execute data
Command
ESC CR ! 12349F ID(2byte)
Available Devices
F, A, H
Description
This command executes the specified ID data.
When the printer supports two or more storage devices, the command saves the data onto the device
specified by the select storage device command. When only one device is enabled, the command saves
onto that device.
Error
N/A
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.5
Font
3.5.1 Save primary font
Command
ESC CR ! 12343F
Available Devices
F, A, H, I
Description
This command saves the primary font which is currently selected into the device. The primary font can
also be saved by control panel operation.
The ID specified with the ESC * c # D(Font ID ) command is used for registration.
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command saves the font onto the device specified by
the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command saves the font onto
that device.
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.
Error
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:
43 CARD1 W ERROR
43 CARD2 W ERROR
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR
HL-2460/3260N:
43 CARD ERROR
43 HDD ERROR
HL-1650/1670N:
43 SERVICE E74
3.5.2 Save secondary font
Command
ESC CR ! 12344F
Available Devices
F, A, H, I
Description
This command saves the secondary font which is currently selected into the device. The secondary font
can also be saved by control panel operation.
The ID specified with the ESC * c # D(Font ID) command is used for registration.
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command saves the font onto the device specified by
the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command saves the font onto
that device.
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.
Error
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:
43 CARD1 W ERROR
43 CARD2 W ERROR
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR
HL-2460/3260N:
43 CARD ERROR
43 HDD ERROR
HL-1650/1670N:
43 SERVICE E74
APPENDIX B - FLASH/ PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.5.3 Delete all download fonts
Command
ESC * c 1028F
Available Devices
F, A, H, I
Description
This command deletes all the download fonts which are saved in the device.
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command deletes the download fonts in the device
specified by the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command deletes
the download fonts in that device.
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.
Error
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:
43 CARD1 W ERROR
43 CARD2 W ERROR
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR
HL-2460/3260N:
43 CARD ERROR
43 HDD ERROR
HL-1650/1670N:
43 SERVICE E74
3.5.4 Delete download font with specified ID
Command
ESC * c 1026F
Available Devices
F, A, H, I
Description
This command deletes the font with the ID which is specified with the ESC * c # D(Font ID )
command from the device.
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command deletes the download fonts in the device
specified by the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command deletes
the download fonts in that device.
If any download fonts with the specified ID are not saved in the device, this command is ignored.
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.
Error
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:
43 CARD1 W ERROR
43 CARD2 W ERROR
HL-2400Ce/34000CN:
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR
HL-2460/3260N:
43 CARD ERROR
43 HDD ERROR
HL-1650/1670N:
43 SERVICE E74
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.5.5 Save download font with specified ID
Command
ESC * c 1029F
Available Devices
F, A, H, I
Description
This command saves the font with the ID which is specified with the ESC * C # D(Font ID) command.
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command saves the download fonts in the device
specified by the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command saves
the download fonts in that device.
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.
Error
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:
43 CARD1 W ERROR
43 CARD2 W ERROR
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR
HL-2460/3260N:
43 CARD ERROR
43 HDD ERROR
HL-1650/1670N:
43 SERVICE E74
APPENDIX B - FLASH/ PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.6
Macro
3.6.1 Delete all macros
Command
ESC & f 1030X
Available Devices
F, A, H, I
Description
This command deletes all the macros which are saved in the device.
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command deletes all the macros in the device specified
by the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command deletes all the
macros in that device.
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.
Error
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:
43 CARD1 W ERROR
43 CARD2 W ERROR
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR
HL-2460/3260N:
43 CARD ERROR
43 HDD ERROR
HL-1650/1670N:
43 SERVICE E74
3.6.2 Delete macro with specified ID
Command
ESC & f 1036X
Available Devices
F, A, H, I
Description
This command deletes the macro with the ID which is specified with the ESC & f # Y(Macro ID
Configuration) command from the device.
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command deletes the macros in the device specified by
the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command deletes the macros
in that device. If any macros with the specified ID are not saved in the device, the command is ignored.
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.
Error
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:
43 CARD1 W ERROR
43 CARD2 W ERROR
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR
HL-2460/3260N:
43 CARD ERROR
43 HDD ERROR
HL-1650/1670N:
43 SERVICE E74
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.6.3 Save macro with specified ID
Command
ESC & f 1038X
Available Devices
F, A, H, I
Description
This command saves a macro with the ID which is specified with the ESC & f # Y(Macro ID
Configuration) command on the device.
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command saves the macros on the device specified by
the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command saves the macros on
that device.
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.
Error
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:
43 CARD1 W ERROR
43 CARD2 W ERROR
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR
HL-2460/3260N:
43 CARD ERROR
43 HDD ERROR
HL-1650/1670N:
43 SERVICE E74
3.6.4
Save image (Fixed printing location)
Command
ESC CR ! 12348F
Available Devices
F
Description
After transferring the last print data into the image data area, this command saves the data with the ID
which is specified with the ESC & f # Y(Macro ID Configuration) command as a PCL command on the
device.
The printing location for the saved data is fixed on the page.
The data can be executed by the data execute command (ESC CR ! 12349 F).
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command saves the data on the device specified with
the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command saves the data on
that device.
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.
Error
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:
43 CARD1 W ERROR
43 CARD2 W ERROR
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR
APPENDIX B - FLASH/ PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.6.5
Save image (Printing location not fixed)
Command
ESC CR ! 12350F
Available Device
F
Description
After transferring the last print data into the image data area, this command saves the data with the ID
which is specified with the ESC & f # Y(Macro ID Configuration) command as a PCL command on the
device.
The printing location for the saved data is not fixed on the page.
The move cursor command allows you to print the data anywhere you want when executing this command.
The data can be executed by the data execute command (ESC CR ! 12349 F).
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command saves the data on the device specified with
the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command saves the data on
that device.
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.
Error
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:
43 CARD1 W ERROR
43 CARD2 W ERROR
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.7
Copy Card (For HL-1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/2460/3260N Only)
Command
ESC CR ! 12357F
Available Devices
F, A
Description
1) Flash memory card
After executing a logical format on the transfer device, this command copies to the transfer device only
when the two devices have the same memory size. It is essential that the transfer device has already been
formatted.
The specify device command allows you to specify the source device.
Specified Device
Copy Order
Slot 2 ® Slot 1
Slot 1 ® Slot 2
1
2
** “Slot 2 ® Slot 1” is the default setting.
2) ATA flash memory card
After executing a logical format on the transfer device, this command copies to the transfer device file by
file from the master device.
If the memory runs short in the transfer device during the data transfer, the copy process is discontinued.
Data written to the transfer device before the error is valid in the device.
The specify device command allows you to specify the source device.
Specified Device
Copy Order
Slot 2 ® Slot 1
Slot 1 ® Slot 2
1
2
** “Slot 2 ® Slot 1” is the default setting.
Error
43 CARD1 W ERROR
43 CARD2 W ERROR
(HL-2460 / 3260N)
Specified Device
Copy Order
1
Internal HDD ® Slot 1
Slot 1 ® Internal HDD
2,3
Note that this command cannot copy the spool data.
Error
43 CARD ERROR
43 HDD ERROR
APPENDIX B - FLASH/ PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.
USE CARD COMMANDS FROM PCL
4.1
Execute Macros
Command
ESC & l 2 X
ESC & l 3 X
ESC & l 4 X
Execute Macro
Call Macro
Macro Overlay
Available Devices
F, A, H, I
Description
The macros saved in the device can be executed from the PCL command language as well as saving
macros in the printer memory.
The priority for searching is as follows;
1. Macro in printer memory
2. Macro in Card 1
3. Macro in Card 2
4. Macro in Internal HDD
The above priority is never affected by the select storage device command (ESC CR ! 12358F).
Error
N/A
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 16
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.2
Use Download Fonts
Command
ESC ( # X
ESC ) # X
Designates soft font # as Primary
Designates soft font # as Secondary
** # = font ID number
Available Devices
F, A, H, I
Description
The download fonts saved in the device can be selected from the PCL command language as well as
saving download fonts in printer memory.
The priority for searching is as follows;
1. Macro in printer memory
2. Macro in Card 1
3. Macro in Card 2
4. Macro in Internal HDD
The above priority is never affected by the select storage device command (ESC CR ! 12358F).
The download fonts can be also selected from the font select command in PCL.
Error
N/A
APPENDIX B - FLASH/ PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
5.
USE CARD COMMANDS FROM POSTSCRIPT
The PostScript emulation recognizes the storage device as a hard disk (except a Flash memory card) and
the PostScript file operation allows you to read/write data on these devices.
(i.e.)
Create the file named “test” and write the data, “This is a data string” onto the device which is inserted
into Slot 1.
/fl (%disk0%test)(w)file def
fl (This is a data string) write
fl closefile
For PostScript, the following command should be used to specify the hard disk which is to be used;
(%disk#%)
** # = number
The above number corresponds to the slots of the HL-1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/2460/2460N
printer as follows;
Slot 1:
Slot 2:
(%disk0%)
(%disk1%)
Internal HDD: (%disk2%)
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 18
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
APPENDIX C
HBP MODE
COMMANDS
<For HL-8 2 0 / 1 0 2 0 / 1 0 4 0 On ly>
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CONTENTS
1. DESCRIPTIONS.....................................................................................................................................3
2. COMMAND TO ENTER HBP MODE..................................................................................................4
3. HBP COMMANDS .................................................................................................................................5
3.1 Command List.....................................................................................................................................5
3.2 Commands (Detailed Explanation).....................................................................................................6
3.2.1 Resolution setting commands ............................................................................................................ 6
3.2.2 Economy mode setting commands..................................................................................................... 6
3.2.3 Sleep mode setting commands .......................................................................................................... 7
3.2.4 Mode setting commands ................................................................................................................... 8
3.2.5 Engine related setting commands....................................................................................................... 9
3.2.6 Engine related execute commands..................................................................................................... 9
3.2.7 Graphic data input commands.......................................................................................................... 10
3.2.8 Formfeed commands....................................................................................................................... 10
3.2.9 Exit commands .............................................................................................................................. 10
3.3 Graphic Data Format ........................................................................................................................11
4. RECOMMENDED COMMAND STRING......................................................................................... 13
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
1.
DESCRIPTIONS
The HBP mode commands can be used for the HL-820/1020/1040 printers only.
The following commands and syntax are used in these specifications.
Description:
<Esc>:
meaning or code
0 x 1b
<Space>: 0 x 20
<LF>:
*:
0 x 0a
1byte of data
+:
sign for combining data ( This is not a control code.)
character string enclosed in parentheses means 1 data byte described in binary format
(••••)B:
CHR$(•): character of the value (in decimal) enclosed in parentheses
••H:
means hexadecimal value
(Examples)
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<LF>
1bH
58H
25H
40H
2dH
50H
31H
4aH
32H
4cH
33H
0aH
34H
35H
@L+(00000000)B
-> 40H
4cH
00H
00H
@J+CHR$ (0) + CHR$ (1)
- > 40H 4aH
01H
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
2.
COMMAND TO ENTER HBP MODE
Command
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<LF>
@PJL<Space>ENTER<Space>LANGUAGE<Space>=<Space>HBP<LF>
Function
The printer enters the HBP mode when this command is received.
Explanation
The printer can receive this command when it is in the idle condition (during HP emulation, IBM emulation, Epson
emulation and Auto emulation for HL-1040). The printer reports an error if it receives this command when it is
already in HBP mode. The printer enters HBP mode when it receives this command. This mode continues until
one of following occurs.
(1) The printer receives the Exit command.
(2) The printer power is turned off.
(3) InputPrime Signal is brought LOW.
The printer executes the following HBP commands in HBP mode.
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.
HBP COMMANDS
An HBP command is composed of ‘@’ + an Uppercase Alphabetic character + parameters (not necessary for
some commands).
3.1
Command List
<Character string>
<Functions>
@A
@B
@C
@D
@E
@F
@G
@H
@I
Reserved
Reserved
Not used
Speed setting for Centronics I/F
Economy mode setting
Form feed
Data input
Not used
Information request
@J
Settings for engine related items
@K
@L
@M
@N
@O
@P
@Q
@R
@S
@T
@U
@V
@W
@X
@Y
@Z
Execution for engine related items
Resolution setting
Mode setting
Reserved
Not used
Reserved
Not used
Reserved
Not used
Setting for sleep time
Not used
Not used
Not used
Exit
Not used
Not used
Not used : An error occurs in the printer if these character strings are sent as commands.
Reserved : These commands are not necessary to create the driver. Do not use these commands.
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.2
Commands (Detailed Explanation)
3.2.1 Resolution setting commands
Command
@L + *
Function
This command sets the printer resolution.
Command
Resolution
@ L+ (00000000)B
@ L+ (00000101)B
@ L+ (00001010)B
600dpi
300dpi
150dpi
(Default)
Explanation
The resolution is set when the printer receives this command.
This command is applied from the next page printed after the FormFeed command after this command is sent (i.e.
the next complete page).
The resolution is valid until the one of the following occurs.
(1) The printer receives the Exit command.
(2) The printer power is turned off.
(3) InputPrime Signal is brought LOW.
After (1) is sent, the printer resolution is uncertain. The driver must resend this command again after the HBP
mode switch command is sent.
After (2) or (3), the resolution returns to default (600 dpi).
3.2.2 Economy mode setting commands
Command
@E + *
Function
Command
Economy Mode
@ E+ (00000000)B
@ E+ (00000001)B
@ E+ (00000010)B
@ E+ (00000011)B
OFF
Level 1 (Darkest)
Level 2
(Default)
Level 3 (Lightest)
Explanation
This command is applied from the next page printed after the FormFeed command after this command is input.
Default value is Economy Mode OFF.
The ECONOMY MODE is valid until the one of the following occurs.
(1) The printer receives the Exit command.
(2) The printer power is turned off.
(3) InputPrime Signal is brought LOW.
After (1) is sent, the ECONOMY MODE value is uncertain. The driver must resend this command again after the
HBP mode switch command is sent.
After (2) or (3), the ECONOMY MODE value returns to default. (OFF)
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.2.3 Sleep mode setting commands
Command
@T+ *
Function
This command sets the sleep time in minutes.
Explanation
This command is valid immediately after the printer receives the command.
The command is valid until one of the following occurs.
(1) The printer receives the Exit command.
(2) The printer receives a new sleep time setting command.
(3) The printer power is turned off.
(4) InputPrime Signal is brought LOW.
This command sets the time from the last printer operation (printing, key pressing, motor being driven) to entering
sleep mode.
1 byte of binary data (0-255) after the @T command indicates the minute(s) delay to enter sleep mode. However,
there are two exceptions. If the value is set to 0, the sleep time is set to 5 seconds. If the value is set to 255, the
printer does not go into sleep mode.
For the HL-1040, the command is valid during HBP mode only, it is not effective after using the @X Exit
command.
Note1:
Sleep time means the time from the last operation ( Key Pressing, Data receiving, Printing) to entering sleep
mode.
Note2:
HL-1040 also accepts the PJL command which sets the sleep time. The sleep time set by the PJL command is
valid both in HBP mode and in Non-HBP modes. (PCL, EPSON or IBM emulation)
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.2.4 Mode setting commands
Command
@M+*
Function
This command allows various error mode operations to be set. 1 byte, used as 8 bits, that follows the @M
command select the settings for each mode.
Bit0:0 = The printer clears the input buffer when a Paper Jam error or Undefined Code error occurs. The printer
does not recover automatically from a Print Overrun error.
1 = The printer does not clear the input buffer when a Paper Jam error or Undefined Code error occurs.
The printer recovers automatically 10 seconds later from a Print Overrun error.
Bit1:
Not used
Bit2:0 = The printer generates an error when an undefined code is received.
1 = The printer ignores any undefined codes.
Bit3:
Not used
Bit4:0 = The printer does not ignore any illegal data which is received before entering the HBP mode. (The
printer will ignore any illegal data until approx. 32kbyte is received, then the data after that is
recognized as undefined code.)
Bit5:
Bit6:
Bit7:
Not used
Not used
Select printer error messages ON or OFF. (HL-820/1020/1040)
The printer does not print an error message when an error occurs.
0:
1:
The printer prints an error message when an error occurs. The printer resets when an error occurs
when Bit7:1. Therefore the setting of Bit0:1 is ignored.
This command works immediately after it is sent to the printer. The command actions apply to the data before
printing.
The most appropriate value is as follows;
@M<81H>
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.2.5 Engine related setting commands
Command
@J+*
Function
This command allows the setting of engine related commands. Each setting depends on the value of the 3 byte
command string.
@J+CHR$ (0) +CHR$ (n): Sets Media Type
This command allows the printer to change the temperature control for the fuser unit when printing.
n=0:
n=1:
n=2:
n=3:
Regular (Default)
Thick paper
Thicker paper
Transparency
@J+CHR$ (1) +CHR$ (n): Sets the toner stirring time
The value of n (0-255) sets the toner stirring time in seconds. The value 0 gives the default setting of 30 seconds
stored in the printer, and 1- 6 is fixed at 6 seconds. Toner is stirred by the @K+CHR$ (0) command. It is not
necessary to set it from the driver.
@J+CHR$ (2) +CHR$ (n): Indicates Envelope mode
n=0
n=1
Normal mode
Envelope mode
The driver sets the value to 1 if the paper length is from 180 mm to 250 mm, and the value to 0 when it is shorter
or longer.
@J+CHR$ (3) +CHR$ (n): Sets the envelope mode level
The value n sets the time limit in continuous envelope printing. The default (0) is 20 seconds, which represents a
printing speed of 3 ppm.
When set to 0, the time limit in continuous envelope printing is set to 20 seconds.
The printing speed is fastest if the setting is shorter than normal loading speed, such as 1 second or 2 seconds.
It is not necessary to set it from the driver.
3.2.6 Engine related execute commands
Command
@K+*
Function
This is an immediately executed command.
@K+CHR$ (0):
Execute toner stirring
To set the toner stirring time, use the command, @J+CHR$(1)+CHR$(n).
It is not necessary to set this command from the driver.
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.2.7 Graphic data input commands
Command
@G+[data length(3bytes)]+data
Function
The 3 bytes of data following the @G command shows the length of the data, N. The N bytes following this 3
byte header is handled as graphic data.
(Example)
fprintf(fp,”@G%c%c%c”,
(char)((data_length>>16)&0xff),
(char)((data_length>>8)&0xff),
(char)((data_length>>0)&0xff) );
fwrite(data,(size_t)1,(size_t)data_length,fp);
See section 2.3 for further details of the data format.
The printer driver can send the printer 1 page of print data divided into sections by sending these commands
continuously. It is recommended to send 1 page of print data without dividing into sections when the 1 page
print data is more than the printer memory (500 Kbytes) as the printer will print this ' on the fly' and sending it in
one block will improve the print performance.
3.2.8 Formfeed commands
Command
@F
Remark: The last raster scan on each page should be a white raster. For instance, the white raster command
‘@G<00H><00H><01H><FFH>‘ should be sent before the @F command.
Function
This command sets a page break.
The printer works as follows when it receives this command;
(1) If 1 page of print data is less than the input buffer size in the printer, the printer recognizes the command
as a page break and starts printing.
(2) If 1 page of print data is more than the input buffer size in the printer, then since the printer has already
started printing, this command is handled as a page break only.
When it is received after printing, a Print Overrun error occurs in the printer. If Bit0 is set to 1 in the mode
setting command (@M+*) mentioned in section 2.2.5., the printer ignores the data until it receives this
form feed command when a Print Overrun error occurs.
3.2.9 Exit commands
Command
@X
Function
This command exits from HBP mode
The HL-1040 printer is restored to the default emulation mode by this command
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.3
Graphic Data Format
The data format, which follows the @G+ [number of data bytes (3 bytes)] command, is as shown below.
the number of
command bytes for
raster 1
command byte 1 modified data 1
command byte 1 modified data 1
command byte 2 modified data 2
the number of
command bytes for
raster 2
modified data 2
modified data 3
:
:
The number of
command bytes for
raster n
command byte 1 modified data 1
The description of each byte
(1) the number of command bytes for raster n
This byte describes the number of command bytes for each raster.
In the case that the raster data is the same as the former raster, 00h is sent as the number of command bytes.
In the case that the data is all white, FFh is sent as the number of command bytes and the data format ,
which should follow the number of command bytes, is not necessary.
(2) command byte
The operation of this byte is divided into the following 2 uses.
Data replacement
0
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
b6, b5, b4, b3 the replacement position (4bits)
b2, b1, b0
the amount of replacement data (3bits): The input value is 1 less than the actual data count
of the replacement data.
When both b6, b5, b4, b3 and b2, b1, b0 are overflow, the next byte shows the replacement position and the
byte after the next byte shows the amount of replacement data.
Repeated data replacement
1
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
b6, b5
the replacement position (2bits)
b4, b3, b2, b1, b0 the number of loops (5bits): The input value is 2 less than the actual number of loops.
(Example)
The 4th byte of data onward is replaced by the three data bytes 00h, AAh, 55h
00100010b,00h,AAh,55h
The 15th byte of data onward is replaced by the two data bytes 33h, 44h and the 20th data onward
( absolute value) is replaced by the two data bytes FFh.
01111001b,33h,44h,00100001b,FFh
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
The 5th byte data onward is replaced by the twelve data bytes AAh.
11101010b,02h,Aah
When the replacement position and the amount of replacement data are overflow, the next data byte
becomes an Expansion Offset Byte. However, if the number is FFh, 00h is added.
The number of command bytes = 300, FFh+2Dh
The number of command bytes = 510, FFh+FFh+00h
If there are more than two command bytes for 1 raster, the replacement position for the second command
byte onwards is indicated by the offset byte, starting from the data position replaced by the first command
byte.
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
4.
RECOMMENDED COMMAND STRING
The command strings below shows the recommended command stream for two pages of a print job.
<Esc>%-12345X@PJL<LF>
used for HL-820/1020/1040
used for HL-820/1020/1040
@PJL DEFAULT AUTOSLEEP=0<LF>
@PJL DEFAULT TIMEOUTSLEEP= 15<LF> used for HL-820/1020/1040
<Esc>%-12345X@PJL<LF>
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = HBP<LF>
Enter into HBP mode
Set 600 dpi resolution
Set economy mode off
Set Sleep time to 15 minutes
Set mode
@L<00H>
@E<00H>
@T<0FH>
@M<81H>
Error Print on
@J<00H><00H>
@J<02H><00H>
Set the MediaType ( normal paper)
Thick paper : @J<00H><01H>]
Normal Paper ( not Envelope)
Envelope [@J<02H><01H>]
1 page of data (1st page)
white raster
@G<size(3byte)><data>
@G+ <00H><00H><01H><FFH>
@F
Form feed ( 1st page)
1 page of data (2nd page)
white raster
@G<size(3byte)><data>
@G+ <00H><00H><01H><FFH>
@F
Form feed ( 2nd page)
Exit from HBP mode
@X
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
APPENDIX D
REFERENCE LIST OF
MX-2000/4000/5000
SERIES UNIQUE
COMMANDS
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000/4000/5000 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CONTENTS
1. INTRODUCTION .............................................................................................................3
2. GENERAL SPECIFICATION ........................................................................................4
3. COMMAND REFERENCE LIST...................................................................................5
3.1. Commands Descriptions............................................................................................ 5
3.1.1.
3.1.2.
3.1.3.
3.1.4.
3.1.5.
3.1.6.
PJL output tray & mode setting .................................................................................5
PJL mailbox protection & bin number setting ..............................................................6
PJL avoidance of mailbox bin full................................................................................6
PCL output tray setting.............................................................................................7
PS output tray & mode setting ..................................................................................7
PS mailbox protection & bin number setting ...............................................................9
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000/4000/5000 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
1.
INTRODUCTION
This manual covers the general specifications and the command reference list of the MX-2000 series (MX-2001 /
MX-2002 / MX-2003), MX-4000 series (MX-4100 / MX-4200 / MX-4300) and MX-5000 Mailbox units. The MX-
2000 series Mailbox units are optionally installed onto the HL-2060 printer, the MX-4000 series are optionally
installed onto the HL-2460 printer, and MX-5000 series are optionally installed onto the HL-3260 printer.
If you need further information on the mechanical system, refer to the service manual of MX-2000 series or MX-
4000 series.
Note:
While the MX-2001/4100 Mailbox unit is available in all countries, the MX-2003/4200 is available in U.S.
and Canada only, and the MX-2002/4300 is available in the other countries than U.S. and Canada.
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000/4000/5000 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
2.
GENERAL SPECIFICATION
The Mailbox unit is an option for the HL-2060, HL-2460 or HL-3260 printer and the MX-2000/4000 series
composed of three types of units. The MX-2001/4100 Lower Mailbox unit consists of five bins. The MX-
2002/4200 Upper Mailbox unit is additionally installed onto the MX-2001/4100 and also consists of five bins. The
MX-2003/4300 Mailbox unit consists of ten bins. Once you have installed the unit, it works as a stacker, sorter
and mailbox for the printer.
HL-2060 : MX-2001/2002/2003
HL-2460 : MX-4001/4002/4003
HL-3260 : MX-5000
Function
Stacker
Description
Printed paper is ejected into the multiple output bins behaving as a single
high-capacity tray.
Sorter
Printed paper is ejected as a set for a print job into a bin when multiple
sets of documents are printed and collated.
Mailbox
Printed paper is ejected into the bin specified as your own mail box.
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000/4000/5000 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.
COMMAND REFERENCE LIST
This section describes the specific commands as listed below used to support the functions of the Mailbox unit.
1) PJL output tray & mode setting
2) PJL mailbox protection & bin number setting
3) PJL avoidance of output bin full
4) PCL output tray setting
5) PS output tray & mode setting
6) PS mailbox protection & bin number setting
For the details on each command, refer to the following sections.
3.1. Commands Descriptions
3.1.1. PJL output tray & mode setting
Format
@PJL SET/DEFAULT OUTBIN=TrayName
Parameter
TrayName*
· UPPER:
Select the printer face-down output tray.
Select the #1 bin of the Mailbox unit.
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN1:
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN2:
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN3:
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN4:
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN5:
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN6:
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN7:
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN8:
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN9:
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN10:
· ALLSTACKER:
Select the #2 bin of the Mailbox unit.
Select the #3 bin of the Mailbox unit.
Select the #4 bin of the Mailbox unit.
Select the #5 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)
Select the #6 bin of the Mailbox unit (except HL-3260)
Select the #7 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)
Select the #8 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)
Select the #9 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)
Select the #10 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)
Select the stacker function. **
· ALLSORTER:
Select the sorter function. **
* = The tray names are compatible with the HP tray naming.
** = These are unique tray names (parameters) for the HL-2060/2460/3260.
Default = ALLSTACKER
Explanation
·
This command selects the specified output tray and output mode, trays defined as Mailboxes are numbered
from the bottom of the unit upwards
·
·
This command is ignored when there is no specified tray.
The ALLSTACKER and ALLSORTER parameters are executed for all output trays other than the ones which
are defined and protected as mailboxes. (Refer to Section 3.1.2 ‘PJL mailbox protection & tray number
setting’.)
·
The difference between the SET and DEFAULT selection and the effective period of this setting follow the
PJL specifications.
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000/4000/5000 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.1.2. PJL mailbox protection & bin number setting
Format
@PJL SET/DEFAULT MAILBOXPROTECT=TrayNumber
Parameter
TrayNumber
<HL-2060/2460>
· Lower unit:
#1 to 5 from bottom to top
· Lower unit + Upper unit: #1 to 10 from bottom to top
<HL-3260>
#1 to 4 from bottom to top
Default = 0
Explanation
·
·
·
This command sets the bins with numbers larger than the TrayNumber specified as mailbox use only. They
cannot then be used for either stacker or sorter functions.
If the bin number is set to 0, the mailbox protection is released, then all bins can be used for stacker and sorter
functions.
If the bin number is set out of the effective range, this command is ignored.
<HL-2060/2460>
Setting type
Effective range
0
· MX not installed
· Lower unit installed
· Lower & upper unit installed
0, 1 ~ 5
0, 1 ~ 10
<HL-3260>
Setting type
· MX not installed
· MX installed
Effective range
0
0, 1 ~ 4
·
The difference between the SET and DEFAULT selection and the effective period of this setting follow the
PJL specifications.
3.1.3. PJL avoidance of mailbox bin full
Command
@PJL SET/DEFAULT AVOIDMAILBOXFULL=ON/OFF
Parameter
ON/OFF
· OFF:
· ON:
Paper is ejected to the printer face-down output tray when the specified tray is full.
Paper is not ejected to the printer face-down output tray even when the specified tray is full.
Default = OFF
Explanation
·
·
When paper is ejected into a bin specified by a setting command which limits the bin selection, this command
selects whether to eject automatically paper to the printer face-down output tray or not when the specified bin
is full.
The difference between the SET and DEFAULT selection and the effective period of this setting follow the
PJL specifications.
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000/4000/5000 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.1.4. PCL output tray setting
Command
Esc&l#G (27)(38)(108)#(71) <1Bh><38h><6ch>#<47h>
Parameter
# denotes the output tray.
· 1:
· 3:
· 4:
· 5:
· 6:
· 7:
· 8:
· 9:
Select the printer face-down output tray.
Select #1 bin of the Mailbox unit.
Select #2 bin of the Mailbox unit.
Select #3 bin of the Mailbox unit.
Select #4 bin of the Mailbox unit.
Select #5 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)
Select #6 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)
Select #7 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)
· 10: Select #8 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)
· 11: Select #9 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)
· 12: Select #10 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)
Default = 1
Explanation
·
This command selects the specified output tray, trays defined as Mailboxes are numbered from the bottom of
the unit upwards
·
·
·
This command is ignored when the specified tray is not available.
The PJL OUTBIN command is ignored when this command is executed.
Refer to the Technical Reference Guide Section 4.1.2 ‘Output tray’ in Chapter 2 ‘PCL’.
3.1.5. PS output tray & mode setting
Command
<HL-2060>
# setoutputmode
<HL-2460/3260>
<</BROutbinMode #>> setpagedevice
Parameter
#
· 0:
Select the printer face-down output tray.
Select the stacker function.
· 1:
· 2:
Select the sorter function.
· 4~10:
· 11:
· 12:
· 13:
· 14:
· 15
Select the printer face-down output tray.
Select #1 bin of the Mailbox unit.
Select #2 bin of the Mailbox unit.
Select #3 bin of the Mailbox unit.
Select #4 bin of the Mailbox unit.
Select #5 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)
Select #6 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)
Select #7 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)
Select #8 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)
Select #9 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)
Select #10 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)
· 16:
· 17:
· 18:
· 19:
· 20:
Default = 0
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000/4000/5000 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
Explanation
·
·
·
This operator selects the specified output tray and output mode.
This operator is ignored when no tray is specified.
The ‘1’ and ‘2’ parameters are executed for all output trays other than ones which are defined and protected
as mailboxes.
<Example>
(HL-2060)
This operator is registered in ‘statusdict’.
statusdict begin
0 setoutputmode
end
(HL-2460/3260)
<</BROutbinMode 0>> setpagedevice
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000/4000/5000 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.1.6. PS mailbox protection & bin number setting
Command
<HL-2060>
# setoutputprotect
<HL-2460/3260>
<</BROutbinProtect #>> setpagedevice
Parameter
#
<HL-2060/2460>
· Lower unit:
#1 to 5 from bottom to top
· Lower unit + Upper unit: #1 to 10 from bottom to top
<HL-3260>
#1 to 4 from bottom to top
Default = 0
Explanation
·
·
·
This operator sets the bins with numbers larger than the TrayNumber specified as mailbox use only. They
cannot then be used for either stacker or sorter functions.
If the bin number is set to 0, the mailbox protection is released, then all bins can be used for stacker and sorter
functions.
If the bin number is set out of the effective range, this operator is ignored.
<HL-2060/2460>
Setting type
Effective range
· MX not installed
0
· Lower unit installed
· Lower & upper unit installed
0, 1 ~ 5
0, 1 ~ 10
<HL-3260>
Setting type
· MX not installed
· MX installed
Effective range
0
0, 1 ~ 4
<Example>
(HL-2060)
This operator is registered in ‘statusdict’.
statusdict begin
5 setoutputprotect
end
(HL-2460/3260)
<</BROutbinProtect 4>> setpagedevice
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000/4000/5000 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
APPENDIX E
REFERENCE LIST OF
FS-5050 UNIQUE
COMMANDS
APPENDIX E REFERENCE LIST OF FS-5050 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
CONTENTS
1. INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................3
2. GENERAL SPECIFICATION ...........................................................................................3
3. COMMAND REFERENCE LIST......................................................................................3
3.1. Commands Descriptions................................................................................................ 4
3.1.1. PJL output tray..............................................................................................................4
3.1.2. PCL output tray .............................................................................................................4
3.1.3. PS output tray...............................................................................................................4
3.1.4. PJL staple on/off............................................................................................................5
3.1.5. PS staple on/off.............................................................................................................5
3.1.6. PJL job offset on/off........................................................................................................6
3.1.7. PS job offset on/off.........................................................................................................6
3.1.8. PCL job separate (Esc&l1T).........................................................................................6
APPENDIX E REFERENCE LIST OF FS-5050 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
1.
2.
INTRODUCTION
This manual covers the general specifications and the command reference list of the FS-5050 Finisher/Stapler
units, which are optionally installed onto the HL-3260 printer.
GENERAL SPECIFICATION
The Finisher/Stapler unit is an option for the HL-3260 printer.
Function
Description
Printed pages can be sorted or stapled.
Finisher/
Stapler
3.
COMMAND REFERENCE LIST
This section describes the specific commands as listed below used to support the functions of the
Finisher/Stapler unit.
1) PJL output tray
2) PCL output tray
3) PS output tray
4) PJL staple on/off
5) PS staple on/off
6) PJL job offset on/off
7) PS job offset on/off
8) PCL job separate
For the details on each command, refer to the following sections.
APPENDIX E REFERENCE LIST OF FS-5050 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.1. Commands Descriptions
3.1.1. PJL output tray
Format
@PJL SET/DEFAULT OUTBIN=TrayName
Parameter
TrayName*
· FINISHER:
Select the tray of the Finisher/Stapler unit
Default = ALLSTACKER
Explanation
·
·
·
This command selects the Finisher/Stapler unit.
This command is ignored when the Finisher/Stapler unit is not available.
The difference between the SET and DEFAULT selection and the effective period of this setting follow the
PJL specifications.
3.1.2. PCL output tray
Command
Esc&l#G (27)(38)(108)#(71) <1Bh><38h><6ch>#<47h>
Parameter
# denotes the output tray.
· 100: Select the Finisher/Stapler unit.
Default = 1
Explanation
·
·
·
This command selects the Finisher/Stapler unit.
This command is ignored when the Finisher/Stapler unit is not available.
The PJL OUTBIN command is ignored when this command is executed.
3.1.3. PS output tray
Command
<</BROutbinMode #>>setpagedevice
Parameter
#
· 3:
Select the Finisher/Stapler unit.
Default = 0
Explanation
·
·
This command selects the Finisher/Stapler unit.
This command is ignored when the Finisher/Stapler unit is not available.
<Examp le>
<</BROutbinMode 3>>setpagedevice
APPENDIX E REFERENCE LIST OF FS-5050 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.1.4. PJL staple on/off
Format
@PJL SET/DEFAULT STAPLE=StapleName
Parameter
StapleName*
· UPPER LEFT:
· UPPER RIGHT:
· LOWER LEFT:
· LOWER RIGHT:
· OFF:
Select the upper left of the Finisher/Stapler unit
Select the upper right of the Finisher/Stapler unit
Select the lower left of the Finisher/Stapler unit
Select the lower right of the Finisher/Stapler unit
Default = UPPER LEFT
Explanation
·
·
·
This command selects the staple.
This command is ignored when the Finisher/Stapler unit is not available.
The difference between the SET and DEFAULT selection and the effective period of this setting follow the
PJL specifications.
3.1.5. PS staple on/off
Command
<</BRStaple #>>setpagedevice
Parameter
#
· 0:
· 1:
· 2:
· 3:
· 4:
Select off of the Finisher/Stapler unit.
Select the upper left of the Finisher/Stapler unit.
Select the upper right of the Finisher/Stapler unit.
Select the lower left of the Finisher/Stapler unit.
Select the upper right of the Finisher/Stapler unit.
Default = 0
Explanation
·
·
This command selects the staple.
This command is ignored when the Finisher/Stapler unit is not available.
<Example>
<</BRStaple 0>>setpagedevice
APPENDIX E REFERENCE LIST OF FS-5050 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2001/10/02
3.1.6. PJL job offset on/off
Format
@PJL SET/DEFAULT JOBOFFSET=ON/OFF
Parameter
· ON:
Paper is ejected offset by each job.
Paper is ejected together.
· OFF:
Default = ON
Explanation
·
·
·
This command selects the job offset.
This command is ignored when the Finisher/Stapler unit is not available.
The difference between the SET and DEFAULT selection and the effective period of this setting follow the
PJL specifications.
3.1.7. PS job offset on/off
Command
Parameter
bool
· True:
Paper is ejected offset by each job.
Paper is ejected together.
· False:
Default = false
Explanation
·
·
This command selects the job off set.
This command is ignored when the Finisher/Stapler unit is not available.
<Example>
<<BRjoboffset true>>setpagedevice
3.1.8. PCL job separate (Esc&l1T)
Command
Esc&l1T (27)(38)(108)(49)(84) <1Bh><26h><6ch><31h><54h>
Explanation
·
·
This command separates the job.
This command is ignored when the Finisher/Stapler unit is not available.
APPENDIX E REFERENCE LIST OF FS-5050 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
|